MOTOROLA MC68HC908MR16

68HC08M6
HC08M68HC
8M68HC08M
MC68HC908MR32/D
REV 5
MC68HC908MR32
MC68HC908MR16
Advance Information
HCMOS
Microcontroller Unit
blank
MC68HC908MR32
MC68HC908MR16
Technical Summary
Motorola reserves the right to make changes without further notice to any products
herein. Motorola makes no warranty, representation or guarantee regarding the
suitability of its products for any particular purpose, nor does Motorola assume any
liability arising out of the application or use of any product or circuit, and specifically
disclaims any and all liability, including without limitation consequential or incidental
damages. "Typical" parameters which may be provided in Motorola data sheets and/or
specifications can and do vary in different applications and actual performance may
vary over time. All operating parameters, including "Typicals" must be validated for
each customer application by customer’s technical experts. Motorola does not convey
any license under its patent rights nor the rights of others. Motorola products are not
designed, intended, or authorized for use as components in systems intended for
surgical implant into the body, or other applications intended to support or sustain life,
or for any other application in which the failure of the Motorola product could create a
situation where personal injury or death may occur. Should Buyer purchase or use
Motorola products for any such unintended or unauthorized application, Buyer shall
indemnify and hold Motorola and its officers, employees, subsidiaries, affiliates, and
distributors harmless against all claims, costs, damages, and expenses, and
reasonable attorney fees arising out of, directly or indirectly, any claim of personal
injury or death associated with such unintended or unauthorized use, even if such claim
alleges that Motorola was negligent regarding the design or manufacture of the part.
Motorola, Inc. is an Equal Opportunity/Affirmative Action Employer.
Motorola and
are registered trademarks of Motorola, Inc.
DigitalDNA is a trademark of Motorola, Inc.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
© Motorola, Inc., 2001
Advance Information
3
Revision History
To provide the most up-to-date information, the revision of our
documents on the World Wide Web will be the most current. Your printed
copy may be an earlier revision. To verify you have the latest information
available, refer to:
http://www.motorola.com/semiconductors/
The following revision history table summarizes changes contained in
this document. For your convenience, the page number designators
have been linked to the appropriate location.
Revision History
Date
August,
2001
October,
2001
December,
2001
Revision
Level
Page
Number(s)
Figure 2-1. Memory Map — Added FLASH Block Protect Register
(FLBPR) at address location $FF7E
41
Figure A-1. MC68HC908MR16 Memory Map — Added FLASH Block
Protect Register (FLBPR) at address location $FF7E
388
19.4.3 Conversion Time — Reworked equations and text for clarity.
346
Figure 10-1. Monitor Mode Circuit — PTA7 and connecting circuitry
added
187
Table 10-2. Monitor Mode Signal Requirements and Options — Switch
locations added to column headings for clarity
189
Section 11. Timer Interface A (TIMA) — Timer discrepancies corrected
throughout this section.
199
Section 12. Timer Interface B (TIMB) — Timer discrepancies corrected
throughout this section.
225
3
4
5
Advance Information
4
Description
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Advance Information — MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32
List of Sections
Section 1. General Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
Section 2. Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
Section 3. Random-Access Memory (RAM) . . . . . . . . . . 55
Section 4. FLASH Memory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
Section 5. Configuration Register (CONFIG) . . . . . . . . . 67
Section 6. Central Processor Unit (CPU) . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Section 7. System Integration Module (SIM) . . . . . . . . . 89
Section 8. Clock Generator Module (CGM) . . . . . . . . . . 109
Section 9. Pulse-Width Modulator
for Motor Control (PWMMC) . . . . . . . . . . . 135
Section 10. Monitor ROM (MON) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185
Section 11. Timer Interface A (TIMA). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199
Section 12. Timer Interface B (TIMB). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225
Section 13. Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI) . . 249
Section 14. Serial Communications Interface
Module (SCI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279
Section 15. Input/Output (I/O) Ports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 309
Section 16. Computer Operating Properly (COP) . . . . 325
Section 17. External Interrupt (IRQ) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 331
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
List of Sections
Advance Information
5
List of Sections
Section 18. Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 337
Section 19. Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) . . . . . . 343
Section 20. Power-On Reset (POR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 359
Section 21. Break Module (BRK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 361
Section 22. Electrical Specifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 369
Section 23. Mechanical Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . 381
Section 24. Ordering Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 385
Appendix A. MC68HC908MR16 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 387
Advance Information
6
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
List of Sections
MOTOROLA
Advance Information — MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32
7DEOHRI&RQWHQWV
Section 1. General Description
1.1
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
1.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
1.3
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
1.4
MCU Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
1.5
Pin Assignments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
1.5.1
Power Supply Pins (VDD and VSS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35
1.5.2
Oscillator Pins (OSC1 and OSC2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35
1.5.3
External Reset Pin (RST) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
1.5.4
External Interrupt Pin (IRQ) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
1.5.5
CGM Power Supply Pins (VDDA and VSSA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
1.5.6
External Filter Capacitor Pin (CGMXFC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
1.5.7
Analog Power Supply Pins (VDDA and VSSA) . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
1.5.8
ADC Voltage Decoupling Capacitor Pin (VREFH) . . . . . . . . . 36
1.5.9
ADC Voltage Reference Low Pin (VREFL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
1.5.10 Port A Input/Output (I/O) Pins (PTA7–PTA0) . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
1.5.11 Port B I/O Pins (PTB7/ATD7–PTB0/ATD0) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
1.5.12 Port C I/O Pins (PTC6–PTC2
and PTC1/ATD9–PTC0/ATD8) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .37
1.5.13 Port D Input-Only Pins (PTD6/IS3–PTD4/IS1
and PTD3/FAULT4–PTD0/FAULT1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
1.5.14 PWM Pins (PWM6–PWM1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
1.5.15 PWM Ground Pin (PWMGND) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
1.5.16 Port E I/O Pins (PTE7/TCH3A–PTE3/TCLKA
and PTE2/TCH1B–PTE0/TCLKB). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
1.5.17 Port F I/O Pins (PTF5/TxD–PTF4/RxD
and PTF3/MISO–PTF0/SPSCK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Table of Contents
Advance Information
7
Table of Contents
Section 2. Memory Map
2.1
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
2.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
2.3
Unimplemented Memory Locations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
2.4
Reserved Memory Locations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
2.5
I/O Section . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
2.6
Monitor ROM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54
Section 3. Random-Access Memory (RAM)
3.1
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
3.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
3.3
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
Section 4. FLASH Memory
4.1
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
4.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
4.3
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
4.4
FLASH Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
4.5
FLASH Page Erase Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
4.6
FLASH Mass Erase Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
4.7
FLASH Program/Read Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
4.8
FLASH Block Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64
4.9
FLASH Block Protect Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
4.10
Wait Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
4.11
Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
Section 5. Configuration Register (CONFIG)
Advance Information
8
5.1
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
5.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
5.3
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
5.4
Configuration Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Table of Contents
MOTOROLA
Table of Contents
Section 6. Central Processor Unit (CPU)
6.1
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
6.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
6.3
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
6.4
CPU Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
6.4.1
Accumulator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
6.4.2
Index Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
6.4.3
Stack Pointer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
6.4.4
Program Counter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75
6.4.5
Condition Code Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
6.5
Arithmetic/Logic Unit (ALU) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
6.6
Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
6.6.1
Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .78
6.6.2
Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .78
6.7
CPU During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
6.8
Instruction Set Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79
6.9
Opcode Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
Section 7. System Integration Module (SIM)
7.1
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
7.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90
7.3
SIM Bus Clock Control and Generation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
7.3.1
Bus Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .93
7.3.2
Clock Startup from POR or LVI Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
7.3.3
Clocks in Wait Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
7.4
Reset and System Initialization. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
7.4.1
External Pin Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
7.4.2
Active Resets from Internal Sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
7.4.2.1
Power-On Reset (POR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
7.4.2.2
Computer Operating Properly (COP) Reset. . . . . . . . . . . 97
7.4.2.3
Illegal Opcode Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97
7.4.2.4
Illegal Address Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97
7.4.2.5
Forced Monitor Mode Entry Reset (MENRST). . . . . . . . . 98
7.4.2.6
Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI) Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .98
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Table of Contents
Advance Information
9
Table of Contents
7.5
SIM Counter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
7.5.1
SIM Counter During Power-On Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
7.5.2
SIM Counter and Reset States. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
7.6
Exception Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
7.6.1
Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
7.6.1.1
Hardware Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101
7.6.1.2
Software Interrupt (SWI) Instruction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
7.6.2
Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
7.7
Low-Power Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
7.7.1
Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .102
7.7.2
Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104
7.8
SIM Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104
7.8.1
SIM Break Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
7.8.2
SIM Reset Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
7.8.3
SIM Break Flag Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
Section 8. Clock Generator Module (CGM)
8.1
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
8.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
8.3
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
8.4
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
8.4.1
Crystal Oscillator Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
8.4.2
Phase-Locked Loop Circuit (PLL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
8.4.2.1
PLL Circuits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
8.4.2.2
Acquisition and Tracking Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .115
8.4.2.3
Manual and Automatic PLL Bandwidth Modes . . . . . . . 115
8.4.2.4
Programming the PLL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
8.4.2.5
Special Programming Exceptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
8.4.3
Base Clock Selector Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
8.4.4
CGM External Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
8.5
I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
8.5.1
Crystal Amplifier Input Pin (OSC1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .121
8.5.2
Crystal Amplifier Output Pin (OSC2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
8.5.3
External Filter Capacitor Pin (CGMXFC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
8.5.4
PLL Analog Power Pin (VDDA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
8.5.5
Oscillator Enable Signal (SIMOSCEN). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
Advance Information
10
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Table of Contents
MOTOROLA
Table of Contents
8.5.6
8.5.7
8.5.8
Crystal Output Frequency Signal (CGMXCLK) . . . . . . . . .122
CGM Base Clock Output (CGMOUT). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
CGM CPU Interrupt (CGMINT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
8.6
CGM Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
8.6.1
PLL Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
8.6.2
PLL Bandwidth Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
8.6.3
PLL Programming Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
8.7
Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
8.8
Wait Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
8.9
Acquisition/Lock Time Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
8.9.1
Acquisition/Lock Time Definitions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
8.9.2
Parametric Influences on Reaction Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . .132
8.9.3
Choosing a Filter Capacitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
8.9.4
Reaction Time Calculation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
Section 9. Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control
(PWMMC)
9.1
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
9.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136
9.3
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
9.4
Timebase . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
9.4.1
Resolution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .141
9.4.2
Prescaler . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
9.5
PWM Generators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
9.5.1
Load Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
9.5.2
PWM Data Overflow and Underflow Conditions. . . . . . . . .147
9.6
Output Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147
9.6.1
Selecting Six Independent PWMs
or Three Complementary PWM Pairs . . . . . . . . . . . . . .147
9.6.2
Dead-Time Insertion. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149
9.6.3
Top/Bottom Correction with Motor Phase
Current Polarity Sensing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153
9.6.4
Output Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157
9.6.5
PWM Output Port Control. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Table of Contents
Advance Information
11
Table of Contents
9.7
Fault Protection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
9.7.1
Fault Condition Input Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
9.7.1.1
Fault Pin Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .161
9.7.1.2
Automatic Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163
9.7.1.3
Manual Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164
9.7.2
Software Output Disable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
9.7.3
Output Port Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
9.8
Initialization and the PWMEN Bit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
9.9
PWM Operation in Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168
9.10 Control Logic Block. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .168
9.10.1 PWM Counter Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168
9.10.2 PWM Counter Modulo Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
9.10.3 PWMx Value Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170
9.10.4 PWM Control Register 1. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171
9.10.5 PWM Control Register 2. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173
9.10.6 Dead-Time Write-Once Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176
9.10.7 PWM Disable Mapping Write-Once Register . . . . . . . . . . . 176
9.10.8 Fault Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177
9.10.9 Fault Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
9.10.10 Fault Acknowledge Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180
9.10.11 PWM Output Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182
9.11 PWM Glossary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183
Section 10. Monitor ROM (MON)
10.1 Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185
10.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185
10.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186
10.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186
10.4.1 Entering Monitor Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .188
10.4.1.1
Normal Monitor Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188
10.4.1.2
Forced Monitor Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190
10.4.2 Data Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
10.4.3 Echoing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
10.4.4 Break Signal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192
10.4.5 Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .192
10.4.6 Baud Rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .196
10.5 Security. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .196
Advance Information
12
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Table of Contents
MOTOROLA
Table of Contents
Section 11. Timer Interface A (TIMA)
11.1
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199
11.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
11.3
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
11.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204
11.4.1 TIMA Counter Prescaler. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204
11.4.2 Input Capture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204
11.4.3 Output Compare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .205
11.4.3.1
Unbuffered Output Compare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206
11.4.3.2
Buffered Output Compare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .206
11.4.4 Pulse-Width Modulation (PWM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207
11.4.4.1
Unbuffered PWM Signal Generation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209
11.4.4.2
Buffered PWM Signal Generation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210
11.4.4.3
PWM Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211
11.5
Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212
11.6
Wait Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212
11.7 I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213
11.7.1 TIMA Clock Pin (PTE3/TCLKA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213
11.7.2 TIMA Channel I/O Pins
(PTE4/TCH0A–PTE7/TCH3A) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213
11.8 I/O Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214
11.8.1 TIMA Status and Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214
11.8.2 TIMA Counter Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216
11.8.3 TIMA Counter Modulo Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217
11.8.4 TIMA Channel Status and Control Registers . . . . . . . . . . . 217
11.8.5 TIMA Channel Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222
Section 12. Timer Interface B (TIMB)
12.1
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225
12.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226
12.3
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226
12.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226
12.4.1 TIMB Counter Prescaler. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227
12.4.2 Input Capture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Table of Contents
Advance Information
13
Table of Contents
12.4.3 Output Compare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .230
12.4.3.1
Unbuffered Output Compare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230
12.4.3.2
Buffered Output Compare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .231
12.4.4 Pulse-Width Modulation (PWM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232
12.4.4.1
Unbuffered PWM Signal Generation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233
12.4.4.2
Buffered PWM Signal Generation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234
12.4.4.3
PWM Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234
12.5
Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236
12.6
Wait Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236
12.7 I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236
12.7.1 TIMB Clock Pin (PTD4/ATD12) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237
12.7.2 TIMB Channel I/O Pins
(PTE1/TCH0B–PTE2/TCH1B) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237
12.8 I/O Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237
12.8.1 TIMB Status and Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238
12.8.2 TIMB Counter Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
12.8.3 TIMB Counter Modulo Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241
12.8.4 TIMB Channel Status and Control Registers . . . . . . . . . . . 242
12.8.5 TIMB Channel Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246
Section 13. Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
13.1
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249
13.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250
13.3
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250
13.4
Pin Name Conventions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250
13.5 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251
13.5.1 Master Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251
13.5.2 Slave Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254
13.6 Transmission Formats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255
13.6.1 Clock Phase and Polarity Controls. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .255
13.6.2 Transmission Format When CPHA = 0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255
13.6.3 Transmission Format When CPHA = 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257
13.6.4 Transmission Initiation Latency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258
Advance Information
14
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Table of Contents
MOTOROLA
Table of Contents
13.7 Error Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 260
13.7.1 Overflow Error . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 260
13.7.2 Mode Fault Error . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .262
13.8
Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264
13.9
Resetting the SPI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266
13.10 Queuing Transmission Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266
13.11 Low-Power Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268
13.12 I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268
13.12.1 MISO (Master In/Slave Out) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269
13.12.2 MOSI (Master Out/Slave In) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269
13.12.3 SPSCK (Serial Clock). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269
13.12.4 SS (Slave Select) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270
13.12.5 VSS (Clock Ground) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 271
13.13 I/O Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 271
13.13.1 SPI Control Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 272
13.13.2 SPI Status and Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274
13.13.3 SPI Data Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277
Section 14. Serial Communications Interface
Module (SCI)
14.1
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279
14.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280
14.3
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280
14.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281
14.4.1 Data Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283
14.4.2 Transmitter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .283
14.4.2.1
Character Length . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283
14.4.2.2
Character Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283
14.4.2.3
Break Characters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285
14.4.2.4
Idle Characters. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285
14.4.2.5
Inversion of Transmitted Output. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .286
14.4.2.6
Transmitter Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 286
14.4.3 Receiver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 286
14.4.3.1
Character Length . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 286
14.4.3.2
Character Reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 288
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Table of Contents
Advance Information
15
Table of Contents
14.4.3.3
14.4.3.4
14.4.3.5
14.4.3.6
14.4.3.7
Data Sampling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 288
Framing Errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 290
Receiver Wakeup. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 290
Receiver Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291
Error Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292
14.5
Wait Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292
14.6
SCI During Break Module Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293
14.7 I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293
14.7.1 PTE2/TxD (Transmit Data). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293
14.7.2 PTE1/RxD (Receive Data) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294
14.8 I/O Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294
14.8.1 SCI Control Register 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294
14.8.2 SCI Control Register 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 297
14.8.3 SCI Control Register 3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 300
14.8.4 SCI Status Register 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 301
14.8.5 SCI Status Register 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 305
14.8.6 SCI Data Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 306
14.8.7 SCI Baud Rate Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 306
Section 15. Input/Output (I/O) Ports
15.1
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 309
15.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 309
15.3 Port A . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 312
15.3.1 Port A Data Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 312
15.3.2 Data Direction Register A . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 312
15.4 Port B . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314
15.4.1 Port B Data Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314
15.4.2 Data Direction Register B. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314
15.5 Port C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316
15.5.1 Port C Data Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316
15.5.2 Data Direction Register C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316
15.6
Port D . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 318
15.7 Port E . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 319
15.7.1 Port E Data Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 319
15.7.2 Data Direction Register E . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 320
Advance Information
16
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Table of Contents
MOTOROLA
Table of Contents
15.8 Port F . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 321
15.8.1 Port F Data Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 321
15.8.2 Data Direction Register F . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 322
Section 16. Computer Operating Properly (COP)
16.1
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 325
16.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 325
16.3
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 326
16.4 I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 327
16.4.1 CGMXCLK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .327
16.4.2 COPCTL Write . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 327
16.4.3 Power-On Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .327
16.4.4 Internal Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328
16.4.5 Reset Vector Fetch. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328
16.4.6 COPD (COP Disable). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328
16.5
COP Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328
16.6
Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328
16.7
Monitor Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .329
16.8
Wait Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 329
16.9
Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 329
Section 17. External Interrupt (IRQ)
17.1
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 331
17.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 331
17.3
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 331
17.4
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 332
17.5
IRQ Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .335
17.6
IRQ Status and Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 336
Section 18. Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI)
18.1
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 337
18.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 337
18.3
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 337
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Table of Contents
Advance Information
17
Table of Contents
18.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 338
18.4.1 Polled LVI Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 339
18.4.2 Forced Reset Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 339
18.4.3 False Reset Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .339
18.4.4 LVI Trip Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 340
18.5
LVI Status and Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .340
18.6
LVI Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .341
18.7
Wait Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 341
18.8
Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 342
Section 19. Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
19.1
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 343
19.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 344
19.3
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 344
19.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 344
19.4.1 ADC Port I/O Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 345
19.4.2 Voltage Conversion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 346
19.4.3 Conversion Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .346
19.4.4 Continuous Conversion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 347
19.4.5 Result Justification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 347
19.4.6 Monotonicity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 348
19.5
Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 348
19.6
Wait Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 349
19.7 I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 349
19.7.1 ADC Analog Power Pin (VDDAD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 349
19.7.2 ADC Analog Ground Pin (VSSAD). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 349
19.7.3 ADC Voltage Reference Pin (VREFH) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 349
19.7.4 ADC Voltage Reference Low Pin (VREFL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 350
19.7.5 ADC Voltage In (ADVIN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 350
19.7.6 ADC External Connections. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 350
19.7.6.1
VREFH and VREFL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 350
19.7.6.2
ANx . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 350
19.7.6.3
Grounding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 351
19.8 I/O Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 351
19.8.1 ADC Status and Control Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 351
Advance Information
18
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Table of Contents
MOTOROLA
Table of Contents
19.8.2
19.8.3
19.8.4
ADC Data Register High . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 354
ADC Data Register Low . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 355
ADC Clock Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 356
Section 20. Power-On Reset (POR)
20.1
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 359
20.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 359
20.3
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 359
Section 21. Break Module (BRK)
21.1
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 361
21.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 361
21.3
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 362
21.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 362
21.4.1 Flag Protection During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 364
21.4.2 CPU During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .364
21.4.3 TIM1 and TIM2 During Break Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 364
21.4.4 COP During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .364
21.5 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 364
21.5.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .364
21.5.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .365
21.6 Break Module Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 365
21.6.1 Break Status and Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .365
21.6.2 Break Address Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 366
21.6.3 Break Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 367
21.6.4 Break Flag Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 368
Section 22. Electrical Specifications
22.1
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 369
22.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 369
22.3
Absolute Maximum Ratings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 370
22.4
Functional Operating Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 371
22.5
Thermal Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 371
22.6
DC Electrical Characteristics (VDD = 5.0 Vdc ± 10%) . . . . . . . 372
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Table of Contents
Advance Information
19
Table of Contents
22.7
FLASH Memory Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .373
22.8
Control Timing (VDD = 5.0 Vdc ± 10%) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 374
22.9
Serial Peripheral Interface Characteristics
(VDD = 5.0 Vdc ± 10%) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 375
22.10 TImer Interface Module Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 378
22.11 Clock Generation Module Component Specifications . . . . . . 378
22.12 CGM Operating Conditions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 378
22.13 CGM Acquisition/Lock Time Specifications
. . . . . . . . . . . . 379
22.14 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) Characteristics. . . . . . . . .380
Section 23. Mechanical Specifications
23.1
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 381
23.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 381
23.3
64-Pin Plastic Quad Flat Pack (QFP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .382
23.4
56-Pin Shrink Dual In-Line Package (SDIP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .383
Section 24. Ordering Information
24.1
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 385
24.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 385
24.3
Order Numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 385
Appendix A. MC68HC908MR16
Advance Information
20
A.1
Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 387
A.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 387
A.3
Memory Map. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 388
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Table of Contents
MOTOROLA
Advance Information — MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32
List of Figures
Figure
Title
1-1
1-2
1-3
1-4
MCU Block Diagram. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
64-Pin QFP Pin Assignments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .33
56-Pin SDIP Pin Assignments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
Power Supply Bypassing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
2-1
2-2
Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
Control, Status, and Data Registers Summary . . . . . . . . . .42
4-1
4-2
4-3
4-4
FLASH Control Register (FLCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
FLASH Programming Flowchart. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
FLASH Block Protect Register (FLBPR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
FLASH Block Protect Start Address. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
5-1
Configuration Register (CONFIG) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
6-1
6-2
6-3
6-4
6-5
6-6
CPU Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
Accumulator (A) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
Index Register (H:X). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
Stack Pointer (SP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
Program Counter (PC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75
Condition Code Register (CCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
7-1
7-2
7-3
7-4
7-5
7-6
7-7
7-8
7-9
SIM Block Diagram. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
CGM Clock Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
External Reset Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
Sources of Internal Reset. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
Internal Reset Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
POR Recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
Interrupt Entry. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
Interrupt Processing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
Interrupt Recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Page
List of Figures
Advance Information
21
List of Figures
Figure
Advance Information
22
Title
Page
7-10
7-11
7-12
7-13
7-14
7-15
7-16
Interrupt Recognition Example . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
Wait Mode Entry Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
Wait Recovery from Interrupt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .103
Wait Recovery from Internal Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .103
SIM Break Status Register (SBSR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104
SIM Reset Status Register (SRSR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .106
SIM Break Flag Control Register (SBFCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
8-1
8-2
8-3
8-4
8-5
8-6
8-7
CGM Block Diagram. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
CGM I/O Register Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .113
CGM External Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
CGM I/O Register Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .123
PLL Control Register (PCTL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .124
PLL Bandwidth Control Register (PBWC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
PLL Programming Register (PPG) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .128
9-1
9-2
9-3
9-4
9-5
9-6
9-7
9-8
9-9
9-10
9-11
9-12
9-13
9-14
9-15
9-16
9-17
9-18
9-19
9-20
9-21
9-22
PWM Module Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .137
Register Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
Center-Aligned PWM (Positive Polarity). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
Edge-Aligned PWM (Positive Polarity) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
Reload Frequency Change . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
PWM Interrupt Requests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
Center-Aligned PWM Value Loading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145
Center-Aligned Loading of Modulus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145
Edge-Aligned PWM Value Loading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .146
Edge-Aligned Modulus Loading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146
Complementary Pairing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148
Typical AC Motor Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148
Dead-Time Generators. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .150
Effects of Dead-Time Insertion. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151
Dead-Time at Duty Cycle Boundaries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152
Dead-Time and Small Pulse Widths. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152
Ideal Complementary Operation (Dead-Time = 0) . . . . . . . 154
Current Convention . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155
Top/Bottom Correction for PWMs 1 and 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
PWM Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157
PWM Output Control Register (PWMOUT) . . . . . . . . . . . . 158
Dead-Time Insertion During OUTCTL = 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
List of Figures
MOTOROLA
List of Figures
Figure
9-23
9-24
9-25
9-26
9-27
9-28
9-29
9-30
9-31
9-32
9-33
9-34
9-35
9-36
9-37
9-38
9-39
9-40
9-41
Title
9-42
9-43
9-44
9-45
9-46
9-47
Dead-Time Insertion During OUTCTL = 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
PWM Disable Mapping Write-Once Register (DISMAP) . . 161
PWM Disabling Scheme. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
PWM Disabling Decode Scheme . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163
PWM Disabling in Automatic Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .163
PWM Disabling in Manual Mode (Example 1) . . . . . . . . . . 165
PWM Disabling in Manual Mode (Example 2) . . . . . . . . . . 165
PWM Software Disable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
PWMEN and PWM Pins. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
PWM Counter Register High (PCNTH) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168
PWM Counter Register Low (PCNTL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168
PWM Counter Modulo Register High (PMODH) . . . . . . . . 169
PWM Counter Modulo Register Low (PMODL) . . . . . . . . .169
PWMx Value Registers High (PVALxH) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170
PWMx Value Registers Low (PVALxL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170
PWM Control Register 1 (PCTL1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171
PWM Control Register 2 (PCTL2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174
Dead-Time Write-Once Register (DEADTM) . . . . . . . . . . . 176
PWM Disable Mapping
Write-Once Register (DISMAP). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .176
Fault Control Register (FCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .177
Fault Status Register (FSR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
Fault Acknowledge Register (FTACK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180
PWM Output Control Register (PWMOUT) . . . . . . . . . . . . 182
PWM Clock Cycle and PWM Cycle Definitions . . . . . . . . .184
PWM Load Cycle/Frequency Definition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
10-1
10-2
10-3
10-4
10-5
10-6
Monitor Mode Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187
Monitor Data Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
Sample Monitor Waveforms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
Read Transaction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
Break Transaction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192
Monitor Mode Entry Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197
11-1
11-2
11-3
11-4
TIMA Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201
TIM I/O Register Summary. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202
PWM Period and Pulse Width . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208
TIMA Status and Control Register (TASC). . . . . . . . . . . . . 214
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Page
List of Figures
Advance Information
23
List of Figures
Figure
11-5
11-6
11-7
11-8
11-9
12-1
12-2
12-3
12-4
12-5
12-6
24
Page
TIMA Counter Registers (TACNTH and TACNTL) . . . . . . . 216
TIMA Counter Modulo Registers
(TAMODH and TAMODL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .217
TIMA Channel Status
and Control Registers (TASC0–TASC3) . . . . . . . . . . . . 218
CHxMAX Latency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221
TIMA Channel Registers (TACH0H/L–TACH3H/L) . . . . . . 222
12-8
12-9
TIMB Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227
TIMB I/O Register Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .228
PWM Period and Pulse Width . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232
TIMB Status and Control Register (TBSC). . . . . . . . . . . . . 238
TIMB Counter Registers (TBCNTH and TBCNTL) . . . . . . . 240
TIMB Counter Modulo Registers
(TBMODH and TBMODL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .241
TIMB Channel Status
and Control Registers (TBSC0–TBSC1) . . . . . . . . . . . . 242
CHxMAX Latency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246
TIMB Channel Registers (TBCH0H/L–TBCH1H/L) . . . . . . 246
13-1
13-2
13-3
13-4
13-5
13-6
13-7
13-8
13-9
13-10
13-11
13-12
13-13
13-14
13-15
SPI Module Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252
SPI I/O Register Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253
Full-Duplex Master-Slave Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253
Transmission Format (CPHA = 0) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256
CPHA/SS Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .256
Transmission Format (CPHA = 1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257
Transmission Start Delay (Master) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .259
Missed Read of Overflow Condition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261
Clearing SPRF When OVRF Interrupt Is Not Enabled . . . . 262
SPI Interrupt Request Generation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265
SPRF/SPTE CPU Interrupt Timing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .267
CPHA/SS Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .270
SPI Control Register (SPCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .272
SPI Status and Control Register (SPSCR). . . . . . . . . . . . . 274
SPI Data Register (SPDR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277
14-1
14-2
SCI Module Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281
SCI I/O Register Summary. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282
12-7
Advance Information
Title
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
List of Figures
MOTOROLA
List of Figures
Figure
Title
14-3
14-4
14-5
14-6
14-7
14-8
14-9
14-10
14-11
14-12
14-13
14-14
SCI Data Formats. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283
SCI Transmitter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284
SCI Receiver Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .287
Receiver Data Sampling. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 288
SCI Control Register 1 (SCC1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 295
SCI Control Register 2 (SCC2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 298
SCI Control Register 3 (SCC3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 300
SCI Status Register 1 (SCS1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 302
Flag Clearing Sequence. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 304
SCI Status Register 2 (SCS2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 305
SCI Data Register (SCDR). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 306
SCI Baud Rate Register (SCBR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 306
15-1
15-2
15-3
15-4
15-5
15-6
15-7
15-8
15-9
15-10
15-11
15-12
15-13
15-14
15-15
15-16
15-17
15-18
I/O Port Register Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 310
Port A Data Register (PTA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 312
Data Direction Register A (DDRA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .312
Port A I/O Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .313
Port B Data Register (PTB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314
Data Direction Register B (DDRB) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .314
Port B I/O Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .315
Port C Data Register (PTC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316
Data Direction Register C (DDRC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .316
Port C I/O Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .317
Port D Data Register (PTD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 318
Port D Input Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 318
Port E Data Register (PTE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 319
Data Direction Register E (DDRE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .320
Port E I/O Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .320
Port F Data Register (PTF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 321
Data Direction Register F (DDRF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 322
Port F I/O Circuit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .323
16-1
16-2
16-3
COP Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 326
COP I/O Register Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 326
COP Control Register (COPCTL). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328
17-1
17-2
IRQ Module Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 332
IRQ I/O Register Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 332
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Page
List of Figures
Advance Information
25
List of Figures
Figure
IRQ Interrupt Flowchart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 334
IRQ Status and Control Register (ISCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 336
18-1
18-2
18-3
LVI Module Block Diagram. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 338
LVI I/O Register Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 339
LVI Status and Control Register (LVISCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . 340
19-1
19-2
19-3
19-4
19-8
19-9
ADC Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 345
8-Bit Truncation Mode Error . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 348
ADC Status and Control Register (ADSCR). . . . . . . . . . . . 351
ADC Data Register High (ADRH)
Left Justified Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 354
ADC Data Register High (ADRH)
Right Justified Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 354
ADC Data Register Low (ADRL)
Left Justified Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 354
ADC Data Register Low (ADRL)
Right Justified Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 355
ADC Data Register Low (ADRL) 8-Bit Mode . . . . . . . . . . . 356
ADC Clock Register (ADCLK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 356
21-1
21-2
21-3
21-4
21-5
21-6
21-7
Break Module Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .363
I/O Register Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 363
Break Status and Control Register (BRKSCR) . . . . . . . . .365
Break Address Register High (BRKH) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 366
Break Address Register Low (BRKL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 366
SIM Break Status Register (SBSR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .367
SIM Break Flag Control Register (SBFCR) . . . . . . . . . . . . 368
22-1
22-2
SPI Master Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 376
SPI Slave Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .377
23-1
23-2
MC68HC908MR32FU . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 382
MC68HC908MR32B. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 383
A-1
MC68HC908MR16 Memory Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 388
19-6
19-7
26
Page
17-3
17-4
19-5
Advance Information
Title
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
List of Figures
MOTOROLA
Advance Information — MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32
List of Tables
Table
Title
2-1
Vector Addresses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .53
4-1
Examples of Protect Start Address. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
6-1
6-2
Instruction Set Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79
Opcode Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .87
7-1
7-2
Signal Name Conventions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
PIN Bit Set Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .94
8-1
8-2
Variable Definitions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
VCO Frequency Multiplier (N) Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
9-1
9-2
9-3
9-4
9-5
9-6
9-7
9-8
9-9
9-10
PWM Prescaler. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
PWM Reload Frequency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
PWM Data Overflow and Underflow Conditions . . . . . . . . . . 147
Current Sense Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154
Correction Methods . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155
OUTx Bits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158
Correction Methods . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172
PWM Reload Frequency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174
PWM Prescaler. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175
OUTx Bits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183
10-1
10-2
10-3
10-4
10-5
10-6
10-7
Mode Differences . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .188
Monitor Mode Signal Requirements and Options . . . . . . . . .189
READ (Read Memory) Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193
WRITE (Write Memory) Command. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193
IREAD (Indexed Read) Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194
IWRITE (Indexed Write) Command . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194
READSP (Read Stack Pointer) Command. . . . . . . . . . . . . .195
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Page
List of Tables
Advance Information
27
List of Tables
Table
Advance Information
28
Title
Page
10-8
10-9
RUN (Run User Program) Command. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
Monitor Baud Rate Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196
11-1
11-2
Prescaler Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216
Mode, Edge, and Level Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220
12-1
12-2
Prescaler Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239
Mode, Edge, and Level Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245
13-1
13-2
13-3
13-4
Pin Name Conventions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251
SPI Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264
SPI Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .271
SPI Master Baud Rate Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276
14-1
14-2
14-3
14-4
14-5
14-6
14-7
Start Bit Verification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289
Data Bit Recovery. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .289
Stop Bit Recovery. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .290
Character Format Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 297
SCI Baud Rate Prescaling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 307
SCI Baud Rate Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 307
SCI Baud Rate Selection Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .308
15-1
15-2
15-3
15-4
15-5
15-6
Port A Pin Functions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 313
Port B Pin Functions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 315
Port C Pin Functions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 317
Port D Pin Functions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 318
Port E Pin Functions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 321
Port F Pin Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 323
18-1
LVIOUT Bit Indication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 341
19-1
19-2
Mux Channel Select . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 353
ADC Clock Divide Ratio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 357
24-1
Order Numbers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 385
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
List of Tables
MOTOROLA
Advance Information — MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32
Section 1. General Description
1.1 Contents
1.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
1.3
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
1.4
MCU Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
1.5
Pin Assignments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33
1.5.1
Power Supply Pins (VDD and VSS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35
1.5.2
Oscillator Pins (OSC1 and OSC2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .35
1.5.3
External Reset Pin (RST) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
1.5.4
External Interrupt Pin (IRQ) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
1.5.5
CGM Power Supply Pins (VDDA and VSSA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
1.5.6
External Filter Capacitor Pin (CGMXFC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
1.5.7
Analog Power Supply Pins (VDDA and VSSA) . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
1.5.8
ADC Voltage Decoupling Capacitor Pin (VREFH) . . . . . . . . . 36
1.5.9
ADC Voltage Reference Low Pin (VREFL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
1.5.10 Port A Input/Output (I/O) Pins (PTA7–PTA0) . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
1.5.11 Port B I/O Pins (PTB7/ATD7–PTB0/ATD0) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
1.5.12 Port C I/O Pins (PTC6–PTC2
and PTC1/ATD9–PTC0/ATD8) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .37
1.5.13 Port D Input-Only Pins (PTD6/IS3–PTD4/IS1
and PTD3/FAULT4–PTD0/FAULT1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
1.5.14 PWM Pins (PWM6–PWM1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
1.5.15 PWM Ground Pin (PWMGND) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
1.5.16 Port E I/O Pins (PTE7/TCH3A–PTE3/TCLKA
and PTE2/TCH1B–PTE0/TCLKB). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
1.5.17 Port F I/O Pins (PTF5/TxD–PTF4/RxD
and PTF3/MISO–PTF0/SPSCK) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
General Description
Advance Information
29
General Description
1.2 Introduction
The MC68HC908MR32 is a member of the low-cost, high-performance
M68HC08 Family of 8-bit microcontroller units (MCUs). The M68HC08
Family is based on the customer-specified integrated circuit (CSIC)
design strategy. All MCUs in the family use the enhanced M68HC08
central processor unit (CPU08) and are available with a variety of
modules, memory sizes and types, and package types.
1.3 Features
Features of the MC68HC908MR32 include:
•
High-performance M68HC08 architecture
•
Fully upward-compatible object code with M6805, M146805, and
M68HC05 Families
•
8-MHz internal bus frequency
•
On-chip FLASH memory with in-circuit programming capabilities
of FLASH program memory:
MC68HC908MR32 — 32 Kbytes
MC68HC908MR16 — 16 Kbytes
•
On-chip programming firmware for use with host personal
computer
•
FLASH data security(1)
•
768 bytes of on-chip random-access memory (RAM)
•
12-bit, 6-channel center-aligned or edge-aligned pulse-width
modulator (PWMMC)
•
Serial peripheral interface module (SPI)
•
Serial communications interface module (SCI)
•
16-bit, 4-channel timer interface module (TIMA)
•
16-bit, 2-channel timer interface module (TIMB)
•
Clock generator module (CGM)
1. No security feature is absolutely secure. However, Motorola’s strategy is to make reading
or copying the FLASH difficult for unauthorized users.
Advance Information
30
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
General Description
MOTOROLA
General Description
MCU Block Diagram
•
Low-voltage inhibit (LVI) module with software selectable trip
points
•
10-bit, 10-channel analog-to-digital converter (ADC)
•
System protection features:
– Optional computer operating properly (COP) reset
– Low-voltage detection with optional reset
– Illegal opcode or address detection with optional reset
– Fault detection with optional PWM disabling
•
Available packages:
– 64-pin plastic quad flat pack (QFP)
– 56-pin shrink dual in-line package (SDIP)
•
Low-power design, fully static with wait mode
•
Master reset pin (RST) and power-on reset (POR)
•
Stop mode as an option
•
Break module (BRK) supports setting the in-circuit simulator (ICS)
single break point
Features of the CPU08 include:
•
Enhanced M68HC05 programming model
•
Extensive loop control functions
•
16 addressing modes (eight more than the M68HC05)
•
16-bit index register and stack pointer
•
Memory-to-memory data transfers
•
Fast 8 × 8 multiply instruction
•
Fast 16/8 divide instruction
•
Binary-coded decimal (BCD) instructions
•
Optimization for controller applications
•
C language support
1.4 MCU Block Diagram
Figure 1-1 shows the structure of the MC68HC908MR32.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
General Description
Advance Information
31
PTA
PTA7–PTA0
PTB
PTB7/ATD7
PTB6/ATD6
PTB5/ATD5
PTB4/ATD4
PTB3/ATD3
PTB2/ATD2
PTB1/ATD1
PTB0/ATD0
PTC
PTC6
PTC5
PTC4
PTC3
PTC2
PTC1/ATD9(1)
PTC0/ATD8
PTD
PTD6/IS3
PTD5/IS2
PTD4/IS1
PTD3/FAULT4
PTD2/FAULT3
PTD1/FAULT2
PTD0/FAULT1
PTE
CONTROL AND STATUS REGISTERS — 112 BYTES
DDRA
ARITHMETIC/LOGIC
UNIT
PTE7/TCH3A
PTE6/TCH2A
PTE5/TCH1A
PTE4/TCH0A
PTE3/TCLKA
PTE2/TCH1B(1)
PTE1/TCH0B(1)
PTE0/TCLKB(1)
LOW-VOLTAGE INHIBIT
MODULE
COMPUTER OPERATING PROPERLY
MODULE
DDRB
CPU
REGISTERS
USER FLASH — 32,256 BYTES
TIMER INTERFACE
MODULE A
USER RAM — 768 BYTES
MOTOROLA
CLOCK GENERATOR
MODULE
RST
SYSTEM INTEGRATION
MODULE
IRQ
IRQ
MODULE
VDDA
VSSA(3)
VREFL(3
VREFH
PWMGND
PWM6–PWM1
VSS
VDD
VDDA
VSSA
ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL CONVERTER
MODULE
PULSE-WIDTH MODULATOR
MODULE
DDRC
SERIAL PERIPHERAL INTERFACE
MODULE
POWER-ON RESET
MODULE
SINGLE BRKPT BREAK
MODULE
PTF5/TxD
PTF4/RxD
PTF3/MISO(1)
PTF2/MOSI(1)
PTF1/SS(1)
DDRE
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
General Description
OSC1
OSC2
CGMXFC
SERIAL COMMUNICATIONS INTERFACE
MODULE
DDRF
USER FLASH VECTOR SPACE — 46 BYTES
PTF
MONITOR ROM — 240 BYTES
TIMER INTERFACE
MODULE B
PTF0/SPSCK(1)
POWER
Notes:
1. These pins are not available in the 56-pin SDIP package.
2. This module is not available in the 56-pin SDIP package.
3. In the 56-pin SDIP package, these pins are bonded together.
Figure 1-1. MCU Block Diagram
General Description
Advance Information
32
INTERNAL BUS
M68HC08 CPU
General Description
Pin Assignments
1.5 Pin Assignments
PTB2/ATD2
RST
VDDA
CGMXFC
OSC1
OSC2
VSSA
PTA0
PTA1
PTA2
PTA3
PTA4
PTA5
PTA6
PTA7
PTB0/ATD0
PTB1/ATD1
Figure 1-2 shows the 64-pin QFP pin assignments and Figure 1-3
shows the 56-pin SDIP pin assignments.
IRQ
PTB3/ATD3
PTF5/TxD
PTB4/ATD4
PTF4/RxD
PTB5/ATD5
PTF3/MISO
PTB6/ATD6
PTF2/MOSI
PTB7/ATD7
PTF1/SS
PTC0/ATD8
PTF0/SPSCK
PTC1/ATD9
VSS
VDDA
VDD
VSSA
PTE7/TCH3A
VREFL
PTE6/TCH2A
VREFH
PTE5/TCH1A
PTC2
PTE4/TCH0A
PTC3
PTE3/TCLKA
PTC4
PTE2/TCH1B
PTE1/TCH0B
PWM6
PWM5
PWMGND
PWM4
PWM3
PWM2
PWM1
PTD6/IS3
PTD5/IS2
PTD4/IS1
PTD3/FAULT4
PTD2/FAULT3
PTD1/FAULT2
PTD0/FAULT1
PTC6
PTE0/TCLKB
PTC5
Figure 1-2. 64-Pin QFP Pin Assignments
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
General Description
Advance Information
33
General Description
PTA2
1
56
PTA1
PTA3
2
55
PTA0
PTA4
3
54
VSSA
PTA5
4
53
OSC2
PTA6
5
52
OSC1
PTA7
6
51
CGMXFC
PTB0/ATD0
7
50
VDDA
PTB1/ATD1
8
49
RST
PTB2/ATD2
9
48
IRQ
PTB3/ATD3
10
47
PTF5/TxD
PTB4/ATD4
11
46
PTF4/RxD
PTB5/ATD5
12
45
VSS
PTB6/ATD5
13
44
VDD
PTB7/ATD7
14
43
PTE7/TCH3A
PTC0/ATD8
15
42
PTE6/TCH2A
VDDAD
16
41
PTE5/TCH1A
VSSAD/V REFL
17
40
PTE4/TCH0A
VREFH
18
39
PTE3/TCLKA
PTC2
19
38
NC
PTC3
20
37
PWM6
PTC4
21
36
PWM5
PTC5
22
35
PWMGND
PTC6
23
34
PWM4
PTD0/FAULT1
24
33
PWM3
PTD1/FAULT2
25
32
PWM2
PTD2/FAULT3
26
31
PWM1
PTD3/FAULT4
27
30
PTD6/IS3
PTD4/IS1
28
29
PTD5/IS2
Note: PTC1, PTE0, PTE1, PTE2, PTF0, PTF1, PTF2, and PTF3 are removed from this package.
Figure 1-3. 56-Pin SDIP Pin Assignments
Advance Information
34
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
General Description
MOTOROLA
General Description
Pin Assignments
1.5.1 Power Supply Pins (VDD and VSS)
VDD and VSS are the power supply and ground pins. The MCU operates
from a single power supply.
Fast signal transitions on MCU pins place high, short-duration current
demands on the power supply. To prevent noise problems, take special
care to provide power supply bypassing at the MCU as Figure 1-4
shows. Place the C1 bypass capacitor as close to the MCU as possible.
Use a high-frequency-response ceramic capacitor for C1. C2 is an
optional bulk current bypass capacitor for use in applications that require
the port pins to source high-current levels.
MCU
VDD
VSS
C1
0.1 µF
+
C2
1–10 µF
VDD
Note: Component values shown represent typical applications.
Figure 1-4. Power Supply Bypassing
1.5.2 Oscillator Pins (OSC1 and OSC2)
The OSC1 and OSC2 pins are the connections for the on-chip oscillator
circuit. For more detailed information, see Section 8. Clock Generator
Module (CGM).
1.5.3 External Reset Pin (RST)
A logic 0 on the RST pin forces the MCU to a known startup state. RST
is bidirectional, allowing a reset of the entire system. It is driven low when
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
General Description
Advance Information
35
General Description
any internal reset source is asserted. See Section 7. System
Integration Module (SIM).
1.5.4 External Interrupt Pin (IRQ)
IRQ is an asynchronous external interrupt pin. See Section 17. External
Interrupt (IRQ).
1.5.5 CGM Power Supply Pins (VDDA and VSSA)
VDDA and VSSA are the power supply pins for the analog portion of the
clock generator module (CGM). Decoupling of these pins should be per
the digital supply. See Section 8. Clock Generator Module (CGM).
1.5.6 External Filter Capacitor Pin (CGMXFC)
CGMXFC is an external filter capacitor connection for the CGM. See
Section 8. Clock Generator Module (CGM).
1.5.7 Analog Power Supply Pins (VDDA and VSSA)
VDDAD and VSSA are the power supply pins for the analog-to-digital
converter. Decoupling of these pins should be per the digital supply. See
Section 19. Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC).
1.5.8 ADC Voltage Decoupling Capacitor Pin (VREFH)
VREFH is the power supply for setting the reference voltage. Connect the
VREFH pin to the same voltage potential as VDDAD. See Section 19.
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC).
1.5.9 ADC Voltage Reference Low Pin (VREFL)
VREFL is the lower reference supply for the ADC. Connect the VREFL pin
to the same voltage potential as VSSAD. See Section 19.
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC).
Advance Information
36
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
General Description
MOTOROLA
General Description
Pin Assignments
1.5.10 Port A Input/Output (I/O) Pins (PTA7–PTA0)
PTA7–PTA0 are general-purpose bidirectional input/output (I/O) port
pins. See Section 15. Input/Output (I/O) Ports.
1.5.11 Port B I/O Pins (PTB7/ATD7–PTB0/ATD0)
Port B is an 8-bit special function port that shares all eight pins with the
analog-to-digital converter (ADC). See Section 19. Analog-to-Digital
Converter (ADC) and Section 15. Input/Output (I/O) Ports.
1.5.12 Port C I/O Pins (PTC6–PTC2 and PTC1/ATD9–PTC0/ATD8)
PTC6–PTC2 are general-purpose bidirectional I/O port pins (see
Section 15. Input/Output (I/O) Ports). PTC1/ATD9–PTC0/ATD8 are
special function port pins that are shared with the analog-to-digital
converter (ADC). See Section 19. Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
and Section 15. Input/Output (I/O) Ports.
1.5.13 Port D Input-Only Pins (PTD6/IS3–PTD4/IS1 and PTD3/FAULT4–PTD0/FAULT1)
PTD6/IS3–PTD4/IS1 are special function input-only port pins that also
serve as current sensing pins for the pulse-width modulator module
(PWMMC). PTD3/FAULT4–PTD0/FAULT1 are special function port pins
that also serve as fault pins for the PWMMC. See Section 9.
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC) and Section 15.
Input/Output (I/O) Ports.
1.5.14 PWM Pins (PWM6–PWM1)
PWM6–PWM1 are dedicated pins used for the outputs of the
pulse-width modulator module (PWMMC). These are high-current sink
pins. See Section 9. Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control
(PWMMC) and Section 22. Electrical Specifications.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
General Description
Advance Information
37
General Description
1.5.15 PWM Ground Pin (PWMGND)
PWMGND is the ground pin for the pulse-width modulator module
(PWMMC). This dedicated ground pin is used as the ground for the six
high-current PWM pins. See Section 9. Pulse-Width Modulator for
Motor Control (PWMMC).
1.5.16 Port E I/O Pins (PTE7/TCH3A–PTE3/TCLKA and PTE2/TCH1B–PTE0/TCLKB)
Port E is an 8-bit special function port that shares its pins with the two
timer interface modules (TIMA and TIMB). See Section 11. Timer
Interface A (TIMA), Section 12. Timer Interface B (TIMB), and
Section 15. Input/Output (I/O) Ports.
1.5.17 Port F I/O Pins (PTF5/TxD–PTF4/RxD and PTF3/MISO–PTF0/SPSCK)
Port F is a 6-bit special function port that shares two of its pins with the
serial communications interface module (SCI) and four of its pins with
the serial peripheral interface module (SPI). See Section 13. Serial
Peripheral Interface Module (SPI), Section 14. Serial
Communications Interface Module (SCI), and Section 15.
Input/Output (I/O) Ports.
Advance Information
38
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
General Description
MOTOROLA
Advance Information — MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32
Section 2. Memory Map
2.1 Contents
2.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
2.3
Unimplemented Memory Locations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
2.4
Reserved Memory Locations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
2.5
I/O Section . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
2.6
Monitor ROM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .54
2.2 Introduction
The central processor unit (CPU08) can address 64 Kbytes of memory
space. The memory map, shown in Figure 2-1, includes:
•
32 Kbytes of FLASH
•
768 bytes of random-access memory (RAM)
•
46 bytes of user-defined vectors
•
240 bytes of monitor read-only memory (ROM)
2.3 Unimplemented Memory Locations
Some addresses are unimplemented. Accessing an unimplemented
address can cause an illegal address reset. In the memory map and in
the input/output (I/O) register summary, unimplemented addresses are
shaded.
Some I/O bits are read only; the write function is unimplemented. Writing
to a read-only I/O bit has no effect on microcontroller unit (MCU)
operation. In register figures, the write function of read-only bits is
shaded.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Memory Map
Advance Information
39
Memory Map
Similarly, some I/O bits are write only; the read function is
unimplemented. Reading of write-only I/O bits has no effect on MCU
operation. In register figures, the read function of write-only bits is
shaded.
2.4 Reserved Memory Locations
Some addresses are reserved. Writing to a reserved address can
have unpredictable effects on MCU operation. In the memory map,
Figure 2-1, and in the I/O register summary, Figure 2-2, reserved
addresses are marked with the word reserved.
Some I/O bits are reserved. Writing to a reserved bit can have
unpredictable effects on MCU operation. In register figures, reserved
bits are marked with the letter R.
2.5 I/O Section
Addresses $0000–$005F, shown in Figure 2-2, contain most of the
control, status, and data registers. Additional I/O registers have these
addresses:
Advance Information
40
•
$FE00, SIM break status register (SBSR)
•
$FE01, SIM reset status register (SRSR)
•
$FE03, SIM break flag control register (SBFCR)
•
$FE07, FLASH control register (FLCR)
•
$FE0C, Break address register high (BRKH)
•
$FE0D, Break address register low (BRKL)
•
$FE0E, Break status and control register (BRKSCR)
•
$FE0F, LVI status and control register (LVISCR)
•
$FF7E, FLASH block protect register (FLBPR)
•
$FFFF, COP control register (COPCTL)
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Memory Map
MOTOROLA
Memory Map
I/O Section
$0000
↓
$005F
I/O REGISTERS — 96 BYTES
$0060
↓
$035F
RAM — 768 BYTES
$0360
↓
$7FFF
UNIMPLEMENTED — 31,904 BYTES
$8000
↓
$FDFF
FLASH — 32,256 BYTES
$FE00
SIM BREAK STATUS REGISTER (SBSR)
$FE01
SIM RESET STATUS REGISTER (SRSR)
$FE02
RESERVED
$FE03
SIM BREAK FLAG CONTROL REGISTER (SBFCR)
$FE04
RESERVED
$FE05
RESERVED
$FE06
RESERVED
$FE07
RESERVED
$FE08
FLASH CONTROL REGISTER (FLCR)
$FE09
UNIMPLEMENTED
$FE0A
UNIMPLEMENTED
$FE0B
UNIMPLEMENTED
$FE0C
SIM BREAK ADDRESS REGISTER HIGH (BRKH)
$FE0D
SIM BREAK ADDRESS REGISTER LOW (BRKL)
$FE0E
SIM BREAK FLAG CONTROL REGISTER (SBFCR)
$FE0F
LVI STATUS AND CONTROL REGISTER (LVISCR)
$FE10
↓
$FEFF
MONITOR ROM — 240 BYTES
$FF00
↓
$FF7D
UNIMPLEMENTED — 126 BYTES
$FF7E
FLASH BLOCK PROTECT REGISTER (FLBPR)
$FF7F
↓
$FFD1
UNIMPLEMENTED — 83 BYTES
$FFD2
↓
$FFFF
VECTORS — 46 BYTES
Figure 2-1. Memory Map
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Memory Map
Advance Information
41
Memory Map
Addr.
Register Name
Read:
Port A Data Register
PTA7
(PTA) Write:
See page 312.
Reset:
$0000
Read:
Port B Data Register
PTB7
(PTB) Write:
See page 314.
Reset:
$0001
Read:
Port C Data Register
(PTC) Write:
See page 316.
Reset:
$0002
Read:
Port D Data Register
(PTD) Write:
See page 318.
Reset:
$0003
$0004
$0005
$0006
Bit 7
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
PTA6
PTA5
PTA4
PTA3
PTA2
PTA1
PTA0
PTB2
PTB1
PTB0
PTC2
PTC1
PTC0
Unaffected by reset
PTB6
PTB5
PTB4
PTB3
Unaffected by reset
0
PTC6
PTC5
PTC4
PTC3
R
Unaffected by reset
0
PTD6
PTD5
PTD4
PTD3
PTD2
PTD1
PTD0
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Unaffected by reset
Read:
Data Direction Register A
DDRA7
(DDRA) Write:
See page 312.
Reset:
0
Read:
Data Direction Register B
DDRB7
(DDRB) Write:
See page 314.
Reset:
0
Read:
Data Direction Register C
(DDRC) Write:
See page 316.
Reset:
6
DDRA6
DDRA5
DDRA4
DDRA3
DDRA2
DDRA1
DDRA0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
DDRB6
DDRB5
DDRB4
DDRB3
DDRB2
DDRB1
DDRB0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
DDRC6
DDRC5
DDRC4
DDRC3
DDRC2
DDRC1
DDRC0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
PTE2
PTE1
PTE0
PTF2
PTF1
PTF0
0
R
0
$0007
Unimplemented
Read:
Port E Data Register
PTE7
(PTE) Write:
See page 319.
Reset:
$0008
$0009
U = Unaffected
PTE6
PTE5
PTE4
PTE3
Unaffected by reset
Read:
Port F Data Register
(PTF) Write:
See page 321.
Reset:
0
0
R
R
X = Indeterminate
R
PTF5
PTF4
PTF3
Unaffected by reset
= Reserved
Bold
= Buffered
= Unimplemented
Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers Summary (Sheet 1 of 11)
Advance Information
42
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Memory Map
MOTOROLA
Memory Map
I/O Section
Addr.
Register Name
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
$000A
Unimplemented
$000B
Unimplemented
$000C
$000D
$000E
$000F
$0010
$0011
$0012
Read:
Data Direction Register E
DDRE7
(DDRE) Write:
See page 320.
Reset:
0
Read:
Data Direction Register F
(DDRF) Write:
See page 322.
Reset:
Read:
TIMA Status/Control Register
(TASC) Write:
See page 214.
Reset:
2
1
Bit 0
DDRE6
DDRE5
DDRE4
DDRE3
DDRE2
DDRE1
DDRE0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
DDRF5
DDRF4
DDRF3
DDRF2
DDRF1
DDRF0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
PS2
PS1
PS0
TRST
R
0
0
R
R
TOF
TOIE
TSTOP
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
Read: Bit 15
TIMA Counter Register High
(TACNTH) Write:
R
See page 216.
Reset:
0
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
TIMA Counter Register Low
(TACNTL) Write:
See page 216.
Reset:
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
CH0IE
MS0B
MS0A
ELS0B
ELS0A
TOV0
CH0MAX
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bold
= Buffered
Read:
TIMA Counter Modulo
Bit 15
Register High (TAMODH) Write:
See page 217.
Reset:
1
Read:
TIMA Counter Modulo
Register Low (TAMODL) Write:
See page 217.
Reset:
Read: CH0F
TIMA Channel 0 Status/Control
0
$0013
Register (TASC0) Write:
See page 218.
Reset:
0
U = Unaffected
X = Indeterminate
R
= Reserved
= Unimplemented
Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers Summary (Sheet 2 of 11)
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Memory Map
Advance Information
43
Memory Map
Addr.
Register Name
Bit 7
Read:
TIMA Channel 0 Register High
Bit 15
$0014
(TACH0H) Write:
See page 222.
Reset:
Read:
TIMA Channel 0 Register Low
$0015
(TACH0L) Write:
See page 222.
Reset:
Bit 7
Read:
TIMA Channel 1 Register High
Bit 15
$0017
(TACH1H) Write:
See page 222.
Reset:
Bit 7
Read:
TIMA Channel 2 Register High
Bit 15
$001A
(TACH2H) Write:
See page 222.
Reset:
Bit 7
X = Indeterminate
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Indeterminate after reset
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
0
CH1IE
MS1A
ELS1B
ELS1A
TOV1
CH1MAX
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Indeterminate after reset
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
CH2IE
MS2B
MS2A
ELS2B
ELS2A
TOV2
CH2MAX
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Indeterminate after reset
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Indeterminate after reset
Read: CH3F
TIMA Channel 3 Status/Control
0
$001C
Register (TASC3) Write:
See page 218.
Reset:
0
U = Unaffected
4
Indeterminate after reset
Read: CH2F
TIMA Channel 2 Status/Control
0
$0019
Register (TASC2) Write:
See page 218.
Reset:
0
Read:
TIMA Channel 2 Register Low
$001B
(TACH2L) Write:
See page 222.
Reset:
5
Indeterminate after reset
Read: CH1F
TIMA Channel 1 Status/Control
0
$0016
Register (TASC1) Write:
See page 222.
Reset:
0
Read:
TIMA Channel 1 Register Low
$0018
(TACH1L) Write:
See page 222.
Reset:
6
R
0
CH3IE
MS3A
ELS3B
ELS3A
TOV3
CH3MAX
0
0
0
0
0
Bold
= Buffered
R
0
0
= Reserved
= Unimplemented
Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers Summary (Sheet 3 of 11)
Advance Information
44
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Memory Map
MOTOROLA
Memory Map
I/O Section
Addr.
Register Name
Bit 7
Read:
TIMA Channel 3 Register High
Bit 15
$001D
(TACH3H) Write:
See page 222.
Reset:
Read:
TIMA Channel 3 Register Low
$001E
(TACH3L) Write:
See page 222.
Reset:
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Indeterminate after reset
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Read:
PWM Control Register 1
(PCTL1) Write:
See page 171.
Reset:
$0020
Read:
Fault Acknowledge Register
(FTACK) Write:
See page 180.
Reset:
$0025
U = Unaffected
LVIRST
LVIPWR
STOPE
COPD
0
1
1
0
0
PWMINT
PWMF
ISENS1
ISENS0
LDOK
PWMEN
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
IPOL1
IPOL2
IPOL3
PRSC1
PRSC0
0
0
0
0
0
0
FINT3
FMODE3
FINT2
FMODE2
FINT1
FMODE1
0
0
0
0
0
0
FFLAG4
FPIN3
FFLAG3
FPIN2
FFLAG2
FPIN1
FFLAG1
0
U
0
U
0
U
0
0
DT6
DT5
DT4
DT3
DT2
DT1
Read: FPIN4
Fault Status Register
(FSR) Write:
See page 179.
Reset:
U
$0023
INDEP
DISY
0
LDFQ0
0
Read:
Fault Control Register
FINT4 FMODE4
(FCR) Write:
See page 177.
Reset:
0
0
$0022
Bit 3
DISX
Read:
PWM Control Register 2
LDFQ1
(PCTL2) Write:
See page 174.
Reset:
0
$0021
Bit 4
Indeterminate after reset
Read:
Configuration Register
EDGE BOTNEG TOPNEG
(CONFIG) Write:
See page 68.
Reset:
0
0
0
$001F
$0024
6
0
FTACK4
0
Read:
PWM Output Control
Register (PWMOUT) Write:
See page 182.
Reset:
0
X = Indeterminate
R
FTACK3
FTACK2
FTACK1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
OUTCTL
OUT6
OUT5
OUT4
OUT3
OUT2
OUT1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bold
= Buffered
0
= Reserved
= Unimplemented
Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers Summary (Sheet 4 of 11)
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Memory Map
Advance Information
45
Memory Map
Addr.
$0026
$0027
Register Name
Read:
PWM Counter Register High
(PCNTH) Write:
See page 168.
Reset:
Read:
PWM Counter Register Low
(PCNTL) Write:
See page 168.
Reset:
Read:
PWM Counter Modulo Register
$0028
High (PMODH) Write:
See page 169.
Reset:
Read:
PWM Counter Modulo Register
$0029
Low (PMODL) Write:
See page 169.
Reset:
$002A
$002B
$002C
$002D
$002E
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
X
X
X
X
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bold
= Buffered
Read:
PWM 1 Value Register High
Bit 15
(PVAL1H) Write:
See page 170.
Reset:
0
Read:
PWM 1 Value Register Low
(PVAL1L) Write:
See page 170.
Reset:
Read:
PWM 2 Value Register High
Bit 15
(PVAL2H) Write:
See page 170.
Reset:
0
Read:
PWM 2 Value Register Low
(PVAL2L) Write:
See page 170.
Reset:
Read:
PWM 3 Value Register High
Bit 15
(PVAL3H) Write:
See page 170.
Reset:
0
U = Unaffected
X = Indeterminate
R
= Reserved
= Unimplemented
Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers Summary (Sheet 5 of 11)
Advance Information
46
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Memory Map
MOTOROLA
Memory Map
I/O Section
Addr.
$002F
$0030
$0031
$0032
$0033
$0034
$0035
Register Name
Read:
PWM 3 Value Register Low
(PVAL3L) Write:
See page 170.
Reset:
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Bold
= Buffered
Read:
PWM 4 Value Register High
Bit 15
(PVAL4H) Write:
See page 170.
Reset:
0
Read:
PWM 4 Value Register Low
(PVAL4L) Write:
See page 170.
Reset:
Read:
PWM 5 Value Register High
Bit 15
(PMVAL5H) Write:
See page 170.
Reset:
0
Read:
PWM 5 Value Register Low
(PVAL5L) Write:
See page 170.
Reset:
Read:
PWM 6 Value Register High
Bit 15
(PVAL6H) Write:
See page 170.
Reset:
0
Read:
PWM 6 Value Register Low
(PMVAL6L) Write:
See page 170.
Reset:
Read:
Dead-Time Write-Once
Register (DEADTM) Write:
See page 176.
Reset:
$0036
$0037
Bit 7
Read:
PWM Disable Mapping
Write-Once Register Write:
(DISMAP) See page 161.
Reset:
U = Unaffected
X = Indeterminate
R
= Reserved
= Unimplemented
Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers Summary (Sheet 6 of 11)
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Memory Map
Advance Information
47
Memory Map
Addr.
Register Name
$0038
Read:
SCI Control Register 1
LOOPS
(SCC1) Write:
See page 295.
Reset:
0
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
ENSCI
TXINV
M
WAKE
ILTY
PEN
PTY
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
TCIE
SCRIE
ILIE
TE
RE
RWU
SBK
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
ORIE
NEIE
FEIE
PEIE
R
R
U
0
0
0
0
0
0
TC
SCRF
IDLE
OR
NF
FE
PE
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
BKF
RPF
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
SCI Data Register
(SCDR) Write:
See page 306.
Reset:
R7
R6
R5
R4
R3
R2
R1
R0
T7
T6
T5
T4
T3
T2
T1
T0
Read:
SCI Baud Rate Register
(SCBR) Write:
See page 306.
Reset:
0
SCR2
SCR1
SCR0
0
0
0
Read:
SCI Control Register 2
SCTIE
(SCC2) Write:
See page 298.
Reset:
0
$0039
Read:
SCI Control Register 3
(SCC3) Write:
See page 300.
Reset:
$003A
R8
T8
R
U
Read: SCTE
SCI Status Register 1
(SCS1) Write:
R
See page 302.
Reset:
1
$003B
Read:
SCI Status Register 2
(SCS2) Write:
See page 305.
Reset:
$003C
$003D
$003E
$003F
Bit 7
Read:
IRQ Status/Control Register
(ISCR) Write:
See page 336.
Reset:
Unaffected by reset
U = Unaffected
X = Indeterminate
0
SCP1
SCP0
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R
0
0
IRQF
IMASK1 MODE1
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
AIEN
ADCO
ADCH4
ADCH3
ADCH2
ADCH1
ADCH0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
Bold
= Buffered
Read: COCO/
ADC Status and Control
Register (ADSCR) Write: IDMAS
See page 351.
Reset:
0
$0040
0
R
= Reserved
ACK1
= Unimplemented
Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers Summary (Sheet 7 of 11)
Advance Information
48
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Memory Map
MOTOROLA
Memory Map
I/O Section
Addr.
$0041
$0042
Register Name
Read:
ADC Data Register High
Right Justified Mode(ADRH) Write:
See page 354.
Reset:
Read:
ADC Data Register Low
Right Justified Mode (ADRL) Write:
See page 355.
Reset:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
AD9
AD8
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Unaffected by reset
AD7
AD6
AD5
AD4
AD3
AD2
AD1
AD0
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
MODE0
0
Unaffected by reset
Read:
ADC Clock Register
ADIV2
(ADCLK) Write:
See page 356.
Reset:
0
$0043
0
ADIV1
Read:
SPI Data Register
(SPDR) Write:
See page 277.
Reset:
$0046
MODE1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
R
SPMSTR
CPOL
CPHA
SPWOM
SPE
SPTIE
0
1
0
1
0
0
0
OVRF
MODF
SPTE
MODFEN
SPR1
SPR0
R
R
R
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
R7
R6
R5
R4
R3
R2
R1
R0
T7
T6
T5
T4
T3
T2
T1
T0
PS2
PS1
PS0
Read: SPRF
SPI Status and Control
R
Register (SPSCR) Write:
See page 274.
Reset:
0
$0045
ADICLK
R
Read:
SPI Control Register
SPRIE
(SPCR) Write:
See page 272.
Reset:
0
$0044
ADIV0
ERRIE
Unaffected by reset
$0047
Unimplemented
↓
$0050
$0051
$0052
Unimplemented
Read:
TIMB Status/Control Register
(TBSC) Write:
See page 238.
Reset:
TOF
TOIE
0
0
Read: Bit 15
TIMB Counter Register High
(TBCNTH) Write:
R
See page 240.
Reset:
0
U = Unaffected
X = Indeterminate
R
0
0
TRST
R
TSTOP
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bold
= Buffered
= Reserved
= Unimplemented
Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers Summary (Sheet 8 of 11)
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Memory Map
Advance Information
49
Memory Map
Addr.
$0053
Register Name
Read:
TIMB Counter Register Low
(TBCNTL) Write:
See page 240.
Reset:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
CH0IE
MS0B
MS0A
ELS0B
ELS0A
TOV0
CH0MAX
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Read:
TIMB Counter Modulo Register
Bit 15
$0054
High (TBMODH) Write:
See page 241.
Reset:
1
Read:
TIMB Counter Modulo Register
$0055
Low (TBMODL) Write:
See page 241.
Reset:
Read: CH0F
TIMB Channel 0 Status/Control
0
$0056
Register Write:
(TBSC0) See page 242.
Reset:
0
Read:
TIMB Channel 0 Register High
Bit 15
$0057
(TBCH0H) Write:
See page 246.
Reset:
Read:
TIMB Channel 0 Register Low
$0058
(TBCH0L) Write:
See page 246.
Reset:
Bit 7
Read:
TIMB Channel 1 Register High
Bit 15
$005A
(TBCH1H) Write:
See page 246.
Reset:
U = Unaffected
X = Indeterminate
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Indeterminate after reset
Read: CH1F
TIMB Channel 1 Status/Control
0
$0059
Register Write:
(TBSC1) See page 242.
Reset:
0
Read:
TIMB Channel 1 Register Low
$005B
(TBCH1L) Write:
See page 246.
Reset:
Indeterminate after reset
Bit 7
0
CH1IE
MS1A
ELS1B
ELS1A
TOV1
CH1MAX
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Indeterminate after reset
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Indeterminate after reset
R
= Reserved
Bold
= Buffered
= Unimplemented
Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers Summary (Sheet 9 of 11)
Advance Information
50
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Memory Map
MOTOROLA
Memory Map
I/O Section
Addr.
Register Name
$005C
$005D
$005E
Bit 7
6
Read:
PLL Control Register
PLLIE
(PCTL) Write:
See page 124.
Reset:
0
PLLF
Read:
PLL Bandwidth Control
AUTO
Register (PBWC) Write:
See page 126.
Reset:
0
LOCK
Read:
PLL Programming Register
MUL7
(PPG) Write:
See page 128.
Reset:
0
5
4
PLLON
BCS
R
0
1
0
ACQ
XLD
R
$FE01
1
Bit 0
1
1
1
1
R
R
R
R
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
MUL6
MUL5
MUL4
VRS7
VRS6
VRS5
VRS4
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
R
BW
R
Unimplemented
Read:
SIM Break Status Register
(SBSR) Write:
See page 104.
Reset:
Read:
SIM Reset Status Register
(SRSR) Write:
See page 106.
Reset:
R
R
R
PIN
COP
ILOP
ILAD
MENRST
LVI
0
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
HVEN
MASS
ERASE
PGM
$FE08
FLASH Control Register Read:
(FLCR)
Write:
See page 59.
Reset:
0
0
Read:
Break Address Register High
Bit 15
(BRKH) Write:
See page 366.
Reset:
0
X = Indeterminate
R
POR
$FE03
U = Unaffected
R
0
Read:
SIM Break Flag Control
BCFE
Register (SBFCR) Write:
See page 107.
Reset:
0
$FE0C
2
0
$005F
$FE00
3
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bold
= Buffered
= Reserved
= Unimplemented
Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers Summary (Sheet 10 of 11)
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Memory Map
Advance Information
51
Memory Map
Addr.
$FE0D
$FE0E
Register Name
Read:
Break Address Register Low
(BRKL) Write:
See page 366.
Reset:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R
R
R
R
R
Read:
Break Status and Control
BRKE
Register (BRKSCR) Write:
See page 365.
Reset:
0
Read: LVIOUT
LVI Status and Control
Register (LVISCR) Write:
R
See page 340.
Reset:
0
$FE0F
Read:
FLASH Block Protect Register
BPR7
$FF7E
(FLBPR) Write:
See page 65.
Reset:
0
BRKA
0
0
TRPSEL
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
BPR6
BPR5
BPR4
BPR3
BPR2
BPR1
BPR0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
COP Control Register
(COPCTL) Write:
See page 328.
Reset:
$FFFF
U = Unaffected
X = Indeterminate
Low byte of reset vector
Clear COP counter
Unaffected by reset
R
= Reserved
Bold
= Buffered
= Unimplemented
Figure 2-2. Control, Status, and Data Registers Summary (Sheet 11 of 11)
Advance Information
52
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Memory Map
MOTOROLA
Memory Map
I/O Section
Table 2-1 is a list of vector locations.
Table 2-1. Vector Addresses
Priority
Low
Address
Vector
$FFD2
SCI transmit vector (high)
$FFD3
SCI transmit vector (low)
$FFD4
SCI receive vector (high)
$FFD5
SCI receive vector (low)
$FFD6
SCI error vector (high)
$FFD7
SCI error vector (low)
$FFD8
SPI transmit vector (high)(1)
$FFD9
SPI transmit vector (low)(1)
$FFDA
SPI receive vector (high)(1)
$FFDB
SPI receive vector (low)(1)
$FFDC
A/D vector (high)
$FFDD
A/D vector (low)
$FFDE
TIM B overflow vector (high)
$FFDF
TIM B overflow vector (low)
$FFE0
TIM B channel 1 vector (high)
$FFE1
TIM B channel 1 vector (low)
$FFE2
TIM B channel 0 vector (high)
$FFE3
TIM B channel 0 vector (low)
$FFE4
TIM A overflow vector (high)
$FFE5
TIM A overflow vector (low)
$FFE6
TIM A channel 3 vector (high)
$FFE7
TIM A channel 3 vector (low)
$FFE8
TIM A channel 2 vector (high)
$FFE9
TIM A channel 2 vector (low)
$FFEA
TIM A channel 1 vector (high)
$FFEB
TIM A channel 1 vector (low)
$FFEC
TIM A channel 0 vector (high)
$FFED
TIM A channel 0 vector (low)
1. The SPI module is not available in the 56-pin SDIP package.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Memory Map
Advance Information
53
Memory Map
Table 2-1. Vector Addresses (Continued)
High
Priority
Address
Vector
$FFEE
PWMMC vector (high)
$FFEF
PWMMC vector (low)
$FFF0
FAULT 4 (high)
$FFF1
FAULT 4 (low)
$FFF2
FAULT 3 (high)
$FFF3
FAULT 3 (low)
$FFF4
FAULT 2 (high)
$FFF5
FAULT 2 (low)
$FFF6
FAULT 1 (high)
$FFF7
FAULT 1 (low)
$FFF8
PLL vector (high)
$FFF9
PLL vector (low)
$FFFA
IRQ vector (high)
$FFFB
IRQ vector (low)
$FFFC
SWI vector (high)
$FFFD
SWI vector (low)
$FFFE
Reset vector (high)
$FFFF
Reset vector (low)
2.6 Monitor ROM
The 240 bytes at addresses $FE10–$FEFF are reserved ROM
addresses that contain the instructions for the monitor functions. See
Section 10. Monitor ROM (MON).
Advance Information
54
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Memory Map
MOTOROLA
Advance Information — MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32
Section 3. Random-Access Memory (RAM)
3.1 Contents
3.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
3.3
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55
3.2 Introduction
This section describes the 768 bytes of random-access memory (RAM).
3.3 Functional Description
Addresses $0060–$035F are RAM locations. The location of the stack
RAM is programmable. The 16-bit stack pointer allows the stack to be
anywhere in the 64-Kbyte memory space.
NOTE:
For correct operation, the stack pointer must point only to RAM
locations.
Within page zero are 160 bytes of RAM. Because the location of the
stack RAM is programmable, all page zero RAM locations can be used
for input/output (I/O) control and user data or code. When the stack
pointer is moved from its reset location at $00FF, direct addressing
mode instructions can access efficiently all page zero RAM locations.
Page zero RAM, therefore, provides ideal locations for frequently
accessed global variables.
Before processing an interrupt, the central processor unit (CPU) uses
five bytes of the stack to save the contents of the CPU registers.
NOTE:
For M68HC05 and M1468HC05 compatibility, the H register is not
stacked.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Random-Access Memory (RAM)
Advance Information
55
Random-Access Memory (RAM)
During a subroutine call, the CPU uses two bytes of the stack to store
the return address. The stack pointer decrements during pushes and
increments during pulls.
NOTE:
Advance Information
56
Be careful when using nested subroutines. The CPU may overwrite data
in the RAM during a subroutine or during the interrupt stacking
operation.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Random-Access Memory (RAM)
MOTOROLA
Advance Information — MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32
Section 4. FLASH Memory
4.1 Contents
4.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
4.3
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
4.4
FLASH Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
4.5
FLASH Page Erase Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
4.6
FLASH Mass Erase Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
4.7
FLASH Program/Read Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
4.8
FLASH Block Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64
4.9
FLASH Block Protect Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
4.10
Wait Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
4.11
Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
4.2 Introduction
This section describes the operation of the embedded FLASH memory.
This memory can be read, programmed, and erased from a single
external supply. The program and erase operations are enabled through
the use of an internal charge pump.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
FLASH Memory
Advance Information
57
FLASH Memory
4.3 Functional Description
The FLASH memory is an array of 32,256 bytes with an additional
46 bytes of user vectors and one byte of block protection.
NOTE:
An erased bit reads as a logic 1 and a programmed bit reads as a logic 0.
Program and erase operations are facilitated through control bits in a
memory mapped register. Details for these operations appear later in
this section.
Memory in the FLASH array is organized into two rows per page. The
page size is 128 bytes per page. The minimum erase page size is
128 bytes. Programming is performed on a row basis, 64 bytes at a time.
The address ranges for the user memory and vectors are:
•
$8000–$FDFF, user memory
•
$FF7E, block protect register (FLBPR)
•
$FE08, FLASH control register (FLCR)
•
$FFDC–$FFFF, reserved for user-defined interrupt and reset
vectors
Programming tools are available from Motorola. Contact a local Motorola
representative for more information.
NOTE:
A security feature prevents viewing of the FLASH contents.(1)
1. No security feature is absolutely secure. However, Motorola’s strategy is to make reading
or copying the FLASH difficult for unauthorized users.
Advance Information
58
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
FLASH Memory
MOTOROLA
FLASH Memory
FLASH Control Register
4.4 FLASH Control Register
The FLASH control register (FLCR) controls FLASH program and erase
operations.
Address:
Read:
$FE08
Bit 7
6
5
4
0
0
0
0
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
0
3
2
1
Bit 0
HVEN
MASS
ERASE
PGM
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 4-1. FLASH Control Register (FLCR)
HVEN — High-Voltage Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables the charge pump to drive high voltages for
program and erase operations in the array. HVEN can only be set if
either PGM = 1 or ERASE = 1 and the proper sequence for program
or erase is followed.
1 = High voltage enabled to array and charge pump on
0 = High voltage disabled to array and charge pump off
MASS — Mass Erase Control Bit
Setting this read/write bit configures the 32-Kbyte FLASH array for
mass erase operation.
1 = MASS erase operation selected
0 = MASS erase operation unselected
ERASE — Erase Control Bit
This read/write bit configures the memory for erase operation.
ERASE is interlocked with the PGM bit such that both bits cannot be
equal to 1 or set to 1 at the same time.
1 = Erase operation selected
0 = Erase operation unselected
PGM — Program Control Bit
This read/write bit configures the memory for program operation.
PGM is interlocked with the ERASE bit such that both bits cannot be
equal to 1 or set to 1 at the same time.
1 = Program operation selected
0 = Program operation unselected
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
FLASH Memory
Advance Information
59
FLASH Memory
4.5 FLASH Page Erase Operation
Use this step-by-step procedure to erase a page (128 bytes) of FLASH
memory to read as logic 1:
1. Set the ERASE bit, and clear the MASS bit in the FLASH control
register.
2. Read the FLASH block protect register.
3. Write any data to any FLASH address within the page address
range desired.
4. Wait for a time, tNVS, minimum of 10 µs.
5. Set the HVEN bit.
6. Wait for a time, tErase, minimum of 1 ms.
7. Clear the ERASE bit.
8. Wait for a time, tNVH, minimum of 5 µs.
9. Clear the HVEN bit.
10. After a time, tRCV (typically 1 µs), the memory can be accessed
again in read mode.
NOTE:
Advance Information
60
While these operations must be performed in the order shown, other
unrelated operations may occur between the steps.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
FLASH Memory
MOTOROLA
FLASH Memory
FLASH Mass Erase Operation
4.6 FLASH Mass Erase Operation
Use this step-by-step procedure to erase the entire FLASH memory to
read as logic 1:
1. Set both the ERASE bit and the MASS bit in the FLASH control
register.
2. Read from the FLASH block protect register.
3. Write any data to any FLASH address(2) within the FLASH
memory address range.
4. Wait for a time, tNVS, minimum of 10 µs.
5. Set the HVEN bit.
6. Wait for a time, tMErase, minimum of 4 ms.
7. Clear the ERASE bit.
8. Wait for a time, tNVHL, minimum of 100 µs.
9. Clear the HVEN bit.
10. After a time, tRCV (minimum of 1 µs), the memory can be accessed
again in read mode.
NOTE:
Programming and erasing of FLASH locations cannot be performed by
code being executed from the FLASH memory. While these operations
must be performed in the order shown, other unrelated operations may
occur between the steps.
2. In monitor mode, when security sequence fails (see Section 10. Monitor ROM (MON)),
write to the FLASH block protect register instead of any FLASH address.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
FLASH Memory
Advance Information
61
FLASH Memory
4.7 FLASH Program/Read Operation
Programming of the FLASH memory is done on a row basis. A row
consists of 64 consecutive bytes starting from addresses $XX00,
$XX40, $0080 and $XXC0.
Use this step-by-step procedure to program a row of FLASH memory
(Figure 4-2 provides a flowchart representation):
1. Set the PGM bit. This configures the memory for program
operation and enables the latching of address and data for
programming.
2. Read from the FLASH block protect register.
3. Write any data to any FLASH address within the row address
range desired.
4. Wait for a time, tNVS, minimum of 10 µs.
5. Set the HVEN bit.
6. Wait for a time, tPGS, minimum of 5 µs.
7. Write data to the FLASH address to be programmed.
8. Wait for a time, tPROG, minimum of 30 µs.
9. Repeat step 7 and 8 until all the bytes within the row are
programmed.
10. Clear the PGM bit.
11. Wait for a time, tNVH, minimum of 5 µs.
12. Clear the HVEN bit.
13. After a time, tRCV (minimum of 1 µs), the memory can be accessed
in read mode again.
This program sequence is repeated throughout the memory until all data
is programmed.
NOTE:
Advance Information
62
The time between each FLASH address change, or the time between
the last FLASH address programmed to clearing of the PGM bit, must
not exceed the maximum programming time, tPROG.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
FLASH Memory
MOTOROLA
FLASH Memory
FLASH Program/Read Operation
ALGORITHM FOR PROGRAMMING
A ROW (64 BYTES) OF FLASH MEMORY
1
SET PGM BIT
2
READ THE FLASH BLOCK PROTECT REGISTER
3
WRITE ANY DATA TO ANY FLASH ADDRESS
WITHIN THE ROW ADDRESS RANGE DESIRED
4
WAIT FOR A TIME, tNVS
5
SET HVEN BIT
6
WAIT FOR A TIME, tPGS
7
WRITE DATA TO THE FLASH ADDRESS
TO BE PROGRAMMED
8
WAIT FOR A TIME, tPROG
COMPLETED
PROGRAMMING
THIS ROW?
YES
NO
10
11
CLEAR PGM BIT
WAIT FOR A TIME, tNVH
Note:
The time between each FLASH address change (step 7 to step 7), or
the time between the last FLASH address programmed
to clearing PGM bit (step 7 to step 10)
must not exceed the maximum programming
time, tPROG max.
12
13
This row program algorithm assumes the row/s
to be programmed are initially erased.
CLEAR HVEN BIT
WAIT FOR A TIME, tRCV
END OF PROGRAMMING
Figure 4-2. FLASH Programming Flowchart
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
FLASH Memory
Advance Information
63
FLASH Memory
NOTE:
Programming and erasing of FLASH locations cannot be performed by
code being executed from the FLASH memory. While these operations
must be performed in the order shown, other unrelated operations may
occur between the steps. Do not exceed tPROG maximum. See
Section 22. Electrical Specifications.
4.8 FLASH Block Protection
Due to the ability of the on-board charge pump to erase and program the
FLASH memory in the target application, provision is made for protecting
a block of memory from unintentional erase or program operations due
to system malfunction. This protection is done by using a FLASH block
protect register (FLBPR).
The FLBPR determines the range of the FLASH memory which is to be
protected. The range of the protected area starts from a location defined
by FLBPR and ends at the bottom of the FLASH memory ($FFFF). When
the memory is protected, the HVEN bit cannot be set in either ERASE or
PROGRAM operations.
NOTE:
In performing a program or erase operation, the FLASH block protect
register must be read after setting the PGM or ERASE bit and before
asserting the HVEN bit
When the FLBPR is programmed with all 0s, the entire memory is
protected from being programmed and erased. When all the bits are
erased (all 1s), the entire memory is accessible for program and erase.
When bits within the FLBPR are programmed, they lock a block of
memory, whose address ranges are shown in 4.9 FLASH Block Protect
Register. Once the FLBPR is programmed with a value other than $FF,
any erase or program of the FLBPR or the protected block of FLASH
memory is prohibited. The FLBPR itself can be erased or programmed
only with an external voltage, VTST, present on the IRQ pin. This voltage
also allows entry from reset into the monitor mode.
Advance Information
64
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
FLASH Memory
MOTOROLA
FLASH Memory
FLASH Block Protect Register
4.9 FLASH Block Protect Register
The FLASH block protect register (FLBPR) is implemented as a byte
within the FLASH memory, and therefore can be written only during a
programming sequence of the FLASH memory. The value in this register
determines the starting location of the protected range within the FLASH
memory.
Address:
$FF7E
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
BPR7
BPR6
BPR5
BPR4
BPR3
BPR2
BPR1
BPR0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
U = Unaffected by reset. Initial value from factory is 1.
Write to this register by a programming sequence to the FLASH memory.
Figure 4-3. FLASH Block Protect Register (FLBPR)
BPR[7:0] — FLASH Block Protect Bits
These eight bits represent bits [14:7] of a 16-bit memory address.
Bit 15 is logic 1 and bits [6:0] are logic 0s.
The resultant 16-bit address is used for specifying the start address
of the FLASH memory for block protection. The FLASH is protected
from this start address to the end of FLASH memory at $FFFF. With
this mechanism, the protect start address can be XX00 and XX80
(128 bytes page boundaries) within the FLASH memory.
16-BIT MEMORY ADDRESS
START ADDRESS OF FLASH
BLOCK PROTECT
1
FLBPR VALUE
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Figure 4-4. FLASH Block Protect Start Address
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
FLASH Memory
Advance Information
65
FLASH Memory
Refer to Table 4-1 for examples of the protect start address.
Table 4-1. Examples of Protect Start Address
BPR[7:0]
Start of Address of Protect Range
$00
The entire FLASH memory is protected.
$01 (0000 0001)
$8080 (1000 0000 1000 0000)
$02 (0000 0010)
$8100 (1000 0001 0000 0000)
and so on...
$FE (1111 1110)
$FF00 (1111 1111 0000 0000)
$FF
The entire FLASH memory is not protected.
Note: The end address of the protected range is always $FFFF.
4.10 Wait Mode
Putting the MCU into wait mode while the FLASH is in read mode does
not affect the operation of the FLASH memory directly, but there will not
be any memory activity since the CPU is inactive.
The WAIT instruction should not be executed while performing a
program or erase operation on the FLASH. Otherwise, the operation will
discontinue, and the FLASH will be on standby mode.
4.11 Stop Mode
Putting the MCU into stop mode while the FLASH is in read mode does
not affect the operation of the FLASH memory directly, but there will not
be any memory activity since the CPU is inactive.
The STOP instruction should not be executed while performing a
program or erase operation on the FLASH, otherwise the operation will
discontinue, and the FLASH will be on standby mode
NOTE:
Advance Information
66
Standby mode is the power-saving mode of the FLASH module in which
all internal control signals to the FLASH are inactive and the current
consumption of the FLASH is at a minimum.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
FLASH Memory
MOTOROLA
Advance Information — MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32
Section 5. Configuration Register (CONFIG)
5.1 Contents
5.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
5.3
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
5.4
Configuration Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
5.2 Introduction
This section describes the configuration register (CONFIG). This register
contains bits that configure these options:
•
Resets caused by the low-voltage inhibit (LVI) module
•
Power to the LVI module
•
Computer operating properly (COP) module
•
Top-side pulse-width modulator (PWM) polarity
•
Bottom-side PWM polarity
•
Edge-aligned versus center-aligned PWMs
•
Six independent PWMs versus three complementary PWM pairs
5.3 Functional Description
The configuration register (CONFIG) is used in the initialization of
various options. The configuration register can be written once after
each reset. All of the configuration register bits are cleared during reset.
Since the various options affect the operation of the microcontroller unit
(MCU), it is recommended that this register be written immediately after
reset. The configuration register is located at $001F and may be read at
anytime.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Configuration Register (CONFIG)
Advance Information
67
Configuration Register (CONFIG)
NOTE:
On a FLASH device, the options are one-time writeable by the user after
each reset. The registers are not in the FLASH memory but are special
registers containing one-time writeable latches after each reset. Upon a
reset, the configuration register defaults to predetermined settings as
shown in Figure 5-1.
If the LVI module and the LVI reset signal are enabled, a reset occurs
when VDD falls to a voltage, VLVRx, and remains at or below that level for
at least nine consecutive central processor unit (CPU) cycles. Once an
LVI reset occurs, the MCU remains in reset until VDD rises to a voltage,
VLVRX.
5.4 Configuration Register
Address:
$001F
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
INDEP
LVIRST
LVIPWR
STOPE
COPD
0
1
1
0
0
Read:
EDGE
BOTNEG TOPNEG
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
Figure 5-1. Configuration Register (CONFIG)
EDGE — Edge-Align Enable Bit
EDGE determines if the motor control PWM will operate in
edge-aligned mode or center-aligned mode. See Section 9.
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC).
1 = Edge-aligned mode enabled
0 = Center-aligned mode enabled
BOTNEG — Bottom-Side PWM Polarity Bit
BOTNEG determines if the bottom-side PWMs will have positive or
negative polarity. See Section 9. Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor
Control (PWMMC).
1 = Negative polarity
0 = Positive polarity
Advance Information
68
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Configuration Register (CONFIG)
MOTOROLA
Configuration Register (CONFIG)
Configuration Register
TOPNEG — Top-Side PWM Polarity Bit
TOPNEG determines if the top-side PWMs will have positive or
negative polarity. See Section 9. Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor
Control (PWMMC).
1 = Negative polarity
0 = Positive polarity
INDEP — Independent Mode Enable Bit
INDEP determines if the motor control PWMs will be six independent
PWMs or three complementary PWM pairs. See Section 9.
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC).
1 = Six independent PWMs
0 = Three complementary PWM pairs
LVIRST — LVI Reset Enable Bit
LVIRST enables the reset signal from the LVI module. See
Section 18. Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI).
1 = LVI module resets enabled
0 = LVI module resets disabled
LVIPWR — LVI Power Enable Bit
LVIPWR enables the LVI module. See Section 18. Low-Voltage
Inhibit (LVI).
1 = LVI module power enabled
0 = LVI module power disabled
STOPE — Stop Enable Bit
Writing a 0 or a 1 to bit 1 has no effect on MCU operation. Bit 1
operates the same as the other bits within this write-once register
operate.
1 = STOP mode enabled
0 = STOP mode disabled
COPD — COP Disable Bit
COPD disables the COP module. See Section 16. Computer
Operating Properly (COP).
1 = COP module disabled
0 = COP module enabled
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Configuration Register (CONFIG)
Advance Information
69
Configuration Register (CONFIG)
Advance Information
70
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Configuration Register (CONFIG)
MOTOROLA
Advance Information — MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32
Section 6. Central Processor Unit (CPU)
6.1 Contents
6.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
6.3
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
6.4
CPU Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
6.4.1
Accumulator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
6.4.2
Index Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
6.4.3
Stack Pointer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
6.4.4
Program Counter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .75
6.4.5
Condition Code Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
6.5
Arithmetic/Logic Unit (ALU) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
6.6
Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
6.6.1
Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .78
6.6.2
Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .78
6.7
CPU During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
6.8
Instruction Set Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79
6.9
Opcode Map . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
6.2 Introduction
This section describes the central processor unit (CPU08, version A).
The M68HC08 CPU is an enhanced and fully object-code-compatible
version of the M68HC05 CPU. The CPU08 Reference Manual, Motorola
document order number CPU08RM/AD, contains a description of the
CPU instruction set, addressing modes, and architecture.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Advance Information
71
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
6.3 Features
Features of the CPU08 include:
•
Fully upward, object-code compatibility with M68HC05 Family
•
16-bit stack pointer with stack manipulation instructions
•
16-bit index register with X-register manipulation instructions
•
8-MHz CPU internal bus frequency
•
64-Kbyte program/data memory space
•
16 addressing modes
•
Memory-to-memory data moves without using accumulator
•
Fast 8-bit by 8-bit multiply and 16-bit by 8-bit divide instructions
•
Enhanced binary-coded decimal (BCD) data handling
•
Modular architecture with expandable internal bus definition for
extension of addressing range beyond 64 Kbytes
•
Low-power wait mode
6.4 CPU Registers
Figure 6-1 shows the five CPU registers. CPU registers are not part of
the memory map.
0
7
ACCUMULATOR (A)
0
15
H
X
INDEX REGISTER (H:X)
0
15
STACK POINTER (SP)
0
15
PROGRAM COUNTER (PC)
7
0
V 1 1 H I N Z C CONDITION CODE REGISTER (CCR)
CARRY/BORROW FLAG
ZERO FLAG
NEGATIVE FLAG
INTERRUPT MASK
HALF-CARRY FLAG
TWO’S COMPLEMENT OVERFLOW FLAG
Figure 6-1. CPU Registers
Advance Information
72
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
MOTOROLA
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
CPU Registers
6.4.1 Accumulator
The accumulator is a general-purpose 8-bit register. The CPU uses the
accumulator to hold operands and the results of arithmetic/logic
operations.
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Unaffected by reset
Figure 6-2. Accumulator (A)
6.4.2 Index Register
The 16-bit index register allows indexed addressing of a 64-Kbyte
memory space. H is the upper byte of the index register, and X is the
lower byte. H:X is the concatenated 16-bit index register.
In the indexed addressing modes, the CPU uses the contents of the
index register to determine the conditional address of the operand.
Bit
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Read:
Write:
Reset:
X = Indeterminate
Figure 6-3. Index Register (H:X)
The index register can serve also as a temporary data storage location.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Advance Information
73
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
6.4.3 Stack Pointer
The stack pointer (SP) is a 16-bit register that contains the address of
the next location on the stack. During a reset, the stack pointer is preset
to $00FF. The reset stack pointer (RSP) instruction sets the least
significant byte to $FF and does not affect the most significant byte. The
stack pointer decrements as data is pushed onto the stack and
increments as data is pulled from the stack.
In the stack pointer 8-bit offset and 16-bit offset addressing modes, the
stack pointer can function as an index register to access data on the
stack. The CPU uses the contents of the stack pointer to determine the
conditional address of the operand.
Bit
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Figure 6-4. Stack Pointer (SP)
NOTE:
Advance Information
74
The location of the stack is arbitrary and may be relocated anywhere in
RAM. Moving the SP out of page zero ($0000–$00FF) frees direct
address (page zero) space. For correct operation, the stack pointer must
point only to RAM locations.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
MOTOROLA
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
CPU Registers
6.4.4 Program Counter
The program counter (PC) is a 16-bit register that contains the address
of the next instruction or operand to be fetched.
Normally, the program counter automatically increments to the next
sequential memory location every time an instruction or operand is
fetched. Jump, branch, and interrupt operations load the program
counter with an address other than that of the next sequential location.
During reset, the program counter is loaded with the reset vector
address located at $FFFE and $FFFF. The vector address is the
address of the first instruction to be executed after exiting the reset state.
Bit
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
Bit
0
1
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Loaded with vector from $FFFE and $FFFF
Figure 6-5. Program Counter (PC)
6.4.5 Condition Code Register
The 8-bit condition code register (CCR) contains the interrupt mask and
five flags that indicate the results of the instruction just executed. Bits 6
and 5 are set permanently to logic 1. The functions of the condition code
register are described here.
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
V
1
1
H
I
N
Z
C
X
1
1
X
1
X
X
X
Read:
Write:
Reset:
X = Indeterminate
Figure 6-6. Condition Code Register (CCR)
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Advance Information
75
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
V — Overflow Flag
The CPU sets the overflow flag when a two's complement overflow
occurs. The signed branch instructions BGT, BGE, BLE, and BLT use
the overflow flag.
1 = Overflow
0 = No overflow
H — Half-Carry Flag
The CPU sets the half-carry flag when a carry occurs between
accumulator bits 3 and 4 during an ADD or ADC operation. The
half-carry flag is required for binary-coded decimal (BCD) arithmetic
operations. The decimal adjust A (DAA) instruction uses the states of
the H and C flags to determine the appropriate correction factor.
1 = Carry between bits 3 and 4
0 = No carry between bits 3 and 4
I — Interrupt Mask Bit
When the interrupt mask is set, all maskable CPU interrupts are
disabled. CPU interrupts are enabled when the interrupt mask is
cleared. When a CPU interrupt occurs, the interrupt mask is set
automatically after the CPU registers are saved on the stack, but
before the interrupt vector is fetched.
1 = Interrupts disabled
0 = Interrupts enabled
NOTE:
To maintain M6805 compatibility, the upper byte of the index register (H)
is not stacked automatically. If the interrupt service routine modifies H,
then the user must stack and unstack H using the push H onto stack
(PSHH) and pull H from stack (PULH) instructions.
After the I bit is cleared, the highest-priority interrupt request is
serviced first.
A return-from-interrupt (RTI) instruction pulls the CPU registers from
the stack and restores the interrupt mask from the stack. After any
reset, the interrupt mask is set and can be cleared only by the clear
interrupt mask software instruction (CLI).
Advance Information
76
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
MOTOROLA
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Arithmetic/Logic Unit (ALU)
N — Negative Flag
The CPU sets the negative flag when an arithmetic operation, logic
operation, or data manipulation produces a negative result, setting
bit 7 of the result.
1 = Negative result
0 = Non-negative result
Z — Zero Flag
The CPU sets the zero flag when an arithmetic operation, logic
operation, or data manipulation produces a result of $00.
1 = Zero result
0 = Non-zero result
C — Carry/Borrow Flag
The CPU sets the carry/borrow flag when an addition operation
produces a carry out of bit 7 of the accumulator or when a subtraction
operation requires a borrow. Some instructions — such as bit test and
branch, shift, and rotate — also clear or set the carry/borrow flag.
1 = Carry out of bit 7
0 = No carry out of bit 7
6.5 Arithmetic/Logic Unit (ALU)
The ALU performs the arithmetic and logic operations defined by the
instruction set.
Refer to the CPU08 Reference Manual, Motorola document order
number CPU08RM/AD, for a description of the instructions and
addressing modes and more detail about CPU architecture.
6.6 Low-Power Modes
The WAIT and STOP instructions put the MCU in low power-consumption
standby modes.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Advance Information
77
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
6.6.1 Wait Mode
The WAIT instruction:
•
Clears the interrupt mask (I bit) in the condition code register,
enabling interrupts. After exit from wait mode by interrupt, the I bit
remains clear. After exit by reset, the I bit is set.
•
Disables the CPU clock
6.6.2 Stop Mode
The STOP instruction:
•
Clears the interrupt mask (I bit) in the condition code register,
enabling external interrupts. After exit from stop mode by external
interrupt, the I bit remains clear. After exit by reset, the I bit is set.
•
Disables the CPU clock
After exiting stop mode, the CPU clock begins running after the oscillator
stabilization delay.
6.7 CPU During Break Interrupts
If a break module is present on the MCU, the CPU starts a break
interrupt by:
•
Loading the instruction register with the software interrupt (SWI)
instruction
•
Loading the program counter with $FFFC:$FFFD or with
$FEFC:$FEFD in monitor mode
The break interrupt begins after completion of the CPU instruction in
progress. If the break address register match occurs on the last cycle of
a CPU instruction, the break interrupt begins immediately.
A return-from-interrupt instruction (RTI) in the break routine ends the
break interrupt and returns the MCU to normal operation if the break
interrupt has been deasserted.
Advance Information
78
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
MOTOROLA
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Instruction Set Summary
6.8 Instruction Set Summary
Table 6-1 provides a summary of the M68HC08 instruction set..
V H I N Z C
ADC #opr
ADC opr
ADC opr
ADC opr,X
ADC opr,X
ADC ,X
ADC opr,SP
ADC opr,SP
A ← (A) + (M) + (C)
Add with Carry
–
IMM
DIR
EXT
IX2
IX1
IX
SP1
SP2
A9
B9
C9
D9
E9
F9
9EE9
9ED9
ii
dd
hh ll
ee ff
ff
IMM
DIR
EXT
IX2
IX1
IX
SP1
SP2
AB
BB
CB
DB
EB
FB
9EEB
9EDB
ii
dd
hh ll
ee ff
ff
ADD #opr
ADD opr
ADD opr
ADD opr,X
ADD opr,X
ADD ,X
ADD opr,SP
ADD opr,SP
Add without Carry
AIS #opr
Add Immediate Value (Signed) to SP
SP ← (SP) + (16 « M)
– – – – – – IMM
AIX #opr
Add Immediate Value (Signed) to H:X
H:X ← (H:X) + (16 « M)
– – – – – – IMM
AND #opr
AND opr
AND opr
AND opr,X
AND opr,X
AND ,X
AND opr,SP
AND opr,SP
ASL opr
ASLA
ASLX
ASL opr,X
ASL ,X
ASL opr,SP
A ← (A) & (M)
Logical AND
Arithmetic Shift Left
(Same as LSL)
ASR opr
ASRA
ASRX
ASR opr,X
ASR opr,X
ASR opr,SP
Arithmetic Shift Right
BCC rel
Branch if Carry Bit Clear
A ← (A) + (M)
C
0 – –
0
b7
b0
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (C) = 0
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
– –
IMM
DIR
EXT
IX2
–
IX1
IX
SP1
SP2
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
– –
2
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
ff
ee ff
2
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
A7
ii
2
AF
ii
2
ii
dd
hh ll
ee ff
ff
2
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
A4
B4
C4
D4
E4
F4
9EE4
9ED4
ff
ee ff
DIR
INH
INH
IX1
IX
SP1
38 dd
48
58
68 ff
78
9E68 ff
4
1
1
4
3
5
DIR
INH
INH
IX1
IX
SP1
37 dd
47
57
67 ff
77
9E67 ff
4
1
1
4
3
5
b0
C
b7
–
ff
ee ff
Cycles
Description
Operand
Operation
Effect on
CCR
Opcode
Source
Form
Address
Mode
Table 6-1. Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 1 of 8)
– – – – – – REL
24
rr
3
Advance Information
79
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
V H I N Z C
11
13
15
17
19
1B
1D
1F
dd
dd
dd
dd
dd
dd
dd
dd
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
Mn ← 0
DIR
DIR
DIR
DIR
– – – – – – DIR
DIR
DIR
DIR
Branch if Carry Bit Set (Same as BLO)
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (C) = 1
– – – – – – REL
25
rr
3
BEQ rel
Branch if Equal
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (Z) = 1
– – – – – – REL
27
rr
3
BGE opr
Branch if Greater Than or Equal To
(Signed Operands)
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (N ⊕ V) = 0
– – – – – – REL
90
rr
3
BGT opr
Branch if Greater Than (Signed
Operands)
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (Z) | (N ⊕ V) = 0 – – – – – – REL
92
rr
3
BHCC rel
Branch if Half Carry Bit Clear
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (H) = 0
– – – – – – REL
28
rr
3
BHCS rel
Branch if Half Carry Bit Set
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (H) = 1
– – – – – – REL
29
rr
BHI rel
Branch if Higher
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (C) | (Z) = 0
– – – – – – REL
22
rr
3
BHS rel
Branch if Higher or Same
(Same as BCC)
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (C) = 0
– – – – – – REL
24
rr
3
BIH rel
Branch if IRQ Pin High
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? IRQ = 1
– – – – – – REL
2F
rr
3
BIL rel
Branch if IRQ Pin Low
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? IRQ = 0
– – – – – – REL
2E
rr
3
ii
dd
hh ll
ee ff
ff
ff
ee ff
2
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
93
rr
3
BCLR n, opr
Clear Bit n in M
BCS rel
BIT #opr
BIT opr
BIT opr
BIT opr,X
BIT opr,X
BIT ,X
BIT opr,SP
BIT opr,SP
Bit Test
BLE opr
Branch if Less Than or Equal To
(Signed Operands)
BLO rel
Branch if Lower (Same as BCS)
BLS rel
(A) & (M)
0 – –
IMM
DIR
EXT
IX2
–
IX1
IX
SP1
SP2
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (Z) | (N ⊕ V) = 1 – – – – – – REL
(b0)
(b1)
(b2)
(b3)
(b4)
(b5)
(b6)
(b7)
Cycles
Description
Operand
Operation
Effect on
CCR
Opcode
Source
Form
Address
Mode
Table 6-1. Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 2 of 8)
A5
B5
C5
D5
E5
F5
9EE5
9ED5
3
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (C) = 1
– – – – – – REL
25
rr
3
Branch if Lower or Same
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (C) | (Z) = 1
– – – – – – REL
23
rr
3
BLT opr
Branch if Less Than (Signed Operands)
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (N ⊕ V) =1
– – – – – – REL
91
rr
3
BMC rel
Branch if Interrupt Mask Clear
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (I) = 0
– – – – – – REL
2C
rr
3
BMI rel
Branch if Minus
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (N) = 1
– – – – – – REL
2B
rr
3
BMS rel
Branch if Interrupt Mask Set
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (I) = 1
– – – – – – REL
2D
rr
3
Advance Information
80
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
MOTOROLA
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Instruction Set Summary
V H I N Z C
Cycles
Description
Operand
Operation
Effect on
CCR
Opcode
Source
Form
Address
Mode
Table 6-1. Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 3 of 8)
BNE rel
Branch if Not Equal
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (Z) = 0
– – – – – – REL
26
rr
3
BPL rel
Branch if Plus
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (N) = 0
– – – – – – REL
2A
rr
3
BRA rel
Branch Always
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel
– – – – – – REL
20
rr
3
01
03
05
07
09
0B
0D
0F
dd rr
dd rr
dd rr
dd rr
dd rr
dd rr
dd rr
dd rr
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
21
rr
3
BRCLR n,opr,rel Branch if Bit n in M Clear
BRN rel
PC ← (PC) + 3 + rel ? (Mn) = 0
PC ← (PC) + 2
Branch Never
BRSET n,opr,rel Branch if Bit n in M Set
BSET n,opr
Set Bit n in M
BSR rel
Branch to Subroutine
CBEQ opr,rel
CBEQA #opr,rel
CBEQX #opr,rel Compare and Branch if Equal
CBEQ opr,X+,rel
CBEQ X+,rel
CBEQ opr,SP,rel
– – – – –
DIR
DIR
DIR
DIR
DIR
DIR
DIR
DIR
(b0)
(b1)
(b2)
(b3)
(b4)
(b5)
(b6)
(b7)
– – – – – – REL
DIR
DIR
DIR
DIR
DIR
DIR
DIR
DIR
(b0)
(b1)
(b2)
(b3)
(b4)
(b5)
(b6)
(b7)
00
02
04
06
08
0A
0C
0E
dd rr
dd rr
dd rr
dd rr
dd rr
dd rr
dd rr
dd rr
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
5
Mn ← 1
DIR
DIR
DIR
– – – – – – DIR
DIR
DIR
DIR
DIR
(b0)
(b1)
(b2)
(b3)
(b4)
(b5)
(b6)
(b7)
10
12
14
16
18
1A
1C
1E
dd
dd
dd
dd
dd
dd
dd
dd
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
PC ← (PC) + 2; push (PCL)
SP ← (SP) – 1; push (PCH)
SP ← (SP) – 1
PC ← (PC) + rel
– – – – – – REL
AD
rr
4
DIR
IMM
– – – – – – IMM
IX1+
IX+
SP1
31
41
51
61
71
9E61
dd rr
ii rr
ii rr
ff rr
rr
ff rr
5
4
4
5
4
6
PC ← (PC) + 3 + rel ? (Mn) = 1
PC ← (PC)
PC ← (PC)
PC ← (PC)
PC ← (PC)
PC ← (PC)
PC ← (PC)
+ 3 + rel ? (A)
+ 3 + rel ? (A)
+ 3 + rel ? (X)
+ 3 + rel ? (A)
+ 2 + rel ? (A)
+ 4 + rel ? (A)
– (M)
– (M)
– (M)
– (M)
– (M)
– (M)
= $00
= $00
= $00
= $00
= $00
= $00
– – – – –
CLC
Clear Carry Bit
C←0
– – – – – 0 INH
98
1
CLI
Clear Interrupt Mask
I←0
– – 0 – – – INH
9A
2
M ← $00
A ← $00
X ← $00
H ← $00
M ← $00
M ← $00
M ← $00
DIR
INH
INH
0 – – 0 1 – INH
IX1
IX
SP1
CLR opr
CLRA
CLRX
CLRH
CLR opr,X
CLR ,X
CLR opr,SP
Clear
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
3F dd
4F
5F
8C
6F ff
7F
9E6F ff
3
1
1
1
3
2
4
Advance Information
81
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
V H I N Z C
CMP #opr
CMP opr
CMP opr
CMP opr,X
CMP opr,X
CMP ,X
CMP opr,SP
CMP opr,SP
Compare A with M
(A) – (M)
COM opr
COMA
COMX
COM opr,X
COM ,X
COM opr,SP
Complement (One’s Complement)
CPHX #opr
CPHX opr
Compare H:X with M
CPX #opr
CPX opr
CPX opr
CPX ,X
CPX opr,X
CPX opr,X
CPX opr,SP
CPX opr,SP
Compare X with M
DAA
Decimal Adjust A
Decrement
DIV
Divide
EOR #opr
EOR opr
EOR opr
EOR opr,X
EOR opr,X
EOR ,X
EOR opr,SP
EOR opr,SP
Exclusive OR M with A
Advance Information
82
(M) = $FF – (M)
(A) = $FF – (M)
(X) = $FF – (M)
(M) = $FF – (M)
(M) = $FF – (M)
(M) = $FF – (M)
(H:X) – (M:M + 1)
(X) – (M)
(A) 10
DBNZ opr,rel
DBNZA rel
Decrement and Branch if Not Zero
DBNZX rel
DBNZ opr,X,rel
DBNZ X,rel
DBNZ opr,SP,rel
DEC opr
DECA
DECX
DEC opr,X
DEC ,X
DEC opr,SP
M←
A←
X←
M←
M←
M←
– –
IMM
DIR
EXT
IX2
IX1
IX
SP1
SP2
DIR
INH
INH
1 IX1
IX
SP1
A ← (A ⊕ M)
ff
ee ff
33 dd
43
53
63 ff
73
9E63 ff
2
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
4
1
1
4
3
5
IMM
DIR
65
75
ii ii+1
dd
3
4
IMM
DIR
EXT
IX2
IX1
IX
SP1
SP2
A3
B3
C3
D3
E3
F3
9EE3
9ED3
ii
dd
hh ll
ee ff
ff
2
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
INH
72
– –
– –
A ← (A) – 1 or M ← (M) – 1 or X ← (X) – 1
DIR
PC ← (PC) + 3 + rel ? (result) ≠ 0
INH
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (result) ≠ 0
– – – – – – INH
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (result) ≠ 0
IX1
PC ← (PC) + 3 + rel ? (result) ≠ 0
IX
PC ← (PC) + 2 + rel ? (result) ≠ 0
SP1
PC ← (PC) + 4 + rel ? (result) ≠ 0
A ← (H:A)/(X)
H ← Remainder
ii
dd
hh ll
ee ff
ff
0 – –
U – –
M ← (M) – 1
A ← (A) – 1
X ← (X) – 1
M ← (M) – 1
M ← (M) – 1
M ← (M) – 1
A1
B1
C1
D1
E1
F1
9EE1
9ED1
Cycles
Description
Operand
Operation
Effect on
CCR
Opcode
Source
Form
Address
Mode
Table 6-1. Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 4 of 8)
– –
– – – –
0 – –
DIR
INH
INH
–
IX1
IX
SP1
INH
IMM
DIR
EXT
– IX2
IX1
IX
SP1
SP2
3B
4B
5B
6B
7B
9E6B
ff
ee ff
2
dd rr
rr
rr
ff rr
rr
ff rr
3A dd
4A
5A
6A ff
7A
9E6A ff
52
A8
B8
C8
D8
E8
F8
9EE8
9ED8
5
3
3
5
4
6
4
1
1
4
3
5
7
ii
dd
hh ll
ee ff
ff
ff
ee ff
2
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
MOTOROLA
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Instruction Set Summary
V H I N Z C
INC opr
INCA
INCX
INC opr,X
INC ,X
INC opr,SP
JMP
JMP
JMP
JMP
JMP
opr
opr
opr,X
opr,X
,X
JSR opr
JSR opr
JSR opr,X
JSR opr,X
JSR ,X
LDA
LDA
LDA
LDA
LDA
LDA
LDA
LDA
#opr
opr
opr
opr,X
opr,X
,X
opr,SP
opr,SP
LDHX #opr
LDHX opr
LDX
LDX
LDX
LDX
LDX
LDX
LDX
LDX
#opr
opr
opr
opr,X
opr,X
,X
opr,SP
opr,SP
LSL opr
LSLA
LSLX
LSL opr,X
LSL ,X
LSL opr,SP
Increment
Jump to Subroutine
Move
MUL
PC ← Jump Address
2
3
4
3
2
PC ← (PC) + n (n = 1, 2, or 3)
Push (PCL); SP ← (SP) – 1
Push (PCH); SP ← (SP) – 1
PC ← Unconditional Address
DIR
EXT
– – – – – – IX2
IX1
IX
BD
CD
DD
ED
FD
dd
hh ll
ee ff
ff
4
5
6
5
4
IMM
DIR
EXT
IX2
–
IX1
IX
SP1
SP2
A6
B6
C6
D6
E6
F6
9EE6
9ED6
ii
dd
hh ll
ee ff
ff
ff
ee ff
2
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
– IMM
DIR
45
55
ii jj
dd
3
4
IMM
DIR
EXT
IX2
– IX1
IX
SP1
SP2
AE
BE
CE
DE
EE
FE
9EEE
9EDE
ii
dd
hh ll
ee ff
ff
2
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
A ← (M)
0 – –
H:X ← (M:M + 1)
0 – –
X ← (M)
Load X from M
MOV
MOV
MOV
MOV
0 – –
C
0
b7
0
C
b7
– –
38 dd
48
58
68 ff
78
9E68 ff
4
1
1
4
3
5
DIR
INH
INH
IX1
IX
SP1
34 dd
44
54
64 ff
74
9E64 ff
4
1
1
4
3
5
– – 0
H:X ← (H:X) + 1 (IX+D, DIX+)
X:A ← (X) × (A)
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
0 – –
ff
ee ff
DIR
INH
INH
IX1
IX
SP1
b0
(M)Destination ← (M)Source
Unsigned multiply
b0
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
4
1
1
4
3
5
dd
hh ll
ee ff
ff
Load H:X from M
Logical Shift Right
– –
3C dd
4C
5C
6C ff
7C
9E6C ff
BC
CC
DC
EC
FC
Load A from M
Logical Shift Left
(Same as ASL)
DIR
INH
– INH
IX1
IX
SP1
DIR
EXT
– – – – – – IX2
IX1
IX
Jump
LSR opr
LSRA
LSRX
LSR opr,X
LSR ,X
LSR opr,SP
opr,opr
opr,X+
#opr,opr
X+,opr
M ← (M) + 1
A ← (A) + 1
X ← (X) + 1
M ← (M) + 1
M ← (M) + 1
M ← (M) + 1
Cycles
Description
Operand
Operation
Effect on
CCR
Opcode
Source
Form
Address
Mode
Table 6-1. Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 5 of 8)
DD
DIX+
– IMD
IX+D
– 0 – – – 0 INH
4E
5E
6E
7E
42
dd dd
dd
ii dd
dd
5
4
4
4
5
Advance Information
83
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
V H I N Z C
NEG opr
NEGA
NEGX
NEG opr,X
NEG ,X
NEG opr,SP
Negate (Two’s Complement)
NOP
No Operation
NSA
Nibble Swap A
M ← –(M) = $00 – (M)
A ← –(A) = $00 – (A)
X ← –(X) = $00 – (X)
M ← –(M) = $00 – (M)
M ← –(M) = $00 – (M)
– –
DIR
INH
INH
IX1
IX
SP1
30 dd
40
50
60 ff
70
9E60 ff
Cycles
Description
Operand
Operation
Effect on
CCR
Opcode
Source
Form
Address
Mode
Table 6-1. Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 6 of 8)
4
1
1
4
3
5
None
– – – – – – INH
9D
1
A ← (A[3:0]:A[7:4])
– – – – – – INH
62
3
ii
dd
hh ll
ee ff
ff
2
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
ORA #opr
ORA opr
ORA opr
ORA opr,X
ORA opr,X
ORA ,X
ORA opr,SP
ORA opr,SP
Inclusive OR A and M
PSHA
Push A onto Stack
Push (A); SP ← (SP) – 1
– – – – – – INH
87
2
PSHH
Push H onto Stack
Push (H); SP ← (SP) – 1
– – – – – – INH
8B
2
PSHX
Push X onto Stack
Push (X); SP ← (SP) – 1
– – – – – – INH
89
2
PULA
Pull A from Stack
SP ← (SP + 1); Pull (A)
– – – – – – INH
86
2
PULH
Pull H from Stack
SP ← (SP + 1); Pull (H)
– – – – – – INH
8A
2
PULX
Pull X from Stack
SP ← (SP + 1); Pull (X)
– – – – – – INH
88
2
ROL opr
ROLA
ROLX
ROL opr,X
ROL ,X
ROL opr,SP
Rotate Left through Carry
A ← (A) | (M)
0 – –
C
b7
Rotate Right through Carry
RSP
Reset Stack Pointer
SP ← $FF
RTI
Return from Interrupt
SP ← (SP) + 1; Pull (CCR)
SP ← (SP) + 1; Pull (A)
SP ← (SP) + 1; Pull (X)
SP ← (SP) + 1; Pull (PCH)
SP ← (SP) + 1; Pull (PCL)
RTS
Return from Subroutine
Advance Information
84
C
– –
ff
ee ff
39 dd
49
59
69 ff
79
9E69 ff
4
1
1
4
3
5
DIR
INH
INH
IX1
IX
SP1
36 dd
46
56
66 ff
76
9E66 ff
4
1
1
4
3
5
b0
SP ← SP + 1; Pull (PCH)
SP ← SP + 1; Pull (PCL)
AA
BA
CA
DA
EA
FA
9EEA
9EDA
DIR
INH
INH
IX1
IX
SP1
b0
ROR opr
RORA
RORX
ROR opr,X
ROR ,X
ROR opr,SP
b7
– –
IMM
DIR
EXT
– IX2
IX1
IX
SP1
SP2
– – – – – – INH
9C
1
INH
80
7
– – – – – – INH
81
4
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
MOTOROLA
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Instruction Set Summary
V H I N Z C
SBC
SBC
SBC
SBC
SBC
SBC
SBC
SBC
#opr
opr
opr
opr,X
opr,X
,X
opr,SP
opr,SP
A ← (A) – (M) – (C)
Subtract with Carry
– –
IMM
DIR
EXT
IX2
IX1
IX
SP1
SP2
A2
B2
C2
D2
E2
F2
9EE2
9ED2
ii
dd
hh ll
ee ff
ff
ff
ee ff
Cycles
Description
Operand
Operation
Effect on
CCR
Opcode
Source
Form
Address
Mode
Table 6-1. Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 7 of 8)
2
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
SEC
Set Carry Bit
C←1
– – – – – 1 INH
99
1
SEI
Set Interrupt Mask
I←1
– – 1 – – – INH
9B
2
STA opr
STA opr
STA opr,X
STA opr,X
STA ,X
STA opr,SP
STA opr,SP
Store A in M
STHX opr
Store H:X in M
STOP
Enable IRQ Pin; Stop Oscillator
STX
STX
STX
STX
STX
STX
STX
opr
opr
opr,X
opr,X
,X
opr,SP
opr,SP
SUB #opr
SUB opr
SUB opr
SUB opr,X
SUB opr,X
SUB ,X
SUB opr,SP
SUB opr,SP
M ← (A)
(M:M + 1) ← (H:X)
I ← 0; Stop Oscillator
M ← (X)
Store X in M
A ← (A) – (M)
Subtract
SWI
Software Interrupt
PC ← (PC) + 1; Push (PCL)
SP ← (SP) – 1; Push (PCH)
SP ← (SP) – 1; Push (X)
SP ← (SP) – 1; Push (A)
SP ← (SP) – 1; Push (CCR)
SP ← (SP) – 1; I ← 1
PCH ← Interrupt Vector High Byte
PCL ← Interrupt Vector Low Byte
TAP
Transfer A to CCR
CCR ← (A)
TAX
Transfer A to X
TPA
Transfer CCR to A
B7
C7
D7
E7
F7
9EE7
9ED7
– DIR
35
– – 0 – – – INH
8E
0 – –
0 – –
0 – –
– –
dd
hh ll
ee ff
ff
ff
ee ff
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
dd
4
1
DIR
EXT
IX2
– IX1
IX
SP1
SP2
BF
CF
DF
EF
FF
9EEF
9EDF
dd
hh ll
ee ff
ff
IMM
DIR
EXT
IX2
IX1
IX
SP1
SP2
A0
B0
C0
D0
E0
F0
9EE0
9ED0
ii
dd
hh ll
ee ff
ff
ff
ee ff
ff
ee ff
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
2
3
4
4
3
2
4
5
– – 1 – – – INH
83
9
INH
84
2
X ← (A)
– – – – – – INH
97
1
A ← (CCR)
– – – – – – INH
85
1
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
DIR
EXT
IX2
– IX1
IX
SP1
SP2
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Advance Information
85
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
V H I N Z C
TST opr
TSTA
TSTX
TST opr,X
TST ,X
TST opr,SP
Test for Negative or Zero
TSX
Transfer SP to H:X
TXA
Transfer X to A
TXS
Transfer H:X to SP
WAIT
Enable Interrupts; Stop Processor
A
C
CCR
dd
dd rr
DD
DIR
DIX+
ee ff
EXT
ff
H
H
hh ll
I
ii
IMD
IMM
INH
IX
IX+
IX+D
IX1
IX1+
IX2
M
N
(A) – $00 or (X) – $00 or (M) – $00
0 – –
DIR
INH
– INH
IX1
IX
SP1
3D dd
4D
5D
6D ff
7D
9E6D ff
Cycles
Description
Operand
Operation
Effect on
CCR
Opcode
Source
Form
Address
Mode
Table 6-1. Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 8 of 8)
3
1
1
3
2
4
H:X ← (SP) + 1
– – – – – – INH
95
2
A ← (X)
– – – – – – INH
9F
1
(SP) ← (H:X) – 1
– – – – – – INH
94
2
I bit ← 0
– – 0 – – – INH
8F
1
Accumulator
Carry/borrow bit
Condition code register
Direct address of operand
Direct address of operand and relative offset of branch instruction
Direct to direct addressing mode
Direct addressing mode
Direct to indexed with post increment addressing mode
High and low bytes of offset in indexed, 16-bit offset addressing
Extended addressing mode
Offset byte in indexed, 8-bit offset addressing
Half-carry bit
Index register high byte
High and low bytes of operand address in extended addressing
Interrupt mask
Immediate operand byte
Immediate source to direct destination addressing mode
Immediate addressing mode
Inherent addressing mode
Indexed, no offset addressing mode
Indexed, no offset, post increment addressing mode
Indexed with post increment to direct addressing mode
Indexed, 8-bit offset addressing mode
Indexed, 8-bit offset, post increment addressing mode
Indexed, 16-bit offset addressing mode
Memory location
Negative bit
n
opr
PC
PCH
PCL
REL
rel
rr
SP1
SP2
SP
U
V
X
Z
&
|
⊕
()
–( )
#
«
←
?
:
—
Any bit
Operand (one or two bytes)
Program counter
Program counter high byte
Program counter low byte
Relative addressing mode
Relative program counter offset byte
Relative program counter offset byte
Stack pointer, 8-bit offset addressing mode
Stack pointer 16-bit offset addressing mode
Stack pointer
Undefined
Overflow bit
Index register low byte
Zero bit
Logical AND
Logical OR
Logical EXCLUSIVE OR
Contents of
Negation (two’s complement)
Immediate value
Sign extend
Loaded with
If
Concatenated with
Set or cleared
Not affected
6.9 Opcode Map
See Table 6-2.
Advance Information
86
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
MOTOROLA
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Table 6-2. Opcode Map
Bit Manipulation
DIR
DIR
MSB
Branch
REL
DIR
INH
3
4
1
2
5
BRSET0
3
DIR
5
BRCLR0
3
DIR
5
BRSET1
3
DIR
5
BRCLR1
3
DIR
5
BRSET2
3
DIR
5
BRCLR2
3
DIR
5
BRSET3
3
DIR
5
BRCLR3
3
DIR
5
BRSET4
3
DIR
5
BRCLR4
3
DIR
5
BRSET5
3
DIR
5
BRCLR5
3
DIR
5
BRSET6
3
DIR
5
BRCLR6
3
DIR
5
BRSET7
3
DIR
5
BRCLR7
3
DIR
4
BSET0
2
DIR
4
BCLR0
2
DIR
4
BSET1
2
DIR
4
BCLR1
2
DIR
4
BSET2
2
DIR
4
BCLR2
2
DIR
4
BSET3
2
DIR
4
BCLR3
2
DIR
4
BSET4
2
DIR
4
BCLR4
2
DIR
4
BSET5
2
DIR
4
BCLR5
2
DIR
4
BSET6
2
DIR
4
BCLR6
2
DIR
4
BSET7
2
DIR
4
BCLR7
2
DIR
3
BRA
2 REL
3
BRN
2 REL
3
BHI
2 REL
3
BLS
2 REL
3
BCC
2 REL
3
BCS
2 REL
3
BNE
2 REL
3
BEQ
2 REL
3
BHCC
2 REL
3
BHCS
2 REL
3
BPL
2 REL
3
BMI
2 REL
3
BMC
2 REL
3
BMS
2 REL
3
BIL
2 REL
3
BIH
2 REL
5
6
1
NEGX
1
INH
4
CBEQX
3 IMM
7
DIV
1
INH
1
COMX
1
INH
1
LSRX
1
INH
4
LDHX
2
DIR
1
RORX
1
INH
1
ASRX
1
INH
1
LSLX
1
INH
1
ROLX
1
INH
1
DECX
1
INH
3
DBNZX
2
INH
1
INCX
1
INH
1
TSTX
1
INH
4
MOV
2 DIX+
1
CLRX
1
INH
4
NEG
2
IX1
5
CBEQ
3 IX1+
3
NSA
1
INH
4
COM
2
IX1
4
LSR
2
IX1
3
CPHX
3 IMM
4
ROR
2
IX1
4
ASR
2
IX1
4
LSL
2
IX1
4
ROL
2
IX1
4
DEC
2
IX1
5
DBNZ
3
IX1
4
INC
2
IX1
3
TST
2
IX1
4
MOV
3 IMD
3
CLR
2
IX1
SP1
IX
9E6
7
Control
INH
INH
8
9
IMM
DIR
EXT
A
B
C
Register/Memory
IX2
SP2
D
9ED
IX1
SP1
IX
E
9EE
F
LSB
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
A
B
C
E
F
1
4
NEGA
NEG
INH
2
DIR 1
4
5
CBEQ CBEQA
3
DIR 3 IMM
5
MUL
1
INH
1
4
COMA
COM
INH
2
DIR 1
1
4
LSRA
LSR
INH
2
DIR 1
3
4
LDHX
STHX
2
DIR 3 IMM
1
4
RORA
ROR
INH
2
DIR 1
1
4
ASRA
ASR
INH
2
DIR 1
1
4
LSLA
LSL
INH
2
DIR 1
1
4
ROLA
ROL
INH
2
DIR 1
1
4
DECA
DEC
INH
2
DIR 1
3
5
DBNZ DBNZA
INH
3
DIR 2
1
4
INCA
INC
INH
2
DIR 1
1
3
TSTA
TST
INH
2
DIR 1
5
MOV
3
DD
1
3
CLRA
CLR
INH
2
DIR 1
87
INH Inherent
REL Relative
IMM Immediate
IX
Indexed, No Offset
DIR Direct
IX1 Indexed, 8-Bit Offset
EXT Extended
IX2 Indexed, 16-Bit Offset
DD Direct-Direct
IMD Immediate-Direct
IX+D Indexed-Direct DIX+ Direct-Indexed
*Pre-byte for stack pointer indexed instructions
3
5
NEG
NEG
IX
3 SP1 1
4
6
CBEQ
CBEQ
IX+
4 SP1 2
2
DAA
1
INH
3
5
COM
COM
IX
3 SP1 1
3
5
LSR
LSR
IX
3 SP1 1
4
CPHX
2
DIR
3
5
ROR
ROR
IX
3 SP1 1
3
5
ASR
ASR
IX
3 SP1 1
3
5
LSL
LSL
IX
3 SP1 1
3
5
ROL
ROL
IX
3 SP1 1
3
5
DEC
DEC
IX
3 SP1 1
4
6
DBNZ
DBNZ
IX
4 SP1 2
3
5
INC
INC
IX
3 SP1 1
2
4
TST
TST
IX
3 SP1 1
4
MOV
2 IX+D
2
4
CLR
CLR
IX
3 SP1 1
SP1 Stack Pointer, 8-Bit Offset
SP2 Stack Pointer, 16-Bit Offset
IX+ Indexed, No Offset with
Post Increment
IX1+ Indexed, 1-Byte Offset with
Post Increment
3
7
BGE
RTI
1
INH 2 REL
3
4
BLT
RTS
1
INH 2 REL
3
BGT
2 REL
3
9
BLE
SWI
1
INH 2 REL
2
2
TXS
TAP
INH
1
INH 1
2
1
TSX
TPA
INH
1
INH 1
2
PULA
1
INH
1
2
TAX
PSHA
INH
1
INH 1
1
2
CLC
PULX
INH
1
INH 1
1
2
SEC
PSHX
INH
1
INH 1
2
2
CLI
PULH
INH
1
INH 1
2
2
SEI
PSHH
INH
1
INH 1
1
1
RSP
CLRH
INH
1
INH 1
1
NOP
1
INH
1
STOP
*
1
INH
1
1
TXA
WAIT
INH
1
INH 1
2
SUB
2 IMM
2
CMP
2 IMM
2
SBC
2 IMM
2
CPX
2 IMM
2
AND
2 IMM
2
BIT
2 IMM
2
LDA
2 IMM
2
AIS
2 IMM
2
EOR
2 IMM
2
ADC
2 IMM
2
ORA
2 IMM
2
ADD
2 IMM
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
4
BSR
REL 2
2
LDX
2 IMM 2
2
AIX
2 IMM 2
2
3
SUB
DIR
3
CMP
DIR
3
SBC
DIR
3
CPX
DIR
3
AND
DIR
3
BIT
DIR
3
LDA
DIR
3
STA
DIR
3
EOR
DIR
3
ADC
DIR
3
ORA
DIR
3
ADD
DIR
2
JMP
DIR
4
JSR
DIR
3
LDX
DIR
3
STX
DIR
MSB
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
4
SUB
EXT
4
CMP
EXT
4
SBC
EXT
4
CPX
EXT
4
AND
EXT
4
BIT
EXT
4
LDA
EXT
4
STA
EXT
4
EOR
EXT
4
ADC
EXT
4
ORA
EXT
4
ADD
EXT
3
JMP
EXT
5
JSR
EXT
4
LDX
EXT
4
STX
EXT
0
4
SUB
3
IX2
4
CMP
3
IX2
4
SBC
3
IX2
4
CPX
3
IX2
4
AND
3
IX2
4
BIT
3
IX2
4
LDA
3
IX2
4
STA
3
IX2
4
EOR
3
IX2
4
ADC
3
IX2
4
ORA
3
IX2
4
ADD
3
IX2
4
JMP
3
IX2
6
JSR
3
IX2
4
LDX
3
IX2
4
STX
3
IX2
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
4
5
SUB
SP2
5
CMP
SP2
5
SBC
SP2
5
CPX
SP2
5
AND
SP2
5
BIT
SP2
5
LDA
SP2
5
STA
SP2
5
EOR
SP2
5
ADC
SP2
5
ORA
SP2
5
ADD
SP2
5
LDX
SP2
5
STX
4 SP2
4
3
SUB
2
IX1
3
CMP
2
IX1
3
SBC
2
IX1
3
CPX
2
IX1
3
AND
2
IX1
3
BIT
2
IX1
3
LDA
2
IX1
3
STA
2
IX1
3
EOR
2
IX1
3
ADC
2
IX1
3
ORA
2
IX1
3
ADD
2
IX1
3
JMP
2
IX1
5
JSR
2
IX1
3
LDX
2
IX1
3
STX
2
IX1
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
4
SUB
SP1
4
CMP
SP1
4
SBC
SP1
4
CPX
SP1
4
AND
SP1
4
BIT
SP1
4
LDA
SP1
4
STA
SP1
4
EOR
SP1
4
ADC
SP1
4
ORA
SP1
4
ADD
SP1
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
4
LDX
SP1 1
4
STX
3 SP1 1
3
High Byte of Opcode in Hexadecimal
LSB
Low Byte of Opcode in Hexadecimal
1
5 Cycles
BRSET0 Opcode Mnemonic
3
DIR Number of Bytes / Addressing Mode
2
SUB
IX
2
CMP
IX
2
SBC
IX
2
CPX
IX
2
AND
IX
2
BIT
IX
2
LDA
IX
2
STA
IX
2
EOR
IX
2
ADC
IX
2
ORA
IX
2
ADD
IX
2
JMP
IX
4
JSR
IX
2
LDX
IX
2
STX
IX
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Opcode Map
D
Advance Information
0
Read-Modify-Write
INH
IX1
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
Advance Information
88
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Central Processor Unit (CPU)
MOTOROLA
Advance Information — MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32
Section 7. System Integration Module (SIM)
7.1 Contents
7.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90
7.3
SIM Bus Clock Control and Generation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
7.3.1
Bus Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .93
7.3.2
Clock Startup from POR or LVI Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
7.3.3
Clocks in Wait Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
7.4
Reset and System Initialization. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
7.4.1
External Pin Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
7.4.2
Active Resets from Internal Sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
7.4.2.1
Power-On Reset (POR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96
7.4.2.2
Computer Operating Properly (COP) Reset. . . . . . . . . . . 97
7.4.2.3
Illegal Opcode Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97
7.4.2.4
Illegal Address Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97
7.4.2.5
Forced Monitor Mode Entry Reset (MENRST). . . . . . . . . 98
7.4.2.6
Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI) Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .98
7.5
SIM Counter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
7.5.1
SIM Counter During Power-On Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
7.5.2
SIM Counter and Reset States. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
7.6
Exception Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
7.6.1
Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
7.6.1.1
Hardware Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101
7.6.1.2
Software Interrupt (SWI) Instruction. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
7.6.2
Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
7.7
Low-Power Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102
7.7.1
Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .102
7.7.2
Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
System Integration Module (SIM)
Advance Information
89
System Integration Module (SIM)
7.8
SIM Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104
7.8.1
SIM Break Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104
7.8.2
SIM Reset Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
7.8.3
SIM Break Flag Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
7.2 Introduction
This section describes the system integration module (SIM). Together
with the central processor unit (CPU), the SIM controls all
microcontroller unit (MCU) activities.
A block diagram of the SIM is shown in Figure 7-1.
The SIM is a system state controller that coordinates CPU and exception
timing. The SIM is responsible for:
•
Bus clock generation and control for CPU and peripherals:
– Wait/reset/break entry and recovery
– Internal clock control
•
Master reset control, including power-on reset (POR) and
computer operating properly (COP) timeout
•
Interrupt control:
– Acknowledge timing
– Arbitration control timing
– Vector address generation
•
CPU enable/disable timing
•
Modular architecture expandable to 128 interrupt sources
Table 7-1 shows the internal signal names used in this section.
Advance Information
90
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
System Integration Module (SIM)
MOTOROLA
System Integration Module (SIM)
Introduction
MODULE WAIT
WAIT
CONTROL
CPU WAIT (FROM CPU)
SIMOSCEN (TO CGM)
SIM
COUNTER
COP CLOCK
CGMXCLK (FROM CGM)
CGMOUT (FROM CGM)
÷2
CLOCK
CONTROL
RESET
PIN LOGIC
CLOCK GENERATORS
INTERNAL CLOCKS
LVI (FROM LVI MODULE)
POR CONTROL
MASTER
RESET
CONTROL
RESET PIN CONTROL
SIM RESET STATUS REGISTER
ILLEGAL OPCODE (FROM CPU)
ILLEGAL ADDRESS (FROM ADDRESS
MAP DECODERS)
COP (FROM COP MODULE)
RESET
INTERRUPT CONTROL
AND PRIORITY DECODE
INTERRUPT SOURCES
CPU INTERFACE
Figure 7-1. SIM Block Diagram
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
System Integration Module (SIM)
Advance Information
91
System Integration Module (SIM)
Table 7-1. Signal Name Conventions
Signal Name
Description
CGMXCLK
Buffered version of OSC1 from clock generator module (CGM)
CGMVCLK
Phase-locked loop (PLL) circuit output
CGMOUT
PLL-based or OSC1-based clock output from CGM module
(Bus clock = CGMOUT divided by two)
IAB
Internal address bus
IDB
Internal data bus
PORRST
Signal from the power-on reset module to the SIM
IRST
Internal reset signal
R/W
Read/write signal
7.3 SIM Bus Clock Control and Generation
The bus clock generator provides system clock signals for the CPU and
peripherals on the MCU. The system clocks are generated from an
incoming clock, CGMOUT, as shown in Figure 7-2. This clock can come
from either an external oscillator or from the on-chip phase-locked loop
(PLL) circuit. See Section 8. Clock Generator Module (CGM).
CGMXCLK
OSC1
CGMVCLK
PLL
CLOCK
SELECT
CIRCUIT
÷2
A
CGMOUT
B S*
*When S = 1,
CGMOUT = B
SIM COUNTER
BUS CLOCK
GENERATORS
÷2
6,0
BCS
PTC2
MONITOR MODE
USER MODE
&*0
Figure 7-2. CGM Clock Signals
Advance Information
92
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
System Integration Module (SIM)
MOTOROLA
System Integration Module (SIM)
Reset and System Initialization
7.3.1 Bus Timing
In user mode, the internal bus frequency is either the crystal oscillator
output (CGMXCLK) divided by four or the PLL output (CGMVCLK)
divided by four. See Section 8. Clock Generator Module (CGM).
7.3.2 Clock Startup from POR or LVI Reset
When the power-on reset (POR) module or the low-voltage inhibit (LVI)
module generates a reset, the clocks to the CPU and peripherals are
inactive and held in an inactive phase until after the 4096 CGMXCLK
cycle POR timeout has completed. The RST pin is driven low by the SIM
during this entire period. The internal bus (IBUS) clocks start upon
completion of the timeout.
7.3.3 Clocks in Wait Mode
In wait mode, the CPU clocks are inactive. The SIM also produces two
sets of clocks for other modules. Refer to the wait mode subsection of
each module to see if the module is active or inactive in wait mode.
Some modules can be programmed to be active in wait mode.
7.4 Reset and System Initialization
The MCU has these reset sources:
•
Power-on reset module (POR)
•
External reset pin (RST)
•
Computer operating properly (COP) module
•
Low-voltage inhibit (LVI) module
•
Illegal opcode
•
Illegal address
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
System Integration Module (SIM)
Advance Information
93
System Integration Module (SIM)
All of these resets produce the vector $FFFE–FFFF ($FEFE–FEFF in
monitor mode) and assert the internal reset signal (IRST). IRST causes
all registers to be returned to their default values and all modules to be
returned to their reset states.
An internal reset clears the SIM counter (see 7.5 SIM Counter), but an
external reset does not. Each of the resets sets a corresponding bit in
the SIM reset status register (SRSR). See 7.8.2 SIM Reset Status
Register.
7.4.1 External Pin Reset
Pulling the asynchronous RST pin low halts all processing. The PIN bit
of the SIM reset status register (SRSR) is set as long as RST is held low
for a minimum of 67 CGMXCLK cycles, assuming that neither the POR
nor the LVI was the source of the reset. See Table 7-2 for details.
Figure 7-3 shows the relative timing.
Table 7-2. PIN Bit Set Timing
Reset Type
Number of Cycles Required to Set PIN
POR/LVI
4163 (4096 + 64 + 3)
All others
67 (64 + 3)
CGMOUT
RST
IAB
PC
VECT H
VECT L
Figure 7-3. External Reset Timing
Advance Information
94
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
System Integration Module (SIM)
MOTOROLA
System Integration Module (SIM)
Reset and System Initialization
7.4.2 Active Resets from Internal Sources
All internal reset sources actively pull the RST pin low for 32 CGMXCLK
cycles to allow resetting of external peripherals. The internal reset
signal (IRST) continues to be asserted for an additional 32 cycles (see
Figure 7-5). An internal reset can be caused by an illegal address, illegal
opcode, COP timeout, LVI, or POR. (See Figure 7-4.)
ILLEGAL ADDRESS RST
ILLEGAL OPCODE RST
COPRST
LVI
POR
INTERNAL RESET
Figure 7-4. Sources of Internal Reset
NOTE:
For LVI or POR resets, the SIM cycles through 4096 CGMXCLK cycles
during which the SIM forces the RST pin low. The internal reset signal
then follows the sequence from the falling edge of RST, as shown in
Figure 7-5.
IRST
RST
RST PULLED LOW BY MCU
32 CYCLES
32 CYCLES
CGMXCLK
IAB
VECTOR HIGH
Figure 7-5. Internal Reset Timing
The COP reset is asynchronous to the bus clock.
The active reset feature allows the part to issue a reset to peripherals
and other chips within a system built around the MCU.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
System Integration Module (SIM)
Advance Information
95
System Integration Module (SIM)
7.4.2.1 Power-On Reset (POR)
When power is first applied to the MCU, the power-on reset (POR)
module generates a pulse to indicate that power-on has occurred. The
external reset pin (RST) is held low while the SIM counter counts out
4096 CGMXCLK cycles. Sixty-four CGMXCLK cycles later, the CPU and
memories are released from reset to allow the reset vector sequence to
occur.
At power-on, these events occur:
•
A POR pulse is generated.
•
The internal reset signal is asserted.
•
The SIM enables CGMOUT.
•
Internal clocks to the CPU and modules are held inactive for 4096
CGMXCLK cycles to allow stabilization of the oscillator.
•
The RST pin is driven low during the oscillator stabilization time.
•
The POR bit of the SIM reset status register (SRSR) is set and all
other bits in the register are cleared.
OSC1
PORRST
4096
CYCLES
32
CYCLES
32
CYCLES
CGMXCLK
CGMOUT
RST
$FFFE
IAB
$FFFF
Figure 7-6. POR Recovery
Advance Information
96
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
System Integration Module (SIM)
MOTOROLA
System Integration Module (SIM)
Reset and System Initialization
7.4.2.2 Computer Operating Properly (COP) Reset
An input to the SIM is reserved for the COP reset signal. The overflow of
the COP counter causes an internal reset and sets the COP bit in the
SIM reset status register (SRSR). The SIM actively pulls down the RST
pin for all internal reset sources.
To prevent a COP module timeout, write any value to location $FFFF.
Writing to location $FFFF clears the COP counter and bits 12–4 of
the SIM counter. The SIM counter output, which occurs at least every
213–24 CGMXCLK cycles, drives the COP counter. The COP should be
serviced as soon as possible out of reset to guarantee the maximum
amount of time before the first timeout.
The COP module is disabled if the RST pin or the IRQ pin is held at VHI
while the MCU is in monitor mode. The COP module can be disabled
only through combinational logic conditioned with the high voltage signal
on the RST or the IRQ pin. This prevents the COP from becoming
disabled as a result of external noise. During a break state, VHI on the
RST pin disables the COP module.
7.4.2.3 Illegal Opcode Reset
The SIM decodes signals from the CPU to detect illegal instructions. An
illegal instruction sets the ILOP bit in the SIM reset status register
(SRSR) and causes a reset.
Because the MC68HC908MR32 has stop mode disabled, execution of
the STOP instruction will cause an illegal opcode reset.
7.4.2.4 Illegal Address Reset
An opcode fetch from addresses other than FLASH or RAM addresses
generates an illegal address reset (unimplemented locations within
memory map). The SIM verifies that the CPU is fetching an opcode prior
to asserting the ILAD bit in the SIM reset status register (SRSR) and
resetting the MCU. A data fetch from an unmapped address does not
generate a reset.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
System Integration Module (SIM)
Advance Information
97
System Integration Module (SIM)
7.4.2.5 Forced Monitor Mode Entry Reset (MENRST)
The MENRST module monitors the reset vector fetches and will assert
an internal reset if it detects that the reset vectors are erased ($FF).
When the MCU comes out of reset, it is forced into monitor mode.
7.4.2.6 Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI) Reset
The low-voltage inhibit (LVI) module asserts its output to the SIM when
the VDD voltage falls to the VLVRX voltage and remains at or below that
level for at least nine consecutive CPU cycles (see 22.6 DC Electrical
Characteristics (VDD = 5.0 Vdc ± 10%)). The LVI bit in the SIM reset
status register (SRSR) is set, and the external reset pin (RST) is held low
while the SIM counter counts out 4096 CGMXCLK cycles. Sixty-four
CGMXCLK cycles later, the CPU is released from reset to allow the reset
vector sequence to occur. The SIM actively pulls down the RST pin for
all internal reset sources.
7.5 SIM Counter
The SIM counter is used by the power-on reset (POR) module to allow
the oscillator time to stabilize before enabling the internal bus (IBUS)
clocks. The SIM counter also serves as a prescaler for the computer
operating properly (COP) module. The SIM counter overflow supplies
the clock for the COP module. The SIM counter is 13 bits long and is
clocked by the falling edge of CGMXCLK.
7.5.1 SIM Counter During Power-On Reset
The power-on reset (POR) module detects power applied to the MCU.
At power-on, the POR circuit asserts the signal PORRST. Once the SIM
is initialized, it enables the clock generation (CGM) module to drive the
bus clock state machine.
7.5.2 SIM Counter and Reset States
External reset has no effect on the SIM counter. The SIM counter is
free-running after all reset states. For counter control and internal reset
recovery sequences, see 7.4.2 Active Resets from Internal Sources.
Advance Information
98
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
System Integration Module (SIM)
MOTOROLA
System Integration Module (SIM)
Exception Control
7.6 Exception Control
Normal, sequential program execution can be changed in three different
ways:
1. Interrupts:
a. Maskable hardware CPU interrupts
b. Non-maskable software interrupt instruction (SWI)
2. Reset
3. Break interrupts
7.6.1 Interrupts
At the beginning of an interrupt, the CPU saves the CPU register
contents on the stack and sets the interrupt mask (I bit) to prevent
additional interrupts. At the end of an interrupt, the return-from-interrupt
(RTI) instruction recovers the CPU register contents from the stack so
that normal processing can resume. Figure 7-7 shows interrupt entry
timing. Figure 7-9 shows interrupt recovery timing.
Interrupts are latched, and arbitration is performed in the SIM at the start
of interrupt processing. The arbitration result is a constant that the CPU
uses to determine which vector to fetch. Once an interrupt is latched by
the SIM, no other interrupt can take precedence, regardless of priority,
until the latched interrupt is serviced (or the I bit is cleared).
See Figure 7-8.
MODULE
INTERRUPT
I BIT
IAB
IDB
DUMMY
DUMMY
SP
SP – 1
SP – 2
PC – 1[7:0] PC – 1[15:8]
SP – 3
X
SP – 4
A
VECT H
CCR
VECT L
V DATA H
START
ADDR
V DATA L
OPCODE
R/W
Figure 7-7. Interrupt Entry
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
System Integration Module (SIM)
Advance Information
99
System Integration Module (SIM)
FROM RESET
BREAK
OR SWI
I BIT SET?
INTERRUPT?
YES
NO
YES
I BIT SET?
NO
INTERRUPT?
YES
NO
STACK CPU REGISTERS
SET I BIT
LOAD PC WITH INTERRUPT VECTOR
AS MANY INTERRUPTS AS EXIST ON CHIP
FETCH NEXT
INSTRUCTION
SWI
INSTRUCTION?
YES
NO
RTI
INSTRUCTION?
YES
UNSTACK CPU REGISTERS
NO
EXECUTE INSTRUCTION
Figure 7-8. Interrupt Processing
Advance Information
100
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
System Integration Module (SIM)
MOTOROLA
System Integration Module (SIM)
Exception Control
MODULE
INTERRUPT
I BIT
IAB
IDB
SP – 4
SP – 3
CCR
SP – 2
A
SP – 1
X
SP
PC
PC + 1
PC – 1[7:0] PC – 1[15:8] OPCODE
OPERAND
R/W
Figure 7-9. Interrupt Recovery
7.6.1.1 Hardware Interrupts
A hardware interrupt does not stop the current instruction. Processing of
a hardware interrupt begins after completion of the current instruction.
When the current instruction is complete, the SIM checks all pending
hardware interrupts. If interrupts are not masked (I bit clear in the
condition code register), and if the corresponding interrupt enable bit is
set, the SIM proceeds with interrupt processing; otherwise, the next
instruction is fetched and executed.
If more than one interrupt is pending at the end of an instruction
execution, the highest priority interrupt is serviced first. Figure 7-10
demonstrates what happens when two interrupts are pending. If an
interrupt is pending upon exit from the original interrupt service routine,
the pending interrupt is serviced before the load-accumulator-frommemory (LDA) instruction is executed.
CLI
LDA#$FF
INT1
BACKGROUND ROUTINE
PSHH
INT1 INTERRUPT SERVICE ROUTINE
PULH
RTI
INT2
PSHH
INT2 INTERRUPT SERVICE ROUTINE
PULH
RTI
Figure 7-10. Interrupt Recognition Example
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
System Integration Module (SIM)
Advance Information
101
System Integration Module (SIM)
The LDA opcode is prefetched by both the INT1 and INT2 RTI
instructions. However, in the case of the INT1 RTI prefetch, this is a
redundant operation.
NOTE:
To maintain compatibility with the M6805 Family, the H register is not
pushed on the stack during interrupt entry. If the interrupt service routine
modifies the H register or uses the indexed addressing mode, software
should save the H register and then restore it prior to exiting the routine.
7.6.1.2 Software Interrupt (SWI) Instruction
The software interrupt (SWI) instruction is a non-maskable instruction
that causes an interrupt regardless of the state of the interrupt mask
(I bit) in the condition code register.
7.6.2 Reset
All reset sources always have equal and highest priority and cannot be
arbitrated.
7.7 Low-Power Mode
Executing the WAIT instruction puts the MCU in a low
power-consumption mode for standby situations. The SIM holds the
CPU in a non-clocked state. WAIT clears the interrupt mask (I) in the
condition code register, allowing interrupts to occur.
7.7.1 Wait Mode
In wait mode, the CPU clocks are inactive while the peripheral clocks
continue to run. Figure 7-11 shows the timing for wait mode entry.
A module that is active during wait mode can wake up the CPU with an
interrupt if the interrupt is enabled. Stacking for the interrupt begins one
cycle after the WAIT instruction during which the interrupt occurred.
Refer to the wait mode subsection of each module to see if the module
is active or inactive in wait mode. Some modules can be programmed to
be active in wait mode.
Advance Information
102
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
System Integration Module (SIM)
MOTOROLA
System Integration Module (SIM)
Low-Power Mode
Wait mode can also be exited by a reset. If the COP disable bit, COPD,
in the configuration register is logic 0, then the computer operating
properly module (COP) is enabled and remains active in wait mode.
IAB
WAIT ADDR
IDB
WAIT ADDR + 1
PREVIOUS DATA
SAME
SAME
NEXT OPCODE
SAME
SAME
R/W
Note: Previous data can be operand data or the WAIT opcode, depending on the
last instruction.
Figure 7-11. Wait Mode Entry Timing
Figure 7-12 and Figure 7-13 show the timing for wait recovery.
IAB
IDB
$6E0B
$A6
$A6
$6E0C
$A6
$00FF
$01
$0B
$00FE
$00FD
$00FC
$6E
EXITSTOPWAIT
Note: EXITSTOPWAIT = RST pin OR CPU interrupt
Figure 7-12. Wait Recovery from Interrupt
32
&<&/(6
IAB
IDB
$6E0B
$A6
$A6
32
&<&/(6
RST VCT H RST VCT L
$A6
RST
CGMXCLK
Figure 7-13. Wait Recovery from Internal Reset
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
System Integration Module (SIM)
Advance Information
103
System Integration Module (SIM)
7.7.2 Stop Mode
In stop mode, the SIM counter is reset and the system clocks are
disabled. An interrupt request from a module can cause an exit from stop
mode. Stacking for interrupts begins after the selected stop recovery
time has elapsed. Reset or break also causes an exit from stop mode.
The SIM disables the clock generator module outputs (CGMOUT and
CGMXCLK) in stop mode, stopping the CPU and peripherals. Stop
recovery time is hard wired at the normal delay of 4096 CGMXCLK
cycles.
It is important to note that when using the PWM generator, its outputs will
stop toggling when stop mode is entered. The PWM module must be
disabled before entering stop mode to prevent external inverter failure.
7.8 SIM Registers
This subsection describes the SIM registers.
7.8.1 SIM Break Status Register
The SIM break status register (SBSR) contains a flag to indicate that a
break caused an exit from wait mode.
Address:
$FE00
BIt 7
6
5
4
3
2
R
R
R
R
R
R
Read:
1
Bit 0
SBSW
Write:
Note(1)
Reset:
0
R
= Reserved
R
Note 1. Writing a logic 0 clears SBSW.
Figure 7-14. SIM Break Status Register (SBSR)
Advance Information
104
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
System Integration Module (SIM)
MOTOROLA
System Integration Module (SIM)
SIM Registers
SBSW — SIM Break Stop/Wait Bit
This status bit is useful in applications requiring a return to wait mode
after exiting from a break interrupt. Clear SBSW by writing a logic 0 to
it. Reset clears SBSW.
1 = Wait mode was exited by break interrupt.
0 = Wait mode was not exited by break interrupt.
SBSW can be read within the break state SWI routine. The user can
modify the return address on the stack by subtracting one from it. The
following code is an example of this. Writing 0 to the SBSW bit
clears it.
; This code works if the H register has been pushed onto the stack in the break
; service routine software. This code should be executed at the end of the break
; service routine software.
HIBYTE
EQU
5
LOBYTE
EQU
6
;
If not SBSW, do RTI
BRCLR
SBSW,SBSR, RETURN
; See if wait mode was exited by break.
;
TST
LOBYTE,SP
;If RETURNLO is not zero,
BNE
DOLO
;then just decrement low byte.
DEC
HIBYTE,SP
;Else deal with high byte, too.
DOLO
DEC
LOBYTE,SP
;Point to WAIT opcode.
RETURN
PULH
RTI
;Restore H register.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
System Integration Module (SIM)
Advance Information
105
System Integration Module (SIM)
7.8.2 SIM Reset Status Register
The SIM reset status register (SRSR) contains six flags that show the
source of the last reset. Clear the SIM reset status register by reading it.
A power-on reset sets the POR bit and clears all other bits in the
register.
Address: $FE01
BIt 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
POR
PIN
COP
ILOP
ILAD
MENRST
LVI
0
Write:
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Reset:
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R
= Reserved
Figure 7-15. SIM Reset Status Register (SRSR)
POR — Power-On Reset Bit
1 = Last reset caused by POR circuit
0 = Read of SRSR
PIN — External Reset Bit
1 = Last reset caused by external reset pin (RST)
0 = POR or read of SRSR
COP — Computer Operating Properly Reset Bit
1 = Last reset caused by COP counter
0 = POR or read of SRSR
ILOP — Illegal Opcode Reset Bit
1 = Last reset caused by an illegal opcode
0 = POR or read of SRSR
ILAD — Illegal Address Reset Bit (opcode fetches only)
1 = Last reset caused by an opcode fetch from an illegal address
0 = POR or read of SRSR
MENRST — Forced Monitor Mode Entry Reset Bit
1 = Last reset caused by the MENRST circuit
0 = POR or read of SRSR
Advance Information
106
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
System Integration Module (SIM)
MOTOROLA
System Integration Module (SIM)
SIM Registers
LVI — Low-Voltage Inhibit Reset Bit
1 = Last reset caused by the LVI circuit
0 = POR or read of SRSR
7.8.3 SIM Break Flag Control Register
The SIM break control register (SBFCR) contains a bit that enables
software to clear status bits while the MCU is in a break state.
Address:
$FE03
BIt 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
BCFE
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
R
= Reserved
Figure 7-16. SIM Break Flag Control Register (SBFCR)
BCFE — Break Clear Flag Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables software to clear status bits by accessing
status registers while the MCU is in a break state. To clear status bits
during the break state, the BCFE bit must be set.
1 = Status bits clearable during break
0 = Status bits not clearable during break
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
System Integration Module (SIM)
Advance Information
107
System Integration Module (SIM)
Advance Information
108
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
System Integration Module (SIM)
MOTOROLA
Advance Information — MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32
Section 8. Clock Generator Module (CGM)
8.1 Contents
8.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
8.3
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
8.4
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
8.4.1
Crystal Oscillator Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
8.4.2
Phase-Locked Loop Circuit (PLL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
8.4.2.1
PLL Circuits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
8.4.2.2
Acquisition and Tracking Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .115
8.4.2.3
Manual and Automatic PLL Bandwidth Modes . . . . . . . 115
8.4.2.4
Programming the PLL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
8.4.2.5
Special Programming Exceptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
8.4.3
Base Clock Selector Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
8.4.4
CGM External Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
8.5
I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
8.5.1
Crystal Amplifier Input Pin (OSC1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .121
8.5.2
Crystal Amplifier Output Pin (OSC2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
8.5.3
External Filter Capacitor Pin (CGMXFC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
8.5.4
PLL Analog Power Pin (VDDA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
8.5.5
Oscillator Enable Signal (SIMOSCEN). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
8.5.6
Crystal Output Frequency Signal (CGMXCLK) . . . . . . . . .122
8.5.7
CGM Base Clock Output (CGMOUT). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
8.5.8
CGM CPU Interrupt (CGMINT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
8.6
CGM Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123
8.6.1
PLL Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
8.6.2
PLL Bandwidth Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
8.6.3
PLL Programming Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128
8.7
Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
8.8
Wait Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
Advance Information
109
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
8.9
Acquisition/Lock Time Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
8.9.1
Acquisition/Lock Time Definitions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
8.9.2
Parametric Influences on Reaction Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . .132
8.9.3
Choosing a Filter Capacitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
8.9.4
Reaction Time Calculation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
8.2 Introduction
This section describes the clock generator module (CGM, version A).
The CGM generates the crystal clock signal, CGMXCLK, which operates
at the frequency of the crystal. The CGM also generates the base clock
signal, CGMOUT, from which the system integration module (SIM)
derives the system clocks.
CGMOUT is based on either the crystal clock divided by two or the
phase-locked loop (PLL) clock, CGMVCLK, divided by two. The PLL is
a frequency generator designed for use with crystals or ceramic
resonators. The PLL can generate an 8-MHz bus frequency without
using a 32-MHz external clock.
8.3 Features
Features of the CGM include:
Advance Information
110
•
PLL with output frequency in integer multiples of the crystal
reference
•
Programmable hardware voltage-controlled oscillator (VCO) for
low-jitter operation
•
Automatic bandwidth control mode for low-jitter operation
•
Automatic frequency lock detector
•
Central processor unit (CPU) interrupt on entry or exit from locked
condition
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
MOTOROLA
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
Functional Description
8.4 Functional Description
The CGM consists of three major submodules:
1. Crystal oscillator circuit — The crystal oscillator circuit generates
the constant crystal frequency clock, CGMXCLK.
2. Phase-locked loop (PLL) — The PLL generates the
programmable VCO frequency clock, CGMVCLK.
3. Base clock selector circuit — This software-controlled circuit
selects either CGMXCLK divided by two or the VCO clock,
CGMVCLK, divided by two as the base clock, CGMOUT. The SIM
derives the system clocks from CGMOUT.
Figure 8-1 shows the structure of the CGM.
8.4.1 Crystal Oscillator Circuit
The crystal oscillator circuit consists of an inverting amplifier and an
external crystal. The OSC1 pin is the input to the amplifier and the OSC2
pin is the output. The SIMOSCEN signal from the system integration
module (SIM) enables the crystal oscillator circuit.
The CGMXCLK signal is the output of the crystal oscillator circuit and
runs at a rate equal to the crystal frequency. CGMXCLK is then buffered
to produce CGMRCLK, the PLL reference clock.
CGMXCLK can be used by other modules which require precise timing
for operation. The duty cycle of CGMXCLK is not guaranteed to be
50 percent and depends on external factors, including the crystal and
related external components.
An externally generated clock also can feed the OSC1 pin of the crystal
oscillator circuit. Connect the external clock to the OSC1 pin and let the
OSC2 pin float.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
Advance Information
111
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
CRYSTAL OSCILLATOR
OSC2
CGMXCLK
CLOCK
SELECT
CIRCUIT
OSC1
÷2
A
CGMOUT
B S*
TO SIM
TO SIM
*WHEN S = 1, CGMOUT = B
SIMOSCEN
CGMRDV
CGMRCLK
VDDA
BCS
CGMXFC
USER MODE
VSS
VRS[7:4]
PTC2
MONITOR MODE
PHASE
DETECTOR
VOLTAGE
CONTROLLED
OSCILLATOR
LOOP
FILTER
PLL ANALOG
LOCK
DETECTOR
LOCK
BANDWIDTH
CONTROL
AUTO
ACQ
INTERRUPT
CONTROL
PLLIE
CGMINT
PLLF
MUL[7:4]
CGMVDV
FREQUENCY
DIVIDER
CGMVCLK
Figure 8-1. CGM Block Diagram
Advance Information
112
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
MOTOROLA
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
Functional Description
Addr.
Register Name
Read:
PLL Control Register
(PCTL) Write:
See page 124.
Reset:
$005C
$005D
Bit 7
$005E
5
4
PLLON
BCS
PLLF
PLLIE
R
0
Read:
PLL Bandwidth Control Register
AUTO
(PBWC) Write:
See page 126.
Reset:
0
Read:
PLL Programming Register
(PPG) Write:
See page 128.
Reset:
6
0
1
0
ACQ
XLD
LOCK
R
3
2
1
Bit 0
1
1
1
1
R
R
R
R
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
MUL7
MUL6
MUL5
MUL4
VRS7
VRS6
VRS5
VRS4
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
R
= Reserved
Figure 8-2. CGM I/O Register Summary
8.4.2 Phase-Locked Loop Circuit (PLL)
The PLL is a frequency generator that can operate in either acquisition
mode or tracking mode, depending on the accuracy of the output
frequency. The PLL can change between acquisition and tracking
modes either automatically or manually.
8.4.2.1 PLL Circuits
The PLL consists of these circuits:
•
Voltage-controlled oscillator (VCO)
•
Modulo VCO frequency divider
•
Phase detector
•
Loop filter
•
Lock detector
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
Advance Information
113
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
The operating range of the VCO is programmable for a wide range of
frequencies and for maximum immunity to external noise, including
supply and CGMXFC noise. The VCO frequency is bound to a range
from roughly one-half to twice the center-of-range frequency, fVRS.
Modulating the voltage on the CGMXFC pin changes the frequency
within this range. By design, fVRS is equal to the nominal center-of-range
frequency, fNOM, (4.9152 MHz) times a linear factor, L or (L) fNOM.
CGMRCLK is the PLL reference clock, a buffered version of CGMXCLK.
CGMRCLK runs at a frequency, fRCLK, and is fed to the PLL through a
buffer. The buffer output is the final reference clock, CGMRDV, running
at a frequency, fRDV = fRCLK.
The VCO’s output clock, CGMVCLK, running at a frequency, fVCLK, is
fed back through a programmable modulo divider. The modulo divider
reduces the VCO clock by a factor, N. The divider’s output is the VCO
feedback clock, CGMVDV, running at a frequency, fVDV = fVCLK/N. (See
8.4.2.4 Programming the PLL for more information.)
The phase detector then compares the VCO feedback clock, CGMVDV,
with the final reference clock, CGMRDV. A correction pulse is generated
based on the phase difference between the two signals. The loop filter
then slightly alters the dc voltage on the external capacitor connected to
CGMXFC based on the width and direction of the correction pulse. The
filter can make fast or slow corrections depending on its mode,
described in 8.4.2.2 Acquisition and Tracking Modes. The value of the
external capacitor and the reference frequency determines the speed of
the corrections and the stability of the PLL.
The lock detector compares the frequencies of the VCO feedback clock,
CGMVDV, and the final reference clock, CGMRDV. Therefore, the
speed of the lock detector is directly proportional to the final reference
frequency, fRDV. The circuit determines the mode of the PLL and the lock
condition based on this comparison.
Advance Information
114
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
MOTOROLA
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
Functional Description
8.4.2.2 Acquisition and Tracking Modes
The PLL filter is manually or automatically configurable into one of two
operating modes:
1. Acquisition mode — In acquisition mode, the filter can make large
frequency corrections to the VCO. This mode is used at PLL
startup or when the PLL has suffered a severe noise hit and the
VCO frequency is far off the desired frequency. When in
acquisition mode, the ACQ bit is clear in the PLL bandwidth control
register. See 8.6.2 PLL Bandwidth Control Register.
2. Tracking mode — In tracking mode, the filter makes only small
corrections to the frequency of the VCO. PLL jitter is much lower
in tracking mode, but the response to noise is also slower. The
PLL enters tracking mode when the VCO frequency is nearly
correct, such as when the PLL is selected as the base clock
source. See 8.4.3 Base Clock Selector Circuit. The PLL is
automatically in tracking mode when not in acquisition mode or
when the ACQ bit is set.
8.4.2.3 Manual and Automatic PLL Bandwidth Modes
The PLL can change the bandwidth or operational mode of the loop filter
manually or automatically.
In automatic bandwidth control mode (AUTO = 1), the lock detector
automatically switches between acquisition and tracking modes.
Automatic bandwidth control mode also is used to determine when the
VCO clock, CGMVCLK, is safe to use as the source for the base clock,
CGMOUT. See 8.6.2 PLL Bandwidth Control Register. If PLL
interrupts are enabled, the software can wait for a PLL interrupt request
and then check the LOCK bit. If interrupts are disabled, software can poll
the LOCK bit continuously (during PLL startup, usually) or at periodic
intervals. In either case, when the LOCK bit is set, the VCO clock is safe
to use as the source for the base clock. See 8.4.3 Base Clock Selector
Circuit. If the VCO is selected as the source for the base clock and the
LOCK bit is clear, the PLL has suffered a severe noise hit and the
software must take appropriate action, depending on the application.
See 8.7 Interrupts for information and precautions on using interrupts.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
Advance Information
115
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
These conditions apply when the PLL is in automatic bandwidth control
mode:
•
The ACQ bit (see 8.6.2 PLL Bandwidth Control Register) is a
read-only indicator of the mode of the filter. For more information,
see 8.4.2.2 Acquisition and Tracking Modes.
•
The ACQ bit is set when the VCO frequency is within a certain
tolerance, ∆TRK, and is cleared when the VCO frequency is out of
a certain tolerance, ∆UNT. For more information, see
8.9 Acquisition/Lock Time Specifications.
•
The LOCK bit is a read-only indicator of the locked state of the
PLL.
•
The LOCK bit is set when the VCO frequency is within a certain
tolerance, ∆Lock, and is cleared when the VCO frequency is out of
a certain tolerance, ∆UNL. For more information, see
8.9 Acquisition/Lock Time Specifications.
•
CPU interrupts can occur if enabled (PLLIE = 1) when the PLL’s
lock condition changes, toggling the LOCK bit. For more
information, see 8.6.1 PLL Control Register.
The PLL also may operate in manual mode (AUTO = 0). Manual mode
is used by systems that do not require an indicator of the lock condition
for proper operation. Such systems typically operate well below fBUSMAX
and require fast startup. These conditions apply when in manual mode:
Advance Information
116
•
ACQ is a writable control bit that controls the mode of the filter.
Before turning on the PLL in manual mode, the ACQ bit must be
clear.
•
Before entering tracking mode (ACQ = 1), software must wait a
given time, tACQ (see 8.9 Acquisition/Lock Time
Specifications), after turning on the PLL by setting PLLON in the
PLL control register (PCTL).
•
Software must wait a given time, tAL, after entering tracking mode
before selecting the PLL as the clock source to CGMOUT
(BCS = 1).
•
The LOCK bit is disabled.
•
CPU interrupts from the CGM are disabled.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
MOTOROLA
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
Functional Description
8.4.2.4 Programming the PLL
Use this 9-step procedure to program the PLL. Table 8-1 lists the
variables used and their meaning.
Table 8-1. Variable Definitions
Variable
Definition
fBUSDES
Desired bus clock frequency
fVCLKDES
Desired VCO clock frequency
fRCLK
Chosen reference crystal frequency
fVCLK
Calculated VCO clock frequency
fBUS
Calculated bus clock frequency
fNOM
Nominal VCO center frequency
fVRS
Shifted FCO center frequency
1. Choose the desired bus frequency, fBUSDES.
Example: fBUSDES = 8 MHz
2. Calculate the desired VCO frequency, fVCLKDES.
fVCLKDES = 4 x fBUSDES
Example: fVCLKDES = 4 x 8 MHz = 32 MHz
3. Using a reference frequency, fRCLK, equal to the crystal frequency,
calculate the VCO frequency multiplier, N. Round the result to the
nearest integer.
N=
Example: N =
fVCLKDES
fRCLK
32 MHz
= 8 MHz
4 MHz
4. Calculate the VCO frequency, fVCLK.
fVCLK = N x fRCLK
Example: fVCLK = 8 x 4 MHz = 32 MHz
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
Advance Information
117
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
5. Calculate the bus frequency, fBUS, and compare fBUS with
fBUSDES.
fBUS =
Example: N =
fVCLK
4
32 MHz
= 8 MHz
4 MHz
6. If the calculated fBUS is not within the tolerance limits of the
application, select another fBUSDES or another fRCLK.
7. Using the value 4.9152 MHz for fNOM, calculate the VCO linear
range multiplier, L. The linear range multiplier controls the
frequency range of the PLL.
L = round
Example: L =
fVCLK
fNOM
32 MHz
= 7 MHz
4.9152 MHz
8. Calculate the VCO center-of-range frequency, fVRS. The
center-or-range frequency is the midpoint between the minimum
and maximum frequencies attainable by the PLL.
fVRS = L x fNOM
Example: fVRS = 7 x 4.9152 MHz = 34.4 MHz
For proper operation,
CAUTION:
Exceeding the recommended maximum bus frequency or VCO
frequency can crash the MCU.
9. Program the PLL registers accordingly:
a. In the upper four bits of the PLL programming register (PPG),
program the binary equivalent of N.
b. In the lower four bits of the PLL programming register (PPG),
program the binary equivalent of L.
Advance Information
118
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
MOTOROLA
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
Functional Description
8.4.2.5 Special Programming Exceptions
The programming method described in 8.4.2.4 Programming the PLL
does not account for possible exceptions. A value of 0 for N or L is
meaningless when used in the equations given. To account for these
exceptions:
•
A 0 value for N is interpreted exactly the same as a value of 1.
•
A 0 value for L disables the PLL and prevents its selection as the
source for the base clock. See 8.4.3 Base Clock Selector
Circuit.
8.4.3 Base Clock Selector Circuit
This circuit is used to select either the crystal clock, CGMXCLK, or the
VCO clock, CGMVCLK, as the source of the base clock, CGMOUT. The
two input clocks go through a transition control circuit that waits up to
three CGMXCLK cycles and three CGMVCLK cycles to change from
one clock source to the other. During this time, CGMOUT is held in
stasis. The output of the transition control circuit is then divided by two
to correct the duty cycle. Therefore, the bus clock frequency, which is
one-half of the base clock frequency, is one-fourth the frequency of the
selected clock (CGMXCLK or CGMVCLK).
The BCS bit in the PLL control register (PCTL) selects which clock drives
CGMOUT. The VCO clock cannot be selected as the base clock source
if the PLL is not turned on. The PLL cannot be turned off if the VCO clock
is selected. The PLL cannot be turned on or off simultaneously with the
selection or deselection of the VCO clock. The VCO clock also cannot
be selected as the base clock source if the factor L is programmed to a 0.
This value would set up a condition inconsistent with the operation of the
PLL, so that the PLL would be disabled and the crystal clock would be
forced as the source of the base clock.
8.4.4 CGM External Connections
In its typical configuration, the CGM requires seven external
components. Five of these are for the crystal oscillator and two are for
the PLL.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
Advance Information
119
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
The crystal oscillator is normally connected in a Pierce oscillator
configuration, as shown in Figure 8-3. Figure 8-3 shows only the logical
representation of the internal components and may not represent actual
circuitry.
SIMOSCEN
CGMXCLK
OSC1
OSC2
VSS
CGMXFC
VDDA
VDD
C)
R 6*
C%<3
R%
X1
C1
C2
*R S can be 0 (shorted) when used with higher-frequency crystals.
Refer to manufacturer’s data.
Figure 8-3. CGM External Connections
The oscillator configuration uses five components:
1. Crystal, X1
2. Fixed capacitor, C1
3. Tuning capacitor, C2 (can also be a fixed capacitor)
4. Feedback resistor, RB
5. Series resistor, RS (optional)
The series resistor (RS) is included in the diagram to follow strict Pierce
oscillator guidelines and may not be required for all ranges of operation,
especially with high-frequency crystals. Refer to the crystal
manufacturer’s data for more information.
Advance Information
120
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
MOTOROLA
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
I/O Signals
Figure 8-3 also shows the external components for the PLL:
NOTE:
•
Bypass capacitor, CBYP
•
Filter capacitor, CF
Routing should be done with great care to minimize signal cross talk and
noise. (See 8.9 Acquisition/Lock Time Specifications for routing
information and more information on the filter capacitor’s value and its
effects on PLL performance.)
8.5 I/O Signals
This section describes the CGM input/output (I/O) signals.
8.5.1 Crystal Amplifier Input Pin (OSC1)
The OSC1 pin is an input to the crystal oscillator amplifier.
8.5.2 Crystal Amplifier Output Pin (OSC2)
The OSC2 pin is the output of the crystal oscillator inverting amplifier.
8.5.3 External Filter Capacitor Pin (CGMXFC)
The CGMXFC pin is required by the loop filter to filter out phase
corrections. A small external capacitor is connected to this pin.
NOTE:
To prevent noise problems, CF should be placed as close to the
CGMXFC pin as possible, with minimum routing distances and no
routing of other signals across the CF connection.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
Advance Information
121
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
8.5.4 PLL Analog Power Pin (VDDA)
VDDA is a power pin used by the analog portions of the PLL. Connect
the VDDA pin to the same voltage potential as the VDD pin.
NOTE:
Route VDDA carefully for maximum noise immunity and place bypass
capacitors as close as possible to the package.
8.5.5 Oscillator Enable Signal (SIMOSCEN)
The SIMOSCEN signal comes from the system integration module (SIM)
and enables the oscillator and PLL.
8.5.6 Crystal Output Frequency Signal (CGMXCLK)
CGMXCLK is the crystal oscillator output signal. It runs at the full speed
of the crystal (fXCLK) and comes directly from the crystal oscillator circuit.
Figure 8-3 shows only the logical relation of CGMXCLK to OSC1 and
OSC2 and may not represent the actual circuitry. The duty cycle of
CGMXCLK is unknown and may depend on the crystal and other
external factors. Also, the frequency and amplitude of CGMXCLK can be
unstable at startup.
8.5.7 CGM Base Clock Output (CGMOUT)
CGMOUT is the clock output of the CGM. This signal goes to the SIM,
which generates the MCU clocks. CGMOUT is a 50 percent duty cycle
clock running at twice the bus frequency. CGMOUT is software
programmable to be either the oscillator output, CGMXCLK, divided by
two or the VCO clock, CGMVCLK, divided by two.
8.5.8 CGM CPU Interrupt (CGMINT)
CGMINT is the interrupt signal generated by the PLL lock detector.
Advance Information
122
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
MOTOROLA
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
CGM Registers
8.6 CGM Registers
These registers control and monitor operation of the CGM:
•
PLL control register (PCTL)
See 8.6.1 PLL Control Register.
•
PLL bandwidth control register (PBWC)
See 8.6.2 PLL Bandwidth Control Register.
•
PLL programming register (PPG)
See 8.6.3 PLL Programming Register.
Figure 8-4 is a summary of the CGM registers.
Addr.
Register Name
Read:
PLL Control Register
(PCTL) Write:
See page 124.
Reset:
$005C
$005D
Bit 7
PLLIE
$005E
PLLF
5
4
PLLON
BCS
R
0
Read:
PLL Bandwidth Control Register
AUTO
(PBWC) Write:
See page 126.
Reset:
0
Read:
PLL Programming Register
(PPG) Write:
See page 128.
Reset:
6
0
LOCK
1
0
ACQ
XLD
R
3
2
1
Bit 0
1
1
1
1
R
R
R
R
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
MUL7
MUL6
MUL5
MUL4
VRS7
VRS6
VRS5
VRS4
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
R
= Reserved
Notes:
1. When AUTO = 0, PLLIE is forced to logic 0 and is read-only.
2. When AUTO = 0, PLLF and LOCK read as logic 0.
3. When AUTO = 1, ACQ is read-only.
4. When PLLON = 0 or VRS[7:4] = $0, BCS is forced to logic 0 and is read-only.
5. When PLLON = 1, the PLL programming register is read-only.
6. When BCS = 1, PLLON is forced set and is read-only.
Figure 8-4. CGM I/O Register Summary
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
Advance Information
123
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
8.6.1 PLL Control Register
The PLL control register (PCTL) contains the interrupt enable and flag
bits, the on/off switch, and the base clock selector bit.
Address:
$005C
Bit 7
Read:
6
4
PLLON
BCS
PLLF
PLLIE
Write:
Reset:
5
R
0
0
R
= Reserved
1
0
3
2
1
Bit 0
1
1
1
1
R
R
R
R
1
1
1
1
Figure 8-5. PLL Control Register (PCTL)
PLLIE — PLL Interrupt Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables the PLL to generate an interrupt request
when the LOCK bit toggles, setting the PLL flag, PLLF. When the
AUTO bit in the PLL bandwidth control register (PBWC) is clear,
PLLIE cannot be written and reads as logic 0. Reset clears the
PLLIE bit.
1 = PLL interrupts enabled
0 = PLL interrupts disabled
PLLF — PLL Interrupt Flag
This read-only bit is set whenever the LOCK bit toggles. PLLF
generates an interrupt request if the PLLIE bit also is set. PLLF
always reads as logic 0 when the AUTO bit in the PLL bandwidth
control register (PBWC) is clear. Clear the PLLF bit by reading the
PLL control register. Reset clears the PLLF bit.
1 = Change in lock condition
0 = No change in lock condition
NOTE:
Advance Information
124
Do not inadvertently clear the PLLF bit. Any read or read-modify-write
operation on the PLL control register clears the PLLF bit.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
MOTOROLA
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
CGM Registers
PLLON — PLL On Bit
This read/write bit activates the PLL and enables the VCO clock,
CGMVCLK. PLLON cannot be cleared if the VCO clock is driving the
base clock, CGMOUT (BCS = 1). See 8.4.3 Base Clock Selector
Circuit. Reset sets this bit so that the loop can stabilize as the MCU
is powering up.
1 = PLL on
0 = PLL off
BCS — Base Clock Select Bit
This read/write bit selects either the crystal oscillator output,
CGMXCLK, or the VCO clock, CGMVCLK, as the source of the CGM
output, CGMOUT. CGMOUT frequency is one-half the frequency of
the selected clock. BCS cannot be set while the PLLON bit is clear.
After toggling BCS, it may take up to three CGMXCLK and three
CGMVCLK cycles to complete the transition from one source clock to
the other. During the transition, CGMOUT is held in stasis. See
8.4.3 Base Clock Selector Circuit. Reset clears the BCS bit.
1 = CGMVCLK divided by two drives CGMOUT
0 = CGMXCLK divided by two drives CGMOUT
NOTE:
PLLON and BCS have built-in protection that prevents the base clock
selector circuit from selecting the VCO clock as the source of the base
clock if the PLL is off. Therefore, PLLON cannot be cleared when BCS
is set, and BCS cannot be set when PLLON is clear. If the PLL is off
(PLLON = 0), selecting CGMVCLK requires two writes to the PLL control
register. See 8.4.3 Base Clock Selector Circuit.
PCTL[3:0] — Unimplemented Bits
These bits provide no function and always read as logic 1s.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
Advance Information
125
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
8.6.2 PLL Bandwidth Control Register
The PLL bandwidth control register (PBWC):
•
Selects automatic or manual (software-controlled) bandwidth
control mode
•
Indicates when the PLL is locked
•
In automatic bandwidth control mode, indicates when the PLL is in
acquisition or tracking mode
•
In manual operation, forces the PLL into acquisition or tracking
mode
Address: $005D
Bit 7
Read:
6
4
ACQ
XLD
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
LOCK
AUTO
Write:
Reset:
5
R
0
0
R
= Reserved
0
0
Figure 8-6. PLL Bandwidth Control Register (PBWC)
AUTO — Automatic Bandwidth Control Bit
This read/write bit selects automatic or manual bandwidth control.
When initializing the PLL for manual operation (AUTO = 0), clear the
ACQ bit before turning on the PLL. Reset clears the AUTO bit.
1 = Automatic bandwidth control
0 = Manual bandwidth control
LOCK — Lock Indicator Bit
When the AUTO bit is set, LOCK is a read-only bit that becomes set
when the VCO clock, CGMVCLK, is locked (running at the
programmed frequency). When the AUTO bit is clear, LOCK reads as
logic 0 and has no meaning. Reset clears the LOCK bit.
1 = VCO frequency correct or locked
0 = VCO frequency incorrect or unlocked
Advance Information
126
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
MOTOROLA
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
CGM Registers
ACQ — Acquisition Mode Bit
When the AUTO bit is set, ACQ is a read-only bit that indicates
whether the PLL is in acquisition mode or tracking mode. When the
AUTO bit is clear, ACQ is a read/write bit that controls whether the
PLL is in acquisition or tracking mode.
In automatic bandwidth control mode (AUTO = 1), the last-written
value from manual operation is stored in a temporary location and is
recovered when manual operation resumes. Reset clears this bit,
enabling acquisition mode.
1 = Tracking mode
0 = Acquisition mode
XLD — Crystal Loss Detect Bit
When the VCO output, CGMVCLK, is driving CGMOUT, this
read/write bit can indicate whether the crystal reference frequency is
active or not. To check the status of the crystal reference, follow these
steps:
1. Write a logic 1 to XLD.
2. Wait N × 4 cycles. (N is the VCO frequency multiplier.)
3. Read XLD.
The crystal loss detect function works only when the BCS bit is set,
selecting CGMVCLK to drive CGMOUT. When BCS is clear, XLD
always reads as logic 0.
1 = Crystal reference is not active.
0 = Crystal reference is active.
PBWC[3:0] — Reserved for Test
These bits enable test functions not available in user mode. To ensure
software portability from development systems to user applications,
software should write 0s to PBWC[3:0] whenever writing to PBWC.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
Advance Information
127
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
8.6.3 PLL Programming Register
The PLL programming register (PPG) contains the programming
information for the modulo feedback divider and the programming
information for the hardware configuration of the VCO.
Address: $005E
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
MUL7
MUL6
MUL5
MUL4
VRS7
VRS6
VRS5
VRS4
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Figure 8-7. PLL Programming Register (PPG)
MUL[7:4] — Multiplier Select Bits
These read/write bits control the modulo feedback divider that selects
the VCO frequency multiplier, N. See 8.4.2.1 PLL Circuits and
8.4.2.4 Programming the PLL. A value of $0 in the multiplier select
bits configures the modulo feedback divider the same as a value of
$1. Reset initializes these bits to $6 to give a default multiply value
of 6.
Table 8-2. VCO Frequency Multiplier (N) Selection
NOTE:
Advance Information
128
MUL7:MUL6:MUL5:MUL4
VCO Frequency Multiplier (N)
0000
1
0001
1
0010
2
0011
3
1101
13
1110
14
1111
15
The multiplier select bits have built-in protection that prevents them from
being written when the PLL is on (PLLON = 1).
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
MOTOROLA
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
Interrupts
VRS[7:4] — VCO Range Select Bits
These read/write bits control the hardware center-of-range linear
multiplier L, which controls the hardware center-of-range frequency
fVRS. See 8.4.2.1 PLL Circuits, 8.4.2.4 Programming the PLL and
8.6.1 PLL Control Register. VRS[7:4] cannot be written when the
PLLON bit in the PLL control register (PCTL) is set. See 8.4.2.5
Special Programming Exceptions. A value of $0 in the VCO range
select bits disables the PLL and clears the BCS bit in the PCTL. See
8.4.3 Base Clock Selector Circuit and 8.4.2.5 Special
Programming Exceptions for more information.
Reset initializes the bits to $6 to give a default range multiply
value of 6.
NOTE:
The VCO range select bits have built-in protection that prevents them
from being written when the PLL is on (PLLON = 1) and prevents
selection of the VCO clock as the source of the base clock (BCS = 1) if
the VCO range select bits are all clear.
The VCO range select bits must be programmed correctly. Incorrect
programming may result in failure of the PLL to achieve lock.
8.7 Interrupts
When the AUTO bit is set in the PLL bandwidth control register (PBWC),
the PLL can generate a CPU interrupt request every time the LOCK bit
changes state. The PLLIE bit in the PLL control register (PCTL) enables
CPU interrupts from the PLL. PLLF, the interrupt flag in the PCTL,
becomes set whether interrupts are enabled or not. When the AUTO bit
is clear, CPU interrupts from the PLL are disabled and PLLF reads as
logic 0.
Software should read the LOCK bit after a PLL interrupt request to see
if the request was due to an entry into lock or an exit from lock. When the
PLL enters lock, the VCO clock, CGMVCLK, divided by two can be
selected as the CGMOUT source by setting BCS in the PCTL. When the
PLL exits lock, the VCO clock frequency is corrupt, and appropriate
precautions should be taken. If the application is not
frequency-sensitive, interrupts should be disabled to prevent PLL
interrupt service routines from impeding software performance or from
exceeding stack limitations.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
Advance Information
129
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
NOTE:
Software can select the CGMVCLK divided by two as the CGMOUT
source even if the PLL is not locked (LOCK = 0). Therefore, software
should make sure the PLL is locked before setting the BCS bit.
8.8 Wait Mode
The WAIT instruction puts the MCU in low power-consumption standby
mode.
The WAIT instruction does not affect the CGM. Before entering wait
mode, software can disengage and turn off the PLL by clearing the BCS
and PLLON bits in the PLL control register (PCTL). Less power-sensitive
applications can disengage the PLL without turning it off. Applications
that require the PLL to wake the MCU from wait mode also can deselect
the PLL output without turning off the PLL.
8.9 Acquisition/Lock Time Specifications
The acquisition and lock times of the PLL are, in many applications, the
most critical PLL design parameters. Proper design and use of the PLL
ensures the highest stability and lowest acquisition/lock times.
8.9.1 Acquisition/Lock Time Definitions
Typical control systems refer to the acquisition time or lock time as the
reaction time, within specified tolerances, of the system to a step input.
In a PLL, the step input occurs when the PLL is turned on or when it
suffers a noise hit. The tolerance is usually specified as a percent of the
step input or when the output settles to the desired value plus or minus
a percent of the frequency change. Therefore, the reaction time is
constant in this definition, regardless of the size of the step input. For
example, consider a system with a 5 percent acquisition time tolerance.
If a command instructs the system to change from 0 Hz to 1 MHz, the
acquisition time is the time taken for the frequency to reach
1 MHz ± 50 kHz. Fifty kHz = 5% of the 1-MHz step input. If the system is
operating at 1 MHz and suffers a –100-kHz noise hit, the acquisition time
is the time taken to return from 900 kHz to 1 MHz ±5 kHz. Five kHz = 5%
of the 100-kHz step input.
Advance Information
130
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
MOTOROLA
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
Acquisition/Lock Time Specifications
Other systems refer to acquisition and lock times as the time the system
takes to reduce the error between the actual output and the desired
output to within specified tolerances. Therefore, the acquisition or lock
time varies according to the original error in the output. Minor errors may
not even be registered. Typical PLL applications prefer to use this
definition because the system requires the output frequency to be within
a certain tolerance of the desired frequency regardless of the size of the
initial error.
The discrepancy in these definitions makes it difficult to specify an
acquisition or lock time for a typical PLL. Therefore, the definitions for
acquisition and lock times for this module are:
•
Acquisition time, tACQ, is the time the PLL takes to reduce the error
between the actual output frequency and the desired output
frequency to less than the tracking mode entry tolerance, ∆TRK.
Acquisition time is based on an initial frequency error,
(fDES – fORIG)/fDES, of not more than ±100 percent. In automatic
bandwidth control mode (see 8.4.2.3 Manual and Automatic PLL
Bandwidth Modes), acquisition time expires when the ACQ bit
becomes set in the PLL bandwidth control register (PBWC).
•
Lock time, tLock, is the time the PLL takes to reduce the error
between the actual output frequency and the desired output
frequency to less than the lock mode entry tolerance, ∆Lock. Lock
time is based on an initial frequency error, (fDES – fORIG)/fDES, of
not more than ±100 percent. In automatic bandwidth control
mode, lock time expires when the LOCK bit becomes set in the
PLL bandwidth control register (PBWC). See 8.4.2.3 Manual and
Automatic PLL Bandwidth Modes.
Obviously, the acquisition and lock times can vary according to how
large the frequency error is and may be shorter or longer in many cases.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
Advance Information
131
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
8.9.2 Parametric Influences on Reaction Time
Acquisition and lock times are designed to be as short as possible while
still providing the highest possible stability. These reaction times are not
constant, however. Many factors directly and indirectly affect the
acquisition time.
The most critical parameter which affects the reaction times of the PLL
is the reference frequency, fRDV. This frequency is the input to the phase
detector and controls how often the PLL makes corrections. For stability,
the corrections must be small compared to the desired frequency, so
several corrections are required to reduce the frequency error.
Therefore, the slower the reference the longer it takes to make these
corrections. This parameter is also under user control via the choice of
crystal frequency, fXCLK.
Another critical parameter is the external filter capacitor. The PLL
modifies the voltage on the VCO by adding or subtracting charge from
this capacitor. Therefore, the rate at which the voltage changes for a
given frequency error (thus change in charge) is proportional to the
capacitor size. The size of the capacitor also is related to the stability of
the PLL. If the capacitor is too small, the PLL cannot make small enough
adjustments to the voltage and the system cannot lock. If the capacitor
is too large, the PLL may not be able to adjust the voltage in a
reasonable time. See 8.9.3 Choosing a Filter Capacitor.
Also important is the operating voltage potential applied to VDDA. The
power supply potential alters the characteristics of the PLL. A fixed value
is best. Variable supplies, such as batteries, are acceptable if they vary
within a known range at very slow speeds. Noise on the power supply is
not acceptable, because it causes small frequency errors which
continually change the acquisition time of the PLL.
Temperature and processing also can affect acquisition time because
the electrical characteristics of the PLL change. The part operates as
specified as long as these influences stay within the specified limits.
External factors, however, can cause drastic changes in the operation of
the PLL. These factors include noise injected into the PLL through the
filter capacitor filter, capacitor leakage, stray impedances on the circuit
board, and even humidity or circuit board contamination.
Advance Information
132
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
MOTOROLA
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
Acquisition/Lock Time Specifications
8.9.3 Choosing a Filter Capacitor
As described in 8.9.2 Parametric Influences on Reaction Time, the
external filter capacitor, CF, is critical to the stability and reaction time of
the PLL. The PLL is also dependent on reference frequency and supply
voltage. The value of the capacitor must, therefore, be chosen with
supply potential and reference frequency in mind. For proper operation,
the external filter capacitor must be chosen according to this equation:
 V DDA
C F = C FACT  ---------------
 f RDV 
For acceptable values of CFACT, see 8.9 Acquisition/Lock Time
Specifications. For the value of VDDA, choose the voltage potential at
which the MCU is operating. If the power supply is variable, choose a
value near the middle of the range of possible supply values.
This equation does not always yield a commonly available capacitor
size, so round to the nearest available size. If the value is between two
different sizes, choose the higher value for better stability. Choosing the
lower size may seem attractive for acquisition time improvement, but the
PLL can become unstable. Also, always choose a capacitor with a tight
tolerance (±20 percent or better) and low dissipation.
8.9.4 Reaction Time Calculation
The actual acquisition and lock times can be calculated using the
equations here. These equations yield nominal values under these
conditions:
•
Correct selection of filter capacitor, CF, see 8.9.3 Choosing a
Filter Capacitor
•
Room temperature operation
•
Negligible external leakage on CGMXFC
•
Negligible noise
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
Advance Information
133
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
The K factor in the equations is derived from internal PLL parameters.
KACQ is the K factor when the PLL is configured in acquisition mode, and
KTRK is the K factor when the PLL is configured in tracking mode. See
8.4.2.2 Acquisition and Tracking Modes.
 V DDA
8
tACQ =  ---------------  ---------------
 f RDV  K ACQ
 V DDA
4
t AL =  ---------------  --------------
 f RDV  K TRK
tLock = t ACQ + t AL
NOTE:
The inverse proportionality between the lock time and the reference
frequency.
In automatic bandwidth control mode, the acquisition and lock times are
quantized into units based on the reference frequency. See
8.4.2.3 Manual and Automatic PLL Bandwidth Modes A certain
number of clock cycles, QACQ, is required to ascertain that the PLL is
within the tracking mode entry tolerance, ∆TRK, before exiting acquisition
mode. A certain number of clock cycles, nTRK, is required to ascertain
that the PLL is within the lock mode entry tolerance, ∆Lock. Therefore, the
acquisition time, tACQ, is an integer multiple of nACQ/fRDV, and the
acquisition to lock time, tAL, is an integer multiple of nTRK/fRDV. Also,
since the average frequency over the entire measurement period must
be within the specified tolerance, the total time usually is longer than
tLock as calculated in the previous example.
In manual mode, it is usually necessary to wait considerably longer than
tLock before selecting the PLL clock (see 8.4.3 Base Clock Selector
Circuit) because the factors described in 8.9.2 Parametric Influences
on Reaction Time may slow the lock time considerably.
Advance Information
134
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Clock Generator Module (CGM)
MOTOROLA
Advance Information — MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32
Section 9. Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control
(PWMMC)
9.1 Contents
9.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136
9.3
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
9.4
Timebase . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
9.4.1
Resolution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .141
9.4.2
Prescaler . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
9.5
PWM Generators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
9.5.1
Load Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
9.5.2
PWM Data Overflow and Underflow Conditions. . . . . . . . .147
9.6
Output Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147
9.6.1
Selecting Six Independent PWMs
or Three Complementary PWM Pairs . . . . . . . . . . . . . .147
9.6.2
Dead-Time Insertion. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149
9.6.3
Top/Bottom Correction with Motor Phase
Current Polarity Sensing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153
9.6.4
Output Polarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157
9.6.5
PWM Output Port Control. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158
9.7
Fault Protection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
9.7.1
Fault Condition Input Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
9.7.1.1
Fault Pin Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .161
9.7.1.2
Automatic Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163
9.7.1.3
Manual Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .164
9.7.2
Software Output Disable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165
9.7.3
Output Port Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
9.8
Initialization and the PWMEN Bit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166
9.9
PWM Operation in Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
Advance Information
135
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control
9.10 Control Logic Block. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .168
9.10.1 PWM Counter Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168
9.10.2 PWM Counter Modulo Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169
9.10.3 PWMx Value Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170
9.10.4 PWM Control Register 1. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171
9.10.5 PWM Control Register 2. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173
9.10.6 Dead-Time Write-Once Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176
9.10.7 PWM Disable Mapping Write-Once Register . . . . . . . . . . . 176
9.10.8 Fault Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177
9.10.9 Fault Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
9.10.10 Fault Acknowledge Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180
9.10.11 PWM Output Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182
9.11
PWM Glossary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183
9.2 Introduction
This section describes the pulse-width modulator for motor control
(PWMMC, version A). The MC68HC908MR24 PWM module can
generate three complementary PWM pairs or six independent PWM
signals. These PWM signals can be center-aligned or edge-aligned. A
block diagram of the PWM module is shown in Figure 9-1.
A12-bit timer PWM counter is common to all six channels. PWM
resolution is one clock period for edge-aligned operation and two clock
periods for center-aligned operation. The clock period is dependent on
the internal operating frequency (fOP) and a programmable prescaler.
The highest resolution for edge-aligned operation is 125 ns
(fOP = 8 MHz). The highest resolution for center-aligned operation is
250 ns (fOP = 8 MHz).
When generating complementary PWM signals, the module features
automatic dead-time insertion to the PWM output pairs and transparent
toggling of PWM data based upon sensed motor phase current polarity.
A summary of the PWM registers is shown in Figure 9-2.
Advance Information
136
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
MOTOROLA
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
Features
9.3 Features
Features of the PWMMC include:
•
Three complementary PWM pairs or six independent PWM
signals
•
Edge-aligned PWM signals or center-aligned PWM signals
•
PWM signal polarity control
•
20-mA current sink capability on PWM pins
•
Manual PWM output control through software
•
Programmable fault protection
•
Complementary mode featuring:
– Dead-time insertion
– Separate top/bottom pulse width correction via current sensing
or programmable software bits
8
CPU BUS
PWM1 PIN
FAULT PROTECTION
PWM CHANNELS 3 AND 4
PWM2 PIN
OUTPUT CONTROL
CONTROL LOGIC BLOCK
PWM CHANNELS 1 AND 2
PWM3 PIN
PWM4 PIN
PWM5 PIN
PWM CHANNELS 5 AND 6
PWM6 PIN
4
12
FAULT
INTERRUPT
PINS
TIMEBASE
3
COIL CURRENT
POLARITY PINS
Figure 9-1. PWM Module Block Diagram
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
Advance Information
137
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control
Addr.
$0020
$0021
$0022
$0023
$0024
$0025
$0026
$0027
Register Name
Read:
PWM Control Register 1
(PCTL1) Write:
See page 171.
Reset:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
DISX
DISY
PWMINT
PWMF
ISENS1
ISENS0
LDOK
PWMEN
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
IPOL1
IPOL2
IPOL3
PRSC1
PRSC0
0
0
0
0
0
0
FINT3
FMODE3
FINT2
FMODE2
FINT1
FMODE1
0
0
0
0
0
0
FFLAG4
FPIN3
FFLAG3
FPIN2
FFLAG2
FPIN1
FFLAG1
0
U
0
U
0
U
0
0
DT6
DT5
DT4
DT3
DT2
DT1
Read:
PWM Control Register 2
LDFQ1
(PCTL2) Write:
See page 174.
Reset:
0
0
LDFQ0
0
Read:
Fault Control Register
FINT4 FMODE4
(FCR) Write:
See page 177.
Reset:
0
0
Read: FPIN4
Fault Status Register
(FSR) Write:
See page 179.
Reset:
U
Read:
Fault Acknowledge Register
(FTACK) Write:
See page 180.
Reset:
Read:
PWM Output Control
Register (PWMOUT) Write:
See page 182.
Reset:
Read:
PWM Counter Register High
(PCNTH) Write:
See page 168.
Reset:
Read:
PWM Counter Register Low
(PCNTL) Write:
See page 168.
Reset:
Read:
PWM Counter Modulo Register
$0028
High (PMODH) Write:
See page 169.
Reset:
0
FTACK4
0
FTACK3
FTACK2
FTACK1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
OUTCTL
OUT6
OUT5
OUT4
OUT3
OUT2
OUT1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
0
X
X
X
X
Bold
= Buffered
0
0
R
0
= Reserved
0
X = Indeterminate
Figure 9-2. Register Summary (Sheet 1 of 3)
Advance Information
138
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
MOTOROLA
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
Features
Addr.
Register Name
Read:
PWM Counter Modulo Register
$0029
Low (PMODL) Write:
See page 169.
Reset:
$002A
$002B
$002C
$002D
$002E
$002F
$0030
$0031
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bold
= Buffered
Read:
PWM 1 Value Register High
Bit 15
(PVAL1H) Write:
See page 170.
Reset:
0
Read:
PWM 1 Value Register Low
(PVAL1L) Write:
See page 170.
Reset:
Read:
PWM 2 Value Register High
Bit 15
(PVAL2H) Write:
See page 170.
Reset:
0
Read:
PWM 2 Value Register Low
(PVAL2L) Write:
See page 170.
Reset:
Read:
PWM 3 Value Register High
Bit 15
(PVAL3H) Write:
See page 170.
Reset:
0
Read:
PWM 3 Value Register Low
(PVAL3L) Write:
See page 170.
Reset:
Read:
PWM 4 Value Register High
Bit 15
(PVAL4H) Write:
See page 170.
Reset:
0
Read:
PWM 4 Value Register Low
(PVAL4L) Write:
See page 170.
Reset:
R
= Reserved
X = Indeterminate
Figure 9-2. Register Summary (Sheet 2 of 3)
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
Advance Information
139
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control
Addr.
$0032
$0033
$0034
$0035
$0036
$0037
Register Name
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Bold
= Buffered
Read:
PWM 5 Value Register High
Bit 15
(PVAL5H) Write:
See page 170.
Reset:
0
Read:
PWM 5 Value Register Low
(PVAL5L) Write:
See page 170.
Reset:
Read:
PWM 6 Value Register High
Bit 15
(PVAL6H) Write:
See page 170.
Reset:
0
Read:
PWM 6 Value Register Low
(PMVAL6L) Write:
See page 170.
Reset:
Read:
Dead-Time Write-Once
Register (DEADTM) Write:
See page 176.
Reset:
Read:
PWM Disable Mapping
Write-Once Register Write:
(DISMAP) See page 176.
Reset:
R
= Reserved
X = Indeterminate
Figure 9-2. Register Summary (Sheet 3 of 3)
Advance Information
140
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
MOTOROLA
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
Timebase
9.4 Timebase
This section provides a discussion of the timebase.
9.4.1 Resolution
In center-aligned mode, a 12-bit up/down counter is used to create the
PWM period. Therefore, the PWM resolution in center-aligned mode is
two clocks (highest resolution is 250 ns @ fOP = 8 MHz) as shown in
Figure 9-3. The up/down counter uses the value in the timer modulus
register to determine its maximum count. The PWM period will equal:
[(timer modulus) x (PWM clock period) x 2].
UP/DOWN COUNTER
MODULUS = 4
PERIOD = 8 X (PWM CLOCK PERIOD)
PWM = 0
PWM = 1
PWM = 2
PWM = 3
PWM = 4
Figure 9-3. Center-Aligned PWM (Positive Polarity)
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
Advance Information
141
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control
For edge-aligned mode, a 12-bit up-only counter is used to create the
PWM period. Therefore, the PWM resolution in edge-aligned mode is
one clock (highest resolution is125 ns @ fOP = 8 MHz) as shown in
Figure 9-4. Again, the timer modulus register is used to determine the
maximum count. The PWM period will equal:
(timer modulus) x (PWM clock period)
Center-aligned operation versus edge-aligned operation is determined
by the option EDGE. See 5.3 Functional Description.
UP-ONLY COUNTER
MODULUS = 4
PERIOD = 4 X (PWM
CLOCK PERIOD)
PWM = 0
PWM = 1
PWM = 2
PWM = 3
PWM = 4
Figure 9-4. Edge-Aligned PWM (Positive Polarity)
Advance Information
142
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
MOTOROLA
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
PWM Generators
9.4.2 Prescaler
To permit lower PWM frequencies, a prescaler is provided which will
divide the PWM clock frequency by 1, 2, 4, or 8. Table 9-1 shows how
setting the prescaler bits in PWM control register 2 affects the PWM
clock frequency. This prescaler is buffered and will not be used by the
PWM generator until the LDOK bit is set and a new PWM reload cycle
begins.
Table 9-1. PWM Prescaler
Prescaler Bits
PRSC1 and PRSC0
PWM Clock Frequency
00
fOP
01
fOP/2
10
fOP/4
11
fOP/8
9.5 PWM Generators
Pulse-width modulator (PWM) generators are discussed in this
subsection.
9.5.1 Load Operation
To help avoid erroneous pulse widths and PWM periods, the modulus,
prescaler, and PWM value registers are buffered. New PWM values,
counter modulus values, and prescalers can be loaded from their buffers
into the PWM module every one, two, four, or eight PWM cycles. LDFQ1
and LDFQ0 in PWM control register 2 are used to control this reload
frequency, as shown in Table 9-2. When a reload cycle arrives,
regardless of whether an actual reload occurs (as determined by the
LDOK bit), the PWM reload flag bit in PWM control register 1 will be set.
If the PWMINT bit in PWM control register 1 is set, a CPU interrupt
request will be generated when PWMF is set. Software can use this
interrupt to calculate new PWM parameters in real time for the PWM
module.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
Advance Information
143
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control
Table 9-2. PWM Reload Frequency
Reload Frequency Bits
LDFQ1 and LDFQ0
PWM Reload Frequency
00
Every PWM cycle
01
Every 2 PWM cycles
10
Every 4 PWM cycles
11
Every 8 PWM cycles
For ease of software, the LDFQx bits are buffered. When the LDFQx bits
are changed, the reload frequency will not change until the previous
reload cycle is completed. See Figure 9-5.
NOTE:
When reading the LDFQx bits, the value is the buffered value (for
example, not necessarily the value being acted upon).
RELOAD
RELOAD
RELOAD
RELOAD RELOAD RELOADRELOAD
CHANGE RELOAD
FREQUENCY TO
EVERY 4 CYCLES
CHANGE RELOAD
FREQUENCY TO
EVERY CYCLE
Figure 9-5. Reload Frequency Change
PWMINT enables CPU interrupt requests as shown in Figure 9-6. When
this bit is set, CPU interrupt requests are generated when the PWMF bit
is set. When the PWMINT bit is clear, PWM interrupt requests are
inhibited. PWM reloads will still occur at the reload rate, but no interrupt
requests will be generated.
READ PWMF AS 1,
WRITE PWMF AS 0
OR
RESET
VDD
RESET
PWMF
CPU INTERRUPT
REQUEST
D
LATCH
PWM RELOAD
CK
PWMINT
Figure 9-6. PWM Interrupt Requests
Advance Information
144
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
MOTOROLA
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
PWM Generators
To prevent a partial reload of PWM parameters from occurring while the
software is still calculating them, an interlock bit controlled from software
is provided. This bit informs the PWM module that all the PWM
parameters have been calculated, and it is “okay” to use them. A new
modulus, prescaler, and/or PWM value cannot be loaded into the PWM
module until the LDOK bit in PWM control register 1 is set. When the
LDOK bit is set, these new values are loaded into a second set of
registers and used by the PWM generator at the beginning of the next
PWM reload cycle as shown in Figure 9-7, Figure 9-8, Figure 9-9, and
Figure 9-10. After these values are loaded, the LDOK bit is cleared.
NOTE:
When the PWM module is enabled (via the PWMEN bit), a load will occur
if the LDOK bit is set. Even if it is not set, an interrupt will occur if the
PWMINT bit is set. To prevent this, the software should clear the
PWMINT bit before enabling the PWM module.
LDFQ1:LDFQ0 = 00 (RELOAD EVERY CYCLE)
UP/DOWN
COUNTER
LDOK = 1
MODULUS = 3
PWM VALUE = 1
PWMF SET
LDOK = 0
MODULUS = 3
PWM VALUE = 2
PWMF SET
LDOK = 1
MODULUS = 3
PWM VALUE = 2
PWMF SET
LDOK = 0
MODULUS = 3
PWM VALUE = 1
PWMF SET
PWM
Figure 9-7. Center-Aligned PWM Value Loading
LDFQ1:LDFQ0 = 00 (RELOAD EVERY CYCLE)
UP/DOWN
COUNTER
LDOK = 1
MODULUS = 2
PWM VALUE = 1
PWMF SET
LDOK = 1
MODULUS = 3
PWM VALUE = 1
PWMF SET
LDOK = 1
LDOK = 1
LDOK = 0
MODULUS = 2
MODULUS = 1 MODULUS = 2
PWMVALUE = 1 PWM VALUE = 1 PWM VALUE = 1
PWMF SET
PWMF SET
PWMF SET
PWM
Figure 9-8. Center-Aligned Loading of Modulus
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
Advance Information
145
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control
LDFQ1:LDFQ0 = 00 (RELOAD EVERY CYCLE)
UP-ONLY
COUNTER
LDOK = 1
LDOK = 1
LDOK = 0
LDOK = 0
LDOK = 0
MODULUS = 3 MODULUS = 3
MODULUS = 3
MODULUS = 3
MODULUS = 3
PWM VALUE = 1 PWM VALUE = 2 PWM VALUE = 2 PWM VALUE = 1 PWM VALUE = 1
PWMF SET
PWMF SET
PWMF SET
PWMF SET
PWMF SET
PWM
Figure 9-9. Edge-Aligned PWM Value Loading
LDFQ1:LDFQ0 = 00 (RELOAD EVERY CYCLE)
UP-ONLY
COUNTER
LDOK = 1
MODULUS = 3
PWM VALUE = 2
PWMF SET
LDOK = 1
MODULUS = 4
PWM VALUE = 2
PWMF SET
LDOK = 1
MODULUS = 2
PWM VALUE = 2
PWMF SET
LDOK = 0
MODULUS = 1
PWM VALUE = 2
PWMF SET
PWM
Figure 9-10. Edge-Aligned Modulus Loading
Advance Information
146
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
MOTOROLA
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
Output Control
9.5.2 PWM Data Overflow and Underflow Conditions
The PWM value registers are 16-bit registers. Although the counter is
only 12 bits, the user may write a 16-bit signed value to a PWM value
register. As shown in Figure 9-3 and Figure 9-4, if the PWM value is
less than or equal to zero, the PWM will be inactive for the entire period.
Conversely, if the PWM value is greater than or equal to the timer
modulus, the PWM will be active for the entire period. Refer to Table 9-3.
NOTE:
The terms “active” and “inactive” refer to the asserted and negated
states of the PWM signals and should not be confused with the
high-impedance state of the PWM pins.
Table 9-3. PWM Data Overflow and Underflow Conditions
PWMVALxH:PWMVALxL
Condition
PWM Value Used
$0000–$0FFF
Normal
Per register contents
$1000–$7FFF
Overflow
$FFF
$8000–$FFFF
Underflow
$000
9.6 Output Control
This subsection discusses output control.
9.6.1 Selecting Six Independent PWMs or Three Complementary PWM Pairs
The PWM outputs can be configured as six independent PWM channels
or three complementary channel pairs. The option INDEP determines
which mode is used (see 5.3 Functional Description). If
complementary operation is chosen, the PWM pins are paired as shown
in Figure 9-11. Operation of one pair is then determined by one PWM
value register. This type of operation is meant for use in motor drive
circuits such as the one in Figure 9-12.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
Advance Information
147
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control
PWM1 PIN
PWM VALUE REGISTER
PWMS 1 AND 2
PWM VALUE REGISTER
OUTPUT CONTROL
POLARITY & DEAD-TIME INSERTION
PWM2 PIN
PWMS 3 AND 4
PWM3 PIN
PWM4 PIN
PWM5 PIN
PWMS 5 AND 6
PWM VALUE REGISTER
PWM6 PIN
Figure 9-11. Complementary Pairing
PWM
1
PWM
3
PWM
5
TO
AC
MOTOR
INPUTS
PWM
2
PWM
4
PWM
6
Figure 9-12. Typical AC Motor Drive
Advance Information
148
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
MOTOROLA
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
Output Control
When complementary operation is used, two additional features are
provided:
•
Dead-time insertion
•
Separate top/bottom pulse width correction to correct for
distortions caused by the motor drive characteristics
If independent operation is chosen, each PWM has its own PWM value
register.
9.6.2 Dead-Time Insertion
As shown in Figure 9-12, in complementary mode, each PWM pair can
be used to drive top-side/bottom-side transistors.
When controlling dc-to-ac inverters such as this, the top and
bottom PWMs in one pair should never be active at the same time. In
Figure 9-12, if PWM1 and PWM2 were on at the same time, large
currents would flow through the two transistors as they discharge the
bus capacitor. The IGBTs could be weakened or destroyed.
Simply forcing the two PWMs to be inversions of each other is not always
sufficient. Since a time delay is associated with turning off the transistors
in the motor drive, there must be a dead-time between the deactivation
of one PWM and the activation of the other.
A dead-time can be specified in the dead-time write-once register. This
8-bit value specifies the number of CPU clock cycles to use for the
dead-time. The dead-time is not affected by changes in the PWM period
caused by the prescaler.
Dead-time insertion is achieved by feeding the top PWM outputs of the
PWM generator into dead-time generators, as shown in Figure 9-13.
Current sensing determines which PWM value of a PWM generator pair
to use for the top PWM in the next PWM cycle. See 9.6.3 Top/Bottom
Correction with Motor Phase Current Polarity Sensing. When output
control is enabled, the odd OUT bits, rather than the PWM generator
outputs, are fed into the dead-time generators. See 9.6.5 PWM Output
Port Control.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
Advance Information
149
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control
PREDT (TOP)
OUTX
SELECT
DEAD-TIME
POSTDT (TOP)
MUX
PWMPAIR56
(TOP)
PWM (TOP)
PREDT (TOP)
OUTX
SELECT
PWM1
BOTTOM
(PWM2)
PWM2
TOP
(PWM3)
BOTTOM
(PWM4)
POLARITY/OUTPUT DRIVE
PWM (TOP)
TOP
(PWM1)
FAULT
DEAD-TIME
POSTDT (TOP)
MUX
PWMPAIR34
(TOP)
TOP/BOTTOM
GENERATION
DEAD-TIME
6
CURRENT SENSING
PWMGEN<1:6>
PWM GENERATOR
PREDT (TOP)
OUTX
SELECT
DEAD-TIME
POSTDT (TOP)
DEAD-TIME
PWM (TOP)
DEAD-TIME
MUX
PWMPAIR12
(TOP)
TOP/BOTTOM
GENERATION
OUT2
OUT4
OUT6
TOP/BOTTOM
GENERATION
OUTCTL
OUT5
OUT3
OUT1
OUTPUT CONTROL
(OUTCTL)
PWM3
PWM4
TOP
(PWM5)
PWM5
BOTTOM
(PWM6)
PWM6
Figure 9-13. Dead-Time Generators
Whenever an input to a dead-time generator transitions, a dead-time is
inserted (for example, both PWMs in the pair are forced to their inactive
state). The bottom PWM signal is generated from the top PWM and the
dead-time. In the case of output control enabled, the odd OUTx bits
control the top PWMs, the even OUTx bits control the bottom PWMs with
respect to the odd OUTx bits (see Table 9-6). Figure 9-14 shows the
effects of the dead-time insertion.
As seen in Figure 9-14, some pulse width distortion occurs when the
dead-time is inserted. The active pulse widths are reduced. For
example, in Figure 9-14, when the PWM value register is equal to two,
the ideal waveform (with no dead-time) has pulse widths equal to four.
However, the actual pulse widths shrink to two after a dead-time of two
was inserted. In this example, with the prescaler set to divide by one and
center-aligned operation selected, this distortion can be compensated
for by adding or subtracting half the dead-time value to or from the PWM
Advance Information
150
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
MOTOROLA
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
Output Control
register value. This correction is further described in 9.6.3 Top/Bottom
Correction with Motor Phase Current Polarity Sensing.
Further examples of dead-time insertion are shown in Figure 9-15 and
Figure 9-16. Figure 9-15 shows the effects of dead-time insertion at the
duty cycle boundaries (near 0 percent and 100 percent duty cycles).
Figure 9-16 shows the effects of dead-time insertion on pulse widths
smaller than the dead-time.
UP/DOWN COUNTER
MODULUS = 4
PWM VALUE = 2
PWM VALUE = 2
PWM VALUE = 3
PWM1 W/
NO DEAD-TIME
PWM2 W/
NO DEAD-TIME
PWM1 W/
DEAD-TIME = 2
PWM2 W/
DEAD-TIME = 2
2
2
2
2
2
2
Figure 9-14. Effects of Dead-Time Insertion
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
Advance Information
151
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control
UP/DOWN COUNTER
MODULUS = 3
PWM VALUE = 1
PWM VALUE = 1
PWM VALUE = 3
PWM VALUE = 3
PWM1 W/
NO DEAD-TIME
PWM2 W/
NO DEAD-TIME
PWM1 W/
DEAD-TIME = 2
2
PWM2 W/
DEAD-TIME = 2
2
2
2
Figure 9-15. Dead-Time at Duty Cycle Boundaries
UP/DOWN COUNTER
MOUDULUS = 3
PWM VALUE = 2
PWM VALUE = 3
PWM VALUE = 2
PWM VALUE = 1
PWM1 W/
NO DEAD-TIME
PWM2 W/
NO DEAD-TIME
PWM1 W/
DEAD-TIME = 3
PWM2 W/
DEAD-TIME = 3
3
3
3
3
3
3
Figure 9-16. Dead-Time and Small Pulse Widths
Advance Information
152
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
MOTOROLA
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
Output Control
9.6.3 Top/Bottom Correction with Motor Phase Current Polarity Sensing
Ideally, when complementary pairs are used, the PWM pairs are
inversions of each other, as shown in Figure 9-17. When PWM1 is
active, PWM2 is inactive, and vice versa. In this case, the motor terminal
voltage is never allowed to float and is strictly controlled by the PWM
waveforms.
However, when dead-time is inserted, the motor voltage is allowed to
float momentarily during the dead-time interval, creating a distortion in
the motor current waveform. This distortion is aggravated by dissimilar
turn-on and turn-off delays of each of the transistors.
For a typical motor drive inverter as shown in Figure 9-12, for a given
top/bottom transistor pair, only one of the transistors will be effective in
controlling the output voltage at any given time depending on the
direction of the motor current for that pair. To achieve distortion
correction, one of two different correction factors must be added to the
desired PWM value, depending on whether the top or bottom transistor
is controlling the output voltage. Therefore, the software is responsible
for calculating both compensated PWM values and placing them in an
odd/even PWM register pair. By supplying the PWM module with
information regarding which transistor (top or bottom) is controlling the
output voltage at any given time (for instance, the current polarity for that
motor phase), the PWM module selects either the odd or even
numbered PWM value register to be used by the PWM generator.
Current sensing or programmable software bits are then used to
determine which PWM value to use. If the current sensed at the motor
for that PWM pair is positive (voltage on current pin ISx is low) or bit
IPOLx in PWM control register 2 is low, the top PWM value is used for
the PWM pair. Likewise, if the current sensed at the motor for that PWM
pair is negative (voltage on current pin ISx is high) or bit IPOLx in PWM
control register 2 is high, the bottom PWM value is used. See
Table 9-4.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
Advance Information
153
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control
UP/DOWN COUNTER
MODULUS = 4
PWM1
PWM VALUE = 1
PWM2
PWM3
PWM VALUE = 2
PWM4
PWM5
PWM VALUE = 3
PWM6
Figure 9-17. Ideal Complementary Operation (Dead-Time = 0)
NOTE:
This text assumes the user will provide current sense circuitry which
causes the voltage at the corresponding input pin to be low for positive
current and high for negative current. See Figure 9-18 for current
convention. In addition, it assumes the top PWMs are PWMs 1, 3, and 5
while the bottom PWMs are PWMs 2, 4, and 6.
Table 9-4. Current Sense Pins
Advance Information
154
Current
Sense Pin
or Bit
Voltage
on Current
Sense Pin
or IPOLx Bit
PWM Value
Register Used
PWMs
Affected
IS1 or IPOL1
Logic 0
PWM value register 1
PWMs 1 and 2
IS1 or IPOL1
Logic 1
PWM value register 2
PWMs 1 and 2
IS2 or IPOL2
Logic 0
PWM value register 3
PWMs 3 and 4
IS2 or IPOL2
Logic 1
PWM value register 4
PWMs 3 and 4
IS3 or IPOL3
Logic 0
PWM value register 5
PWMs 5 and 6
IS3 or IPOL3
Logic 1
PWM value register 6
PWMs 5 and 6
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
MOTOROLA
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
Output Control
I+
I-
Figure 9-18. Current Convention
To allow for correction based on different current sensing methods or
correction controlled by software, the ISENS1 and ISENS0 bits in PWM
control register 1 are provided to choose the correction method. These
bits provide correction according to Table 9-5.
Table 9-5. Correction Methods
Current Correction Bits
ISENS1 and ISENS0
Correction Method
00
01
Bits IPOL1, IPOL2, and IPOL3 used for correction
10
Current sensing on pins IS1, IS2, and IS3 occurs
during the dead-time.
11
Current sensing on pins IS1, IS2, and IS3 occurs at
the half cycle in center-aligned mode and at the end
of the cycle in edge-aligned mode.
If correction is to be done in software or is not necessary, setting
ISENS1:ISENS0 = 00 or = 01 causes the correction to be based on bits
IPOL1, IPOL2, and IPOL3 in PWM control register 2. If correction is not
required, the user can initialize the IPOLx bits and then only load one
PWM value register per PWM pair.
To allow the user to use a current sense scheme based upon sensed
phase voltage during dead-time, setting ISENS1:ISENS0 = 10 causes
the polarity of the Ix pin to be latched when both the top and bottom
PWMs are off (for example, during the dead-time). At the 0 percent and
100 percent duty cycle boundaries, there is no dead-time so no new
current value is sensed.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
Advance Information
155
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control
To accommodate other current sensing schemes, setting
ISENS1:ISENS0 = 11 causes the polarity of the current sense pin to be
latched half-way into the PWM cycle in center-aligned mode and at the
end of the cycle in edge-aligned mode. Therefore, even at 0 percent and
100 percent duty cycle, the current is sensed.
Distortion correction is only available in complementary mode. At the
beginning of the PWM period, the PWM uses this latched current value
or polarity bit to decide whether the top PWM value or bottom PWM
value is used. Figure 9-19 shows an example of top/bottom correction
for PWMs 1 and 2.
NOTE:
The IPOLx bits and the values latched on the ISx pins are buffered so
that only one PWM register is used per PWM cycle. If the IPOLx bits or
the current sense values change during a PWM period, this new value
will not be used until the next PWM period. The ISENSx bits are NOT
buffered; therefore, changing the current sensing method could affect
the present PWM cycle.
PWM VALUE REG. 2 = 2
PWM VALUE REG. 1 = 1
IS1 POSITIVE
PWM = 1
IS1 POSITIVE
PWM = 1
IS1 NEGATIVE
PWM = 2
IS1 NEGATIVE
PWM = 2
PWM1
PWM2
Figure 9-19. Top/Bottom Correction for PWMs 1 and 2
When the PWM is first enabled by setting PWMEN, PWM value registers
1, 3, and 5 will be used if the ISENSx bits are configured for current
sensing correction. This is because no current will have previously been
sensed.
Advance Information
156
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
MOTOROLA
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
Output Control
9.6.4 Output Polarity
The output polarity of the PWMs is determined by two options: TOPNEG
and BOTNEG. The top polarity option, TOPNEG, controls the polarity of
PWMs 1, 3, and 5. The bottom polarity option, BOTNEG, controls the
polarity of PWMs 2, 4, and 6. Positive polarity means that when the PWM
is active, the PWM output is high. Conversely, negative polarity means
that when the PWM is active, PWM output is low. See Figure 9-20.
NOTE:
Both bits are found in the CONFIG register, which is a write-once
register. This reduces the chances of the software inadvertently
changing the polarity of the PWM signals and possibly damaging the
motor drive hardware.
CENTER-ALIGNED POSITIVE POLARITY
EDGE-ALIGNED POSITIVE POLARITY
UP-ONLY COUNTER
MODULUS = 4
UP/DOWN COUNTER
MODULUS = 4
PWM <= 0
PWM <= 0
PWM = 1
PWM = 1
PWM = 2
PWM = 2
PWM = 3
PWM = 3
PWM >= 4
PWM >= 4
CENTER-ALIGNED NEGATIVE POLARITY
EDGE-ALIGNED NEGATIVE POLARITY
UP-ONLY COUNTER
MODULUS = 4
UP/DOWN COUNTER
MODULUS = 4
PWM <= 0
PWM = 1
PWM <= 0
PWM = 2
PWM = 1
PWM = 3
PWM = 2
PWM >= 4
PWM = 3
PWM >= 4
Figure 9-20. PWM Polarity
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
Advance Information
157
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control
9.6.5 PWM Output Port Control
Conditions may arise in which the PWM pins need to be individually
controlled. This is made possible by the PWM output control register
(PWMOUT) shown in Figure 9-21.
Address:
$0025
Bit 7
Read:
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
OUTCTL
OUT6
OUT5
OUT4
OUT3
OUT2
OUT1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Write:
Reset:
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 9-21. PWM Output Control Register (PWMOUT)
If the OUTCTL bit is set, the PWM pins can be controlled by the OUTx
bits. These bits behave according to Table 9-6.
Table 9-6. OUTx Bits
OUTx Bit
Complementary Mode
Independent Mode
OUT1
1 — PWM1 is active.
0 — PWM1 is inactive.
1 — PWM1 is active.
0 — PWM1 is inactive.
OUT2
1 — PWM2 is complement of PWM 1.
0 — PWM2 is inactive.
1 — PWM2 is active.
0 — PWM2 is inactive.
OUT3
1 — PWM3 is active.
0 — PWM3 is inactive.
1 — PWM3 is active.
0 — PWM3 is inactive.
OUT4
1 — PWM4 is complement of PWM 3.
0 — PWM4 is inactive.
1 — PWM4 is active.
0 — PWM4 is inactive.
OUT5
1 — PWM5 is active.
0 — PWM5 is inactive.
1 — PWM5 is active.
0 — PWM5 is inactive.
OUT6
1 — PWM 6 is complement of PWM 5.
0 — PWM6 is inactive.
1 — PWM6 is active.
0 — PWM6 is inactive.
When OUTCTL is set, the polarity options TOPPOL and BOTPOL will
still affect the outputs. In addition, if complementary operation is in use,
the PWM pairs will not be allowed to be active simultaneously, and
dead-time will still not be violated. When OUTCTL is set and
Advance Information
158
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
MOTOROLA
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
Output Control
complementary operation is in use, the odd OUTx bits are inputs to the
dead-time generators as shown in Figure 9-14. Dead-time is inserted
whenever the odd OUTx bit toggles as shown in Figure 9-22. Although
dead-time is not inserted when the even OUTx bits change, there will be
no dead-time violation as shown in Figure 9-23.
Setting the OUTCTL bit does not disable the PWM generator and current
sensing circuitry. They continue to run, but are no longer controlling the
output pins. In addition, OUTCTL will control the PWM pins even when
PWMEN = 0. When OUTCTL is cleared, the outputs of the PWM
generator become the inputs to the dead-time and output circuitry at the
beginning of the next PWM cycle.
NOTE:
To avoid an unexpected dead-time occurrence, it is recommended that
the OUTx bits be cleared prior to entering and prior to exiting individual
PWM output control mode.
UP/DOWN COUNTER
MODULUS = 4
DEAD-TIME = 2
PWM VALUE = 3
OUTCTL
OUT1
OUT2
PWM1
PWM2
PWM1/PWM2
DEAD-TIME
2
2
DEAD-TIME INSERTED AS PART OF DEAD-TIME INSERTED DUE
NORMAL PWM OPERATION AS
TO SETTING OF OUT1 BIT
CONTROLLED BY CURRENT
SENSING AND PWM GENERATOR
2
DEAD-TIME INSERTED
DUE TO CLEARING OF
OUT1 BIT
Figure 9-22. Dead-Time Insertion During OUTCTL = 1
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
Advance Information
159
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control
UP/DOWN COUNTER
MODULUS = 4
DEAD-TIME = 2
PWM VALUE = 3
OUTCTL
OUT1
OUT2
PWM1
PWM2
PWM1/PWM2
DEAD-TIME
2
2
DEAD-TIME INSERTED BECAUSE
WHEN OUTCTL WAS SET, THE
STATE OF OUT1 WAS SUCH THAT
PWM1 WAS DIRECTED TO TOGGLE
2
2
DEAD-TIME INSERTED
BECAUSE OUT1 TOGGLES,
DIRECTING PWM1 TO
TOGGLE
NO DEAD-TIME INSERTED
BECAUSE OUT1 IS NOT
TOGGLING
Figure 9-23. Dead-Time Insertion During OUTCTL = 1
9.7 Fault Protection
Conditions may arise in the external drive circuitry which require that the
PWM signals become inactive immediately, such as an overcurrent fault
condition. Furthermore, it may be desirable to selectively disable
PWM(s) solely with software.
One or more PWM pins can be disabled (forced to their inactive state)
by applying a logic high to any of the four external fault pins or by writing
a logic high to either of the disable bits (DISX and DISY in PWM control
register 1). Figure 9-25 shows the structure of the PWM disabling
scheme. While the PWM pins are disabled, they are forced to their
inactive state. The PWM generator continues to run — only the output
pins are disabled.
To allow for different motor configurations and the controlling of more
than one motor, the PWM disabling function is organized as two banks,
bank X and bank Y. Bank information combines with information from
the disable mapping register to allow selective PWM disabling. Fault
Advance Information
160
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
MOTOROLA
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
Fault Protection
pin 1, fault pin 2, and PWM disable bit X constitute the disabling function
of bank X. Fault pin 3, fault pin 4, and PWM disable bit Y constitute the
disabling function of bank Y. Figure 9-24 and Figure 9-26 show the
disable mapping write-once register and the decoding scheme of the
bank which selectively disables PWM(s). When all bits of the disable
mapping register are set, any disable condition will disable all PWMs.
A fault can also generate a CPU interrupt. Each fault pin has its own
interrupt vector.
Address: $0037
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Figure 9-24. PWM Disable Mapping Write-Once Register (DISMAP)
9.7.1 Fault Condition Input Pins
A logic high level on a fault pin disables the respective PWM(s)
determined by the bank and the disable mapping register. Each fault pin
incorporates a filter to assist in rejecting spurious faults. All of the
external fault pins are software-configurable to re-enable the PWMs
either with the fault pin (automatic mode) or with software (manual
mode). Each fault pin has an associated FMODE bit to control the PWM
re-enabling method. Automatic mode is selected by setting the FMODEx
bit in the fault control register. Manual mode is selected when FMODEx
is clear.
9.7.1.1 Fault Pin Filter
Each fault pin incorporates a filter to assist in determining a genuine fault
condition. After a fault pin has been logic low for one CPU cycle, a rising
edge (logic high) will be synchronously sampled once per CPU cycle for
two cycles. If both samples are detected logic high, the corresponding
FPIN bit and FFLAG bit will be set. The FPIN bit will remain set until the
corresponding fault pin is logic low and synchronously sampled once in
the following CPU cycle.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
Advance Information
161
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control
DISX
CYCLE START
SOFTWARE X DISABLE
S
Q
R
FMODE2
TWO
SAMPLE
FILTER
FAULT
PIN2
AUTO
MODE
FPIN2
LOGIC HIGH FOR FAULT
ONE
SHOT
BANK X
DISABLE
FAULT PIN 2 DISABLE
S
Q FFLAG2
R
S
Q
R
MANUAL
MODE
CLEAR BY WRITING 1 TO FTACK4
INTERRUPT REQUEST
FINT2
The example is of fault pin 2 with DISX. Fault pin 4 with DISY is logically similar and affects BANK Y disable.
Note: In manual mode (FMODE = 0), faults 2 and 4 may be cleared only if a logic level low at the input of the fault
pin is present.
CYCLE START
FMODE1
FAULT PIN 1 DISABLE
AUTO
MODE
FPIN1
LOGIC HIGH FOR FAULT
TWO
SAMPLE
FILTER
)$8/7
3,1
ONE
SHOT
S
R
Q FFLAG1
S
Q
BANK X DISABLE
R
MANUAL
MODE
CLEAR BY WRITING 1 TO FTACK1
FINT1
INTERRUPT REQUEST
The example is of fault pin 1. Fault pin 3 is logically similar and affects BANK Y disable.
Note: In manual mode (FMODE = 0), faults 1 and 3 may be cleared regardless of the logic level at the input of the fault pin.
Figure 9-25. PWM Disabling Scheme
Advance Information
162
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
MOTOROLA
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
Fault Protection
BIT 7
DISABLE
PWM PIN 1
BIT 6
BANK X
DISABLE
BIT 5
DISABLE
PWM PIN 2
BIT 4
DISABLE
PWM PIN 3
BIT 3
BANK Y
DISABLE
DISABLE
PWM PIN 4
BIT 2
DISABLE
PWM PIN 5
BIT 1
BIT 0
DISABLE
PWM PIN 6
Figure 9-26. PWM Disabling Decode Scheme
9.7.1.2 Automatic Mode
In automatic mode, the PWM(s) are disabled immediately once a filtered
fault condition is detected (logic high). The PWM(s) remain disabled until
the filtered fault condition is cleared (logic low) and a new PWM cycle
begins as shown in Figure 9-27. Clearing the corresponding FFLAGx
event bit will not enable the PWMs in automatic mode.
FILTERED FAULT PIN
PWM(S) ENABLED
PWM(S) DISABLED (INACTIVE)
PWM(S) ENABLED
Figure 9-27. PWM Disabling in Automatic Mode
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
Advance Information
163
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control
The filtered fault pin’s logic state is reflected in the respective FPINx bit.
Any write to this bit is overwritten by the pin state. The FFLAGx event bit
is set with each rising edge of the respective fault pin after filtering has
been applied. To clear the FFLAGx bit, the user must write a 1 to the
corresponding FTACKx bit.
If the FINTx bit is set, a fault condition resulting in setting the
corresponding FFLAG bit will also latch a CPU interrupt request. The
interrupt request latch is not cleared until one of these actions occurs:
•
The FFLAGx bit is cleared by writing a 1 to the corresponding
FTACKx bit.
•
The FINTx bit is cleared. This will not clear the FFLAGx bit.
•
A reset automatically clears all four interrupt latches.
If prior to a vector fetch, the interrupt request latch is cleared by one of
the actions listed, a CPU interrupt will no longer be requested. A vector
fetch does not alter the state of the PWMs, the FFLAGx event flag, or
FINTx.
NOTE:
If the FFLAGx or FINTx bits are not cleared during the interrupt service
routine, the interrupt request latch will not be cleared.
9.7.1.3 Manual Mode
In manual mode, the PWM(s) are disabled immediately once a filtered
fault condition is detected (logic high). The PWM(s) remain disabled until
software clears the corresponding FFLAGx event bit and a new PWM
cycle begins. In manual mode, the fault pins are grouped in pairs, each
pair sharing common functionality. A fault condition on pins 1 and 3 may
be cleared, allowing the PWM(s) to enable at the start of a PWM cycle
regardless of the logic level at the fault pin. See Figure 9-28. A fault
condition on pins 2 and 4 can only be cleared, allowing the PWM(s) to
enable, if a logic low level at the fault pin is present at the start of a PWM
cycle. See Figure 9-29.
The function of the fault control and event bits is the same as in
automatic mode except that the PWMs are not re-enabled until the
FFLAGx event bit is cleared by writing to the FTACKx bit and the filtered
fault condition is cleared (logic low).
Advance Information
164
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
MOTOROLA
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
Fault Protection
FILTERED FAULT PIN 1 OR 3
PWM(S) ENABLED
PWM(S) DISABLED
PWM(S) ENABLED
FFLAGX CLEARED
Figure 9-28. PWM Disabling in Manual Mode (Example 1)
FILTERED FAULT PIN 2 OR 4
PWM(S) ENABLED
PWM(S) DISABLED
PWM(S) ENABLED
FFLAGX CLEARED
Figure 9-29. PWM Disabling in Manual Mode (Example 2)
9.7.2 Software Output Disable
Setting PWM disable bit DISX or DISY in PWM control register 1
immediately disables the corresponding PWM pins as determined by the
bank and disable mapping register. The PWM pin(s) remain disabled
until the PWM disable bit is cleared and a new PWM cycle begins as
shown in Figure 9-30. Setting a PWM disable bit does not latch a CPU
interrupt request, and there are no event flags associated with the PWM
disable bits.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
Advance Information
165
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control
9.7.3 Output Port Control
When operating the PWMs using the OUTx bits (OUTCTL = 1), fault
protection applies as described in this section. Due to the absence of
periodic PWM cycles, fault conditions are cleared upon each CPU cycle
and the PWM outputs are re-enabled, provided all fault clearing
conditions are satisfied.
DISABLE BIT
PWM(S) ENABLED
PWM(S) DISABLED
PWM(S) ENABLED
Figure 9-30. PWM Software Disable
9.8 Initialization and the PWMEN Bit
For proper operation, all registers should be initialized and the LDOK bit
should be set before enabling the PWM via the PWMEN bit. When the
PWMEN bit is first set, a reload will occur immediately, setting the PWMF
flag and generating an interrupt if PWMINT is set. In addition, in
complementary mode, PWM value registers 1, 3, and 5 will be used for
the first PWM cycle if current sensing is selected.
NOTE:
If the LDOK bit is not set when PWMEN is set after a RESET, the
prescaler and PWM values will be 0, but the modulus will be unknown.
If the LDOK bit is not set after the PWMEN bit has been cleared then set
(without a RESET), the modulus value that was last loaded will be used.
If the dead-time register (DEADTM) is changed after PWMEN or
OUTCTL is set, an improper dead-time insertion could occur. However,
the dead-time can never be shorter than the specified value.
Because of the equals-comparator architecture of this PWM, the
modulus = 0 case is considered illegal. Therefore, the modulus register
Advance Information
166
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
MOTOROLA
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
Initialization and the PWMEN Bit
is not reset, and a modulus value of 0 will result in waveforms
inconsistent with the other modulus waveforms. See 9.10.2 PWM
Counter Modulo Registers.
When PWMEN is set, the PWM pins change from high impedance to
outputs. At this time, assuming no fault condition is present, the PWM
pins will drive according to the PWM values, polarity, and dead-time.
See the timing diagram in Figure 9-31.
CPU CLOCK
PWMEN
DRIVE ACCORDING TO PWM
VALUE, POLARITY, AND DEAD-TIME
PWM PINS
HI-Z IF OUTCTL = 0
HI-Z IF OUTCTL = 0
Figure 9-31. PWMEN and PWM Pins
When the PWMEN bit is cleared, this will occur:
•
PWM pins will be three-stated unless OUTCTL = 1.
•
PWM counter is cleared and will not be clocked.
•
Internally, the PWM generator will force its outputs to 0 to avoid
glitches when the PWMEN is set again.
When PWMEN is cleared, these features remain active:
NOTE:
•
All fault circuitry
•
Manual PWM pin control via the PWMOUT register
•
Dead-time insertion when PWM pins change via the PWMOUT
register
The PWMF flag and pending CPU interrupts are NOT cleared when
PWMEN = 0.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
Advance Information
167
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control
9.9 PWM Operation in Wait Mode
When the microcontroller is put in low-power wait mode via the WAIT
instruction, all clocks to the PWM module will continue to run. If an
interrupt is issued from the PWM module (via a reload or a fault), the
microcontroller will exit wait mode.
Clearing the PWMEN bit before entering wait mode will reduce power
consumption in wait mode because the counter, prescaler divider, and
LDFQ divider will no longer be clocked. In addition, power will be
reduced because the PWMs will no longer toggle.
9.10 Control Logic Block
This subsection provides a description of the control logic block.
9.10.1 PWM Counter Registers
The PWM counter registers (PCNTH and PCNTL) display the 12-bit
up/down or up-only counter. When the high byte of the counter is read,
the lower byte is latched. PCNTL will hold this latched value until it is
read. See Figure 9-32 and Figure 9-33.
Address:
Read:
$0026
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Write:
Reset:
= Unimplemented
Figure 9-32. PWM Counter Register High (PCNTH)
Address:
Read:
$0027
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Write:
Reset:
= Unimplemented
Figure 9-33. PWM Counter Register Low (PCNTL)
Advance Information
168
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
MOTOROLA
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
Control Logic Block
9.10.2 PWM Counter Modulo Registers
The PWM counter modulus registers (PMODH and PMODL) hold a
12-bit unsigned number that determines the maximum count for the
up/down or up-only counter. In center-aligned mode, the PWM period
will be twice the modulus (assuming no prescaler). In edge-aligned
mode, the PWM period will equal the modulus. See Figure 9-34 and
Figure 9-35.
Address:
Read:
$0028
Bit 7
6
5
4
0
0
0
0
Write:
Reset:
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
0
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
X
X
X
X
X = Indeterminate
Figure 9-34. PWM Counter Modulo Register High (PMODH)
Address:
$0029
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Read:
Write:
Reset:
X = Indeterminate
Figure 9-35. PWM Counter Modulo Register Low (PMODL)
To avoid erroneous PWM periods, this value is buffered and will not be
used by the PWM generator until the LDOK bit has been set and the next
PWM load cycle begins.
NOTE:
When reading this register, the value read is the buffer (not necessarily
the value the PWM generator is currently using).
Because of the equals-comparator architecture of this PWM, the
modulus = 0 case is considered illegal. Therefore, the modulus register
is not reset, and a modulus value of 0 will result in waveforms
inconsistent with the other modulus waveforms. If a modulus of 0 is
loaded, the counter will continually count down from $FFF. This
operation will not be tested or guaranteed (the user should consider it
illegal). However, the dead-time constraints and fault conditions will still
be guaranteed.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
Advance Information
169
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control
9.10.3 PWMx Value Registers
Each of the six PWMs has a 16-bit PWM value register.
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bold
= Buffered
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Figure 9-36. PWMx Value Registers High (PVALxH)
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bold
= Buffered
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Figure 9-37. PWMx Value Registers Low (PVALxL)
The 16-bit signed value stored in this register determines the duty cycle
of the PWM. The duty cycle is defined as: (PWM value/modulus) x 100.
Writing a number less than or equal to 0 causes the PWM to be off for
the entire PWM period. Writing a number greater than or equal to the
12-bit modulus causes the PWM to be on for the entire PWM period.
If the complementary mode is selected, the PWM pairs share PWM
value registers.
To avoid erroneous PWM pulses, this value is buffered and will not be
used by the PWM generator until the LDOK bit has been set and the next
PWM load cycle begins.
NOTE:
Advance Information
170
When reading these registers, the value read is the buffer (not
necessarily the value the PWM generator is currently using).
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
MOTOROLA
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
Control Logic Block
9.10.4 PWM Control Register 1
PWM control register 1 (PCTL1) controls PWM enabling/disabling, the
loading of new modulus, prescaler, PWM values, and the PWM
correction method. In addition, this register contains the software disable
bits to force the PWM outputs to their inactive states (according to the
disable mapping register).
Address:
$0020
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
DISX
DISY
PWMINT
PWMF
ISENS1
ISENS0
LDOK
PWMEN
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Figure 9-38. PWM Control Register 1 (PCTL1)
DISX — Software Disable Bit for Bank X Bit
This read/write bit allows the user to disable one or more PWM pins
in bank X. The pins that are disabled are determined by the disable
mapping write-once register.
1 = Disable PWM pins in bank X.
0 = Re-enable PWM pins at beginning of next PWM cycle.
DISY — Software Disable Bit for Bank Y Bit
This read/write bit allows the user to disable one or more PWM pins
in bank Y. The pins that are disabled are determined by the disable
mapping write-once register.
1 = Disable PWM pins in bank Y.
0 = Re-enable PWM pins at beginning of next PWM cycle.
PWMINT — PWM Interrupt Enable Bit
This read/write bit allows the user to enable and disable PWM CPU
interrupts. If set, a CPU interrupt will be pending when the PWMF flag
is set.
1 = Enable PWM CPU interrupts.
0 = Disable PWM CPU interrupts.
NOTE:
When PWMINT is cleared, pending CPU interrupts are inhibited.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
Advance Information
171
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control
PWMF — PWM Reload Flag
This read/write bit is set at the beginning of every reload cycle
regardless of the state of the LDOK bit. This bit is cleared by reading
PWM control register 1 with the PWMF flag set, then writing a logic 0
to PWMF. If another reload occurs before the clearing sequence is
complete, then writing logic 0 to PWMF has no effect.
1 = New reload cycle began.
0 = New reload cycle has not begun.
NOTE:
When PWMF is cleared, pending PWM CPU interrupts are cleared (not
including fault interrupts).
ISENS1 and ISENS0 — Current Sense Correction Bits
These read/write bits select the top/bottom correction scheme as
shown in Table 9-7.
Table 9-7. Correction Methods
Current Correction Bits
ISENS1 and ISENS0
Correction Method
00
01
Bits IPOL1, IPOL2, and IPOL3 are used for correction.
10
Current sensing on pins IS1, IS2, and IS3 occurs
during the dead-time.
11
Current sensing on pins IS1, IS2, and IS3 occurs at
the half cycle in center-aligned mode and at the end of
the cycle in edge-aligned mode.
1. The polarity of the ISx pin is latched when both the top and bottom PWMs are off. At
the 0% and 100% duty cycle boundaries, there is no dead-time, so no new current
value is sensed.
2. Current is sensed even with 0% and 100% duty cycle.
NOTE:
The ISENSx bits are not buffered. Changing the current sensing method
can affect the present PWM cycle.
LDOK— Load OK Bit
This read/write bit loads the prescaler bits of the PMCTL2 register and
the entire PMMODH/L and PWMVALH/L registers into a set of
buffers. The buffered prescaler divisor, PWM counter modulus value,
and PWM pulse will take effect at the next PWM load. Set LDOK by
reading it when it is logic 0 and then writing a logic 1 to it. LDOK is
Advance Information
172
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
MOTOROLA
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
Control Logic Block
automatically cleared after the new values are loaded or can be
manually cleared before a reload by writing a 0 to it. Reset clears
LDOK.
1 = Load prescaler, modulus, and PWM values.
0 = Do not load new modulus, prescaler, and PWM values.
NOTE:
The user should initialize the PWM registers and set the LDOK bit before
enabling the PWM.
A PWM CPU interrupt request can still be generated when LDOK is 0.
PWMEN — PWM Module Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables and disables the PWM generator and the
PWM pins. When PWMEN is clear, the PWM generator is disabled
and the PWM pins are in the high-impedance state (unless
OUTCTL = 1).
When the PWMEN bit is set, the PWM generator and PWM pins are
activated.
For more information, see 9.8 Initialization and the PWMEN Bit.
1 = PWM generator and PWM pins enabled
0 = PWM generator and PWM pins disabled
9.10.5 PWM Control Register 2
PWM control register 2 (PCTL2) controls the PWM load frequency, the
PWM correction method, and the PWM counter prescaler. For ease of
software and to avoid erroneous PWM periods, some of these register
bits are buffered. The PWM generator will not use the prescaler value
until the LDOK bit has been set, and a new PWM cycle is starting. The
correction bits are used at the beginning of each PWM cycle (if the
ISENSx bits are configured for software correction). The load frequency
bits are not used until the current load cycle is complete.
See Figure 9-39.
NOTE:
The user should initialize this register before enabling the PWM.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
Advance Information
173
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control
Address:
$0021
Bit 7
6
5
LDFQ1
LDFQ0
0
0
Read:
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
IPOL1
IPOL2
IPOL3
PRSC1
PRSC0
0
0
0
0
0
Bold
= Buffered
0
Write:
Reset:
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 9-39. PWM Control Register 2 (PCTL2)
LDFQ1 and LDFQ0 — PWM Load Frequency Bits
These buffered read/write bits select the PWM CPU load frequency
according to Table 9-8.
NOTE:
When reading these bits, the value read is the buffer value (not
necessarily the value the PWM generator is currently using).
The LDFQx bits take effect when the current load cycle is complete
regardless of the state of the load okay bit, LDOK.
Table 9-8. PWM Reload Frequency
NOTE:
Reload Frequency Bits
LDFQ1 and LDFQ0
PWM Reload Frequency
00
Every PWM cycle
01
Every 2 PWM cycles
10
Every 4 PWM cycles
11
Every 8 PWM cycles
Reading the LPFQx bit reads the buffered values and not necessarily the
values currently in effect.
IPOL1 — Top/Bottom Correction Bit for PWM Pair 1 (PWMs 1 and 2)
This buffered read/write bit selects which PWM value register is used
if top/bottom correction is to be achieved without current sensing.
1 = Use PWM value register 2.
0 = Use PWM value register 1.
NOTE:
Advance Information
174
When reading this bit, the value read is the buffer value (not necessarily
the value the output control block is currently using).
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
MOTOROLA
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
Control Logic Block
The IPOLx bits take effect at the beginning of the next load cycle,
regardless of the state of the load okay bit, LDOK.
IPOL2 — Top/Bottom Correction Bit for PWM Pair 2 (PWMs 3 and 4)
This buffered read/write bit selects which PWM value register is used
if top/bottom correction is to be achieved without current sensing.
1 = Use PWM value register 4.
0 = Use PWM value register 3.
NOTE:
When reading this bit, the value read is the buffer value (not necessarily
the value the output control block is currently using).
IPOL3 — Top/Bottom Correction Bit for PWM Pair 3 (PWMs 5 and 6)
This buffered read/write bit selects which PWM value register is used
if top/bottom correction is to be achieved without current sensing.
1 = Use PWM value register 6.
0 = Use PWM value register 5.
NOTE:
When reading this bit, the value read is the buffer value (not necessarily
the value the output control block is currently using).
PRSC1 and PRSC0 — PWM Prescaler Bits
These buffered read/write bits allow the PWM clock frequency to be
modified as shown in Table 9-9.
NOTE:
When reading these bits, the value read is the buffer value (not
necessarily the value the PWM generator is currently using).
Table 9-9. PWM Prescaler
Prescaler Bits
PRSC1 and PRSC0
PWM Clock Frequency
00
fOP
01
fOP/2
10
fOP/4
11
fOP/8
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
Advance Information
175
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control
9.10.6 Dead-Time Write-Once Register
The dead-time write-once register (DEADTM) holds an 8-bit value which
specifies the number of CPU clock cycles to use for the dead-time when
complementary PWM mode is selected. After this register is written for
the first time, it cannot be rewritten unless a reset occurs. Dead-time is
not affected by changes to the prescaler value.
Address:
$0036
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Figure 9-40. Dead-Time Write-Once Register (DEADTM)
9.10.7 PWM Disable Mapping Write-Once Register
The PWM disable mapping write-once register (DISMAP) holds an 8-bit
value which determines which PWM pins will be disabled if an external
fault or software disable occurs. For a further description of disable
mapping, see 9.7 Fault Protection. After this register is written for the
first time, it cannot be rewritten unless a reset occurs.
Address:
$0037
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Figure 9-41. PWM Disable Mapping
Write-Once Register (DISMAP)
Advance Information
176
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
MOTOROLA
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
Control Logic Block
9.10.8 Fault Control Register
The fault control register (FCR) controls the fault-protection circuitry.
Address: $0022
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
FINT4
FMODE4
FINT3
FMODE3
FINT2
FMODE2
FINT1
FMODE1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Figure 9-42. Fault Control Register (FCR)
FINT4 — Fault 4 Interrupt Enable Bit
This read/write bit allows the CPU interrupt caused by faults on fault
pin 4 to be enabled. The fault protection circuitry is independent of this
bit and will always be active. If a fault is detected, the PWM pins will
still be disabled according to the disable mapping register.
1 = Fault pin 4 will cause CPU interrupts.
0 = Fault pin 4 will not cause CPU interrupts.
FMODE4 —Fault Mode Selection for Fault Pin 4 Bit
(automatic versus manual mode)
This read/write bit allows the user to select between automatic and
manual mode faults. For further descriptions of each mode,
see 9.7 Fault Protection.
1 = Automatic mode
0 = Manual mode
FINT3 — Fault 3 Interrupt Enable Bit
This read/write bit allows the CPU interrupt caused by faults on fault
pin 3 to be enabled. The fault protection circuitry is independent of this
bit and will always be active. If a fault is detected, the PWM pins will
still be disabled according to the disable mapping register.
1 = Fault pin 3 will cause CPU interrupts.
0 = Fault pin 3 will not cause CPU interrupts.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
Advance Information
177
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control
FMODE3 —Fault Mode Selection for Fault Pin 3 Bit
(automatic versus manual mode)
This read/write bit allows the user to select between automatic and
manual mode faults. For further descriptions of each mode,
see 9.7 Fault Protection.
1 = Automatic mode
0 = Manual mode
FINT2 — Fault 2 Interrupt Enable Bit
This read/write bit allows the CPU interrupt caused by faults on fault
pin 2 to be enabled. The fault protection circuitry is independent of this
bit and will always be active. If a fault is detected, the PWM pins will
still be disabled according to the disable mapping register.
1 = Fault pin 2 will cause CPU interrupts.
0 = Fault pin 2 will not cause CPU interrupts.
FMODE2 —Fault Mode Selection for Fault Pin 2 Bit
(automatic versus manual mode)
This read/write bit allows the user to select between automatic and
manual mode faults. For further descriptions of each mode, see
9.7 Fault Protection.
1 = Automatic mode
0 = Manual mode
FINT1 — Fault 1 Interrupt Enable Bit
This read/write bit allows the CPU interrupt caused by faults on fault
pin 1 to be enabled. The fault protection circuitry is independent of this
bit and will always be active. If a fault is detected, the PWM pins will
still be disabled according to the disable mapping register.
1 = Fault pin 1 will cause CPU interrupts.
0 = Fault pin 1 will not cause CPU interrupts.
FMODE1 —Fault Mode Selection for Fault Pin 1 Bit
(automatic versus manual mode)
This read/write bit allows the user to select between automatic and
manual mode faults. For further descriptions of each mode, see
9.7 Fault Protection.
1 = Automatic mode
0 = Manual mode
Advance Information
178
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
MOTOROLA
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
Control Logic Block
9.10.9 Fault Status Register
The fault status register (FSR) is a read-only register that indicates the
current fault status.
Address:
Read:
$0023
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
FPIN4
FFLAG4
FPIN3
FFLAG3
FPIN2
FFLAG2
FPIN1
FFLAG1
U
0
U
0
U
0
U
0
Write:
Reset:
= Unimplemented
U = Unaffected
Figure 9-43. Fault Status Register (FSR)
FPIN4 — State of Fault Pin 4 Bit
This read-only bit allows the user to read the current state of fault
pin 4.
1 = Fault pin 4 is at logic 1.
0 = Fault pin 4 is at logic 0.
FFLAG4 — Fault Event Flag 4
The FFLAG4 event bit is set within two CPU cycles after a rising edge
on fault pin 4. To clear the FFLAG4 bit, the user must write a 1 to the
FTACK4 bit in the fault acknowledge register.
1 = A fault has occurred on fault pin 4.
0 = No new fault on fault pin 4
FPIN3 — State of Fault Pin 3 Bit
This read-only bit allows the user to read the current state of fault
pin 3.
1 = Fault pin 3 is at logic 1.
0 = Fault pin 3 is at logic 0.
FFLAG3 — Fault Event Flag 3
The FFLAG3 event bit is set within two CPU cycles after a rising edge
on fault pin 3. To clear the FFLAG3 bit, the user must write a 1 to the
FTACK3 bit in the fault acknowledge register.
1 = A fault has occurred on fault pin 3.
0 = No new fault on fault pin 3.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
Advance Information
179
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control
FPIN2 — State of Fault Pin 2 Bit
This read-only bit allows the user to read the current state of fault
pin 2.
1 = Fault pin 2 is at logic 1.
0 = Fault pin 2 is at logic 0.
FFLAG2 — Fault Event Flag 2
The FFLAG2 event bit is set within two CPU cycles after a rising edge
on fault pin 2. To clear the FFLAG2 bit, the user must write a 1 to the
FTACK2 bit in the fault acknowledge register.
1 = A fault has occurred on fault pin 2.
0 = No new fault on fault pin 2
FPIN1 — State of Fault Pin 1 Bit
This read-only bit allows the user to read the current state of fault
pin 1.
1 = Fault pin 1 is at logic 1.
0 = Fault pin 1 is at logic 0.
FFLAG1 — Fault Event Flag 1
The FFLAG1 event bit is set within two CPU cycles after a rising edge
on fault pin 1. To clear the FFLAG1 bit, the user must write a 1 to the
FTACK1 bit in the fault acknowledge register.
1 = A fault has occurred on fault pin 1.
0 = No new fault on fault pin 1.
9.10.10 Fault Acknowledge Register
The fault acknowledge register (FTACK) is used to acknowledge and
clear the FFLAGs. In addition, it is used to monitor the current sensing
bits to test proper operation.
Address: $0024
Read:
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
DT6
DT5
DT4
DT3
DT2
DT1
FTACK4
Write:
Reset:
0
0
FTACK3
0
0
FTACK2
0
0
FTACK1
0
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 9-44. Fault Acknowledge Register (FTACK)
Advance Information
180
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
MOTOROLA
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
Control Logic Block
FTACK4 — Fault Acknowledge 4 Bit
The FTACK4 bit is used to acknowledge and clear FFLAG4. This bit
will always read 0. Writing a 1 to this bit will clear FFLAG4. Writing a
0 will have no effect.
FTACK3 — Fault Acknowledge 3 Bit
The FTACK3 bit is used to acknowledge and clear FFLAG3. This bit
will always read 0. Writing a 1 to this bit will clear FFLAG3. Writing a
0 will have no effect.
FTACK2 — Fault Acknowledge 2 Bit
The FTACK2 bit is used to acknowledge and clear FFLAG2. This bit
will always read 0. Writing a 1 to this bit will clear FFLAG2. Writing a
0 will have no effect.
FTACK1 — Fault Acknowledge 1 Bit
The FTACK1 bit is used to acknowledge and clear FFLAG1. This bit
will always read 0. Writing a 1 to this bit will clear FFLAG1. Writing a
0 will have no effect.
DT6 — Dead-Time 6 Bit
Current sensing pin IS3 is monitored immediately before dead-time
ends due to the assertion of PWM6.
DT5 — Dead-Time 5 Bit
Current sensing pin IS3 is monitored immediately before dead-time
ends due to the assertion of PWM5.
DT4 — Dead-Time 4 Bit
Current sensing pin IS2 is monitored immediately before dead-time
ends due to the assertion of PWM4.
DT3 — Dead-Time 3 Bit
Current sensing pin IS2 is monitored immediately before dead-time
ends due to the assertion of PWM3.
DT2 — Dead-Time 2 Bit
Current sensing pin IS1 is monitored immediately before dead-time
ends due to the assertion of PWM2.
DT1 — Dead-Time 1 Bit
Current sensing pin IS1 is monitored immediately before dead-time
ends due to the assertion of PWM1.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
Advance Information
181
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control
9.10.11 PWM Output Control Register
The PWM output control register (PWMOUT) is used to manually control
the PWM pins.
Address: $0025
Bit 7
Read:
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
OUTCTL
OUT6
OUT5
OUT4
OUT3
OUT2
OUT1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Write:
Reset:
0
= Unimplemented
Figure 9-45. PWM Output Control Register (PWMOUT)
OUTCTL— Output Control Enable Bit
This read/write bit allows the user to manually control the PWM pins.
When set, the PWM generator is no longer the input to the dead-time
and output circuitry. The OUTx bits determine the state of the PWM
pins. Setting the OUTCTL bit does not disable the PWM generator.
The generator continues to run, but is no longer the input to the PWM
dead-time and output circuitry. When OUTCTL is cleared, the outputs
of the PWM generator immediately become the inputs to the
dead-time and output circuitry.
1 = PWM outputs controlled manually
0 = PWM outputs determined by PWM generator
OUT6–OUT1— PWM Pin Output Control Bits
These read/write bits control the PWM pins according to Table 9-10.
Advance Information
182
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
MOTOROLA
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
PWM Glossary
Table 9-10. OUTx Bits
OUTx Bit
Complementary Mode
Independent Mode
OUT1
1 — PWM1 is active.
0 — PWM1 is inactive.
1 — PWM1 is active.
0 — PWM1 is inactive.
OUT2
1 — PWM2 is complement of PWM 1.
0 — PWM2 is inactive.
1 — PWM2 is active.
0 — PWM2 is inactive.
OUT3
1 — PWM3 is active.
0 — PWM3 is inactive.
1 — PWM3 is active.
0 — PWM3 is inactive.
OUT4
1 — PWM4 is complement of PWM 3.
0 — PWM4 is inactive.
1 — PWM4 is active.
0 — PWM4 is inactive.
OUT5
1 — PWM5 is active.
0 — PWM5 is inactive.
1 — PWM5 is active.
0 — PWM5 is inactive.
OUT6
1 — PWM 6 is complement of PWM 5.
0 — PWM6 is inactive.
1 — PWM6 is active.
0 — PWM6 is inactive.
9.11 PWM Glossary
CPU cycle — One internal bus cycle (1/fOP)
PWM clock cycle (or period) — One tick of the PWM counter (1/fOP
with no prescaler). See Figure 9-46.
PWM cycle (or period)
•
Center-aligned mode: The time it takes the PWM counter to count
up and count down (modulus * 2/fOP assuming no prescaler). See
Figure 9-46.
•
Edge-aligned mode: The time it takes the PWM counter to count
up (modulus/fOP). See Figure 9-46.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
Advance Information
183
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control
Center-Aligned Mode
PWM CLOCK CYCLE
PWM CYCLE (OR PERIOD)
Edge-Aligned Mode
PWM
CLOCK
CYCLE
PWM CYCLE (OR PERIOD)
Figure 9-46. PWM Clock Cycle and PWM Cycle Definitions
PWM Load Frequency — Frequency at which new PWM parameters
get loaded into the PWM. See Figure 9-47.
LDFQ1:LDFQ0 = 01 — Reload Every Two Cycles
PWM LOAD CYCLE
(1/PWM LOAD FREQUENCY)
RELOAD NEW
MODULUS,
PRESCALER, &
PWM VALUES IF
LDOK = 1
RELOAD NEW
MODULUS,
PRESCALER, &
PWM VALUES IF
LDOK = 1
Figure 9-47. PWM Load Cycle/Frequency Definition
Advance Information
184
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Pulse-Width Modulator for Motor Control (PWMMC)
MOTOROLA
Advance Information — MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32
Section 10. Monitor ROM (MON)
10.1 Contents
10.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185
10.3
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186
10.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186
10.4.1 Entering Monitor Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .188
10.4.1.1
Normal Monitor Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188
10.4.1.2
Forced Monitor Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190
10.4.2 Data Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
10.4.3 Echoing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
10.4.4 Break Signal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192
10.4.5 Commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .192
10.4.6 Baud Rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .196
10.5
Security. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .196
10.2 Introduction
This section describes the monitor read-only memory (ROM). The
monitor ROM (MON) allows complete testing of the microcontroller unit
(MCU) through a single-wire interface with a host computer.
Monitor mode entry can be achieved without the use of VTST as long as
vector addresses $FFFE and $FFFF are blank, thus reducing the
hardware requirements for in-circuit programming.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Monitor ROM (MON)
Advance Information
185
Monitor ROM (MON)
10.3 Features
Features of the monitor ROM include:
•
Normal user-mode pin functionality
•
One pin dedicated to serial communication between monitor ROM
and host computer
•
Standard mark/space non-return-to-zero (NRZ) communication
with host computer
•
4800 baud–28.8 Kbaud communication with host computer
•
Execution of code in random-access memory (RAM) or ROM
•
FLASH programming
10.4 Functional Description
The monitor ROM receives and executes commands from a host
computer. Figure 10-1 shows a sample circuit used to enter monitor
mode and communicate with a host computer via a standard RS-232
interface.
Simple monitor commands can access any memory address. In monitor
mode, the MCU can execute host-computer code in RAM while all MCU
pins retain normal operating mode functions. All communication
between the host computer and the MCU is through the PTA0 pin. A
level-shifting and multiplexing interface is required between PTA0 and
the host computer. PTA0 is used in a wired-OR configuration and
requires a pullup resistor.
Advance Information
186
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Monitor ROM (MON)
MOTOROLA
Monitor ROM (MON)
Functional Description
VDD
10 kΩ
MC68HC908MR16/
MC68HC908MR32
S1
RST
0.1 µF
VHI
10 kΩ
IRQ
VDDA
1
10 µF
MC145407
VDDA
20
+
+
3
18
4
17
0.1 µF
10 µF
VDDAD
VDDAD
0.1 µF
10 µF
+
2
19
+
10 µF
VREFH
VDD
VREFH
0.1 µF
CGMXFC
0.02 µF
DB-25
2
5
16
3
6
15
OSC1
X1
4.9152 MHz
20 pF
7
10 MΩ
OSC2
VDD
1
MC74HC125
VREFL
VSSAD
VSSA
PWMGND
VSS
20 pF
14
2
3
6
5
VDD
VDD
4
0.1 µF
VDD
7
VDD
10 kΩ
10 kΩ
A
B
PTA0
PTA7
PTC2
S3
VDD
S2 Position A — Bus clock = CGMXCLK ÷ 4 or CGMVCLK ÷ 4
S2 Position B — Bus clock = CGMXCLK ÷ 2
S3 Position A — Parallel communication
S3 Position B — Serial communication
VDD
10 kΩ
10 kΩ
A
S2
B
PTC3
PTC4
Figure 10-1. Monitor Mode Circuit
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Monitor ROM (MON)
Advance Information
187
Monitor ROM (MON)
10.4.1 Entering Monitor Mode
There are two methods for entering monitor:
NOTE:
•
The first is the traditional M68HC08 method where VDD + VHI is
applied to IRQ1 and the mode pins are configured appropriately.
•
A second method, intended for in-circuit programming
applications, will force entry into monitor mode without requiring
high voltage on the IRQ1 pin when the reset vector locations of the
FLASH are erased ($FF).
For both methods, holding the PTC2 pin low when entering monitor
mode causes a bypass of a divide-by-two stage at the oscillator. The
CGMOUT frequency is equal to the CGMXCLK frequency, and the
OSC1 input directly generates internal bus clocks. In this case, the
OSC1 signal must have a 50 percent duty cycle at maximum bus
frequency.
is a summary of the differences between user mode and monitor mode.
Table 10-1. Mode Differences
Functions
COP
Rest
Vector
High
Reset
Vector
Low
Break
Vector
High
Break
Vector
Low
SWI
Vector
High
SWI
Vector
Low
User
Enabled
$FFFE
$FFFF
$FFFC
$FFFD
$FFFC
$FFFD
Monitor
Disabled(1)
$FEFE
$FEFF
$FEFC
$FEFD
$FEFC
$FEFD
Modes
1. If the high voltage (VDD + VHI) is removed from the IRQ1 pin or the RST pin, the SIM
asserts its COP enable output. The COP is a mask option enabled or disabled by the
COPD bit in the configuration register.
10.4.1.1 Normal Monitor Mode
Table 10-2 shows the pin conditions for entering monitor mode.
Advance Information
188
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Monitor ROM (MON)
MOTOROLA
Monitor ROM (MON)
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Table 10-2. Monitor Mode Signal Requirements and Options
For Serial
IRQ
RESET
(S1)
$FFFE
/$FFFF
X
GND
X
VTST
VDD
or
VTST
X
PLL PTC3 PTC4
X
OFF
X
1
X
0
PTC2 External
CGMOUT
(S2) Clock(1)
X
0
X
4.9152
MHz
0
4.9152
MHz
Bus
Frequency
COP
0
Disabled
2.4576
MHz
Disabled
VTST
VDD
or
VTST
X
OFF
1
0
1
9.8304
MHz
4.9152
MHz
2.4576
MHz
Disabled
VDD
VDD
$FFFF
Blank
OFF
X
X
X
9.8304
MHz
4.9152
MHz
2.4576
MHz
Disabled
VTST
VDD
or
GND
VDD
or
VTST
Baud
PTA7
PTA0
(S3) Rate(3) (4)
X
X
0
1
0
9600
X
1
DNA
1
0
9600
X
1
DNA
1
0
9600
X
1
DNA
Comment
No operation until
reset goes high
PTC3 and PTC2
voltages only
required if
IRQ = VTST;
PTC2
determines
frequency divider
PTC3 and PTC2
voltages only
required if
IRQ = VTST;
PTC2
determines
frequency divider
External frequency
always divided
by 4
OFF
X
X
X
X
—
—
Enabled
X
X
—
Enters user
mode — will
encounter an
illegal address
reset
Non-$FF
OFF
Programmed
X
X
X
X
—
—
Enabled
X
X
—
Enters user mode
$FFFF
Blank
1. External clock is derived by a 32.768 kHz crystal or a 4.9152/9.8304 MHz off-chip oscillator.
2. DNA = does not apply, X = don’t care
3. PAT0 = 1 if serial communication; PTA0 = X if parallel communication
4. PTA7 = 0 → serial, PTA7 = 1 → parallel communication for security code entry
Monitor ROM (MON)
Functional Description
189
Advance Information
VDD
or
GND
Communication(2)
Monitor ROM (MON)
Enter monitor mode by either:
•
Executing a software interrupt instruction (SWI) or
•
Applying a logic 0 and then a logic 1 to the RST pin
Once out of reset, the MCU waits for the host to send eight security
bytes. After receiving the security bytes, the MCU sends a break signal
(10 consecutive logic 0s) to the host computer, indicating that it is ready
to receive a command. The break signal also provides a timing reference
to allow the host to determine the necessary baud rate.
Monitor mode uses alternate vectors for reset and SWI. The alternate
vectors are in the $FE page instead of the $FF page and allow code
execution from the internal monitor firmware instead of user code. The
computer operating properly (COP) module is disabled in monitor mode
as long as VHI is applied to either the IRQ pin or the RST pin. (See
Section 7. System Integration Module (SIM) for more information on
modes of operation.)
10.4.1.2 Forced Monitor Mode
If the voltage applied to the IRQ1 is less than VDD + VHI the MCU will
come out of reset in user mode. The MENRST module is monitoring the
reset vector fetches and will assert an internal reset if it detects that the
reset vectors are erased ($FF). When the MCU comes out of reset, it is
forced into monitor mode without requiring high voltage on the IRQ1 pin.
The COP module is disabled in forced monitor mode. Any reset other
than a POR reset will automatically force the MCU to come back to the
forced monitor mode.
Advance Information
190
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Monitor ROM (MON)
MOTOROLA
Monitor ROM (MON)
Functional Description
10.4.2 Data Format
Communication with the monitor ROM is in standard non-return-to-zero
(NRZ) mark/space data format. (See Figure 10-2 and Figure 10-3.)
START
BIT
BIT 0
BIT 1
BIT 2
BIT 3
BIT 4
BIT 5
BIT 6
STOP
BIT
BIT 7
NEXT
START
BIT
Figure 10-2. Monitor Data Format
$A5
START
BIT
BIT 0
BIT 1
BIT 2
BIT 3
BIT 4
BIT 5
BIT 6
BIT 7
BREAK
START
BIT
BIT 0
BIT 1
BIT 2
BIT 3
BIT 4
BIT 5
BIT 6
BIT 7
STOP
BIT
STOP
BIT
NEXT
START
BIT
NEXT
START
BIT
Figure 10-3. Sample Monitor Waveforms
The data transmit and receive rate can be anywhere from 4800 baud to
28.8 Kbaud. Transmit and receive baud rates must be identical.
10.4.3 Echoing
As shown in Figure 10-4, the monitor ROM immediately echoes each
received byte back to the PTA0 pin for error checking.
SENT TO
MONITOR
READ
READ
ADDR. HIGH ADDR. HIGH
ADDR. LOW
ECHO
ADDR. LOW
DATA
RESULT
Figure 10-4. Read Transaction
Any result of a command appears after the echo of the last byte of the
command.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Monitor ROM (MON)
Advance Information
191
Monitor ROM (MON)
10.4.4 Break Signal
A start bit followed by nine low bits is a break signal. See Figure 10-5.
When the monitor receives a break signal, it drives the PTA0 pin high for
the duration of two bits before echoing the break signal.
MISSING STOP BIT
2--STOP-BIT DELAY BEFORE ZERO ECHO
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Figure 10-5. Break Transaction
10.4.5 Commands
The monitor ROM uses these commands (see Table 10-3–Table 10-8):
Advance Information
192
•
READ, read memory
•
WRITE, write memory
•
IREAD, indexed read
•
IWRITE, indexed write
•
READSP, read stack pointer
•
RUN, run user program
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Monitor ROM (MON)
MOTOROLA
Monitor ROM (MON)
Functional Description
Table 10-3. READ (Read Memory) Command
Description
Read byte from memory
Operand
Specifies 2-byte address in high byte:low byte order
Data returned
Returns contents of specified address
Opcode
$4A
Command sequence
SENT TO
MONITOR
READ
READ
ADDR. HIGH
ADDR. HIGH
ADDR. LOW
ADDR. LOW
ECHO
DATA
RESULT
Table 10-4. WRITE (Write Memory) Command
Description
Write byte to memory
Operand
Specifies 2-byte address in high byte:low byte order; low byte followed by data byte
Data returned
None
Opcode
$49
Command sequence
SENT TO
MONITOR
WRITE
WRITE
ADDR. HIGH
ADDR. HIGH
ADDR. LOW
ADDR. LOW
DATA
DATA
ECHO
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Monitor ROM (MON)
Advance Information
193
Monitor ROM (MON)
Table 10-5. IREAD (Indexed Read) Command
Description
Read next 2 bytes in memory from last address accessed
Operand
Specifies 2-byte address in high byte:low byte order
Data returned
Returns contents of next two addresses
Opcode
$1A
Command sequence
SENT TO
MONITOR
IREAD
IREAD
DATA
DATA
RESULT
ECHO
Table 10-6. IWRITE (Indexed Write) Command
Description
Write to last address accessed + 1
Operand
Specifies single data byte
Data returned
None
Opcode
$19
Command sequence
SENT TO
MONITOR
IWRITE
IWRITE
DATA
DATA
ECHO
NOTE:
Advance Information
194
A sequence of IREAD or IWRITE commands can sequentially access a
block of memory over the full 64-Kbyte memory map.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Monitor ROM (MON)
MOTOROLA
Monitor ROM (MON)
Functional Description
Table 10-7. READSP (Read Stack Pointer) Command
Description
Reads stack pointer
Operand
None
Data returned
Returns stack pointer in high byte:low byte order
Opcode
$0C
Command sequence
SENT TO
MONITOR
READSP
READSP
SP HIGH
SP LOW
RESULT
ECHO
Table 10-8. RUN (Run User Program) Command
Description
Executes RTI instruction
Operand
None
Data returned
None
Opcode
$28
Command sequence
SENT TO
MONITOR
RUN
RUN
ECHO
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Monitor ROM (MON)
Advance Information
195
Monitor ROM (MON)
10.4.6 Baud Rate
With a 4.9152-MHz crystal and the PTC2 pin at logic 1 during reset,
data is transferred between the monitor and host at 4800 baud. If the
PTC2 pin is at logic 0 during reset, the monitor baud rate is 9600. See
Table 10-9.
Table 10-9. Monitor Baud Rate Selection
VCO Frequency Multiplier (N)
Monitor baud rate
1
2
3
4
5
6
4800
9600
14,400
19,200
24,000
28,800
10.5 Security
A security feature discourages unauthorized reading of FLASH locations
while in monitor mode. The host can bypass the security feature at
monitor mode entry by sending eight security bytes that match the bytes
at locations $FFF6–$FFFD. Locations $FFF6–$FFFD contain
user-defined data.
NOTE:
Do not leave locations $FFF6–$FFFD blank. For security reasons,
program locations $FFF6–$FFFD even if they are not used for vectors.
During monitor mode entry, the MCU waits after the power-on reset for
the host to send the eight security bytes on pin PTA0. If the received
bytes match those at locations $FFF6–$FFFD, the host bypasses the
security feature and can read all FLASH locations and execute code
from FLASH. Security remains bypassed until a power-on reset occurs.
If the reset was not a power-on reset, security remains bypassed and
security code entry is not required. (See Figure 10-6.)
Upon power-on reset, if the received bytes of the security code do not
match the data at locations $FFF6–$FFFD, the host fails to bypass the
security feature. The MCU remains in monitor mode, but reading a
FLASH location returns an invalid value and trying to execute code from
FLASH causes an illegal address reset. After receiving the eight security
bytes from the host, the MCU transmits a break character, signifying that
it is ready to receive a command.
NOTE:
Advance Information
196
The MCU does not transmit a break character until after the host sends
the eight security bytes.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Monitor ROM (MON)
MOTOROLA
Monitor ROM (MON)
Security
V''
4096 + 32 CGMXCLK CYCLES
567
24 BUS CYCLES
PA7
COMMAND
BYTE 8
BYTE 2
BYTE 1
256 BUS CYCLES (MINIMUM)
FROM HOST
PA0
3
1
1
1
3
2
1
COMMAND ECHO
BREAK
BYTE 8 ECHO
BYTE 2 ECHO
BYTE 1 ECHO
FROM MCU
127(6
(FKRGH OD \ELWWLPH V
'DWD UH WXUQGHOD\ ELWWLPH V
:DLWELWWLPH EH IR UHVH QGLQJQH[ WE\ WH Figure 10-6. Monitor Mode Entry Timing
To determine whether the security code entered is correct, check to see
if bit 6 of RAM address $60 is set. If it is, then the correct security code
has been entered and FLASH can be accessed.
If the security sequence fails, the device can be reset (via power-pin
reset only) and brought up in monitor mode to attempt another entry.
After failing the security sequence, the FLASH mode can also be bulk
erased by executing an erase routine that was downloaded into internal
RAM. The bulk erase operation clears the security code locations so that
all eight security bytes become $FF.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Monitor ROM (MON)
Advance Information
197
Monitor ROM (MON)
Advance Information
198
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Monitor ROM (MON)
MOTOROLA
Advance Information — MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32
Section 11. Timer Interface A (TIMA)
11.1 Contents
11.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
11.3
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
11.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204
11.4.1 TIMA Counter Prescaler. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204
11.4.2 Input Capture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204
11.4.3 Output Compare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .205
11.4.3.1
Unbuffered Output Compare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206
11.4.3.2
Buffered Output Compare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .206
11.4.4 Pulse-Width Modulation (PWM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207
11.4.4.1
Unbuffered PWM Signal Generation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209
11.4.4.2
Buffered PWM Signal Generation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210
11.4.4.3
PWM Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211
11.5
Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212
11.6
Wait Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212
11.7 I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213
11.7.1 TIMA Clock Pin (PTE3/TCLKA) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213
11.7.2 TIMA Channel I/O Pins
(PTE4/TCH0A–PTE7/TCH3A) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213
11.8 I/O Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214
11.8.1 TIMA Status and Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214
11.8.2 TIMA Counter Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216
11.8.3 TIMA Counter Modulo Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217
11.8.4 TIMA Channel Status and Control Registers . . . . . . . . . . . 217
11.8.5 TIMA Channel Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
Advance Information
199
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
11.2 Introduction
This section describes the timer interface module A (TIMA). The TIMA is
a 4-channel timer that provides:
•
Timing reference with input capture
•
Output compare
•
Pulse-width modulator functions
Figure 11-1 is a block diagram of the TIMA.
11.3 Features
Features of the TIMA include:
•
Four input capture/output compare channels:
– Rising-edge, falling-edge, or any-edge input capture trigger
– Set, clear, or toggle output compare action
•
Buffered and unbuffered pulse-width modulator (PWM) signal
generation
•
Programmable TIMA clock input:
– 7-frequency internal bus clock prescaler selection
– External TIMA clock input (4-MHz maximum frequency)
Advance Information
200
•
Free-running or modulo up-count operation
•
Toggle any channel pin on overflow
•
TIMA counter stop and reset bits
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
Features
TCLK
PTE3/TCLKA
PRESCALER SELECT
INTERNAL
BUS CLOCK
PRESCALER
TSTOP
PS2
TRST
PS1
PS0
16-BIT COUNTER
TOF
TOIE
INTERRUPT
LOGIC
16-BIT COMPARATOR
TMODH:TMODL
CHANNEL 0
ELS0B
ELS0A
TOV0
CH0MAX
16-BIT COMPARATOR
TCH0H:TCH0L
CH0F
16-BIT LATCH
MS0A
CHANNEL 1
ELS1B
MS0B
ELS1A
TOV1
CH1MAX
16-BIT COMPARATOR
TCH1H:TCH1L
CH0IE
CH1F
16-BIT LATCH
CH1IE
MS1A
CHANNEL 2
ELS2B
ELS2A
TOV2
CH2MAX
16-BIT COMPARATOR
TCH2H:TCH2L
CH2F
16-BIT LATCH
MS2A
CHANNEL 3
ELS3B
MS2B
ELS3A
TOV3
CH3MAX
16-BIT COMPARATOR
TCH3H:TCH3L
CH2IE
CH3F
16-BIT LATCH
MS3A
CH3IE
PTE4
LOGIC
PTE4/TCH0A
INTERRUPT
LOGIC
PTE5
LOGIC
PTE5/TCH1A
INTERRUPT
LOGIC
PTE6
LOGIC
PTE6/TCH2A
INTERRUPT
LOGIC
PTE7
LOGIC
PTE7/TCH3A
INTERRUPT
LOGIC
Figure 11-1. TIMA Block Diagram
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
Advance Information
201
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
Addr.
$000E
$000F
$0010
$0011
$0012
Register Name
Bit 7
Read:
TIMA Status/Control Register
(TASC) Write:
See page 214.
Reset:
6
5
TOIE
TSTOP
4
3
0
0
TRST
R
TOF
0
0
2
1
Bit 0
PS2
PS1
PS0
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
Read: Bit 15
TIMA Counter Register High
(TACNTH) Write:
R
See page 216.
Reset:
0
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
TIMA Counter Register Low
(TACNTL) Write:
See page 216.
Reset:
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
CH0IE
MS0B
MS0A
ELS0B
ELS0A
TOV0
CH0MAX
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
TIMA Counter Modulo
Bit 15
Register High (TAMODH) Write:
See page 217.
Reset:
1
Read:
TIMA Counter Modulo
Register Low (TAMODL) Write:
See page 217.
Reset:
Read: CH0F
TIMA Channel 0 Status/Control
0
$0013
Register (TASC0) Write:
See page 218.
Reset:
0
Read:
TIMA Channel 0 Register High
Bit 15
$0014
(TACH0H) Write:
See page 222.
Reset:
Read:
TIMA Channel 0 Register Low
$0015
(TACH0L) Write:
See page 222.
Reset:
Bit 7
Indeterminate after reset
6
5
4
3
Indeterminate after reset
Read: CH1F
TIMA Channel 1 Status/Control
$0016
Register (TASC1) Write:
0
See page 218.
Reset:
0
R
0
CH1IE
MS1A
ELS1B
ELS1A
TOV1
CH1MAX
0
0
0
0
0
R
0
0
= Reserved
Figure 11-2. TIM I/O Register Summary
Advance Information
202
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
Features
Addr.
Register Name
Bit 7
Read:
TIMA Channel 1 Register High
Bit 15
$0017
(TACH1H) Write:
See page 222.
Reset:
Read:
TIMA Channel 1 Register Low
$0018
(TACH1L) Write:
See page 222.
Reset:
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
2
1
Bit 0
6
5
4
3
Indeterminate after reset
CH2IE
MS2B
MS2A
ELS2B
ELS2A
TOV2
CH2MAX
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
TIMA Channel 2 Register High
Bit 15
$001A
(TACH2H) Write:
See page 222.
Reset:
Indeterminate after reset
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
Indeterminate after reset
Read: CH3F
TIMA Channel 3 Status/Control
$001C
Register (TASC3) Write:
0
See page 218.
Reset:
0
0
CH3IE
MS3A
ELS3B
ELS3A
TOV3
CH3MAX
R
Read:
TIMA Channel 3 Register High
Bit 15
$001D
(TACH3H) Write:
See page 222.
Reset:
Read:
TIMA Channel 3 Register Low
$001E
(TACH3L) Write:
See page 222.
Reset:
5
Indeterminate after reset
Bit 7
Read: CH2F
TIMA Channel 2 Status/Control
$0019
Register (TASC2) Write:
0
See page 218.
Reset:
0
Read:
TIMA Channel 2 Register Low
$001B
(TACH2L) Write:
See page 222.
Reset:
6
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
2
1
Bit 0
Indeterminate after reset
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
Indeterminate after reset
R
= Reserved
Figure 11-2. TIM I/O Register Summary (Continued)
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
Advance Information
203
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
11.4 Functional Description
Figure 11-1 shows the TIMA structure. The central component of the
TIMA is the 16-bit TIMA counter that can operate as a free-running
counter or a modulo up-counter. The TIMA counter provides the timing
reference for the input capture and output compare functions. The TIMA
counter modulo registers, TAMODH–TAMODL, control the modulo
value of the TIMA counter. Software can read the TIMA counter value at
any time without affecting the counting sequence.
The four TIMA channels are programmable independently as input
capture or output compare channels.
11.4.1 TIMA Counter Prescaler
The TIMA clock source can be one of the seven prescaler outputs or the
TIMA clock pin, PTE3/TCLKA. The prescaler generates seven clock
rates from the internal bus clock. The prescaler select bits, PS[2:0], in
the TIMA status and control register select the TIMA clock source.
11.4.2 Input Capture
An input capture function has three basic parts:
1. Edge select logic
2. Input capture latch
3. 16-bit counter
Two 8-bit registers, which make up the 16-bit input capture register, are
used to latch the value of the free-running counter after the
corresponding input capture edge detector senses a defined transition.
The polarity of the active edge is programmable. The level transition
which triggers the counter transfer is defined by the corresponding input
edge bits (ELSxB and ELSxA in TASC0–TASC3 control registers with x
referring to the active channel number). When an active edge occurs on
the pin of an input capture channel, the TIMA latches the contents of the
TIMA counter into the TIMA channel registers, TACHxH–TACHxL. Input
captures can generate TIMA CPU interrupt requests. Software can
determine that an input capture event has occurred by enabling input
capture interrupts or by polling the status flag bit.
Advance Information
204
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
Functional Description
The free-running counter contents are transferred to the TIMA channel
status and control register (TACHxH–TACHxL, see 11.8.5 TIMA
Channel Registers) on each proper signal transition regardless of
whether the TIMA channel flag (CH0F–CH3F in TASC0–TASC3
registers) is set or clear. When the status flag is set, a CPU interrupt is
generated if enabled. The value of the count latched or “captured” is the
time of the event. Because this value is stored in the input capture
register two bus cycles after the actual event occurs, user software can
respond to this event at a later time and determine the actual time of the
event. However, this must be done prior to another input capture on the
same pin; otherwise, the previous time value will be lost.
By recording the times for successive edges on an incoming signal,
software can determine the period and/or pulse width of the signal. To
measure a period, two successive edges of the same polarity are
captured. To measure a pulse width, two alternate polarity edges are
captured. Software should track the overflows at the 16-bit module
counter to extend its range.
Another use for the input capture function is to establish a time
reference. In this case, an input capture function is used in conjunction
with an output compare function. For example, to activate an output
signal a specified number of clock cycles after detecting an input event
(edge), use the input capture function to record the time at which the
edge occurred. A number corresponding to the desired delay is added to
this captured value and stored to an output compare register (see
11.8.5 TIMA Channel Registers). Because both input captures and
output compares are referenced to the same 16-bit modulo counter, the
delay can be controlled to the resolution of the counter independent of
software latencies.
Reset does not affect the contents of the input capture channel registers.
11.4.3 Output Compare
With the output compare function, the TIMA can generate a periodic
pulse with a programmable polarity, duration, and frequency. When the
counter reaches the value in the registers of an output compare channel,
the TIMA can set, clear, or toggle the channel pin. Output compares can
generate TIMA CPU interrupt requests.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
Advance Information
205
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
11.4.3.1 Unbuffered Output Compare
Any output compare channel can generate unbuffered output compare
pulses as described in 11.4.3 Output Compare. The pulses are
unbuffered because changing the output compare value requires writing
the new value over the old value currently in the TIMA channel registers.
An unsynchronized write to the TIMA channel registers to change an
output compare value could cause incorrect operation for up to two
counter overflow periods. For example, writing a new value before the
counter reaches the old value but after the counter reaches the new
value prevents any compare during that counter overflow period. Also,
using a TIMA overflow interrupt routine to write a new, smaller output
compare value may cause the compare to be missed. The TIMA may
pass the new value before it is written.
Use this method to synchronize unbuffered changes in the output
compare value on channel x:
•
When changing to a smaller value, enable channel x output
compare interrupts and write the new value in the output compare
interrupt routine. The output compare interrupt occurs at the end
of the current output compare pulse. The interrupt routine has until
the end of the counter overflow period to write the new value.
•
When changing to a larger output compare value, enable TIMA
overflow interrupts and write the new value in the TIMA overflow
interrupt routine. The TIMA overflow interrupt occurs at the end of
the current counter overflow period. Writing a larger value in an
output compare interrupt routine (at the end of the current pulse)
could cause two output compares to occur in the same counter
overflow period.
11.4.3.2 Buffered Output Compare
Channels 0 and 1 can be linked to form a buffered output compare
channel whose output appears on the PTE4/TCH0A pin. The TIMA
channel registers of the linked pair alternately control the output.
Setting the MS0B bit in TIMA channel 0 status and control register
(TASC0) links channel 0 and channel 1. The output compare value in the
TIMA channel 0 registers initially controls the output on the
PTE4/TCH0A pin. Writing to the TIMA channel 1 registers enables the
Advance Information
206
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
Functional Description
TIMA channel 1 registers to synchronously control the output after the
TIMA overflows. At each subsequent overflow, the TIMA channel
registers (0 or 1) that control the output are the ones written to last.
TASC0 controls and monitors the buffered output compare function, and
TIMA channel 1 status and control register (TASC1) is unused. While the
MS0B bit is set, the channel 1 pin, PTE5/TCH1A, is available as a
general-purpose I/O pin.
Channels 2 and 3 can be linked to form a buffered output compare
channel whose output appears on the PTE6/TCH2A pin. The TIMA
channel registers of the linked pair alternately control the output.
Setting the MS2B bit in TIMA channel 2 status and control register
(TASC2) links channel 2 and channel 3. The output compare value in the
TIMA channel 2 registers initially controls the output on the
PTE6/TCH2A pin. Writing to the TIMA channel 3 registers enables the
TIMA channel 3 registers to synchronously control the output after the
TIMA overflows. At each subsequent overflow, the TIMA channel
registers (2 or 3) that control the output are the ones written to last.
TASC2 controls and monitors the buffered output compare function, and
TIMA channel 3 status and control register (TASC3) is unused. While the
MS2B bit is set, the channel 3 pin, PTE7/TCH3A, is available as a
general-purpose I/O pin.
NOTE:
In buffered output compare operation, do not write new output compare
values to the currently active channel registers. User software should
track the currently active channel to prevent writing a new value to the
active channel. Writing to the active channel registers is the same as
generating unbuffered output compares.
11.4.4 Pulse-Width Modulation (PWM)
By using the toggle-on-overflow feature with an output compare channel,
the TIMA can generate a PWM signal. The value in the TIMA counter
modulo registers determines the period of the PWM signal. The channel
pin toggles when the counter reaches the value in the TIMA counter
modulo registers. The time between overflows is the period of the PWM
signal.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
Advance Information
207
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
As Figure 11-3 shows, the output compare value in the TIMA channel
registers determines the pulse width of the PWM signal. The time
between overflow and output compare is the pulse width. Program the
TIMA to clear the channel pin on output compare if the state of the PWM
pulse is logic 1. Program the TIMA to set the pin if the state of the PWM
pulse is logic 0.
OVERFLOW
OVERFLOW
OVERFLOW
PERIOD
PULSE
WIDTH
PTEx/TCHx
OUTPUT
COMPARE
OUTPUT
COMPARE
OUTPUT
COMPARE
Figure 11-3. PWM Period and Pulse Width
The value in the TIMA counter modulo registers and the selected
prescaler output determines the frequency of the PWM output. The
frequency of an 8-bit PWM signal is variable in 256 increments. Writing
$00FF (255) to the TIMA counter modulo registers produces a PWM
period of 256 times the internal bus clock period if the prescaler select
value is $000 (see 11.8.1 TIMA Status and Control Register).
The value in the TIMA channel registers determines the pulse width of
the PWM output. The pulse width of an 8-bit PWM signal is variable in
256 increments. Writing $0080 (128) to the TIMA channel registers
produces a duty cycle of 128/256 or 50 percent.
Advance Information
208
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
Functional Description
11.4.4.1 Unbuffered PWM Signal Generation
Any output compare channel can generate unbuffered PWM pulses as
described in 11.4.4 Pulse-Width Modulation (PWM). The pulses are
unbuffered because changing the pulse width requires writing the new
pulse width value over the value currently in the TIMA channel registers.
An unsynchronized write to the TIMA channel registers to change a
pulse width value could cause incorrect operation for up to two PWM
periods. For example, writing a new value before the counter reaches
the old value but after the counter reaches the new value prevents any
compare during that PWM period. Also, using a TIMA overflow interrupt
routine to write a new, smaller pulse width value may cause the compare
to be missed. The TIMA may pass the new value before it is written to
the TIMA channel registers.
Use this method to synchronize unbuffered changes in the PWM pulse
width on channel x:
NOTE:
•
When changing to a shorter pulse width, enable channel x output
compare interrupts and write the new value in the output compare
interrupt routine. The output compare interrupt occurs at the end
of the current pulse. The interrupt routine has until the end of the
PWM period to write the new value.
•
When changing to a longer pulse width, enable TIMA overflow
interrupts and write the new value in the TIMA overflow interrupt
routine. The TIMA overflow interrupt occurs at the end of the
current PWM period. Writing a larger value in an output compare
interrupt routine (at the end of the current pulse) could cause two
output compares to occur in the same PWM period.
In PWM signal generation, do not program the PWM channel to toggle
on output compare. Toggling on output compare prevents reliable
0 percent duty cycle generation and removes the ability of the channel
to self-correct in the event of software error or noise. Toggling on output
compare also can cause incorrect PWM signal generation when
changing the PWM pulse width to a new, much larger value.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
Advance Information
209
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
11.4.4.2 Buffered PWM Signal Generation
Channels 0 and 1 can be linked to form a buffered PWM channel whose
output appears on the PTE4/TCH0A pin. The TIMA channel registers of
the linked pair alternately control the pulse width of the output.
Setting the MS0B bit in TIMA channel 0 status and control register
(TASC0) links channel 0 and channel 1. The TIMA channel 0 registers
initially control the pulse width on the PTE4/TCH0A pin. Writing to the
TIMA channel 1 registers enables the TIMA channel 1 registers to
synchronously control the pulse width at the beginning of the next PWM
period. At each subsequent overflow, the TIMA channel registers
(0 or 1) that control the pulse width are the ones written to last. TASC0
controls and monitors the buffered PWM function, and TIMA channel 1
status and control register (TASC1) is unused. While the MS0B bit is set,
the channel 1 pin, PTE5/TCH1A, is available as a general-purpose
I/O pin.
Channels 2 and 3 can be linked to form a buffered PWM channel whose
output appears on the PTE6/TCH2A pin. The TIMA channel registers of
the linked pair alternately control the pulse width of the output.
Setting the MS2B bit in TIMA channel 2 status and control register
(TASC2) links channel 2 and channel 3. The TIMA channel 2 registers
initially control the pulse width on the PTE6/TCH2A pin. Writing to the
TIMA channel 3 registers enables the TIMA channel 3 registers to
synchronously control the pulse width at the beginning of the next PWM
period. At each subsequent overflow, the TIMA channel registers
(2 or 3) that control the pulse width are written to last. TASC2 controls
and monitors the buffered PWM function, and TIMA channel 3 status
and control register (TASC3) is unused. While the MS2B bit is set, the
channel 3 pin, PTE7/TCH3A, is available as a general-purpose
I/O pin.
NOTE:
Advance Information
210
In buffered PWM signal generation, do not write new pulse width values
to the currently active channel registers. User software should track the
currently active channel to prevent writing a new value to the active
channel. Writing to the active channel registers is the same as
generating unbuffered PWM signals.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
Functional Description
11.4.4.3 PWM Initialization
To ensure correct operation when generating unbuffered or buffered
PWM signals, use this initialization procedure:
1. In the TIMA status and control register (TASC):
a. Stop the TIMA counter by setting the TIMA stop bit, TSTOP.
b. Reset the TIMA counter and prescaler by setting the TIMA
reset bit, TRST.
2. In the TIMA counter modulo registers (TAMODH–TAMODL), write
the value for the required PWM period.
3. In the TIMA channel x registers (TACHxH–TACHxL), write the
value for the required pulse width.
4. In TIMA channel x status and control register (TSCx):
a. Write 0:1 (for unbuffered output compare or PWM signals) or
1:0 (for buffered output compare or PWM signals) to the mode
select bits, MSxB–MSxA. (See Table 11-2.)
b. Write 1 to the toggle-on-overflow bit, TOVx.
c.
NOTE:
Write 1:0 (to clear output on compare) or 1:1 (to set output on
compare) to the edge/level select bits, ELSxB–ELSxA. The
output action on compare must force the output to the
complement of the pulse width level. (See Table 11-2.)
In PWM signal generation, do not program the PWM channel to toggle
on output compare. Toggling on output compare prevents reliable
0 percent duty cycle generation and removes the ability of the channel
to self-correct in the event of software error or noise. Toggling on output
compare can also cause incorrect PWM signal generation when
changing the PWM pulse width to a new, much larger value.
5. In the TIMA status control register (TASC), clear the TIMA stop bit,
TSTOP.
Setting MS0B links channels 0 and 1 and configures them for buffered
PWM operation. The TIMA channel 0 registers (TACH0H–TACH0L)
initially control the buffered PWM output. TIMA status control register 0
(TASC0) controls and monitors the PWM signal from the linked
channels. MS0B takes priority over MS0A.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
Advance Information
211
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
Setting MS2B links channels 2 and 3 and configures them for buffered
PWM operation. The TIMA channel 2 registers (TACH2H–TACH2L)
initially control the buffered PWM output. TIMA status control register 2
(TASC2) controls and monitors the PWM signal from the linked
channels. MS2B takes priority over MS2A.
Clearing the toggle-on-overflow bit, TOVx, inhibits output toggles on
TIMA overflows. Subsequent output compares try to force the output to
a state it is already in and have no effect. The result is a 0 percent duty
cycle output.
Setting the channel x maximum duty cycle bit (CHxMAX) and setting the
TOVx bit generates a 100 percent duty cycle output. (See
11.8.4 TIMA Channel Status and Control Registers.)
11.5 Interrupts
These TIMA sources can generate interrupt requests:
•
TIMA overflow flag (TOF) — The timer overflow flag (TOF) bit is
set when the TIMA counter reads the modulo value programmed
in the TIMA counter modulo registers. The TIMA overflow interrupt
enable bit, TOIE, enables TIMA overflow interrupt requests. TOF
and TOIE are in the TIMA status and control registers.
•
TIMA channel flags (CH3F–CH0F) — The CHxF bit is set when an
input capture or output compare occurs on channel x. Channel x
TIMA CPU interrupt requests are controlled by the channel x
interrupt enable bit, CHxIE.
11.6 Wait Mode
The WAIT instruction puts the MCU in low power-consumption standby
mode.
The TIMA remains active after the execution of a WAIT instruction. In
wait mode, the TIMA registers are not accessible by the CPU. Any
enabled CPU interrupt request from the TIMA can bring the MCU out of
wait mode.
Advance Information
212
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
I/O Signals
If TIMA functions are not required during wait mode, reduce power
consumption by stopping the TIMA before executing the WAIT
instruction.
11.7 I/O Signals
Port E shares five of its pins with the TIMA:
•
PTE3/TCLKA is an external clock input to the TIMA prescaler.
•
The four TIMA channel I/O pins are PTE4/TCH0A, PTE5/TCH1A,
PTE6/TCH2A, and PTE7/TCH3A.
11.7.1 TIMA Clock Pin (PTE3/TCLKA)
PTE3/TCLKA is an external clock input that can be the clock source for
the TIMA counter instead of the prescaled internal bus clock. Select the
PTE3/TCLKA input by writing logic 1s to the three prescaler select bits,
PS[2:0]. See 11.8.1 TIMA Status and Control Register. The minimum
TCLK pulse width, TCLKLMIN or TCLKHMIN, is:
1
------------------------------------- + t SU
bus frequency
The maximum TCLK frequency is the least: 4 MHz or bus frequency ÷ 2.
PTE3/TCLKA is available as a general-purpose I/O pin or ADC channel
when not used as the TIMA clock input. When the PTE3/TCLKA pin is
the TIMA clock input, it is an input regardless of the state of the DDRE3
bit in data direction register E.
11.7.2 TIMA Channel I/O Pins (PTE4/TCH0A–PTE7/TCH3A)
Each channel I/O pin is programmable independently as an input
capture pin or an output compare pin. PTE2/TCH0 and PTE4/TCH2 can
be configured as buffered output compare or buffered PWM pins.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
Advance Information
213
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
11.8 I/O Registers
These input/output (I/O) registers control and monitor TIMA operation:
•
TIMA status and control register (TASC)
•
TIMA control registers (TACNTH–TACNTL)
•
TIMA counter modulo registers (TAMODH–TAMODL)
•
TIMA channel status and control registers (TASC0, TASC1,
TASC2, and TASC3)
•
TIMA channel registers (TACH0H–TACH0L, TACH1H–TACH1L,
TACH2H–TACH2L, and TACH3H–TACH3L)
11.8.1 TIMA Status and Control Register
The TIMA status and control register:
•
Enables TIMA overflow interrupts
•
Flags TIMA overflows
•
Stops the TIMA counter
•
Resets the TIMA counter
•
Prescales the TIMA counter clock
Address: $000E
Bit 7
Read:
6
5
TOIE
TSTOP
4
3
0
0
TRST
R
0
0
TOF
Write:
0
Reset:
0
R
0
1
2
1
Bit 0
PS2
PS1
PS0
0
0
0
= Reserved
Figure 11-4. TIMA Status and Control Register (TASC)
TOF — TIMA Overflow Flag
This read/write flag is set when the TIMA counter reaches the modulo
value programmed in the TIMA counter modulo registers. Clear TOF
by reading the TIMA status and control register when TOF is set and
then writing a logic 0 to TOF. If another TIMA overflow occurs before
the clearing sequence is complete, then writing logic 0 to TOF has no
effect. Therefore, a TOF interrupt request cannot be lost due to
Advance Information
214
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
I/O Registers
inadvertent clearing of TOF. Reset clears the TOF bit. Writing a
logic 1 to TOF has no effect.
1 = TIMA counter has reached modulo value.
0 = TIMA counter has not reached modulo value.
TOIE — TIMA Overflow Interrupt Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables TIMA overflow interrupts when the TOF bit
becomes set. Reset clears the TOIE bit.
1 = TIMA overflow interrupts enabled
0 = TIMA overflow interrupts disabled
TSTOP — TIMA Stop Bit
This read/write bit stops the TIMA counter. Counting resumes when
TSTOP is cleared. Reset sets the TSTOP bit, stopping the TIMA
counter until software clears the TSTOP bit.
1 = TIMA counter stopped
0 = TIMA counter active
NOTE:
Do not set the TSTOP bit before entering wait mode if the TIMA is
required to exit wait mode. Also when the TSTOP bit is set and the timer
is configured for input capture operation, input captures are inhibited
until the TSTOP bit is cleared.
TRST — TIMA Reset Bit
Setting this write-only bit resets the TIMA counter and the TIMA
prescaler. Setting TRST has no effect on any other registers.
Counting resumes from $0000. TRST is cleared automatically after
the TIMA counter is reset and always reads as logic 0. Reset clears
the TRST bit.
1 = Prescaler and TIMA counter cleared
0 = No effect
NOTE:
Setting the TSTOP and TRST bits simultaneously stops the TIMA
counter at a value of $0000.
PS[2:0] — Prescaler Select Bits
These read/write bits select either the PTD6/ATD14/TCLK pin or one
of the seven prescaler outputs as the input to the TIMA counter as
Table 11-1 shows. Reset clears the PS[2:0] bits.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
Advance Information
215
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
Table 11-1. Prescaler Selection
PS[2:0]
TIMA Clock Source
000
Internal bus clock ÷1
001
Internal bus clock ÷ 2
010
Internal bus clock ÷ 4
011
Internal bus clock ÷ 8
100
Internal bus clock ÷ 16
101
Internal bus clock ÷ 32
110
Internal bus clock ÷ 64
111
PTE3/TCLKA
11.8.2 TIMA Counter Registers
The two read-only TIMA counter registers contain the high and low bytes
of the value in the TIMA counter. Reading the high byte (TACNTH)
latches the contents of the low byte (TACNTL) into a buffer. Subsequent
reads of TACNTH do not affect the latched TACNTL value until TACNTL
is read. Reset clears the TIMA counter registers. Setting the TIMA reset
bit (TRST) also clears the TIMA counter registers.
NOTE:
If TACNTH is read during a break interrupt, be sure to unlatch TACNTL
by reading TACNTL before exiting the break interrupt. Otherwise,
TACNTL retains the value latched during the break.
Register Name and Address: TACNTH — $000F
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Write:
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Register Name and Address: TACNTL — $0010
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Write:
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R
= Reserved
Figure 11-5. TIMA Counter Registers (TACNTH and TACNTL)
Advance Information
216
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
I/O Registers
11.8.3 TIMA Counter Modulo Registers
The read/write TIMA modulo registers contain the modulo value for the
TIMA counter. When the TIMA counter reaches the modulo value, the
overflow flag (TOF) becomes set, and the TIMA counter resumes
counting from $0000 at the next timer clock. Writing to the high byte
(TAMODH) inhibits the TOF bit and overflow interrupts until the low byte
(TAMODL) is written. Reset sets the TIMA counter modulo registers.
Register Name and Address: TAMODH — $0011
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Register Name and Address: TAMODL — $0012
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Figure 11-6. TIMA Counter Modulo Registers
(TAMODH and TAMODL)
NOTE:
Reset the TIMA counter before writing to the TIMA counter modulo
registers.
11.8.4 TIMA Channel Status and Control Registers
Each of the TIMA channel status and control registers:
•
Flags input captures and output compares
•
Enables input capture and output compare interrupts
•
Selects input capture, output compare, or PWM operation
•
Selects high, low, or toggling output on output compare
•
Selects rising edge, falling edge, or any edge as the active input
capture trigger
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
Advance Information
217
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
•
Selects output toggling on TIMA overflow
•
Selects 0 percent and 100 percent PWM duty cycle
•
Selects buffered or unbuffered output compare/PWM operation
Register Name and Address: TASC0 — $0013
Bit 7
Read:
CH0F
Write:
0
Reset:
0
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
CH0IE
MS0B
MS0A
ELS0B
ELS0A
TOV0
CH0MAX
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
MS1A
ELS1B
ELS1A
TOV1
CH1MAX
0
0
0
0
0
Register Name and Address: TASC1 — $0016
Bit 7
Read:
6
CH1F
5
0
CH1IE
Write:
0
Reset:
0
R
0
0
Register Name and Address: TASC2 — $0019
Bit 7
Read:
CH2F
Write:
0
Reset:
0
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
CH2IE
MS2B
MS2A
ELS2B
ELS2A
TOV2
CH2MAX
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
MS3A
ELS3B
ELS3A
TOV3
CH3MAX
0
0
0
0
0
Register Name and Address: TASC3 — $001C
Bit 7
Read:
6
CH3F
5
0
CH3IE
Write:
0
Reset:
0
R
R
0
0
= Reserved
Figure 11-7. TIMA Channel Status
and Control Registers (TASC0–TASC3)
Advance Information
218
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
I/O Registers
CHxF — Channel x Flag Bit
When channel x is an input capture channel, this read/write bit is set
when an active edge occurs on the channel x pin. When channel x is
an output compare channel, CHxF is set when the value in the TIMA
counter registers matches the value in the TIMA channel x registers.
When CHxIE = 1, clear CHxF by reading TIMA channel x status and
control register with CHxF set, and then writing a logic 0 to CHxF. If
another interrupt request occurs before the clearing sequence is
complete, then writing logic 0 to CHxF has no effect. Therefore, an
interrupt request cannot be lost due to inadvertent clearing of CHxF.
Reset clears the CHxF bit. Writing a logic 1 to CHxF has no effect.
1 = Input capture or output compare on channel x
0 = No input capture or output compare on channel x
CHxIE — Channel x Interrupt Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables TIMA CPU interrupts on channel x.
Reset clears the CHxIE bit.
1 = Channel x CPU interrupt requests enabled
0 = Channel x CPU interrupt requests disabled
MSxB — Mode Select Bit B
This read/write bit selects buffered output compare/PWM operation.
MSxB exists only in the TIMA channel 0 and TIMA channel 2 status
and control registers.
Setting MS0B disables the channel 1 status and control register and
reverts TCH1A pin to general-purpose I/O.
Setting MS2B disables the channel 3 status and control register and
reverts TCH3A pin to general-purpose I/O.
Reset clears the MSxB bit.
1 = Buffered output compare/PWM operation enabled
0 = Buffered output compare/PWM operation disabled
MSxA — Mode Select Bit A
When ELSxB:A ≠ 00, this read/write bit selects either input capture
operation or unbuffered output compare/PWM operation.
See Table 11-2.
1 = Unbuffered output compare/PWM operation
0 = Input capture operation
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
Advance Information
219
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
When ELSxB:A = 00, this read/write bit selects the initial output level
of the TCHxA pin once PWM, input capture, or output compare
operation is enabled. See Table 11-2. Reset clears the MSxA bit.
1 = Initial output level low
0 = Initial output level high
NOTE:
Before changing a channel function by writing to the MSxB or MSxA bit,
set the TSTOP and TRST bits in the TIMA status and control register
(TASC).
ELSxB and ELSxA — Edge/Level Select Bits
When channel x is an input capture channel, these read/write bits
control the active edge-sensing logic on channel x.
When channel x is an output compare channel, ELSxB and ELSxA
control the channel x output behavior when an output compare
occurs.
When ELSxB and ELSxA are both clear, channel x is not connected
to port E, and pin PTEx/TCHxA is available as a general-purpose I/O
pin. However, channel x is at a state determined by these bits and
becomes transparent to the respective pin when PWM, input capture,
or output compare mode is enabled. Table 11-2 shows how ELSxB
and ELSxA work. Reset clears the ELSxB and ELSxA bits.
Table 11-2. Mode, Edge, and Level Selection
MSxB:MSxA
ELSxB:ELSxA
X0
00
Mode
Configuration
Pin under port control; initialize timer output level high
Output preset
X1
00
Pin under port control; initialize timer output level low
00
01
Capture on rising edge only
00
10
00
11
01
01
01
10
01
11
1X
01
1X
10
1X
11
Advance Information
220
Input capture
Capture on falling edge only
Capture on rising or falling edge
Output
compare
or PWM
Buffered
output compare
or buffered PWM
Toggle output on compare
Clear output on compare
Set output on compare
Toggle output on compare
Clear output on compare
Set output on compare
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
I/O Registers
NOTE:
Before enabling a TIMA channel register for input capture operation,
make sure that the PTEx/TACHx pin is stable for at least two bus clocks.
TOVx — Toggle-On-Overflow Bit
When channel x is an output compare channel, this read/write bit
controls the behavior of the channel x output when the TIMA counter
overflows. When channel x is an input capture channel, TOVx has no
effect. Reset clears the TOVx bit.
1 = Channel x pin toggles on TIMA counter overflow.
0 = Channel x pin does not toggle on TIMA counter overflow.
NOTE:
When TOVx is set, a TIMA counter overflow takes precedence over a
channel x output compare if both occur at the same time.
CHxMAX — Channel x Maximum Duty Cycle Bit
When the TOVx is at logic 1 and clear output on compare is selected,
setting the CHxMAX bit forces the duty cycle of buffered and
unbuffered PWM signals to 100 percent. As Figure 11-8 shows,
CHxMAX bit takes effect in the cycle after it is set or cleared. The
output stays at 100 percent duty cycle level until the cycle after
CHxMAX is cleared.
NOTE:
The PWM 0 percent duty cycle is defined as output low all of the time.To
generate the 0 percent duty cycle select clear output on compare and
then clear the TOVx bit (CHxMAX = 0). The PWM 100 percent duty cycle
is defined as output high all of the time. To generate the 100 percent duty
cycle, use the CHxMAX bit in the TSCx register.
OVERFLOW
OVERFLOW
OVERFLOW
OVERFLOW
OVERFLOW
PERIOD
PTEx/TCHx
OUTPUT
COMPARE
OUTPUT
COMPARE
OUTPUT
COMPARE
OUTPUT
COMPARE
CHxMAX
TOVx
Figure 11-8. CHxMAX Latency
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
Advance Information
221
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
11.8.5 TIMA Channel Registers
These read/write registers contain the captured TIMA counter value of
the input capture function or the output compare value of the output
compare function. The state of the TIMA channel registers after reset is
unknown.
In input capture mode (MSxB:MSxA = 0:0), reading the high byte of the
TIMA channel x registers (TACHxH) inhibits input captures until the low
byte (TACHxL) is read.
In output compare mode (MSxB:MSxA ≠ 0:0), writing to the high byte of
the TIMA channel x registers (TACHxH) inhibits output compares until
the low byte (TACHxL) is written.
Register Name and Address: TACH0H — $0014
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Indeterminate after reset
Register Name and Address: TACH0L — $0015
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Indeterminate after reset
Register Name and Address: TACH1H — $0017
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Indeterminate after reset
Figure 11-9. TIMA Channel Registers
(TACH0H/L–TACH3H/L)
Advance Information
222
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
I/O Registers
Register Name and Address: TACH1L — $0018
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Indeterminate after reset
Register Name and Address: TACH2H — $001A
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Indeterminate after reset
Register Name and Address: TACH2L — $001B
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Indeterminate after reset
Register Name and Address: TACH3H — $001D
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Indeterminate after reset
Register Name and Address: TACH3L — $001E
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Indeterminate after reset
Figure 11-9. TIMA Channel Registers
(TACH0H/L–TACH3H/L) (Continued)
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
Advance Information
223
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
Advance Information
224
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Timer Interface A (TIMA)
MOTOROLA
Advance Information — MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32
Section 12. Timer Interface B (TIMB)
12.1 Contents
12.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226
12.3
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226
12.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226
12.4.1 TIMB Counter Prescaler. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227
12.4.2 Input Capture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229
12.4.3 Output Compare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .230
12.4.3.1
Unbuffered Output Compare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230
12.4.3.2
Buffered Output Compare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .231
12.4.4 Pulse-Width Modulation (PWM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232
12.4.4.1
Unbuffered PWM Signal Generation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 233
12.4.4.2
Buffered PWM Signal Generation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234
12.4.4.3
PWM Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234
12.5
Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236
12.6
Wait Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236
12.7 I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236
12.7.1 TIMB Clock Pin (PTD4/ATD12) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237
12.7.2 TIMB Channel I/O Pins
(PTE1/TCH0B–PTE2/TCH1B) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237
12.8 I/O Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237
12.8.1 TIMB Status and Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238
12.8.2 TIMB Counter Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
12.8.3 TIMB Counter Modulo Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241
12.8.4 TIMB Channel Status and Control Registers . . . . . . . . . . . 242
12.8.5 TIMB Channel Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface B (TIMB)
Advance Information
225
Timer Interface B (TIMB)
12.2 Introduction
This section describes the timer interface module B (TIMB). The TIMB is
a 2-channel timer that provides:
•
Timing reference with input capture
•
Output compare
•
Pulse-width modulation functions
Figure 12-1 is a block diagram of the TIMB.
NOTE:
The TIMB module is not available in the 56-pin shrink dual in-line
package (SDIP).
12.3 Features
Features of the TIMB include:
•
Two input capture/output compare channels:
– Rising-edge, falling-edge, or any-edge input capture trigger
– Set, clear, or toggle output compare action
•
Buffered and unbuffered pulse-width modulation (PWM) signal
generation
•
Programmable TIMB clock input:
– 7-frequency internal bus clock prescaler selection
– External TIMB clock input (4-MHz maximum frequency)
•
Free-running or modulo up-count operation
•
Toggle any channel pin on overflow
•
TIMB counter stop and reset bits
12.4 Functional Description
Figure 12-1 shows the TIMB structure. The central component of the
TIMB is the 16-bit TIMB counter that can operate as a free-running
counter or a modulo up-counter. The TIMB counter provides the timing
reference for the input capture and output compare functions. The TIMB
counter modulo registers, TBMODH–TBMODL, control the modulo
value of the TIMB counter. Software can read the TIMB counter value at
any time without affecting the counting sequence.
Advance Information
226
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Timer Interface B (TIMB)
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface B (TIMB)
Functional Description
TCLK
PTE0/TCLKB
PRESCALER SELECT
INTERNAL
BUS CLOCK
PRESCALER
TSTOP
PS2
TRST
PS1
PS0
16-BIT COUNTER
TOF
TOIE
INTERRUPT
LOGIC
16-BIT COMPARATOR
TMODH:TMODL
ELS0B
CHANNEL 0
ELS0A
TOV0
CH0MAX
16-BIT COMPARATOR
TCH0H:TCH0L
CH0F
16-BIT LATCH
MS0A
ELS1B
CHANNEL 1
MS0B
ELS1A
TOV1
CH1MAX
16-BIT COMPARATOR
TCH1H:TCH1L
CH0IE
CH1F
16-BIT LATCH
MS1A
CH1IE
PTE1
LOGIC
PTE1/TCH0B
INTERRUPT
LOGIC
PTE2
LOGIC
PTE2/TCH1B
INTERRUPT
LOGIC
Figure 12-1. TIMB Block Diagram
The two TIMB channels are programmable independently as input
capture or output compare channels.
NOTE:
The TIMB module is not available in the 56-pin SDIP.
12.4.1 TIMB Counter Prescaler
The TIMB clock source can be one of the seven prescaler outputs or the
TIMB clock pin, PTD4/ATD12. The prescaler generates seven clock
rates from the internal bus clock. The prescaler select bits, PS[2:0], in
the TIMB status and control register select the TIMB clock source.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface B (TIMB)
Advance Information
227
Timer Interface B (TIMB)
Addr.
$0051
$0052
$0053
Register Name
6
5
TOIE
TSTOP
0
TIMB Counter Register High Read: Bit 15
R
(TBCNTH) Write:
See page 240. Reset:
0
TIMB Counter Register Low Read:
(TBCNTL) Write:
See page 240. Reset:
TIMB Status/Control Register Read:
(TBSC) Write:
See page 238. Reset:
Bit 7
2
1
Bit 0
PS2
PS1
PS0
0
0
0
0
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
R
R
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
CH0IE
MS0B
MS0A
ELS0B
ELS0A
TOV0
CH0MAX
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
TOF
0
0
TIMB Counter Modulo Register Read: Bit 15
$0054
High (TBMODH) Write:
See page 241. Reset:
1
TIMB Counter Modulo Register Read:
$0055
Low (TBMODL) Write:
See page 241. Reset:
TIMB Channel 0 Status/Control Read: CH0F
$0056
Register Write:
0
(TBSC0) See page 242. Reset:
0
TIMB Channel 0 Register High Read: Bit 15
$0057
(TBCH0H) Write:
See page 246. Reset:
TIMB Channel 0 Register Low Read:
$0058
(TBCH0L) Write:
See page 246. Reset:
Bit 7
3
0
0
TRST
R
1
0
Bit 14
Bit 13
R
Indeterminate after reset
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Indeterminate after reset
TIMB Channel 1 Status/Control Read: CH1F
$0059
Register Write:
0
(TBSC1) See page 242. Reset:
0
TIMB Channel 1 Register High Read: Bit 15
$005A
(TBCH1H) Write:
See page 246. Reset:
TIMB Channel 1 Register Low Read:
$005B
(TBCH1L) Write:
See page 246. Reset:
4
Bit 7
CH1IE
0
R
MS1A
ELS1B
ELS1A
TOV1
CH1MAX
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Indeterminate after reset
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Indeterminate after reset
R
= Reserved
Figure 12-2. TIMB I/O Register Summary
Advance Information
228
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Timer Interface B (TIMB)
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface B (TIMB)
Functional Description
12.4.2 Input Capture
An input capture function has three basic parts:
1. Edge select logic
2. Input capture latch
3. 16-bit counter
Two 8-bit registers, which make up the 16-bit input capture register, are
used to latch the value of the free-running counter after the
corresponding input capture edge detector senses a defined transition.
The polarity of the active edge is programmable. The level transition
which triggers the counter transfer is defined by the corresponding input
edge bits (ELSxB and ELSxA in TBSC0–TBSC1 control registers with x
referring to the active channel number). When an active edge occurs on
the pin of an input capture channel, the TIMB latches the contents of the
TIMB counter into the TIMB channel registers, TCHxH–TCHxL. Input
captures can generate TIMB CPU interrupt requests. Software can
determine that an input capture event has occurred by enabling input
capture interrupts or by polling the status flag bit.
The free-running counter contents are transferred to the TIMB channel
status and control register (TBCHxH–TBCHxL, see 12.8.5 TIMB
Channel Registers) on each proper signal transition regardless of
whether the TIMB channel flag (CH0F–CH1F in TBSC0–TBSC1
registers) is set or clear. When the status flag is set, a CPU interrupt is
generated if enabled. The value of the count latched or “captured” is the
time of the event. Because this value is stored in the input capture
register two bus cycles after the actual event occurs, user software can
respond to this event at a later time and determine the actual time of the
event. However, this must be done prior to another input capture on the
same pin; otherwise, the previous time value will be lost.
By recording the times for successive edges on an incoming signal,
software can determine the period and/or pulse width of the signal. To
measure a period, two successive edges of the same polarity are
captured. To measure a pulse width, two alternate polarity edges are
captured. Software should track the overflows at the 16-bit module
counter to extend its range.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface B (TIMB)
Advance Information
229
Timer Interface B (TIMB)
Another use for the input capture function is to establish a time
reference. In this case, an input capture function is used in conjunction
with an output compare function. For example, to activate an output
signal a specified number of clock cycles after detecting an input event
(edge), use the input capture function to record the time at which the
edge occurred. A number corresponding to the desired delay is added to
this captured value and stored to an output compare register (see 12.8.5
TIMB Channel Registers). Because both input captures and output
compares are referenced to the same 16-bit modulo counter, the delay
can be controlled to the resolution of the counter independent of
software latencies.
Reset does not affect the contents of the input capture channel register
(TBCHxH–TBCHxL).
12.4.3 Output Compare
With the output compare function, the TIMB can generate a periodic
pulse with a programmable polarity, duration, and frequency. When the
counter reaches the value in the registers of an output compare channel,
the TIMB can set, clear, or toggle the channel pin. Output compares can
generate TIMB CPU interrupt requests.
12.4.3.1 Unbuffered Output Compare
Any output compare channel can generate unbuffered output compare
pulses as described in 12.4.3 Output Compare. The pulses are
unbuffered because changing the output compare value requires writing
the new value over the old value currently in the TIMB channel registers.
An unsynchronized write to the TIMB channel registers to change an
output compare value could cause incorrect operation for up to two
counter overflow periods. For example, writing a new value before the
counter reaches the old value but after the counter reaches the new
value prevents any compare during that counter overflow period. Also,
using a TIMB overflow interrupt routine to write a new, smaller output
compare value may cause the compare to be missed. The TIMB may
pass the new value before it is written.
Advance Information
230
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Timer Interface B (TIMB)
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface B (TIMB)
Functional Description
Use this method to synchronize unbuffered changes in the output
compare value on channel x:
•
When changing to a smaller value, enable channel x output
compare interrupts and write the new value in the output compare
interrupt routine. The output compare interrupt occurs at the end
of the current output compare pulse. The interrupt routine has until
the end of the counter overflow period to write the new value.
•
When changing to a larger output compare value, enable TIMB
overflow interrupts and write the new value in the TIMB overflow
interrupt routine. The TIMB overflow interrupt occurs at the end of
the current counter overflow period. Writing a larger value in an
output compare interrupt routine (at the end of the current pulse)
could cause two output compares to occur in the same counter
overflow period.
12.4.3.2 Buffered Output Compare
Channels 0 and 1 can be linked to form a buffered output compare
channel whose output appears on the PTE1/TCH0B pin. The TIMB
channel registers of the linked pair alternately control the output.
Setting the MS0B bit in TIMB channel 0 status and control register
(TBSC0) links channel 0 and channel 1. The output compare value in the
TIMB channel 0 registers initially controls the output on the
PTE1/TCH0B pin. Writing to the TIMB channel 1 registers enables the
TIMB channel 1 registers to synchronously control the output after the
TIMB overflows. At each subsequent overflow, the TIMB channel
registers (0 or 1) that control the output are the ones written to last. TSC0
controls and monitors the buffered output compare function, and TIMB
channel 1 status and control register (TBSC1) is unused. While the
MS0B bit is set, the channel 1 pin, PTE2/TCH1B, is available as a
general-purpose I/O pin.
NOTE:
In buffered output compare operation, do not write new output compare
values to the currently active channel registers. User software should
track the currently active channel to prevent writing a new value to the
active channel. Writing to the active channel registers is the same as
generating unbuffered output compares.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface B (TIMB)
Advance Information
231
Timer Interface B (TIMB)
12.4.4 Pulse-Width Modulation (PWM)
By using the toggle-on-overflow feature with an output compare channel,
the TIMB can generate a PWM signal. The value in the TIMB counter
modulo registers determines the period of the PWM signal. The channel
pin toggles when the counter reaches the value in the TIMB counter
modulo registers. The time between overflows is the period of the PWM
signal.
As Figure 12-3 shows, the output compare value in the TIMB channel
registers determines the pulse width of the PWM signal. The time
between overflow and output compare is the pulse width. Program the
TIMB to clear the channel pin on output compare if the state of the PWM
pulse is logic 1. Program the TIMB to set the pin if the state of the PWM
pulse is logic 0.
OVERFLOW
OVERFLOW
OVERFLOW
PERIOD
PULSE
WIDTH
PTEx/TCHx
OUTPUT
COMPARE
OUTPUT
COMPARE
OUTPUT
COMPARE
Figure 12-3. PWM Period and Pulse Width
The value in the TIMB counter modulo registers and the selected
prescaler output determines the frequency of the PWM output. The
frequency of an 8-bit PWM signal is variable in 256 increments. Writing
$00FF (255) to the TIMB counter modulo registers produces a PWM
period of 256 times the internal bus clock period if the prescaler select
value is $000 (see 12.8.1 TIMB Status and Control Register).
The value in the TIMB channel registers determines the pulse width of
the PWM output. The pulse width of an 8-bit PWM signal is variable in
256 increments. Writing $0080 (128) to the TIMB channel registers
produces a duty cycle of 128/256 or 50 percent.
Advance Information
232
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Timer Interface B (TIMB)
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface B (TIMB)
Functional Description
12.4.4.1 Unbuffered PWM Signal Generation
Any output compare channel can generate unbuffered PWM pulses as
described in 12.4.4 Pulse-Width Modulation (PWM). The pulses are
unbuffered because changing the pulse width requires writing the new
pulse width value over the value currently in the TIMB channel registers.
An unsynchronized write to the TIMB channel registers to change a
pulse width value could cause incorrect operation for up to two PWM
periods. For example, writing a new value before the counter reaches
the old value but after the counter reaches the new value prevents any
compare during that PWM period. Also, using a TIMB overflow interrupt
routine to write a new, smaller pulse width value may cause the compare
to be missed. The TIMB may pass the new value before it is written to
the TIMB channel registers.
Use this method to synchronize unbuffered changes in the PWM pulse
width on channel x:
NOTE:
•
When changing to a shorter pulse width, enable channel x output
compare interrupts and write the new value in the output compare
interrupt routine. The output compare interrupt occurs at the end
of the current pulse. The interrupt routine has until the end of the
PWM period to write the new value.
•
When changing to a longer pulse width, enable TIMB overflow
interrupts and write the new value in the TIMB overflow interrupt
routine. The TIMB overflow interrupt occurs at the end of the
current PWM period. Writing a larger value in an output compare
interrupt routine (at the end of the current pulse) could cause two
output compares to occur in the same PWM period.
In PWM signal generation, do not program the PWM channel to toggle
on output compare. Toggling on output compare prevents reliable
0 percent duty cycle generation and removes the ability of the channel
to self-correct in the event of software error or noise. Toggling on output
compare also can cause incorrect PWM signal generation when
changing the PWM pulse width to a new, much larger value.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface B (TIMB)
Advance Information
233
Timer Interface B (TIMB)
12.4.4.2 Buffered PWM Signal Generation
Channels 0 and 1 can be linked to form a buffered PWM channel whose
output appears on the PTE1/TCH0B pin. The TIMB channel registers of
the linked pair alternately control the pulse width of the output.
Setting the MS0B bit in TIMB channel 0 status and control register
(TBSC0) links channel 0 and channel 1. The TIMB channel 0 registers
initially control the pulse width on the PTE1/TCH0B pin. Writing to the
TIMB channel 1 registers enables the TIMB channel 1 registers to
synchronously control the pulse width at the beginning of the next PWM
period. At each subsequent overflow, the TIMB channel registers
(0 or 1) that control the pulse width are the ones written to last. TBSC0
controls and monitors the buffered PWM function, and TIMB channel 1
status and control register (TBSC1) is unused. While the MS0B bit is set,
the channel 1 pin, PTE2/TCH1B, is available as a general-purpose
I/O pin.
NOTE:
In buffered PWM signal generation, do not write new pulse width values
to the currently active channel registers. User software should track the
currently active channel to prevent writing a new value to the active
channel. Writing to the active channel registers is the same as
generating unbuffered PWM signals.
12.4.4.3 PWM Initialization
To ensure correct operation when generating unbuffered or buffered
PWM signals, use this initialization procedure:
1. In the TIMB status and control register (TBSC):
a. Stop the TIMB counter by setting the TIMB stop bit, TSTOP.
b. Reset the TIMB counter and prescaler by setting the TIMB
reset bit, TRST.
2. In the TIMB counter modulo registers (TBMODH–TBMODL), write
the value for the required PWM period.
3. In the TIMB channel x registers (TBCHxH–TBCHxL), write the
value for the required pulse width.
Advance Information
234
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Timer Interface B (TIMB)
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface B (TIMB)
Functional Description
4. In TIMB channel x status and control register (TBSCx):
a. Write 0:1 (for unbuffered output compare or PWM signals) or
1:0 (for buffered output compare or PWM signals) to the mode
select bits, MSxB–MSxA. (See Table 12-2.)
b. Write 1 to the toggle-on-overflow bit, TOVx.
c.
NOTE:
Write 1:0 (to clear output on compare) or 1:1 (to set output on
compare) to the edge/level select bits, ELSxB–ELSxA. The
output action on compare must force the output to the
complement of the pulse width level. (See Table 12-2.)
In PWM signal generation, do not program the PWM channel to toggle
on output compare. Toggling on output compare prevents reliable
0 percent duty cycle generation and removes the ability of the channel
to self-correct in the event of software error or noise. Toggling on output
compare can also cause incorrect PWM signal generation when
changing the PWM pulse width to a new, much larger value.
5. In the TIMB status control register (TBSC), clear the TIMB stop bit,
TSTOP.
Setting MS0B links channels 0 and 1 and configures them for buffered
PWM operation. The TIMB channel 0 registers (TBCH0H–TBCH0L)
initially control the buffered PWM output. TIMB status control register 0
(TBSC0) controls and monitors the PWM signal from the linked
channels. MS0B takes priority over MS0A.
Clearing the toggle-on-overflow bit, TOVx, inhibits output toggles on
TIMB overflows. Subsequent output compares try to force the output to
a state it is already in and have no effect. The result is a 0 percent duty
cycle output.
Setting the channel x maximum duty cycle bit (CHxMAX) and setting the
TOVx bit generates a 100 percent duty cycle output. (See 12.8.4 TIMB
Channel Status and Control Registers.)
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface B (TIMB)
Advance Information
235
Timer Interface B (TIMB)
12.5 Interrupts
These TIMB sources can generate interrupt requests:
•
TIMB overflow flag (TOF) — The timer overflow flag (TOF) bit is
set when the TIMB counter reaches the modulo value
programmed in the TIMB counter modulo registers. The TIMB
overflow interrupt enable bit, TOIE, enables TIMB overflow
interrupt requests. TOF and TOIE are in the TIMB status and
control registers.
•
TIMB channel flags (CH1F–CH0F) — The CHxF bit is set when an
input capture or output compare occurs on channel x. Channel x
TIMB CPU interrupt requests are controlled by the channel x
interrupt enable bit, CHxIE.
12.6 Wait Mode
The WAIT instruction puts the MCU in low-power standby mode.
The TIMB remains active after the execution of a WAIT instruction. In
wait mode, the TIMB registers are not accessible by the CPU. Any
enabled CPU interrupt request from the TIMB can bring the MCU out of
wait mode.
If TIMB functions are not required during wait mode, reduce power
consumption by stopping the TIMB before executing the WAIT
instruction.
12.7 I/O Signals
Port E shares three of its pins with the TIMB:
Advance Information
236
•
PTD4/ATD12 is an external clock input to the TIMB prescaler.
•
The two TIMB channel I/O pins are PTE1/TCH0B and
PTE2/TCH1B.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Timer Interface B (TIMB)
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface B (TIMB)
I/O Registers
12.7.1 TIMB Clock Pin (PTD4/ATD12)
PTD4/ATD12 is an external clock input that can be the clock source for
the TIMB counter instead of the prescaled internal bus clock. Select the
PTD4/ATD12 input by writing logic 1s to the three prescaler select bits,
PS[2:0]. See 12.8.1 TIMB Status and Control Register. The minimum
TCLK pulse width, TCLKLMIN or TCLKHMIN, is:
1
------------------------------------- + t SU
bus frequency
The maximum TCLK frequency is the least: 4 MHz or bus frequency ÷ 2.
PTD4/ATD12 is available as a general-purpose I/O pin or ADC channel
when not used as the TIMB clock input. When the PTD4/ATD12 pin is
the TIMB clock input, it is an input regardless of the state of the DDRE0
bit in data direction register E.
12.7.2 TIMB Channel I/O Pins (PTE1/TCH0B–PTE2/TCH1B)
Each channel I/O pin is programmable independently as an input
capture pin or an output compare pin. PTE1/TCH0B and PTE2/TCH1B
can be configured as buffered output compare or buffered PWM pins.
12.8 I/O Registers
These input/output (I/O) registers control and monitor TIMB operation:
•
TIMB status and control register (TBSC)
•
TIMB control registers (TBCNTH–TBCNTL)
•
TIMB counter modulo registers (TBMODH–TBMODL)
•
TIMB channel status and control registers (TBSC0 and TBSC1)
•
TIMB channel registers (TBCH0H–TBCH0L and
TBCH1H–TBCH1L)
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface B (TIMB)
Advance Information
237
Timer Interface B (TIMB)
12.8.1 TIMB Status and Control Register
The TIMB status and control register:
•
Enables TIMB overflow interrupts
•
Flags TIMB overflows
•
Stops the TIMB counter
•
Resets the TIMB counter
•
Prescales the TIMB counter clock
Address:
$0051
Bit 7
Read:
6
5
TOIE
TSTOP
4
3
0
0
TRST
R
0
0
TOF
Write:
0
Reset:
0
R
0
1
2
1
Bit 0
PS2
PS1
PS0
0
0
0
= Reserved
Figure 12-4. TIMB Status and Control Register (TBSC)
TOF — TIMB Overflow Flag
This read/write flag is set when the TIMB counter reaches the modulo
value programmed in the TIMB counter modulo registers. Clear TOF
by reading the TIMB status and control register when TOF is set and
then writing a logic 0 to TOF. If another TIMB overflow occurs before
the clearing sequence is complete, then writing logic 0 to TOF has no
effect. Therefore, a TOF interrupt request cannot be lost due to
inadvertent clearing of TOF. Reset clears the TOF bit. Writing a logic
1 to TOF has no effect.
1 = TIMB counter has reached modulo value.
0 = TIMB counter has not reached modulo value.
TOIE — TIMB Overflow Interrupt Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables TIMB overflow interrupts when the TOF bit
becomes set. Reset clears the TOIE bit.
1 = TIMB overflow interrupts enabled
0 = TIMB overflow interrupts disabled
Advance Information
238
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Timer Interface B (TIMB)
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface B (TIMB)
I/O Registers
TSTOP — TIMB Stop Bit
This read/write bit stops the TIMB counter. Counting resumes when
TSTOP is cleared. Reset sets the TSTOP bit, stopping the TIMB
counter until software clears the TSTOP bit.
1 = TIMB counter stopped
0 = TIMB counter active
NOTE:
Do not set the TSTOP bit before entering wait mode if the TIMB is
required to exit wait mode. Also, when the TSTOP bit is set and the timer
is configured for input capture operation, input captures are inhibited
until TSTOP is cleared.
TRST — TIMB Reset Bit
Setting this write-only bit resets the TIMB counter and the TIMB
prescaler. Setting TRST has no effect on any other registers.
Counting resumes from $0000. TRST is cleared automatically after
the TIMB counter is reset and always reads as logic 0. Reset clears
the TRST bit.
1 = Prescaler and TIMB counter cleared
0 = No effect
NOTE:
Setting the TSTOP and TRST bits simultaneously stops the TIMB
counter at a value of $0000.
PS[2:0] — Prescaler Select Bits
These read/write bits select either the PTD4/ATD12 pin or one of the
seven prescaler outputs as the input to the TIMB counter as
Table 12-1 shows. Reset clears the PS[2:0] bits.
Table 12-1. Prescaler Selection
PS[2:0]
TIMB Clock Source
000
Internal bus clock ÷1
001
Internal bus clock ÷ 2
010
Internal bus clock ÷ 4
011
Internal bus clock ÷ 8
100
Internal bus clock ÷ 16
101
Internal bus clock ÷ 32
110
Internal bus clock ÷ 64
111
PTE0/TCLKB
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface B (TIMB)
Advance Information
239
Timer Interface B (TIMB)
12.8.2 TIMB Counter Registers
The two read-only TIMB counter registers contain the high and low bytes
of the value in the TIMB counter. Reading the high byte (TBCNTH)
latches the contents of the low byte (TBCNTL) into a buffer. Subsequent
reads of TBCNTH do not affect the latched TBCNTL value until TBCNTL
is read. Reset clears the TIMB counter registers. Setting the TIMB reset
bit (TRST) also clears the TIMB counter registers.
NOTE:
If TBCNTH is read during a break interrupt, be sure to unlatch TBCNTL
by reading TBCNTL before exiting the break interrupt. Otherwise,
TBCNTL retains the value latched during the break.
Register Name and Address: TBCNTH — $0052
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Write:
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Register Name and Address: TBCNTL — $0053
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Write:
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R
= Reserved
Figure 12-5. TIMB Counter Registers (TBCNTH and TBCNTL)
Advance Information
240
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Timer Interface B (TIMB)
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface B (TIMB)
I/O Registers
12.8.3 TIMB Counter Modulo Registers
The read/write TIMB modulo registers contain the modulo value for the
TIMB counter. When the TIMB counter reaches the modulo value, the
overflow flag (TOF) becomes set, and the TIMB counter resumes
counting from $0000 at the next timer clock. Writing to the high byte
(TBMODH) inhibits the TOF bit and overflow interrupts until the low byte
(TBMODL) is written. Reset sets the TIMB counter modulo registers.
Register Name and Address: TBMODH — $0054
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Register Name and Address: TBMODL — $0055
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Figure 12-6. TIMB Counter Modulo Registers
(TBMODH and TBMODL)
NOTE:
Reset the TIMB counter before writing to the TIMB counter modulo
registers.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface B (TIMB)
Advance Information
241
Timer Interface B (TIMB)
12.8.4 TIMB Channel Status and Control Registers
Each of the TIMB channel status and control registers:
•
Flags input captures and output compares
•
Enables input capture and output compare interrupts
•
Selects input capture, output compare, or PWM operation
•
Selects high, low, or toggling output on output compare
•
Selects rising edge, falling edge, or any edge as the active input
capture trigger
•
Selects output toggling on TIMB overflow
•
Selects 0 percent and 100 percent PWM duty cycle
•
Selects buffered or unbuffered output compare/PWM operation
Register Name and Address: TBSC0 — $0056
Bit 7
Read:
CH0F
Write:
0
Reset:
0
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
CH0IE
MS0B
MS0A
ELS0B
ELS0A
TOV0
CH0MAX
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
MS1A
ELS1B
ELS1A
TOV1
CH1MAX
0
0
0
0
0
Register Name and Address: TBSC1 — $0059
Bit 7
Read:
6
CH1F
5
0
CH1IE
Write:
0
Reset:
0
R
R
0
0
= Reserved
Figure 12-7. TIMB Channel Status
and Control Registers (TBSC0–TBSC1)
Advance Information
242
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Timer Interface B (TIMB)
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface B (TIMB)
I/O Registers
CHxF — Channel x Flag
When channel x is an input capture channel, this read/write bit is set
when an active edge occurs on the channel x pin. When channel x is
an output compare channel, CHxF is set when the value in the TIMB
counter registers matches the value in the TIMB channel x registers.
When CHxIE = 1, clear CHxF by reading TIMB channel x status and
control register with CHxF set, and then writing a logic 0 to CHxF. If
another interrupt request occurs before the clearing sequence is
complete, then writing logic 0 to CHxF has no effect. Therefore, an
interrupt request cannot be lost due to inadvertent clearing of CHxF.
Reset clears the CHxF bit. Writing a logic 1 to CHxF has no effect.
1 = Input capture or output compare on channel x
0 = No input capture or output compare on channel x
CHxIE — Channel x Interrupt Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables TIMB CPU interrupts on channel x.
Reset clears the CHxIE bit.
1 = Channel x CPU interrupt requests enabled
0 = Channel x CPU interrupt requests disabled
MSxB — Mode Select Bit B
This read/write bit selects buffered output compare/PWM operation.
MSxB exists only in the TIMB channel 0.
Setting MS0B disables the channel 1 status and control register and
reverts TCH1B to general-purpose I/O.
Reset clears the MSxB bit.
1 = Buffered output compare/PWM operation enabled
0 = Buffered output compare/PWM operation disabled
MSxA — Mode Select Bit A
When ELSxB:A ≠ 00, this read/write bit selects either input capture
operation or unbuffered output compare/PWM operation.
See Table 12-2.
1 = Unbuffered output compare/PWM operation
0 = Input capture operation
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface B (TIMB)
Advance Information
243
Timer Interface B (TIMB)
When ELSxB:A = 00, this read/write bit selects the initial output level
of the TCHx pin once PWM, input capture, or output compare
operation is enabled. See Table 12-2. Reset clears the MSxA bit.
1 = Initial output level low
0 = Initial output level high
NOTE:
Before changing a channel function by writing to the MSxB or MSxA bit,
set the TSTOP and TRST bits in the TIMB status and control register
(TBSC).
ELSxB and ELSxA — Edge/Level Select Bits
When channel x is an input capture channel, these read/write bits
control the active edge-sensing logic on channel x.
When channel x is an output compare channel, ELSxB and ELSxA
control the channel x output behavior when an output compare
occurs.
When ELSxB and ELSxA are both clear, channel x is not connected
to port E, and pin PTEx/TCHxB is available as a general-purpose I/O
pin. However, channel x is at a state determined by these bits and
becomes transparent to the respective pin when PWM, input capture,
or output compare mode is enabled. Table 12-2 shows how ELSxB
and ELSxA work. Reset clears the ELSxB and ELSxA bits.
NOTE:
Before enabling a TIMB channel register for input capture operation,
make sure that the PTEx/TBCHx pin is stable for at least two bus clocks.
TOVx — Toggle-On-Overflow Bit
When channel x is an output compare channel, this read/write bit
controls the behavior of the channel x output when the TIMB counter
overflows. When channel x is an input capture channel, TOVx has no
effect. Reset clears the TOVx bit.
1 = Channel x pin toggles on TIMB counter overflow.
0 = Channel x pin does not toggle on TIMB counter overflow.
Advance Information
244
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Timer Interface B (TIMB)
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface B (TIMB)
I/O Registers
Table 12-2. Mode, Edge, and Level Selection
MSxB:MSxA
ELSxB:ELSxA
X0
00
Mode
Configuration
Pin under port control; initialize timer output level high
Output preset
X1
00
Pin under port control; initialize timer output level low
00
01
Capture on rising edge only
00
10
00
11
Capture on rising or falling edge
01
01
Toggle output on compare
01
10
01
11
1X
01
1X
10
1X
11
NOTE:
Input capture
Capture on falling edge only
Output compare
Clear output on compare
or PWM
Set output on compare
Buffered output
compare
or buffered
PWM
Toggle output on compare
Clear output on compare
Set output on compare
When TOVx is set, a TIMB counter overflow takes precedence over a
channel x output compare if both occur at the same time.
CHxMAX — Channel x Maximum Duty Cycle Bit
When the TOVx is at logic 1 and clear output on compare is selected,
setting the CHxMAX bit forces the duty cycle of buffered and
unbuffered PWM signals to 100 percent. As Figure 12-8 shows,
CHxMAX bit takes effect in the cycle after it is set or cleared. The
output stays at 100 percent duty cycle level until the cycle after
CHxMAX is cleared.
NOTE:
The PWM 0 percent duty cycle is defined as output low all of the time.To
generate the 0 percent duty cycle select clear output on compare and
then clear the TOVx bit (CHxMAX = 0). The PWM 100 percent duty cycle
is defined as output high all of the time. To generate the 100 percent duty
cycle, use the CHxMAX bit in the TSCx register.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface B (TIMB)
Advance Information
245
Timer Interface B (TIMB)
OVERFLOW
OVERFLOW
OVERFLOW
OVERFLOW
OVERFLOW
PERIOD
PTEx/TCHx
OUTPUT
COMPARE
OUTPUT
COMPARE
OUTPUT
COMPARE
OUTPUT
COMPARE
CHxMAX
TOVx
Figure 12-8. CHxMAX Latency
12.8.5 TIMB Channel Registers
These read/write registers contain the captured TIMB counter value of
the input capture function or the output compare value of the output
compare function. The state of the TIMB channel registers after reset is
unknown.
In input capture mode (MSxB–MSxA = 0:0), reading the high byte of the
TIMB channel x registers (TBCHxH) inhibits input captures until the low
byte (TBCHxL) is read.
In output compare mode (MSxB–MSxA ≠ 0:0), writing to the high byte of
the TIMB channel x registers (TBCHxH) inhibits output compares until
the low byte (TBCHxL) is written.
Register Name and Address: TBCH0H — $0057
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Indeterminate after reset
Figure 12-9. TIMB Channel Registers
(TBCH0H/L–TBCH1H/L) (Sheet 1 of 2)
Advance Information
246
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Timer Interface B (TIMB)
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface B (TIMB)
I/O Registers
Register Name and Address: TBCH0L — $0058
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Indeterminate after reset
Register Name and Address: TBCH1H — $005A
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 15
Bit 14
Bit 13
Bit 12
Bit 11
Bit 10
Bit 9
Bit 8
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Indeterminate after reset
Register Name and Address: TBCH1L — $005B
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Indeterminate after reset
Figure 12-9. TIMB Channel Registers
(TBCH0H/L–TBCH1H/L) (Sheet 2 of 2)
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Timer Interface B (TIMB)
Advance Information
247
Timer Interface B (TIMB)
Advance Information
248
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Timer Interface B (TIMB)
MOTOROLA
Advance Information — MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32
Section 13. Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
13.1 Contents
13.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250
13.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250
13.4 Pin Name Conventions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250
13.5 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251
13.5.1 Master Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251
13.5.2 Slave Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254
13.6 Transmission Formats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255
13.6.1 Clock Phase and Polarity Controls. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .255
13.6.2 Transmission Format When CPHA = 0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255
13.6.3 Transmission Format When CPHA = 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257
13.6.4 Transmission Initiation Latency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258
13.7 Error Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 260
13.7.1 Overflow Error . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 260
13.7.2 Mode Fault Error . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .262
13.8 Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264
13.9 Resetting the SPI . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266
13.10 Queuing Transmission Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266
13.11 Low-Power Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268
13.12 I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268
13.12.1 MISO (Master In/Slave Out) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269
13.12.2 MOSI (Master Out/Slave In) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269
13.12.3 SPSCK (Serial Clock). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269
13.12.4 SS (Slave Select) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270
13.12.5 VSS (Clock Ground) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 271
13.13 I/O Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 271
13.13.1 SPI Control Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 272
13.13.2 SPI Status and Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274
13.13.3 SPI Data Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 277
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
Advance Information
249
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
13.2 Introduction
The serial peripheral interface (SPI) module allows full-duplex,
synchronous, serial communications with peripheral devices.
13.3 Features
Features of the SPI module include:
•
Full-duplex operation
•
Master and slave modes
•
Double-buffered operation with separate transmit and receive
registers
•
Four master mode frequencies (maximum = bus frequency ÷ 2)
•
Maximum slave mode frequency = bus frequency
•
Serial clock with programmable polarity and phase
•
Two separately enabled interrupts with central processor unit
(CPU) service:
– SPRF (SPI receiver full)
– SPTE (SPI transmitter empty)
•
Mode fault error flag with CPU interrupt capability
•
Overflow error flag with CPU interrupt capability
•
Programmable wired-OR mode
•
I2C (inter-integrated circuit) compatibility
13.4 Pin Name Conventions
The generic names of the SPI input/output (I/O) pins are:
Advance Information
250
•
SS, slave select
•
SPSCK, SPI serial clock
•
MOSI, master out/slave in
•
MISO, master in/slave out
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
MOTOROLA
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
Functional Description
SPI pins are shared by parallel I/O ports or have alternate functions. The
full name of an SPI pin reflects the name of the shared port pin or the
name of an alternate pin function. The generic pin names appear in the
text that follows. Table 13-1 shows the full names of the SPI I/O pins.
Table 13-1. Pin Name Conventions
Generic
Pin Names:
MISO
MOSI
SPSCK
SS
Full
Pin Names:
PTF3/MISO
PTF2/MOSI
PTF0/SPSCK
PTF1/SS
13.5 Functional Description
Figure 13-1 shows the structure of the SPI module and Figure 13-2
shows the locations and contents of the SPI I/O registers.
The SPI module allows full-duplex, synchronous, serial communication
between the microcontroller unit (MCU) and peripheral devices,
including other MCUs. Software can poll the SPI status flags or SPI
operation can be interrupt-driven. All SPI interrupts can be serviced by
the CPU.
13.5.1 Master Mode
The SPI operates in master mode when the SPI master bit, SPMSTR, is
set.
NOTE:
Configure the SPI modules as master or slave before enabling them.
Enable the master SPI before enabling the slave SPI. Disable the slave
SPI before disabling the master SPI. See 13.13.1 SPI Control Register.
Only a master SPI module can initiate transmissions. Software begins
the transmission from a master SPI module by writing to the SPI data
register. If the shift register is empty, the byte immediately transfers to
the shift register, setting the SPI transmitter empty bit, SPTE. The byte
begins shifting out on the MOSI pin under the control of the serial clock.
See Figure 13-3.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
Advance Information
251
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
INTERNAL BUS
TRANSMIT DATA REGISTER
CGMOUT ÷ 2
(FROM SIM)
SHIFT REGISTER
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
MISO
0
÷2
CLOCK
DIVIDER
MOSI
÷8
RECEIVE DATA REGISTER
÷ 32
PIN
CONTROL
LOGIC
÷ 128
SPMSTR
SPE
CLOCK
SELECT
SPSCK
M
CLOCK
LOGIC
S
SS
SPR1
SPR0
SPMSTR
CPHA
CPOL
SPWOM
TRANSMITTER CPU INTERRUPT REQUEST
MODFEN
ERRIE
SPI
CONTROL
SPTIE
RECEIVER/ERROR CPU INTERRUPT REQUEST
SPRIE
SPE
SPRF
SPTE
OVRF
MODF
Figure 13-1. SPI Module Block Diagram
Advance Information
252
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
MOTOROLA
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
Functional Description
Addr.
$0044
$0045
$0046
Register Name
Bit 7
Read:
SPI Control Register
SPRIE
(SPCR) Write:
See page 272.
Reset:
0
Read:
SPI Status and Control
Register (SPSCR) Write:
See page 274.
Reset:
Read:
SPI Data Register
(SPDR) Write:
See page 277.
Reset:
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
R
SPMSTR
CPOL
CPHA
SPWOM
SPE
SPTIE
0
1
0
1
0
0
0
OVRF
MODF
SPTE
MODFEN
SPR1
SPR0
R
R
R
SPRF
ERRIE
R
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
R7
R6
R5
R4
R3
R2
R1
R0
T7
T6
T5
T4
T3
T2
T1
T0
Unaffected by reset
R
= Reserved
Figure 13-2. SPI I/O Register Summary
MASTER MCU
SHIFT REGISTER
SLAVE MCU
MISO
MISO
MOSI
MOSI
SPSCK
BAUD RATE
GENERATOR
SS
SHIFT REGISTER
SPSCK
V''
SS
Figure 13-3. Full-Duplex Master-Slave Connections
The SPR1 and SPR0 bits control the baud rate generator and determine
the speed of the shift register. See 13.13.2 SPI Status and Control
Register. Through the SPSCK pin, the baud-rate generator of the
master also controls the shift register of the slave peripheral.
As the byte shifts out on the MOSI pin of the master, another byte shifts
in from the slave on the master’s MISO pin. The transmission ends when
the receiver full bit, SPRF, becomes set. At the same time that SPRF
becomes set, the byte from the slave transfers to the receive data
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
Advance Information
253
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
register. In normal operation, SPRF signals the end of a transmission.
Software clears SPRF by reading the SPI status and control register with
SPRF set and then reading the SPI data register. Writing to the SPI data
register clears the SPTE bit.
13.5.2 Slave Mode
The SPI operates in slave mode when the SPMSTR bit is clear. In slave
mode the SPSCK pin is the input for the serial clock from the master
MCU. Before a data transmission occurs, the SS pin of the slave SPI
must be at logic 0. SS must remain low until the transmission is
complete. See 13.7.2 Mode Fault Error.
In a slave SPI module, data enters the shift register under the control of
the serial clock from the master SPI module. After a byte enters the shift
register of a slave SPI, it transfers to the receive data register, and the
SPRF bit is set. To prevent an overflow condition, slave software then
must read the receive data register before another full byte enters the
shift register.
The maximum frequency of the SPSCK for an SPI configured as a slave
is the bus clock speed (which is twice as fast as the fastest master
SPSCK clock that can be generated). The frequency of the SPSCK for
an SPI configured as a slave does not have to correspond to any SPI
baud rate. The baud rate only controls the speed of the SPSCK
generated by an SPI configured as a master. Therefore, the frequency
of the SPSCK for an SPI configured as a slave can be any frequency
less than or equal to the bus speed.
When the master SPI starts a transmission, the data in the slave shift
register begins shifting out on the MISO pin. The slave can load its shift
register with a new byte for the next transmission by writing to its transmit
data register. The slave must write to its transmit data register at least
one bus cycle before the master starts the next transmission. Otherwise,
the byte already in the slave shift register shifts out on the MISO pin.
Data written to the slave shift register during a transmission remains in
a buffer until the end of the transmission.
When the clock phase bit (CPHA) is set, the first edge of SPSCK starts
a transmission. When CPHA is clear, the falling edge of SS starts a
transmission. See 13.6 Transmission Formats.
Advance Information
254
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
MOTOROLA
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
Transmission Formats
NOTE:
If the write to the data register is late, the SPI transmits the data already
in the shift register from the previous transmission.
SPSCK must be in the proper idle state before the slave is enabled to
prevent SPSCK from appearing as a clock edge.
13.6 Transmission Formats
During an SPI transmission, data is simultaneously transmitted (shifted
out serially) and received (shifted in serially). A serial clock synchronizes
shifting and sampling on the two serial data lines. A slave select line
allows selection of an individual slave SPI device; slave devices that are
not selected do not interfere with SPI bus activities. On a master SPI
device, the slave select line can optionally be used to indicate
multiple-master bus contention.
13.6.1 Clock Phase and Polarity Controls
Software can select any of four combinations of serial clock (SPSCK)
phase and polarity using two bits in the SPI control register (SPCR). The
clock polarity is specified by the CPOL control bit, which selects an
active high or low clock and has no significant effect on the transmission
format.
The clock phase (CPHA) control bit selects one of two fundamentally
different transmission formats. The clock phase and polarity should be
identical for the master SPI device and the communicating slave device.
In some cases, the phase and polarity are changed between
transmissions to allow a master device to communicate with peripheral
slaves having different requirements.
NOTE:
Before writing to the CPOL bit or the CPHA bit, disable the SPI by
clearing the SPI enable bit (SPE).
13.6.2 Transmission Format When CPHA = 0
Figure 13-4 shows an SPI transmission in which CPHA is logic 0. The
figure should not be used as a replacement for data sheet parametric
information.Two waveforms are shown for SPSCK: one for CPOL = 0
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
Advance Information
255
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
and another for CPOL = 1. The diagram may be interpreted as a master
or slave timing diagram since the serial clock (SPSCK), master in/slave
out (MISO), and master out/slave in (MOSI) pins are directly connected
between the master and the slave. The MISO signal is the output from
the slave, and the MOSI signal is the output from the master. The SS line
is the slave select input to the slave. The slave SPI drives its MISO
output only when its slave select input (SS) is at logic 0, so that only the
selected slave drives to the master. The SS pin of the master is not
shown but is assumed to be inactive. The SS pin of the master must be
high or must be reconfigured as general-purpose I/O not affecting the
SPI. (See 13.7.2 Mode Fault Error.) When CPHA = 0, the first SPSCK
edge is the MSB capture strobe. Therefore, the slave must begin driving
its data before the first SPSCK edge, and a falling edge on the SS pin is
used to start the slave data transmission. The slave’s SS pin must be
toggled back to high and then low again between each byte transmitted
as shown in Figure 13-5.
SPSCK CYCLE #
FOR REFERENCE
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
MSB
BIT 6
BIT 5
BIT 4
BIT 3
BIT 2
BIT 1
LSB
BIT 6
BIT 5
BIT 4
BIT 3
BIT 2
BIT 1
LSB
SPSCK, CPOL = 0
SPSCK, CPOL = 1
MOSI
FROM MASTER
MISO
FROM SLAVE
MSB
, TO SLAVE
66
CAPTURE STROBE
Figure 13-4. Transmission Format (CPHA = 0)
MISO/MOSI
BYTE 1
BYTE 2
BYTE 3
MASTER SS
SLAVE SS
CPHA = 0
SLAVE SS
CPHA = 1
Figure 13-5. CPHA/SS Timing
Advance Information
256
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
MOTOROLA
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
Transmission Formats
When CPHA = 0 for a slave, the falling edge of SS indicates the
beginning of the transmission. This causes the SPI to leave its idle state
and begin driving the MISO pin with the MSB of its data. Once the
transmission begins, no new data is allowed into the shift register from
the transmit data register. Therefore, the SPI data register of the slave
must be loaded with transmit data before the falling edge of SS. Any data
written after the falling edge is stored in the transmit data register and
transferred to the shift register after the current transmission.
13.6.3 Transmission Format When CPHA = 1
Figure 13-6 shows an SPI transmission in which CPHA is logic 1. The
figure should not be used as a replacement for data sheet parametric
information. Two waveforms are shown for SPSCK: one for CPOL = 0
and another for CPOL = 1. The diagram may be interpreted as a master
or slave timing diagram since the serial clock (SPSCK), master in/slave
out (MISO), and master out/slave in (MOSI) pins are directly connected
between the master and the slave. The MISO signal is the output from
the slave, and the MOSI signal is the output from the master. The SS line
is the slave select input to the slave. The slave SPI drives its MISO
output only when its slave select input (SS) is at logic 0, so that only the
selected slave drives to the master. The SS pin of the master is not
shown but is assumed to be inactive. The SS pin of the master must be
high or must be reconfigured as general-purpose I/O not affecting the
SPI. See 13.7.2 Mode Fault Error. When CPHA = 1, the master begins
driving its MOSI pin on the first SPSCK edge. Therefore, the slave uses
SPSCK CYCLE #
FOR REFERENCE
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
MOSI
FROM MASTER
MSB
BIT 6
BIT 5
BIT 4
BIT 3
BIT 2
BIT 1
LSB
MISO
FROM SLAVE
MSB
BIT 6
BIT 5
BIT 4
BIT 3
BIT 2
BIT 1
SPSCK, CPOL = 0
SPSCK, CPOL = 1
LSB
SS, TO SLAVE
CAPTURE STROBE
Figure 13-6. Transmission Format (CPHA = 1)
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
Advance Information
257
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
the first SPSCK edge as a start transmission signal. The SS pin can
remain low between transmissions. This format may be preferable in
systems having only one master and only one slave driving the MISO
data line.
When CPHA = 1 for a slave, the first edge of the SPSCK indicates the
beginning of the transmission. This causes the SPI to leave its idle state
and begin driving the MISO pin with the MSB of its data. Once the
transmission begins, no new data is allowed into the shift register from
the transmit data register. Therefore, the SPI data register of the slave
must be loaded with transmit data before the first edge of SPSCK. Any
data written after the first edge is stored in the transmit data register and
transferred to the shift register after the current transmission.
13.6.4 Transmission Initiation Latency
When the SPI is configured as a master (SPMSTR = 1), writing to the
SPDR starts a transmission. CPHA has no effect on the delay to the start
of the transmission, but it does affect the initial state of the SPSCK
signal. When CPHA = 0, the SPSCK signal remains inactive for the first
half of the first SPSCK cycle. When CPHA = 1, the first SPSCK cycle
begins with an edge on the SPSCK line from its inactive to its active
level. The SPI clock rate (selected by SPR1:SPR0) affects the delay
from the write to SPDR and the start of the SPI transmission. See
Figure 13-7 The internal SPI clock in the master is a free-running
derivative of the internal MCU clock. To conserve power, it is enabled
only when both the SPE and SPMSTR bits are set. SPSCK edges occur
halfway through the low time of the internal MCU clock. Since the SPI
clock is free-running, it is uncertain where the write to the SPDR occurs
relative to the slower SPSCK. This uncertainty causes the variation in
the initiation delay shown in Figure 13-7. This delay is no longer than a
single SPI bit time. That is, the maximum delay is two MCU bus cycles
for DIV2, eight MCU bus cycles for DIV8, 32 MCU bus cycles for DIV32,
and 128 MCU bus cycles for DIV128.
Advance Information
258
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
MOTOROLA
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
Transmission Formats
WRITE
TO SPDR
INITIATION DELAY
BUS
CLOCK
MOSI
MSB
BIT 6
BIT 5
SPSCK
CPHA = 1
SPSCK
CPHA = 0
SPSCK CYCLE
NUMBER
1
2
3
INITIATION DELAY FROM WRITE SPDR TO TRANSFER BEGIN
WRITE
TO SPDR
BUS
CLOCK
EARLIEST LATEST
SPSCK = INTERNAL CLOCK ÷ 2;
2 POSSIBLE START POINTS
WRITE
TO SPDR
BUS
CLOCK
EARLIEST
WRITE
TO SPDR
SPSCK = INTERNAL CLOCK ÷ 8;
8 POSSIBLE START POINTS
LATEST
SPSCK = INTERNAL CLOCK ÷ 32;
32 POSSIBLE START POINTS
LATEST
SPSCK = INTERNAL CLOCK ÷ 128;
128 POSSIBLE START POINTS
LATEST
BUS
CLOCK
EARLIEST
WRITE
TO SPDR
BUS
CLOCK
EARLIEST
Figure 13-7. Transmission Start Delay (Master)
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
Advance Information
259
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
13.7 Error Conditions
These flags signal SPI error conditions:
•
Overflow (OVRF) — Failing to read the SPI data register before
the next full byte enters the shift register sets the OVRF bit. The
new byte does not transfer to the receive data register, and the
unread byte still can be read. OVRF is in the SPI status and control
register.
•
Mode fault error (MODF) — The MODF bit indicates that the
voltage on the slave select pin (SS) is inconsistent with the mode
of the SPI. MODF is in the SPI status and control register.
13.7.1 Overflow Error
The overflow flag (OVRF) becomes set if the receive data register still
has unread data from a previous transmission when the capture strobe
of bit 1 of the next transmission occurs. If an overflow occurs, all data
received after the overflow and before the OVRF bit is cleared does not
transfer to the receive data register and does not set the SPI receiver full
bit (SPRF). The unread data that transferred to the receive data register
before the overflow occurred can still be read. Therefore, an overflow
error always indicates the loss of data. Clear the overflow flag by reading
the SPI status and control register and then reading the SPI data
register.
OVRF generates a receiver/error CPU interrupt request if the error
interrupt enable bit (ERRIE) is also set. MODF and OVRF can generate
a receiver/error CPU interrupt request. See Figure 13-10. It is not
possible to enable MODF or OVRF individually to generate a
receiver/error CPU interrupt request. However, leaving MODFEN low
prevents MODF from being set.
Advance Information
260
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
MOTOROLA
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
Error Conditions
If the CPU SPRF interrupt is enabled and the OVRF interrupt is not,
watch for an overflow condition. Figure 13-8 shows how it is possible to
miss an overflow. The first part of Figure 13-8 shows how it is possible
to read the SPSCR and SPDR to clear the SPRF without problems.
However, as illustrated by the second transmission example, the OVRF
bit can be set in between the time that SPSCR and SPDR
are read.
BYTE 1
BYTE 2
BYTE 3
BYTE 4
1
4
6
8
SPRF
OVRF
READ
SPSCR
2
READ
SPDR
5
3
1
%<7(6(76635)%,7
2
&385($'6636&5:,7+635)%,76(7
$1'295)%,7&/($5
3
&385($'6%<7(,163'5
&/($5,1*635)%,7
4
%<7(6(76635)%,7
7
5
&385($'6636&5:,7+635)%,76(7
$1'295)%,7&/($5
6
%<7(6(76295)%,7%<7(,6/267
7
&385($'6%<7(,163'5&/($5,1*635)%,7
%87127295)%,7
8
%<7()$,/6726(7635)%,7%(&$86(
295)%,7,6127&/($5('%<7(,6/267
Figure 13-8. Missed Read of Overflow Condition
In this case, an overflow can easily be missed. Since no more SPRF
interrupts can be generated until this OVRF is serviced, it is not obvious
that bytes are being lost as more transmissions are completed. To
prevent this, either enable the OVRF interrupt or do another read of the
SPSCR following the read of the SPDR. This ensures that the OVRF
was not set before the SPRF was cleared and that future transmissions
can set the SPRF bit. Figure 13-9 illustrates this process. Generally, to
avoid this second SPSCR read, enable the OVRF interrupt to the CPU
by setting the ERRIE bit.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
Advance Information
261
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
BYTE 1
SPI RECEIVE
COMPLETE
BYTE 2
5
1
BYTE 3
7
BYTE 4
11
SPRF
OVRF
READ
SPSCR
2
READ
SPDR
4
6
3
8
1
BYTE 1 SETS SPRF BIT.
2
CPU READS SPSCR WITH SPRF BIT SET
AND OVRF BIT CLEAR.
CPU READS BYTE 1 IN SPDR,
CLEARING SPRF BIT.
3
9
12
14
10
13
8
CPU READS BYTE 2 IN SPDR,
CLEARING SPRF BIT.
9
CPU READS SPSCR AGAIN
TO CHECK OVRF BIT.
10 CPU READS BYTE 2 SPDR,
CLEARING OVRF BIT.
4
CPU READS SPSCR AGAIN
TO CHECK OVRF BIT.
11 BYTE 4 SETS SPRF BIT.
5
BYTE 2 SETS SPRF BIT.
12 CPU READS SPSCR.
6
CPU READS SPSCR WITH SPRF BIT SET
AND OVRF BIT CLEAR.
13 CPU READS BYTE 4 IN SPDR,
CLEARING SPRF BIT.
7
BYTE 3 SETS OVRF BIT. BYTE 3 IS LOST.
14 CPU READS SPSCR AGAIN
TO CHECK OVRF BIT.
Figure 13-9. Clearing SPRF When OVRF Interrupt Is Not Enabled
13.7.2 Mode Fault Error
Setting the SPMSTR bit selects master mode and configures the
SPSCK and MOSI pins as outputs and the MISO pin as an input.
Clearing SPMSTR selects slave mode and configures the SPSCK and
MOSI pins as inputs and the MISO pin as an output. The mode fault bit,
MODF, becomes set any time the state of the slave select pin, SS, is
inconsistent with the mode selected by SPMSTR.
To prevent SPI pin contention and damage to the MCU, a mode fault
error occurs if:
•
The SS pin of a slave SPI goes high during a transmission.
•
The SS pin of a master SPI goes low at any time.
For the MODF flag to be set, the mode fault error enable bit (MODFEN)
must be set. Clearing the MODFEN bit does not clear the MODF flag but
does prevent MODF from being set again after MODF is cleared.
Advance Information
262
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
MOTOROLA
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
Error Conditions
MODF generates a receiver/error CPU interrupt request if the error
interrupt enable bit (ERRIE) is also set. The SPRF, MODF, and OVRF
interrupts share the same CPU interrupt vector. MODF and OVRF can
generate a receiver/error CPU interrupt request. See Figure 13-10. It is
not possible to enable MODF or OVRF individually to generate a
receiver/error CPU interrupt request. However, leaving MODFEN low
prevents MODF from being set.
In a master SPI with the mode fault enable bit (MODFEN) set, the mode
fault flag (MODF) is set if SS goes to logic 0. A mode fault in a master
SPI causes these events to occur:
NOTE:
•
If ERRIE = 1, the SPI generates an SPI receiver/error CPU
interrupt request.
•
The SPE bit is cleared.
•
The SPTE bit is set.
•
The SPI state counter is cleared.
•
The data direction register of the shared I/O port regains control of
port drivers.
To prevent bus contention with another master SPI after a mode fault
error, clear all SPI bits of the data direction register of the shared I/O port
before enabling the SPI.
When configured as a slave (SPMSTR = 0), the MODF flag is set if SS
goes high during a transmission. When CPHA = 0, a transmission begins
when SS goes low and ends once the incoming SPSCK goes back to its
idle level following the shift of the eighth data bit. When CPHA = 1, the
transmission begins when the SPSCK leaves its idle level and SS is
already low. The transmission continues until the SPSCK returns to its
idle level following the shift of the last data bit. See 13.6 Transmission
Formats.
NOTE:
Setting the MODF flag does not clear the SPMSTR bit. Reading
SPMSTR when MODF = 1 will indicate a mode fault error occurred in
either master mode or slave mode.
When CPHA = 0, a MODF occurs if a slave is selected (SS is at logic 0)
and later unselected (SS is at logic 1) even if no SPSCK is sent to that
slave. This happens because SS at logic 0 indicates the start of the
transmission (MISO driven out with the value of MSB) for CPHA = 0.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
Advance Information
263
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
When CPHA = 1, a slave can be selected and then later unselected with
no transmission occurring. Therefore, MODF does not occur since a
transmission was never begun.
In a slave SPI (MSTR = 0), the MODF bit generates an SPI
receiver/error CPU interrupt request if the ERRIE bit is set. The MODF
bit does not clear the SPE bit or reset the SPI in any way. Software can
abort the SPI transmission by clearing the SPE bit of the slave.
NOTE:
A logic 1 voltage on the SS pin of a slave SPI puts the MISO pin in a high
impedance state. Also, the slave SPI ignores all incoming SPSCK
clocks, even if it was already in the middle of a transmission.
To clear the MODF flag, read the SPSCR with the MODF bit set and then
write to the SPCR register. This entire clearing procedure must occur
with no MODF condition existing or else the flag is not cleared.
13.8 Interrupts
Four SPI status flags can be enabled to generate CPU interrupt requests
as shown in Table 13-2.
Table 13-2. SPI Interrupts
Flag
Request
SPTE transmitter empty SPI transmitter CPU interrupt request (SPTIE = 1, SPE = 1)
SPRF receiver full
SPI receiver CPU interrupt request (SPRIE = 1)
OVRF overflow
SPI receiver/error interrupt request (ERRIE = 1)
MODF mode fault
SPI receiver/error interrupt request (ERRIE = 1)
The SPI transmitter interrupt enable bit (SPTIE) enables the SPTE flag
to generate transmitter CPU interrupt requests, provided that the SPI is
enabled (SPE = 1).
The SPI receiver interrupt enable bit (SPRIE) enables the SPRF bit to
generate receiver CPU interrupt requests, provided that the SPI is
enabled (SPE = 1). (See Figure 13-10.)
Advance Information
264
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
MOTOROLA
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
Interrupts
SPTE
SPTIE
SPE
SPI TRANSMITTER
CPU INTERRUPT REQUEST
SPRIE
SPRF
SPI RECEIVER/ERROR
CPU INTERRUPT REQUEST
ERRIE
MODF
OVRF
Figure 13-10. SPI Interrupt Request Generation
The error interrupt enable bit (ERRIE) enables both the MODF and
OVRF bits to generate a receiver/error CPU interrupt request.
The mode fault enable bit (MODFEN) can prevent the MODF flag from
being set so that only the OVRF bit is enabled by the ERRIE bit to
generate receiver/error CPU interrupt requests.
These sources in the SPI status and control register can generate CPU
interrupt requests:
•
SPI receiver full bit (SPRF) — The SPRF bit becomes set every
time a byte transfers from the shift register to the receive data
register. If the SPI receiver interrupt enable bit, SPRIE, is also set,
SPRF can generate either an SPI receiver/error or CPU interrupt.
•
SPI transmitter empty (SPTE) — The SPTE bit becomes set every
time a byte transfers from the transmit data register to the shift
register. If the SPI transmit interrupt enable bit, SPTIE, is also set,
SPTE can generate either an SPTE or CPU interrupt request.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
Advance Information
265
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
13.9 Resetting the SPI
Any system reset completely resets the SPI. Partial resets occur
whenever the SPI enable bit (SPE) is low. Whenever SPE is low:
•
The SPTE flag is set.
•
Any transmission currently in progress is aborted.
•
The shift register is cleared.
•
The SPI state counter is cleared, making it ready for a new
complete transmission.
•
All the SPI port logic is defaulted back to being general-purpose
I/O.
These items are reset only by a system reset:
•
All control bits in the SPCR
•
All control bits in the SPSCR (MODFEN, ERRIE, SPR1, and
SPR0)
•
The status flags SPRF, OVRF, and MODF
By not resetting the control bits when SPE is low, the user can clear SPE
between transmissions without having to set all control bits again when
SPE is set back high for the next transmission.
By not resetting the SPRF, OVRF, and MODF flags, the user can still
service these interrupts after the SPI has been disabled. The user can
disable the SPI by writing 0 to the SPE bit. The SPI can also be disabled
by a mode fault occurring in an SPI that was configured as a master with
the MODFEN bit set.
13.10 Queuing Transmission Data
The double-buffered transmit data register allows a data byte to be
queued and transmitted. For an SPI configured as a master, a queued
data byte is transmitted immediately after the previous transmission has
completed. The SPI transmitter empty flag (SPTE) indicates when the
transmit data buffer is ready to accept new data. Write to the transmit
data register only when the SPTE bit is high. Figure 13-11 shows the
timing associated with doing back-to-back transmissions with the SPI
(SPSCK has CPHA:CPOL = 1:0).
Advance Information
266
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
MOTOROLA
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
Queuing Transmission Data
WRITE TO SPDR
1
SPTE
3
8
5
2
10
SPSCK
CPHA:CPOL = 1:0
MOSI
MSBBIT BIT BIT BIT BIT BIT LSBMSBBIT BIT BIT BIT BIT BIT LSBMSBBIT BIT BIT
6 5 4 3 2 1
6 5 4 3 2 1
6 5 4
BYTE 1
BYTE 2
BYTE 3
9
4
SPRF
6
READ SPSCR
11
7
READ SPDR
12
1 CPU WRITES BYTE 1 TO SPDR, CLEARING SPTE BIT.
7 CPU READS SPDR, CLEARING SPRF BIT.
2 BYTE 1 TRANSFERS FROM TRANSMIT DATA
REGISTER TO SHIFT REGISTER, SETTING SPTE BIT.
8 CPU WRITES BYTE 3 TO SPDR, QUEUEING BYTE
3 AND CLEARING SPTE BIT.
9 SECOND INCOMING BYTE TRANSFERS FROM SHIFT
REGISTER TO RECEIVE DATA REGISTER, SETTING
SPRF BIT.
10 BYTE 3 TRANSFERS FROM TRANSMIT DATA
REGISTER TO SHIFT REGISTER, SETTING SPTE BIT.
11 CPU READS SPSCR WITH SPRF BIT SET.
3 CPU WRITES BYTE 2 TO SPDR, QUEUEING BYTE 2
AND CLEARING SPTE BIT.
4 FIRST INCOMING BYTE TRANSFERS FROM SHIFT
REGISTER TO RECEIVE DATA REGISTER, SETTING
SPRF BIT.
5 BYTE 2 TRANSFERS FROM TRANSMIT DATA
REGISTER TO SHIFT REGISTER, SETTING SPTE BIT.
6 CPU READS SPSCR WITH SPRF BIT SET.
12 CPU READS SPDR, CLEARING SPRF BIT.
Figure 13-11. SPRF/SPTE CPU Interrupt Timing
For a slave, the transmit data buffer allows back-to-back transmissions
without the slave precisely timing its writes between transmissions as in
a system with a single data buffer. Also, if no new data is written to the
data buffer, the last value contained in the shift register is the next data
word to be transmitted.
For an idle master or idle slave that has no data loaded into its transmit
buffer, the SPTE is set again no more than two bus cycles after the
transmit buffer empties into the shift register. This allows the user to
queue up a 16-bit value to send. For an already active slave, the load of
the shift register cannot occur until the transmission is completed. This
implies that a back-to-back write to the transmit data register is not
possible. The SPTE indicates when the next write can occur.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
Advance Information
267
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
13.11 Low-Power Mode
The WAIT instruction puts the MCU in a low power-consumption standby
mode.
The SPI module remains active after the execution of a WAIT instruction.
In wait mode the SPI module registers are not accessible by the CPU.
Any enabled CPU interrupt request from the SPI module can bring the
MCU out of wait mode.
If SPI module functions are not required during wait mode, reduce power
consumption by disabling the SPI module before executing the WAIT
instruction.
To exit wait mode when an overflow condition occurs, enable the OVRF
bit to generate CPU interrupt requests by setting the error interrupt
enable bit (ERRIE). See 13.8 Interrupts.
Since the SPTE bit cannot be cleared during a break with the BCFE bit
cleared, a write to the transmit data register in break mode does not
initiate a transmission nor is this data transferred into the shift register.
Therefore, a write to the SPDR in break mode with the BCFE bit cleared
has no effect.
13.12 I/O Signals
The SPI module has five I/O pins and shares four of them with a parallel
I/O port. The pins are:
•
MISO — Data received
•
MOSI — Data transmitted
•
SPSCK — Serial clock
•
SS — Slave select
The SPI has limited inter-integrated circuit (I2C) capability (requiring
software support) as a master in a single-master environment. To
communicate with I2C peripherals, MOSI becomes an open-drain output
when the SPWOM bit in the SPI control register is set. In I2C
communication, the MOSI and MISO pins are connected to a
bidirectional pin from the I2C peripheral and through a pullup resistor
to VDD.
Advance Information
268
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
MOTOROLA
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
I/O Signals
13.12.1 MISO (Master In/Slave Out)
MISO is one of the two SPI module pins that transmits serial data. In full
duplex operation, the MISO pin of the master SPI module is connected
to the MISO pin of the slave SPI module. The master SPI simultaneously
receives data on its MISO pin and transmits data from its MOSI pin.
Slave output data on the MISO pin is enabled only when the SPI is
configured as a slave. The SPI is configured as a slave when its
SPMSTR bit is logic 0 and its SS pin is at logic 0. To support a
multiple-slave system, a logic 1 on the SS pin puts the MISO pin in a
high-impedance state.
When enabled, the SPI controls data direction of the MISO pin
regardless of the state of the data direction register of the shared
I/O port.
13.12.2 MOSI (Master Out/Slave In)
MOSI is one of the two SPI module pins that transmits serial data. In
full-duplex operation, the MOSI pin of the master SPI module is
connected to the MOSI pin of the slave SPI module. The master SPI
simultaneously transmits data from its MOSI pin and receives data on its
MISO pin.
When enabled, the SPI controls data direction of the MOSI pin
regardless of the state of the data direction register of the shared
I/O port.
13.12.3 SPSCK (Serial Clock)
The serial clock synchronizes data transmission between master and
slave devices. In a master MCU, the SPSCK pin is the clock output. In a
slave MCU, the SPSCK pin is the clock input. In full-duplex operation,
the master and slave MCUs exchange a byte of data in eight serial clock
cycles.
When enabled, the SPI controls data direction of the SPSCK pin
regardless of the state of the data direction register of the shared
I/O port.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
Advance Information
269
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
13.12.4 SS (Slave Select)
The SS pin has various functions depending on the current state of the
SPI. For an SPI configured as a slave, the SS is used to select a slave.
For CPHA = 0, the SS is used to define the start of a transmission. See
13.6 Transmission Formats. Since it is used to indicate the start of a
transmission, the SS must be toggled high and low between each byte
transmitted for the CPHA = 0 format. However, it can remain low
between transmissions for the CPHA = 1 format. See Figure 13-12.
MISO/MOSI
BYTE 1
BYTE 2
BYTE 3
MASTER 66
SLAVE 66
CPHA = 0
SLAVE 66
CPHA = 1
Figure 13-12. CPHA/SS Timing
When an SPI is configured as a slave, the SS pin is always configured
as an input. It cannot be used as a general-purpose I/O regardless of the
state of the MODFEN control bit. However, the MODFEN bit can still
prevent the state of the SS from creating a MODF error. See 13.13.2 SPI
Status and Control Register.
NOTE:
A logic 1 voltage on the SS pin of a slave SPI puts the MISO pin in a
high-impedance state. The slave SPI ignores all incoming SPSCK
clocks, even if it was already in the middle of a transmission.
When an SPI is configured as a master, the SS input can be used in
conjunction with the MODF flag to prevent multiple masters from driving
MOSI and SPSCK. (See 13.7.2 Mode Fault Error.) For the state of the
SS pin to set the MODF flag, the MODFEN bit in the SPSCK register
must be set. If the MODFEN bit is low for an SPI master, the SS pin can
be used as a general-purpose I/O under the control of the data direction
register of the shared I/O port. With MODFEN high, it is an input-only pin
to the SPI regardless of the state of the data direction register of the
shared I/O port.
Advance Information
270
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
MOTOROLA
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
I/O Registers
The CPU can always read the state of the SS pin by configuring the
appropriate pin as an input and reading the port data register.
See Table 13-3.
Table 13-3. SPI Configuration
SPE
SPMSTR
MODFEN
SPI Configuration
State of SS Logic
0
X(1)
X
Not enabled
General-purpose I/O;
SS ignored by SPI
1
0
X
Slave
Input-only to SPI
1
1
0
Master
without MODF
General-purpose I/O;
SS ignored by SPI
1
1
1
Master with MODF
Input-only to SPI
1. X = don’t care
13.12.5 VSS (Clock Ground)
VSS is the ground return for the serial clock pin, SPSCK, and the ground
for the port output buffers. To reduce the ground return path loop and
minimize radio frequency (RF) emissions, connect the ground pin of the
slave to the VSS pin of the master.
13.13 I/O Registers
Three registers control and monitor SPI operation:
•
SPI control register, SPCR
•
SPI status and control register, SPSCR
•
SPI data register, SPDR
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
Advance Information
271
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
13.13.1 SPI Control Register
The SPI control register (SPCR):
•
Enables SPI module interrupt requests
•
Selects CPU interrupt requests or DMA service requests
•
Configures the SPI module as master or slave
•
Selects serial clock polarity and phase
•
Configures the SPSCK, MOSI, and MISO pins as open-drain
outputs
•
Enables the SPI module
Address: $0044
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
SPRIE
R
SPMSTR
CPOL
CPHA
SPWOM
SPE
SPTIE
0
0
1
0
1
0
0
0
R
= Reserved
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Figure 13-13. SPI Control Register (SPCR)
SPRIE — SPI Receiver Interrupt Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables CPU interrupt requests generated by the
SPRF bit. The SPRF bit is set when a byte transfers from the shift
register to the receive data register. Reset clears the SPRIE bit.
1 = SPRF CPU interrupt requests enabled
0 = SPRF CPU interrupt requests disabled
SPMSTR — SPI Master Bit
This read/write bit selects master mode operation or slave mode
operation. Reset sets the SPMSTR bit.
1 = Master mode
0 = Slave mode
Advance Information
272
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
MOTOROLA
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
I/O Registers
CPOL — Clock Polarity Bit
This read/write bit determines the logic state of the SPSCK pin
between transmissions. See Figure 13-4 and Figure 13-6. To
transmit data between SPI modules, the SPI modules must have
identical CPOL values. Reset clears the CPOL bit.
CPHA — Clock Phase Bit
This read/write bit controls the timing relationship between the serial
clock and SPI data. See Figure 13-4 and Figure 13-6. To transmit
data between SPI modules, the SPI modules must have identical
CPHA bits. When CPHA = 0, the SS pin of the slave SPI module must
be set to logic 1 between bytes. See Figure 13-12. Reset sets the
CPHA bit.
When CPHA = 0 for a slave, the falling edge of SS indicates the
beginning of the transmission. This causes the SPI to leave its idle
state and begin driving the MISO pin with the MSB of its data, once
the transmission begins, no new data is allowed into the shift register
from the data register. Therefore, the slave data register must be
loaded with the desired transmit data before the falling edge of SS.
Any data written after the falling edge is stored in the data register and
transferred to the shift register at the current transmission.
When CPHA = 1 for a slave, the first edge of the SPSCK indicates the
beginning of the transmission. The same applies when SS is high for
a slave. The MISO pin is held in a high-impedance state, and the
incoming SPSCK is ignored. In certain cases, it may also cause the
MODF flag to be set. See 13.7.2 Mode Fault Error. A logic 1 on the
SS pin does not in any way affect the state of the SPI state machine.
SPWOM — SPI Wired-OR Mode Bit
This read/write bit disables the pullup devices on pins SPSCK, MOSI,
and MISO so that those pins become open-drain outputs.
1 = Wired-OR SPSCK, MOSI, and MISO pins
0 = Normal push-pull SPSCK, MOSI, and MISO pins
SPE — SPI Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables the SPI module. Clearing SPE causes a
partial reset of the SPI. See 13.9 Resetting the SPI. Reset clears the
SPE bit.
1 = SPI module enabled
0 = SPI module disabled
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
Advance Information
273
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
SPTIE— SPI Transmit Interrupt Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables CPU interrupt requests generated by the
SPTE bit. SPTE is set when a byte transfers from the transmit data
register to the shift register. Reset clears the SPTIE bit.
1 = SPTE CPU interrupt requests enabled
0 = SPTE CPU interrupt requests disabled
13.13.2 SPI Status and Control Register
The SPI status and control register (SPSCR) contains flags to signal
these conditions:
•
Receive data register full
•
Failure to clear SPRF bit before next byte is received (overflow
error)
•
Inconsistent logic level on SS pin (mode fault error)
•
Transmit data register empty
The SPI status and control register also contains bits that perform these
functions:
•
Enable error interrupts
•
Enable mode fault error detection
•
Select master SPI baud rate
Address: $0045
Bit 7
Read:
6
SPRF
5
4
3
OVRF
MODF
SPTE
R
R
R
0
0
1
ERRIE
Write:
R
Reset:
0
R
0
2
1
Bit 0
MODFEN
SPR1
SPR0
0
0
0
= Reserved
Figure 13-14. SPI Status and Control Register (SPSCR)
SPRF — SPI Receiver Full Bit
This clearable, read-only flag is set each time a byte transfers from
the shift register to the receive data register. SPRF generates a CPU
interrupt request if the SPRIE bit in the SPI control register is set also.
Advance Information
274
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
MOTOROLA
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
I/O Registers
During an SPRF CPU interrupt (DMAS = 0), the CPU clears SPRF by
reading the SPI status and control register with SPRF set and then
reading the SPI data register.
Reset clears the SPRF bit.
1 = Receive data register full
0 = Receive data register not full
ERRIE — Error interrupt Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables the MODF and OVRF bits to generate
CPU interrupt requests. Reset clears the ERRIE bit.
1 = MODF and OVRF can generate CPU interrupt requests.
0 = MODF and OVRF cannot generate CPU interrupt requests.
OVRF — Overflow Bit
This clearable, read-only flag is set if software does not read the byte
in the receive data register before the next full byte enters the shift
register. In an overflow condition, the byte already in the receive data
register is unaffected, and the byte that shifted in last is lost. Clear the
OVRF bit by reading the SPI status and control register with OVRF set
and then reading the receive data register. Reset clears the OVRF bit.
1 = Overflow
0 = No overflow
MODF — Mode Fault Bit
This clearable, read-only flag is set in a slave SPI if the SS pin goes
high during a transmission with the MODFEN bit set. In a master SPI,
the MODF flag is set if the SS pin goes low at any time with the
MODFEN bit set. Clear the MODF bit by reading the SPI status and
control register (SPSCR) with MODF set and then writing to the SPI
control register (SPCR). Reset clears the MODF bit.
1 = SS pin at inappropriate logic level
0 = SS pin at appropriate logic level
SPTE — SPI Transmitter Empty Bit
This clearable, read-only flag is set each time the transmit data
register transfers a byte into the shift register. SPTE generates an
SPTE CPU interrupt request or an SPTE DMA service request if the
SPTIE bit in the SPI control register is set also.
NOTE:
Do not write to the SPI data register unless the SPTE bit is high.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
Advance Information
275
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
For an idle master of idle slave that has no data loaded into its
transmit buffer, the SPTE will be set again within two bus cycles since
the transmit buffer empties into the shift register. This allows the user
to queue up a 16-bit value to send. For an already active slave, the
load of the shift register cannot occur until the transmission is
completed. This implies that a back-to-back write to the transmit data
register is not possible. The SPTE indicates when the next write can
occur.
Reset sets the SPTE bit.
1 = Transmit data register empty
0 = Transmit data register not empty
MODFEN — Mode Fault Enable Bit
This read/write bit, when set to 1, allows the MODF flag to be set. If
the MODF flag is set, clearing the MODFEN does not clear the MODF
flag. If the SPI is enabled as a master and the MODFEN bit is low,
then the SS pin is available as a general-purpose I/O.
If the MODFEN bit is set, then this pin is not available as a
general-purpose I/O. When the SPI is enabled as a slave, the SS pin
is not available as a general-purpose I/O regardless of the value of
MODFEN. See 13.12.4 SS (Slave Select).
If the MODFEN bit is low, the level of the SS pin does not affect the
operation of an enabled SPI configured as a master. For an enabled
SPI configured as a slave, having MODFEN low only prevents the
MODF flag from being set. It does not affect any other part of SPI
operation. See 13.7.2 Mode Fault Error.
SPR1 and SPR0 — SPI Baud Rate Select Bits
In master mode, these read/write bits select one of four baud rates as
shown in Table 13-4. SPR1 and SPR0 have no effect in slave mode.
Reset clears SPR1 and SPR0.
Table 13-4. SPI Master Baud Rate Selection
Advance Information
276
SPR1:SPR0
Baud Rate Divisor (BD)
00
2
01
8
10
32
11
128
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
MOTOROLA
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
I/O Registers
Use this formula to calculate the SPI baud rate:
CGMOUT
Baud rate = -------------------------2 × BD
where:
CGMOUT = base clock output of the clock generator module (CGM)
BD = baud rate divisor
13.13.3 SPI Data Register
The SPI data register consists of the read-only receive data register and
the write-only transmit data register. Writing to the SPI data register
writes data into the transmit data register. Reading the SPI data register
reads data from the receive data register. The transmit data and receive
data registers are separate registers that can contain different values.
See Figure 13-1.
Address: $0046
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
R7
R6
R5
R4
R3
R2
R1
R0
Write:
T7
T6
T5
T4
T3
T2
T1
T0
Reset:
Indeterminate after reset
Figure 13-15. SPI Data Register (SPDR)
R7:R0/T7:T0 — Receive/Transmit Data Bits
NOTE:
Do not use read-modify-write instructions on the SPI data register since
the register read is not the same as the register written.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
Advance Information
277
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
Advance Information
278
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Serial Peripheral Interface Module (SPI)
MOTOROLA
Advance Information — MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32
Section 14. Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
14.1 Contents
14.2 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280
14.3 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280
14.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281
14.4.1 Data Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283
14.4.2 Transmitter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .283
14.4.2.1
Character Length . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283
14.4.2.2
Character Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283
14.4.2.3
Break Characters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285
14.4.2.4
Idle Characters. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285
14.4.2.5
Inversion of Transmitted Output. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .286
14.4.2.6
Transmitter Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 286
14.4.3 Receiver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 286
14.4.3.1
Character Length . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 286
14.4.3.2
Character Reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 288
14.4.3.3
Data Sampling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 288
14.4.3.4
Framing Errors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 290
14.4.3.5
Receiver Wakeup. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 290
14.4.3.6
Receiver Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291
14.4.3.7
Error Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292
14.5 Wait Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292
14.6 SCI During Break Module Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293
14.7 I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293
14.7.1 PTE2/TxD (Transmit Data). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293
14.7.2 PTE1/RxD (Receive Data) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294
14.8 I/O Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294
14.8.1 SCI Control Register 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294
14.8.2 SCI Control Register 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 297
14.8.3 SCI Control Register 3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 300
14.8.4 SCI Status Register 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 301
14.8.5 SCI Status Register 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 305
14.8.6 SCI Data Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 306
14.8.7 SCI Baud Rate Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 306
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
Advance Information
279
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
14.2 Introduction
This section describes the serial communications interface module (SCI,
version D), which allows high-speed asynchronous communications
with peripheral devices and other microcontroller units (MCUs).
14.3 Features
Features of the SCI module include:
Advance Information
280
•
Full-duplex operation
•
Standard mark/space non-return-to-zero (NRZ) format
•
32 programmable baud rates
•
Programmable 8-bit or 9-bit character length
•
Separately enabled transmitter and receiver
•
Separate receiver and transmitter CPU interrupt requests
•
Separate receiver and transmitter
•
Programmable transmitter output polarity
•
Two receiver wakeup methods:
– Idle line wakeup
– Address mark wakeup
•
Interrupt-driven operation with eight interrupt flags:
– Transmitter empty
– Transmission complete
– Receiver full
– Idle receiver input
– Receiver overrun
– Noise error
– Framing error
– Parity error
•
Receiver framing error detection
•
Hardware parity checking
•
1/16 bit-time noise detection
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
Functional Description
14.4 Functional Description
Figure 14-1 shows the structure of the SCI module. The SCI allows
full-duplex, asynchronous, NRZ serial communication among the MCU
and remote devices, including other MCUs. The transmitter and receiver
of the SCI operate independently, although they use the same baud rate
generator. During normal operation, the CPU monitors the status of the
SCI, writes the data to be transmitted, and processes received data.
INTERNAL BUS
ERROR
INTERRUPT
CONTROL
RECEIVE
SHIFT REGISTER
PTE1/RxD
SCI DATA
REGISTER
RECEIVER
INTERRUPT
CONTROL
TRANSMITTER
INTERRUPT
CONTROL
SCI DATA
REGISTER
TRANSMIT
SHIFT REGISTER
PTE2/TxD
TXINV
SCTIE
R8
TCIE
T8
SCRIE
ILIE
TE
SCTE
RE
TC
RWU
SBK
SCRF
OR
ORIE
IDLE
NF
NEIE
FE
FEIE
PE
PEIE
LOOPS
LOOPS
WAKEUP
CONTROL
RECEIVE
CONTROL
ENSCI
ENSCI
TRANSMIT
CONTROL
FLAG
CONTROL
BKF
M
RPF
WAKE
ILTY
f23
÷4
PRESCALER
BAUD RATE
GENERATOR
÷ 16
PEN
PTY
DATA SELECTION
CONTROL
Figure 14-1. SCI Module Block Diagram
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
Advance Information
281
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
Addr.
Register Name
$0038
SCI Control Register 1
(SCC1)
See page 295.
$0039
$003A
$003B
$003C
SCI Control Register 2
(SCC2)
See page 298.
SCI Control Register 3
(SCC3)
See page 300.
SCI Status Register 1
(SCS1)
See page 302.
SCI Status Register 2
(SCS2)
See page 305.
SCI Data Register
(SCDR)
See page 306.
$003D
$003E
SCI Baud Rate Register
(SCBR)
See page 306.
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
LOOPS
ENSCI
TXINV
M
WAKE
ILTY
PEN
PTY
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
SCTIE
TCIE
SCRIE
ILIE
TE
RE
RWU
SBK
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
R8
0
0
ORIE
NEIE
FEIE
PEIE
R
R
U
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read: SCTE
TC
SCRF
IDLE
OR
NF
FE
PE
Write:
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Reset:
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
0
0
0
0
0
0
BKF
RPF
Write:
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
R7
R6
R5
R4
R3
R2
R1
R0
Write:
T7
T6
T5
T4
T3
T2
T1
T0
SCR2
SCR1
SCR0
0
0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Read:
Write:
T8
Write:
R
Reset:
U
Reset:
Read:
Unaffected by reset
0
0
0
SCP1
Write:
R
R
Reset:
0
0
R
SCP0
R
0
0
= Reserved
0
U = Unaffected
Figure 14-2. SCI I/O Register Summary
Advance Information
282
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
Functional Description
14.4.1 Data Format
The SCI uses the standard non-return-to-zero mark/space data format
illustrated in Figure 14-3.
8-BIT DATA FORMAT
BIT M IN SCC1 CLEAR
START
BIT
BIT 0
BIT 1
BIT 2
BIT 3
BIT 4
BIT 5
POSSIBLE
PARITY
BIT
BIT 6
BIT 7
9-BIT DATA FORMAT
BIT M IN SCC1 SET
START
BIT
BIT 0
BIT 1
BIT 2
BIT 3
BIT 4
BIT 5
STOP
BIT
NEXT
START
BIT
POSSIBLE
PARITY
BIT
BIT 6
BIT 7
BIT 8
STOP
BIT
NEXT
START
BIT
Figure 14-3. SCI Data Formats
14.4.2 Transmitter
Figure 14-4 shows the structure of the SCI transmitter.
14.4.2.1 Character Length
The transmitter can accommodate either 8-bit or 9-bit data. The state of
the M bit in SCI control register 1 (SCC1) determines character length.
When transmitting 9-bit data, bit T8 in SCI control register 3 (SCC3) is
the ninth bit (bit 8).
14.4.2.2 Character Transmission
During an SCI transmission, the transmit shift register shifts a character
out to the PTE2/TxD pin. The SCI data register (SCDR) is the write-only
buffer between the internal data bus and the transmit shift register. To
initiate an SCI transmission:
1. Enable the SCI by writing a logic 1 to the enable SCI bit (ENSCI)
in SCI control register 1 (SCC1).
2. Enable the transmitter by writing a logic 1 to the transmitter enable
bit (TE) in SCI control register 2 (SCC2).
3. Clear the SCI transmitter empty bit by first reading SCI status
register 1 (SCS1) and then writing to the SCDR.
4. Repeat step 3 for each subsequent transmission.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
Advance Information
283
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
INTERNAL BUS
÷ 16
SCI DATA REGISTER
SCP1
SCR1
H
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
L
37(7['
MSB
TXINV
PTY
PARITY
GENERATION
T8
BREAK
ALL 0s
PEN
PREAMBLE
ALL 1s
M
LOAD FROM SCDR
TRANSMITTER CPU INTERRUPT REQUEST
SCR2
START
SCP0
SCR0
11-BIT
TRANSMIT
SHIFT REGISTER
STOP
f
3
2
BAUD
DIVIDER
SHIFT ENABLE
PRESCALER
÷4
TRANSMITTER
CONTROL LOGIC
SCTE
SCTE
SCTIE
TC
TCIE
SBK
LOOPS
SCTIE
ENSCI
TC
TE
TCIE
Figure 14-4. SCI Transmitter
At the start of a transmission, transmitter control logic automatically
loads the transmit shift register with a preamble of logic 1s. After the
preamble shifts out, control logic transfers the SCDR data into the
transmit shift register. A logic 0 start bit automatically goes into the least
significant bit (LSB) position of the transmit shift register. A logic 1 stop
bit goes into the most significant bit (MSB) position.
The SCI transmitter empty bit, SCTE, in SCS1 becomes set when the
SCDR transfers a byte to the transmit shift register. The SCTE bit
indicates that the SCDR can accept new data from the internal data bus.
If the SCI transmit interrupt enable bit, SCTIE, in SCC2 is also set, the
SCTE bit generates a transmitter CPU interrupt request.
Advance Information
284
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
Functional Description
When the transmit shift register is not transmitting a character, the
PTE2/TxD pin goes to the idle condition, logic 1. If at any time software
clears the ENSCI bit in SCI control register 1 (SCC1), the transmitter and
receiver relinquish control of the port E pins.
14.4.2.3 Break Characters
Writing a logic 1 to the send break bit, SBK, in SCC2 loads the transmit
shift register with a break character. A break character contains all logic
0s and has no start, stop, or parity bit. Break character length depends
on the M bit in SCC1. As long as SBK is at logic 1, transmitter logic
continuously loads break characters into the transmit shift register. After
software clears the SBK bit, the shift register finishes transmitting the
last break character and then transmits at least one logic 1. The
automatic logic 1 at the end of a break character guarantees the
recognition of the start bit of the next character.
The SCI recognizes a break character when a start bit is followed by
eight or nine logic 0 data bits and a logic 0 where the stop bit should be.
Receiving a break character has these effects on SCI registers:
•
Sets the framing error bit (FE) in SCS1
•
Sets the SCI receiver full bit (SCRF) in SCS1
•
Clears the SCI data register (SCDR)
•
Clears the R8 bit in SCC3
•
Sets the break flag bit (BKF) in SCS2
•
May set the overrun (OR), noise flag (NF), parity error (PE), or
reception-in-progress flag (RPF) bits
14.4.2.4 Idle Characters
An idle character contains all logic 1s and has no start, stop, or parity bit.
Idle character length depends on the M bit in SCC1. The preamble is a
synchronizing idle character that begins every transmission.
If the TE bit is cleared during a transmission, the PTE2/TxD pin becomes
idle after completion of the transmission in progress. Clearing and then
setting the TE bit during a transmission queues an idle character to be
sent after the character currently being transmitted.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
Advance Information
285
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
NOTE:
When queueing an idle character, return the TE bit to logic 1 before the
stop bit of the current character shifts out to the PTE2/TxD pin. Setting
TE after the stop bit appears on PTE2/TxD causes data previously
written to the SCDR to be lost.
A good time to toggle the TE bit is when the SCTE bit becomes set and
just before writing the next byte to the SCDR.
14.4.2.5 Inversion of Transmitted Output
The transmit inversion bit (TXINV) in SCI control register 1 (SCC1)
reverses the polarity of transmitted data. All transmitted values, including
idle, break, start, and stop bits, are inverted when TXINV is at logic 1.
See 14.8.1 SCI Control Register 1.
14.4.2.6 Transmitter Interrupts
These conditions can generate CPU interrupt requests from the SCI
transmitter:
•
SCI transmitter empty (SCTE) — The SCTE bit in SCS1 indicates
that the SCDR has transferred a character to the transmit shift
register. SCTE can generate a transmitter CPU interrupt request.
Setting the SCI transmit interrupt enable bit, SCTIE, in SCC2
enables the SCTE bit to generate transmitter CPU interrupt
requests.
•
Transmission complete (TC) — The TC bit in SCS1 indicates that
the transmit shift register and the SCDR are empty and that no
break or idle character has been generated. The transmission
complete interrupt enable bit, TCIE, in SCC2 enables the TC bit to
generate transmitter CPU interrupt requests.
14.4.3 Receiver
Figure 14-5 shows the structure of the SCI receiver.
14.4.3.1 Character Length
The receiver can accommodate either 8-bit or 9-bit data. The state of the
M bit in SCI control register 1 (SCC1) determines character length.
Advance Information
286
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
Functional Description
When receiving 9-bit data, bit R8 in SCI control register 2 (SCC2) is the
ninth bit (bit 8). When receiving 8-bit data, bit R8 is a copy of the eighth
bit (bit 7).
INTERNAL BUS
SCR1
SCR2
SCP0
SCR0
BAUD
PRESCALER DIVIDER
f23
DATA
RECOVERY
PTE1/Rx
CPU INTERRUPT REQUEST
ALL 1s
ERROR CPU INTERRUPT REQUEST
RPF
M
WAKE
PEN
PTY
H
11-BIT
RECEIVE SHIFT REGISTER
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
L
ALL 0s
BKF
ILTY
STOP
÷16
MSB
÷4
SCI DATA REGISTER
START
SCP1
SCRF
WAKEUP
LOGIC
PARITY
CHECKING
IDLE
ILIE
RWU
IDLE
R8
ILIE
SCRF
SCRIE
OR
ORIE
NF
NEIE
FE
FEIE
PE
PEIE
SCRIE
OR
ORIE
NF
NEIE
FE
FEIE
PE
PEIE
Figure 14-5. SCI Receiver Block Diagram
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
Advance Information
287
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
14.4.3.2 Character Reception
During an SCI reception, the receive shift register shifts characters in
from the PTE1/RxD pin. The SCI data register (SCDR) is the read-only
buffer between the internal data bus and the receive shift register.
After a complete character shifts into the receive shift register, the data
portion of the character transfers to the SCDR. The SCI receiver full bit,
SCRF, in SCI status register 1 (SCS1) becomes set, indicating that the
received byte can be read. If the SCI receive interrupt enable bit, SCRIE,
in SCC2 is also set, the SCRF bit generates a receiver CPU interrupt
request.
14.4.3.3 Data Sampling
The receiver samples the PTE1/RxD pin at the RT clock rate. The RT
clock is an internal signal with a frequency 16 times the baud rate. To
adjust for baud rate mismatch, the RT clock is resynchronized at these
times (see Figure 14-6):
•
After every start bit
•
After the receiver detects a data bit change from logic 1 to logic 0
(after the majority of data bit samples at RT8, RT9, and RT10
return a valid logic 1 and the majority of the next RT8, RT9, and
RT10 samples return a valid logic 0)
LSB
START BIT
PTE1/RxD
START BIT
QUALIFICATION
SAMPLES
START BIT
VERIFICATION
DATA
SAMPLING
RT4
RT3
RT2
RT16
RT1
RT15
RT14
RT13
RT12
RT11
RT10
RT9
RT8
RT7
RT6
RT5
RT4
RT3
RT2
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT1
RT CLOCK
STATE
RT1
RT
CLOCK
RT CLOCK
RESET
Figure 14-6. Receiver Data Sampling
Advance Information
288
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
Functional Description
To locate the start bit, data recovery logic does an asynchronous search
for a logic 0 preceded by three logic 1s. When the falling edge of a
possible start bit occurs, the RT clock begins to count to 16.
To verify the start bit and to detect noise, data recovery logic takes
samples at RT3, RT5, and RT7. Table 14-1 summarizes the results of
the start bit verification samples.
Table 14-1. Start Bit Verification
RT3, RT5, and RT7
Samples
Start Bit
Verification
Noise Flag
000
Yes
0
001
Yes
1
010
Yes
1
011
No
0
100
Yes
1
101
No
0
110
No
0
111
No
0
If start bit verification is not successful, the RT clock is reset and a new
search for a start bit begins.
To determine the value of a data bit and to detect noise, recovery logic
takes samples at RT8, RT9, and RT10. Table 14-2 summarizes the
results of the data bit samples.
Table 14-2. Data Bit Recovery
RT8, RT9, and RT10
Samples
Data Bit
Determination
Noise Flag
000
0
0
001
0
1
010
0
1
011
1
1
100
0
1
101
1
1
110
1
1
111
1
0
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
Advance Information
289
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
NOTE:
The RT8, RT9, and RT10 samples do not affect start bit verification. If
any or all of the RT8, RT9, and RT10 start bit samples are logic 1s
following a successful start bit verification, the noise flag (NF) is set and
the receiver assumes that the bit is a start bit.
To verify a stop bit and to detect noise, recovery logic takes samples at
RT8, RT9, and RT10. Table 14-3 summarizes the results of the stop bit
samples.
Table 14-3. Stop Bit Recovery
RT8, RT9, and RT10
Samples
Framing
Error Flag
Noise Flag
000
1
0
001
1
1
010
1
1
011
0
1
100
1
1
101
0
1
110
0
1
111
0
0
14.4.3.4 Framing Errors
If the data recovery logic does not detect a logic 1 where the stop bit
should be in an incoming character, it sets the framing error bit, FE, in
SCS1. The FE flag is set at the same time that the SCRF bit is set. A
break character that has no stop bit also sets the FE bit.
14.4.3.5 Receiver Wakeup
So that the MCU can ignore transmissions intended only for other
receivers in multiple-receiver systems, the receiver can be put into a
standby state. Setting the receiver wakeup bit, RWU, in SCC2 puts the
receiver into a standby state during which receiver interrupts are
disabled.
Advance Information
290
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
Functional Description
Depending on the state of the WAKE bit in SCC1, either of two
conditions on the PTE1/RxD pin can bring the receiver out of the standby
state:
NOTE:
•
Address mark — An address mark is a logic 1 in the most
significant bit position of a received character. When the WAKE bit
is set, an address mark wakes the receiver from the standby state
by clearing the RWU bit. The address mark also sets the SCI
receiver full bit, SCRF. Software can then compare the character
containing the address mark to the user-defined address of the
receiver. If they are the same, the receiver remains awake and
processes the characters that follow. If they are not the same,
software can set the RWU bit and put the receiver back into the
standby state.
•
Idle input line condition — When the WAKE bit is clear, an idle
character on the PTE1/RxD pin wakes the receiver from the
standby state by clearing the RWU bit. The idle character that
wakes the receiver does not set the receiver idle bit, IDLE, or the
SCI receiver full bit, SCRF. The idle line type bit, ILTY, determines
whether the receiver begins counting logic 1s as idle character bits
after the start bit or after the stop bit.
Clearing the WAKE bit after the PTE1/RxD pin has been idle can cause
the receiver to wake up immediately.
14.4.3.6 Receiver Interrupts
These sources can generate CPU interrupt requests from the SCI
receiver:
•
SCI receiver full (SCRF) — The SCRF bit in SCS1 indicates that
the receive shift register has transferred a character to the SCDR.
SCRF can generate a receiver CPU interrupt request. Setting the
SCI receive interrupt enable bit, SCRIE, in SCC2 enables the
SCRF bit to generate receiver CPU interrupts.
•
Idle input (IDLE) — The IDLE bit in SCS1 indicates that 10 or 11
consecutive logic 1s shifted in from the PTE1/RxD pin. The idle
line interrupt enable bit, ILIE, in SCC2 enables the IDLE bit to
generate CPU interrupt requests.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
Advance Information
291
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
14.4.3.7 Error Interrupts
These receiver error flags in SCS1 can generate CPU interrupt requests:
•
Receiver overrun (OR) — The OR bit indicates that the receive
shift register shifted in a new character before the previous
character was read from the SCDR. The previous character
remains in the SCDR, and the new character is lost. The overrun
interrupt enable bit, ORIE, in SCC3 enables OR to generate SCI
error CPU interrupt requests.
•
Noise flag (NF) — The NF bit is set when the SCI detects noise on
incoming data or break characters, including start, data, and stop
bits. The noise error interrupt enable bit, NEIE, in SCC3 enables
NF to generate SCI error CPU interrupt requests.
•
Framing error (FE) — The FE bit in SCS1 is set when a logic 0
occurs where the receiver expects a stop bit. The framing error
interrupt enable bit, FEIE, in SCC3 enables FE to generate SCI
error CPU interrupt requests.
•
Parity error (PE) — The PE bit in SCS1 is set when the SCI
detects a parity error in incoming data. The parity error interrupt
enable bit, PEIE, in SCC3 enables PE to generate SCI error CPU
interrupt requests.
14.5 Wait Mode
The WAIT and STOP instructions put the MCU in low powerconsumption standby modes.
The SCI module remains active after the execution of a WAIT
instruction. In wait mode the SCI module registers are not accessible by
the CPU. Any enabled CPU interrupt request from the SCI module can
bring the MCU out of wait mode.
If SCI module functions are not required during wait mode, reduce power
consumption by disabling the module before executing the WAIT
instruction.
Advance Information
292
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
SCI During Break Module Interrupts
14.6 SCI During Break Module Interrupts
The system integration module (SIM) controls whether status bits in
other modules can be cleared during interrupts generated by the break
module. The BCFE bit in the SIM break flag control register (SBFCR)
enables software to clear status bits during the break state.
To allow software to clear status bits during a break interrupt, write a
logic 1 to the BCFE bit. If a status bit is cleared during the break state, it
remains cleared when the MCU exits the break state.
To protect status bits during the break state, write a logic 0 to the BCFE
bit. With BCFE at logic 0 (its default state), software can read and write
I/O registers during the break state without affecting status bits. Some
status bits have a 2-step read/write clearing procedure. If software does
the first step on such a bit before the break, the bit cannot change during
the break state as long as BCFE is at logic 0. After the break, doing the
second step clears the status bit.
14.7 I/O Signals
Port F shares two of its pins with the SCI module. The two SCI
input/output (I/O) pins are:
•
PTE2/TxD — Transmit data
•
PTE1/RxD — Receive data
14.7.1 PTE2/TxD (Transmit Data)
The PTE2/TxD pin is the serial data output from the SCI transmitter. The
SCI shares the PTE2/TxD pin with port E. When the SCI is enabled, the
PTE2/TxD pin is an output regardless of the state of the DDRF5 bit in
data direction register F (DDRF).
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
Advance Information
293
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
14.7.2 PTE1/RxD (Receive Data)
The PTE1/RxD pin is the serial data input to the SCI receiver. The SCI
shares the PTE1/RxD pin with port E. When the SCI is enabled, the
PTE1/RxD pin is an input regardless of the state of the DDRF4 bit in data
direction register F (DDRF).
14.8 I/O Registers
These I/O registers control and monitor SCI operation:
•
SCI control register 1 (SCC1)
•
SCI control register 2 (SCC2)
•
SCI control register 3 (SCC3)
•
SCI status register 1 (SCS1)
•
SCI status register 2 (SCS2)
•
SCI data register (SCDR)
•
SCI baud rate register (SCBR)
14.8.1 SCI Control Register 1
SCI control register 1 (SCC1):
Advance Information
294
•
Enables loop-mode operation
•
Enables the SCI
•
Controls output polarity
•
Controls character length
•
Controls SCI wakeup method
•
Controls idle character detection
•
Enables parity function
•
Controls parity type
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
I/O Registers
Address: $0038
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
LOOPS
ENSCI
TXINV
M
WAKE
ILTY
PEN
PTY
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Figure 14-7. SCI Control Register 1 (SCC1)
LOOPS — Loop Mode Select Bit
This read/write bit enables loop mode operation. In loop mode the
PTE6/RxD pin is disconnected from the SCI, and the transmitter
output goes into the receiver input. Both the transmitter and the
receiver must be enabled to use loop mode. Reset clears the
LOOPS bit.
1 = Loop mode enabled
0 = Normal operation enabled
ENSCI — Enable SCI Bit
This read/write bit enables the SCI and the SCI baud rate generator.
Clearing ENSCI sets the SCTE and TC bits in SCI status register 1
and disables transmitter interrupts. Reset clears the ENSCI bit.
1 = SCI enabled
0 = SCI disabled
TXINV — Transmit Inversion Bit
This read/write bit reverses the polarity of transmitted data. Reset
clears the TXINV bit.
1 = Transmitter output inverted
0 = Transmitter output not inverted
NOTE:
Setting the TXINV bit inverts all transmitted values, including idle, break,
start, and stop bits.
M — Mode (Character Length) Bit
This read/write bit determines whether SCI characters are eight or
nine bits long. See Table 14-4. The ninth bit can serve as an extra
stop bit, as a receiver wakeup signal, or as a parity bit. Reset clears
the M bit.
1 = 9-bit SCI characters
0 = 8-bit SCI characters
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
Advance Information
295
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
WAKE — Wakeup Condition Bit
This read/write bit determines which condition wakes up the SCI: a
logic 1 (address mark) in the most significant bit (MSB) position of a
received character or an idle condition on the PTE6/RxD pin. Reset
clears the WAKE bit.
1 = Address mark wakeup
0 = Idle line wakeup
ILTY — Idle Line Type Bit
This read/write bit determines when the SCI starts counting logic 1s
as idle character bits. The counting begins either after the start bit or
after the stop bit. If the count begins after the start bit, then a string of
logic 1s preceding the stop bit may cause false recognition of an idle
character. Beginning the count after the stop bit avoids false idle
character recognition, but requires properly synchronized
transmissions. Reset clears the ILTY bit.
1 = Idle character bit count begins after stop bit.
0 = Idle character bit count begins after start bit.
PEN — Parity Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables the SCI parity function. See Table 14-4.
When enabled, the parity function inserts a parity bit in the most
significant bit position. See Figure 14-3. Reset clears the PEN bit.
1 = Parity function enabled
0 = Parity function disabled
PTY — Parity Bit
This read/write bit determines whether the SCI generates and checks
for odd parity or even parity. See Table 14-4. Reset clears the
PTY bit.
1 = Odd parity
0 = Even parity
NOTE:
Advance Information
296
Changing the PTY bit in the middle of a transmission or reception can
generate a parity error.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
I/O Registers
Table 14-4. Character Format Selection
Control Bits
Character Format
M
PEN:PTY
Start
Bits
Data
Bits
Parity
Stop
Bits
Character
Length
0
0X
1
8
None
1
10 bits
1
0X
1
9
None
1
11 bits
0
10
1
7
Even
1
10 bits
0
11
1
7
Odd
1
10 bits
1
10
1
8
Even
1
11 bits
1
11
1
8
Odd
1
11 bits
14.8.2 SCI Control Register 2
SCI control register 2 (SCC2):
•
Enables these CPU interrupt requests:
– Enables the SCTE bit to generate transmitter CPU interrupt
requests
– Enables the TC bit to generate transmitter CPU interrupt
requests
– Enables the SCRF bit to generate receiver CPU interrupt
requests
– Enables the IDLE bit to generate receiver CPU interrupt
requests
•
Enables the transmitter
•
Enables the receiver
•
Enables SCI wakeup
•
Transmits SCI break characters
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
Advance Information
297
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
Address: $0039
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
SCTIE
TCIE
SCRIE
ILIE
TE
RE
RWU
SBK
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Figure 14-8. SCI Control Register 2 (SCC2)
SCTIE — SCI Transmit Interrupt Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables the SCTE bit to generate SCI transmitter
CPU interrupt requests. Setting the SCTIE bit in SCC3 enables SCTE
CPU interrupt requests. Reset clears the SCTIE bit.
1 = SCTE enabled to generate CPU interrupt
0 = SCTE not enabled to generate CPU interrupt
TCIE — Transmission Complete Interrupt Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables the TC bit to generate SCI transmitter CPU
interrupt requests. Reset clears the TCIE bit.
1 = TC enabled to generate CPU interrupt requests
0 = TC not enabled to generate CPU interrupt requests
SCRIE — SCI Receive Interrupt Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables the SCRF bit to generate SCI receiver
CPU interrupt requests. Setting the SCRIE bit in SCC3 enables the
SCRF bit to generate CPU interrupt requests. Reset clears the
SCRIE bit.
1 = SCRF enabled to generate CPU interrupt
0 = SCRF not enabled to generate CPU interrupt
ILIE — Idle Line Interrupt Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables the IDLE bit to generate SCI receiver CPU
interrupt requests. Reset clears the ILIE bit.
1 = IDLE enabled to generate CPU interrupt requests
0 = IDLE not enabled to generate CPU interrupt requests
TE — Transmitter Enable Bit
Setting this read/write bit begins the transmission by sending a
preamble of 10 or 11 logic 1s from the transmit shift register to the
PTE2/TxD pin. If software clears the TE bit, the transmitter completes
any transmission in progress before the PTE2/TxD returns to the idle
Advance Information
298
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
I/O Registers
condition (logic 1). Clearing and then setting TE during a transmission
queues an idle character to be sent after the character currently being
transmitted. Reset clears the TE bit.
1 = Transmitter enabled
0 = Transmitter disabled
NOTE:
Writing to the TE bit is not allowed when the enable SCI bit (ENSCI) is
clear. ENSCI is in SCI control register 1.
RE — Receiver Enable Bit
Setting this read/write bit enables the receiver. Clearing the RE bit
disables the receiver but does not affect receiver interrupt flag bits.
Reset clears the RE bit.
1 = Receiver enabled
0 = Receiver disabled
NOTE:
Writing to the RE bit is not allowed when the enable SCI bit (ENSCI) is
clear. ENSCI is in SCI control register 1.
RWU — Receiver Wakeup Bit
This read/write bit puts the receiver in a standby state during which
receiver interrupts are disabled. The WAKE bit in SCC1 determines
whether an idle input or an address mark brings the receiver out of the
standby state and clears the RWU bit. Reset clears the RWU bit.
1 = Standby state
0 = Normal operation
SBK — Send Break Bit
Setting and then clearing this read/write bit transmits a break
character followed by a logic 1. The logic 1 after the break character
guarantees recognition of a valid start bit. If SBK remains set, the
transmitter continuously transmits break characters with no logic 1s
between them. Reset clears the SBK bit.
1 = Transmit break characters
0 = No break characters being transmitted
NOTE:
Do not toggle the SBK bit immediately after setting the SCTE bit.
Toggling SBK too early causes the SCI to send a break character
instead of a preamble.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
Advance Information
299
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
14.8.3 SCI Control Register 3
SCI control register 3 (SCC3):
•
Stores the ninth SCI data bit received and the ninth SCI data bit to
be transmitted
•
Enables SCI receiver full (SCRF)
•
Enables SCI transmitter empty (SCTE)
•
Enables the following interrupts:
– Receiver overrun interrupts
– Noise error interrupts
– Framing error interrupts
– Parity error interrupts
Address:
$003A
Bit 7
Read:
6
R8
5
4
0
0
R
R
0
0
T8
Write:
R
Reset:
U
U
R
= Reserved
3
2
1
Bit 0
ORIE
NEIE
FEIE
PEIE
0
0
0
0
U = Unaffected
Figure 14-9. SCI Control Register 3 (SCC3)
R8 — Received Bit 8
When the SCI is receiving 9-bit characters, R8 is the read-only ninth
bit (bit 8) of the received character. R8 is received at the same time
that the SCDR receives the other eight bits.
When the SCI is receiving 8-bit characters, R8 is a copy of the eighth
bit (bit 7). Reset has no effect on the R8 bit.
T8 — Transmitted Bit 8
When the SCI is transmitting 9-bit characters, T8 is the read/write
ninth bit (bit 8) of the transmitted character. T8 is loaded into the
transmit shift register at the same time that the SCDR is loaded into
the transmit shift register. Reset has no effect on the T8 bit.
Advance Information
300
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
I/O Registers
ORIE — Receiver Overrun Interrupt Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables SCI error CPU interrupt requests
generated by the receiver overrun bit, OR.
1 = SCI error CPU interrupt requests from OR bit enabled
0 = SCI error CPU interrupt requests from OR bit disabled
NEIE — Receiver Noise Error Interrupt Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables SCI error CPU interrupt requests
generated by the noise error bit, NE. Reset clears NEIE.
1 = SCI error CPU interrupt requests from NE bit enabled
0 = SCI error CPU interrupt requests from NE bit disabled
FEIE — Receiver Framing Error Interrupt Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables SCI error CPU interrupt requests
generated by the framing error bit, FE. Reset clears FEIE.
1 = SCI error CPU interrupt requests from FE bit enabled
0 = SCI error CPU interrupt requests from FE bit disabled
PEIE — Receiver Parity Error Interrupt Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables SCI receiver CPU interrupt
requests generated by the parity error bit, PE. See 14.8.4 SCI Status
Register 1. Reset clears PEIE.
1 = SCI error CPU interrupt requests from PE bit enabled
0 = SCI error CPU interrupt requests from PE bit disabled
14.8.4 SCI Status Register 1
SCI status register 1 (SCS1) contains flags to signal these conditions:
•
Transfer of SCDR data to transmit shift register complete
•
Transmission complete
•
Transfer of receive shift register data to SCDR complete
•
Receiver input idle
•
Receiver overrun
•
Noisy data
•
Framing error
•
Parity error
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
Advance Information
301
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
Address: $003B
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
SCTE
TC
SCRF
IDLE
OR
NF
FE
PE
Write:
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Reset:
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
R
= Reserved
Figure 14-10. SCI Status Register 1 (SCS1)
SCTE — SCI Transmitter Empty Bit
This clearable, read-only bit is set when the SCDR transfers a
character to the transmit shift register. SCTE can generate an SCI
transmitter CPU interrupt request. When the SCTIE bit in SCC2 is set,
SCTE generates an SCI transmitter CPU interrupt request. In normal
operation, clear the SCTE bit by reading SCS1 with SCTE set and
then writing to SCDR. Reset sets the SCTE bit.
1 = SCDR data transferred to transmit shift register
0 = SCDR data not transferred to transmit shift register
TC — Transmission Complete Bit
This read-only bit is set when the SCTE bit is set and no data,
preamble, or break character is being transmitted. TC generates an
SCI transmitter CPU interrupt request if the TCIE bit in SCC2 is also
set. TC is cleared automatically when data, preamble, or break is
queued and ready to be sent. There may be up to 1.5 transmitter
clocks of latency between queueing data, preamble, and break and
the transmission actually starting. Reset sets the TC bit.
1 = No transmission in progress
0 = Transmission in progress
SCRF — SCI Receiver Full Bit
This clearable, read-only bit is set when the data in the receive shift
register transfers to the SCI data register. SCRF can generate an SCI
receiver CPU interrupt request. When the SCRIE bit in SCC2 is set,
SCRF generates a CPU interrupt request. In normal operation, clear
the SCRF bit by reading SCS1 with SCRF set and then reading the
SCDR. Reset clears SCRF.
1 = Received data available in SCDR
0 = Data not available in SCDR
Advance Information
302
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
I/O Registers
IDLE — Receiver Idle Bit
This clearable, read-only bit is set when 10 or 11 consecutive logic 1s
appear on the receiver input. IDLE generates an SCI error CPU
interrupt request if the ILIE bit in SCC2 is also set. Clear the IDLE bit
by reading SCS1 with IDLE set and then reading the SCDR. After the
receiver is enabled, it must receive a valid character that sets the
SCRF bit before an idle condition can set the IDLE bit. Also, after the
IDLE bit has been cleared, a valid character must again set the SCRF
bit before an idle condition can set the IDLE bit. Reset clears the
IDLE bit.
1 = Receiver input idle
0 = Receiver input active or idle since the IDLE bit was cleared
OR — Receiver Overrun Bit
This clearable, read-only bit is set when software fails to read the
SCDR before the receive shift register receives the next character.
The OR bit generates an SCI error CPU interrupt request if the ORIE
bit in SCC3 is also set. The data in the shift register is lost, but the data
already in the SCDR is not affected. Clear the OR bit by reading SCS1
with OR set and then reading the SCDR. Reset clears the OR bit.
1 = Receive shift register full and SCRF = 1
0 = No receiver overrun
Software latency may allow an overrun to occur between reads of
SCS1 and SCDR in the flag-clearing sequence. Figure 14-11 shows
the normal flag-clearing sequence and an example of an overrun
caused by a delayed flag-clearing sequence. The delayed read of
SCDR does not clear the OR bit because OR was not set when SCS1
was read. Byte 2 caused the overrun and is lost. The next
flag-clearing sequence reads byte 3 in the SCDR instead of byte 2.
In applications that are subject to software latency or in which it is
important to know which byte is lost due to an overrun, the
flag-clearing routine can check the OR bit in a second read of SCS1
after reading the data register.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
Advance Information
303
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
NF — Receiver Noise Flag Bit
This clearable, read-only bit is set when the SCI detects noise on the
PTE1/RxD pin. NF generates an NF CPU interrupt request if the NEIE
bit in SCC3 is also set. Clear the NF bit by reading SCS1 and then
reading the SCDR. Reset clears the NF bit.
1 = Noise detected
0 = No noise detected
FE — Receiver Framing Error Bit
This clearable, read-only bit is set when a logic 0 is accepted as the
stop bit. FE generates an SCI error CPU interrupt request if the FEIE
bit in SCC3 also is set. Clear the FE bit by reading SCS1 with FE set
and then reading the SCDR. Reset clears the FE bit.
1 = Framing error detected
0 = No framing error detected
PE — Receiver Parity Error Bit
This clearable, read-only bit is set when the SCI detects a parity error
in incoming data. PE generates a PE CPU interrupt request if the
PEIE bit in SCC3 is also set. Clear the PE bit by reading SCS1 with
PE set and then reading the SCDR. Reset clears the PE bit.
1 = Parity error detected
0 = No parity error detected
BYTE 1
BYTE 2
BYTE 3
SCRF = 0
SCRF = 1
SCRF = 0
SCRF = 1
SCRF = 0
SCRF = 1
NORMAL FLAG CLEARING SEQUENCE
BYTE 4
READ SCS1
SCRF = 1
OR = 0
READ SCS1
SCRF = 1
OR = 0
READ SCS1
SCRF = 1
OR = 0
READ SCDR
BYTE 1
READ SCDR
BYTE 2
READ SCDR
BYTE 3
BYTE 1
BYTE 2
BYTE 3
SCRF = 0
OR = 0
SCRF = 1
OR = 1
SCRF = 0
OR = 1
SCRF = 1
SCRF = 1
OR = 1
DELAYED FLAG CLEARING SEQUENCE
BYTE 4
READ SCS1
SCRF = 1
OR = 0
READ SCS1
SCRF = 1
OR = 1
READ SCDR
BYTE 1
READ SCDR
BYTE 3
Figure 14-11. Flag Clearing Sequence
Advance Information
304
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
I/O Registers
14.8.5 SCI Status Register 2
SCI status register 2 (SCS2) contains flags to signal these conditions:
•
Break character detected
•
Incoming data
Address:
$003C
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
0
0
0
0
0
0
BKF
RPF
Write:
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Reset:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R
= Reserved
Figure 14-12. SCI Status Register 2 (SCS2)
BKF — Break Flag
This clearable, read-only bit is set when the SCI detects a break
character on the PTE1/RxD pin. In SCS1, the FE and SCRF bits are
also set. In 9-bit character transmissions, the R8 bit in SCC3 is
cleared. BKF does not generate a CPU interrupt request. Clear BKF
by reading SCS2 with BKF set and then reading the SCDR. Once
cleared, BKF can become set again only after logic 1s again appear
on the PTE1/RxD pin followed by another break character. Reset
clears the BKF bit.
1 = Break character detected
0 = No break character detected
RPF —Reception-in-Progress Flag
This read-only bit is set when the receiver detects a logic 0 during the
RT1 time period of the start bit search. RPF does not generate an
interrupt request. RPF is reset after the receiver detects false start bits
(usually from noise or a baud rate mismatch, or when the receiver
detects an idle character. Polling RPF before disabling the SCI
module or entering stop mode can show whether a reception is in
progress.
1 = Reception in progress
0 = No reception in progress
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
Advance Information
305
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
14.8.6 SCI Data Register
The SCI data register (SCDR) is the buffer between the internal data bus
and the receive and transmit shift registers. Reset has no effect on data
in the SCI data register.
Address:
$003D
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
R7
R6
R5
R4
R3
R2
R1
R0
Write:
T7
T6
T5
T4
T3
T2
T1
T0
Reset:
Unaffected by reset
Figure 14-13. SCI Data Register (SCDR)
R7/T7:R0/T0 — Receive/Transmit Data Bits
Reading address $003D accesses the read-only received data bits,
R7:R0. Writing to address $003D writes the data to be transmitted,
T7:T0. Reset has no effect on the SCI data register.
14.8.7 SCI Baud Rate Register
The baud rate register (SCBR) selects the baud rate for both the receiver
and the transmitter.
Address:
Read:
$003E
Bit 7
6
0
0
Write:
R
R
Reset:
0
0
R
= Reserved
5
4
SCP1
SCP0
3
2
1
Bit 0
SCR2
SCR1
SCR0
0
0
0
0
R
0
0
0
Figure 14-14. SCI Baud Rate Register (SCBR)
Advance Information
306
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
I/O Registers
SCP1 and SCP0 — SCI Baud Rate Prescaler Bits
These read/write bits select the baud rate prescaler divisor as shown
in Table 14-5. Reset clears SCP1 and SCP0.
Table 14-5. SCI Baud Rate Prescaling
SCP1:SCP0
Prescaler Divisor (PD)
00
1
01
3
10
4
11
13
SCR2–SCR0 — SCI Baud Rate Select Bits
These read/write bits select the SCI baud rate divisor as shown in
Table 14-6. Reset clears SCR2–SCR0.
Table 14-6. SCI Baud Rate Selection
SCR2:SCR1:SCR0
Baud Rate Divisor (BD)
000
1
001
2
010
4
011
8
100
16
101
32
110
64
111
128
Use this formula to calculate the SCI baud rate:
f OP
Baud rate = -----------------------------------64 × PD × BD
where:
fOP = internal operating frequency
PD = prescaler divisor
BD = baud rate divisor
Table 14-7 shows the SCI baud rates that can be generated with a
4.9152-MHz crystal with the CGM set for an fOP of 7.3728 MHz and the
CGM set for an fOP of 4.9152 MHz.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
Advance Information
307
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
Table 14-7. SCI Baud Rate Selection Examples
SCP1:SCP0
Prescaler
Divisor (PD)
SCR2:SCR1:SCR0
Baud Rate
Divisor (BD)
Baud Rate
(fOP = 7.3728 MHz)
Baud Rate
(fOP = 4.9152 MHz)
00
1
000
1
115,200
76,800
00
1
001
2
57,600
38,400
00
1
010
4
28,800
19,200
00
1
011
8
14,400
9600
00
1
100
16
7200
4800
00
1
101
32
3600
2400
00
1
110
64
1800
1200
00
1
111
128
900
600
01
3
000
1
38,400
25,600
01
3
001
2
19,200
12,800
01
3
010
4
9600
6400
01
3
011
8
4800
3200
01
3
100
16
2400
1600
01
3
101
32
1200
800
01
3
110
64
600
400
01
3
111
128
300
200
10
4
000
1
28,800
19,200
10
4
001
2
14,400
9600
10
4
010
4
7200
4800
10
4
011
8
3600
2400
10
4
100
16
1800
1200
10
4
101
32
900
600
10
4
110
64
450
300
10
4
111
128
225
150
11
13
000
1
8861.5
5907.7
11
13
001
2
4430.7
2953.8
11
13
010
4
2215.4
1476.9
11
13
011
8
1107.7
738.5
11
13
100
16
553.8
369.2
11
13
101
32
276.9
184.6
11
13
110
64
138.5
92.3
11
13
111
128
69.2
46.2
Advance Information
308
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Serial Communications Interface Module (SCI)
MOTOROLA
Advance Information — MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32
Section 15. Input/Output (I/O) Ports
15.1 Contents
15.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 309
15.3 Port A . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 312
15.3.1 Port A Data Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 312
15.3.2 Data Direction Register A . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 312
15.4 Port B . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314
15.4.1 Port B Data Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314
15.4.2 Data Direction Register B. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314
15.5 Port C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316
15.5.1 Port C Data Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316
15.5.2 Data Direction Register C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316
15.6
Port D . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 318
15.7 Port E . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 319
15.7.1 Port E Data Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 319
15.7.2 Data Direction Register E . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 320
15.8 Port F . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 321
15.8.1 Port F Data Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 321
15.8.2 Data Direction Register F . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 322
15.2 Introduction
Thirty-seven bidirectional input-output (I/O) pins and seven input pins
form six parallel ports. All I/O pins are programmable as inputs or
outputs.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
Advance Information
309
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
When using the 56-pin package version:
NOTE:
Addr.
$0000
$0001
$0002
$0003
$0004
•
Set the data direction register bits in DDRC such that bit 1 is
written to a logic 1 (along with any other output bits on port C).
•
Set the data direction register bits in DDRE such that bits 0, 1,
and 2 are written to a logic 1 (along with any other output bits on
port E).
•
Set the data direction register bits in DDRF such that bits 0, 1, 2,
and 3 are written to a logic 1 (along with any other output bits on
port F).
Connect any unused I/O pins to an appropriate logic level, either VDD or
VSS. Although PWM6–PWM1 do not require termination for proper
operation, termination reduces excess current consumption and the
possibility of electrostatic damage.
Register Name
Port A Data Register
(PTA)
See page 312.
Port B Data Register
(PTB)
See page 314.
Port C Data Register
(PTC)
See page 316.
Port D Data Register
(PTD)
See page 318.
Data Direction Register A
(DDRA)
See page 312.
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
PTA7
PTA6
PTA5
PTA4
PTA3
PTA2
PTA1
PTA0
PTB2
PTB1
PTB0
PTC2
PTC1
PTC0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Unaffected by reset
Read:
PTB7
PTB6
PTB5
PTB4
PTB3
Write:
Reset:
Unaffected by reset
Read:
0
Write:
R
PTC6
PTC5
Reset:
PTC4
PTC3
Unaffected by reset
Read:
0
PTD6
PTD5
PTD4
PTD3
PTD2
PTD1
PTD0
Write:
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Reset:
Unaffected by reset
Read:
DDRA7
DDRA6
0
0
DDRA5 DDRA4
DDRA3
DDRA2
0
0
DDRA1 DDRA0
Write:
Reset:
R
0
0
0
0
= Reserved
Figure 15-1. I/O Port Register Summary
Advance Information
310
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
MOTOROLA
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
Introduction
Addr.
Register Name
$0005
Data Direction Register B
(DDRB)
See page 314.
$0006
Data Direction Register C
(DDRC)
See page 316.
Bit 7
6
DDRB7
DDRB6
Reset:
0
0
Read:
0
Write:
R
Reset:
0
5
$0009
3
2
DDRB3
DDRB2
0
0
DDRB5 DDRB4
0
0
DDRB1 DDRB0
0
0
DDRC6 DDRC5 DDRC4 DDRC3 DDRC2 DDRC1 DDRC0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
PTE2
PTE1
PTE0
PTF2
PTF1
PTF0
Unimplemented
Port E Data Register
(PTE)
See page 319.
Port F Data Register
(PTF)
See page 321.
Read:
PTE7
PTE6
PTE5
PTE4
PTE3
Write:
Reset:
Unaffected by reset
Read:
0
0
Write:
R
R
PTF5
Reset:
PTF4
PTF3
Unaffected by reset
Unimplemented
$000B
Unimplemented
$000D
Bit 0
Write:
$000A
$000C
1
Read:
$0007
$0008
4
Data Direction Register E
(DDRE)
See page 320.
Data Direction Register F
(DDRF)
See page 322.
Read:
DDRE7
DDRE6
Reset:
0
0
Read:
0
0
Write:
R
R
DDRE5 DDRE4
DDRE3
DDRE2
DDRE1 DDRE0
Write:
0
0
0
0
0
0
DDRF5
DDRF4
DDRF3
DDRF2
DDRF1
DDRF0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Reset:
R
= Reserved
Figure 15-1. I/O Port Register Summary (Continued)
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
Advance Information
311
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
15.3 Port A
Port A is an 8-bit, general-purpose, bidirectional I/O port.
15.3.1 Port A Data Register
The port A data register (PTA) contains a data latch for each of the eight
port A pins.
Address:
$0000
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
PTA7
PTA6
PTA5
PTA4
PTA3
PTA2
PTA1
PTA0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Unaffected by reset
Figure 15-2. Port A Data Register (PTA)
PTA[7:0] — Port A Data Bits
These read/write bits are software programmable. Data direction of
each port A pin is under the control of the corresponding bit in data
direction register A. Reset has no effect on port A data.
15.3.2 Data Direction Register A
Data direction register A (DDRA) determines whether each port A pin is
an input or an output. Writing a logic 1 to a DDRA bit enables the output
buffer for the corresponding port A pin; a logic 0 disables the output
buffer.
Address:
$0004
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
DDRA7
DDRA6
DDRA5
DDRA4
DDRA3
DDRA2
DDRA1
DDRA0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Figure 15-3. Data Direction Register A (DDRA)
Advance Information
312
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
MOTOROLA
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
Port A
DDRA[7:0] — Data Direction Register A Bits
These read/write bits control port A data direction. Reset clears
DDRA[7:0], configuring all port A pins as inputs.
1 = Corresponding port A pin configured as output
0 = Corresponding port A pin configured as input
NOTE:
Avoid glitches on port A pins by writing to the port A data register before
changing data direction register A bits from 0 to 1.
Figure 15-4 shows the port A I/O logic.
READ DDRA ($0004)
WRITE DDRA ($0004)
INTERNAL DATA BUS
DDRAx
RESET
WRITE PTA ($0000)
PTAx
PTAx
READ PTA ($0000)
Figure 15-4. Port A I/O Circuit
When bit DDRAx is a logic 1, reading address $0000 reads the PTAx
data latch. When bit DDRAx is a logic 0, reading address $0000 reads
the voltage level on the pin. The data latch can always be written,
regardless of the state of its data direction bit. Table 15-1 summarizes
the operation of the port A pins.
Table 15-1. Port A Pin Functions
DDRA
Bit
PTA Bit
I/O Pin
Mode
Accesses
to DDRA
Accesses to PTA
Read/Write
Read
Write
0
X(1)
Input, Hi-Z(2)
DDRA[7:0]
Pin
PTA[7:0](3)
1
X
Output
DDRA[7:0]
PTA[7:0]
PTA[7:0]
1. X = don’t care
2. Hi-Z = high impedance
3. Writing affects data register, but does not affect input.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
Advance Information
313
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
15.4 Port B
Port B is an 8-bit, general-purpose, bidirectional I/O port that shares its
pins with the analog-to-digital convertor (ADC) module.
15.4.1 Port B Data Register
The port B data register (PTB) contains a data latch for each of the eight
port B pins.
Address:
$0001
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
PTB7
PTB6
PTB5
PTB4
PTB3
PTB2
PTB1
PTB0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Unaffected by reset
Figure 15-5. Port B Data Register (PTB)
PTB[7:0] — Port B Data Bits
These read/write bits are software-programmable. Data direction of
each port B pin is under the control of the corresponding bit in data
direction register B. Reset has no effect on port B data.
15.4.2 Data Direction Register B
Data direction register B (DDRB) determines whether each port B pin is
an input or an output. Writing a logic 1 to a DDRB bit enables the output
buffer for the corresponding port B pin; a logic 0 disables the output
buffer.
Address:
$0005
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
DDRB7
DDRB6
DDRB5
DDRB4
DDRB3
DDRB2
DDRB1
DDRB0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Figure 15-6. Data Direction Register B (DDRB)
Advance Information
314
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
MOTOROLA
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
Port B
DDRB[7:0] — Data Direction Register B Bits
These read/write bits control port B data direction. Reset clears
DDRB[7:0], configuring all port B pins as inputs.
1 = Corresponding port B pin configured as output
0 = Corresponding port B pin configured as input
NOTE:
Avoid glitches on port B pins by writing to the port B data register before
changing data direction register B bits from 0 to 1.
Figure 15-7 shows the port B I/O logic.
READ DDRB ($0005)
WRITE DDRB ($0005)
INTERNAL DATA BUS
DDRBx
RESET
WRITE PTB ($0001)
PTBx
PTBx
READ PTB ($0001)
Figure 15-7. Port B I/O Circuit
When bit DDRBx is a logic 1, reading address $0001 reads the PTBx
data latch. When bit DDRBx is a logic 0, reading address $0001 reads
the voltage level on the pin. The data latch can always be written,
regardless of the state of its data direction bit. Table 15-2 summarizes
the operation of the port B pins.
Table 15-2. Port B Pin Functions
DDRB
Bit
PTB Bit
I/O Pin Mode
Accesses
to DDRB
Accesses to PTB
Read/Write
Read
Write
0
X(1)
Input, Hi-Z(2)
DDRB[7:0]
Pin
PTB[7:0](3)
1
X
Output
DDRB[7:0]
PTB[7:0]
PTB[7:0]
1. X = don’t care
2. Hi-Z = high impedance
3. Writing affects data register, but does not affect input.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
Advance Information
315
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
15.5 Port C
Port C is a 7-bit, general-purpose, bidirectional I/O port that shares two
of its pins with the analog-to-digital convertor module (ADC).
15.5.1 Port C Data Register
The port C data register (PTC) contains a data latch for each of the
seven port C pins.
Address:
$0002
Bit 7
Read:
0
Write:
R
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
PTC6
PTC5
PTC4
PTC3
PTC2
PTC1
PTC0
Reset:
Unaffected by reset
R
= Reserved
Figure 15-8. Port C Data Register (PTC)
PTC[6:0] — Port C Data Bits
These read/write bits are software-programmable. Data direction of
each port C pin is under the control of the corresponding bit in data
direction register C. Reset has no effect on port C data.
15.5.2 Data Direction Register C
Data direction register C (DDRC) determines whether each port C pin is
an input or an output. Writing a logic 1 to a DDRC bit enables the output
buffer for the corresponding port C pin; a logic 0 disables the output
buffer.
Address:
$0006
Bit 7
Read:
0
Write:
R
Reset:
0
R
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
DDRC6
DDRC5
DDRC4
DDRC3
DDRC2
DDRC1
DDRC0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Reserved
Figure 15-9. Data Direction Register C (DDRC)
Advance Information
316
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
MOTOROLA
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
Port C
DDRC[6:0] — Data Direction Register C Bits
These read/write bits control port C data direction. Reset clears
DDRC[6:0], configuring all port C pins as inputs.
1 = Corresponding port C pin configured as output
0 = Corresponding port C pin configured as input
NOTE:
Avoid glitches on port C pins by writing to the port C data register before
changing data direction register C bits from 0 to 1.
Figure 15-10 shows the port C I/O logic.
READ DDRC ($0006)
WRITE DDRC ($0006)
INTERNAL DATA BUS
DDRCx
RESET
WRITE PTC ($0002)
PTCx
PTCx
READ PTC ($0002)
Figure 15-10. Port C I/O Circuit
When bit DDRCx is a logic 1, reading address $0002 reads the PTCx
data latch. When bit DDRCx is a logic 0, reading address $0002 reads
the voltage level on the pin. The data latch can always be written,
regardless of the state of its data direction bit. Table 15-3 summarizes
the operation of the port C pins.
Table 15-3. Port C Pin Functions
DDRC
Bit
PTC Bit
I/O Pin Mode
Accesses
to DDRC
Accesses to PTC
Read/Write
Read
Write
0
X(1)
Input, Hi-Z(2)
DDRC[6:0]
Pin
PTC[6:0](3)
1
X
Output
DDRC[6:0]
PTC[6:0]
PTC[6:0]
1. X = don’t care
2. Hi-Z = high impedance
3. Writing affects data register, but does not affect input.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
Advance Information
317
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
15.6 Port D
Port D is a 7-bit, input-only port that shares its pins with the pulse width
modulator for motor control module (PMC).
The port D data register (PTD) contains a data latch for each of the
seven port pins.
Address:
$0003
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
0
PTD6
PTD5
PTD4
PTD3
PTD2
PTD1
PTD0
Write:
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Reset:
Unaffected by reset
= Reserved
R
Figure 15-11. Port D Data Register (PTD)
PTD[6:0] — Port D Data Bits
These read/write bits are software programmable. Reset has no
effect on port D data.
INTERNAL DATA BUS
Figure 15-12 shows the port D input logic.
READ PTD ($0003)
PTDx
Figure 15-12. Port D Input Circuit
Reading address $0003 reads the voltage level on the pin. Table 15-4
summarizes the operation of the port D pins.
Table 15-4. Port D Pin Functions
PTD Bit
X
(1)
Pin Mode
Input, Hi-Z
(2)
Accesses to PTD
Read
Write
Pin
PTD[6:0](3)
1. X = don’t care
2. Hi-Z = high impedance
3. Writing affects data register, but does not affect input.
Advance Information
318
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
MOTOROLA
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
Port E
15.7 Port E
Port E is an 8-bit, special function port that shares five of its pins with the
timer interface module (TIM) and two of its pins with the serial
communications interface module (SCI).
15.7.1 Port E Data Register
The port E data register (PTE) contains a data latch for each of the eight
port E pins.
Address:
$0008
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
PTE7
PTE6
PTE5
PTE4
PTE3
PTE2
PTE1
PTE0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Unaffected by reset
Figure 15-13. Port E Data Register (PTE)
PTE[7:0] — Port E Data Bits
PTE[7:0] are read/write, software-programmable bits. Data direction
of each port E pin is under the control of the corresponding bit in data
direction register E.
NOTE:
Data direction register E (DDRE) does not affect the data direction of
port E pins that are being used by the TIMA or TIMB. However, the
DDRE bits always determine whether reading port E returns the states
of the latches or the states of the pins.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
Advance Information
319
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
15.7.2 Data Direction Register E
Data direction register E (DDRE) determines whether each port E pin is
an input or an output. Writing a logic 1 to a DDRE bit enables the output
buffer for the corresponding port E pin; a logic 0 disables the output
buffer.
Address:
$000C
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
DDRE7
DDRE6
DDRE5
DDRE4
DDRE3
DDRE2
DDRE1
DDRE0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Figure 15-14. Data Direction Register E (DDRE)
DDRE[7:0] — Data Direction Register E Bits
These read/write bits control port E data direction. Reset clears
DDRE[7:0], configuring all port E pins as inputs.
1 = Corresponding port E pin configured as output
0 = Corresponding port E pin configured as input
NOTE:
Avoid glitches on port E pins by writing to the port E data register before
changing data direction register E bits from 0 to 1.
Figure 15-15 shows the port E I/O logic.
READ DDRE ($000C)
INTERNAL DATA BUS
WRITE DDRE ($000C)
DDREx
RESET
WRITE PTE ($0008)
PTEx
PTEx
READ PTE ($0008)
Figure 15-15. Port E I/O Circuit
Advance Information
320
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
MOTOROLA
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
Port F
When bit DDREx is a logic 1, reading address $0008 reads the PTEx
data latch. When bit DDREx is a logic 0, reading address $0008 reads
the voltage level on the pin. The data latch can always be written,
regardless of the state of its data direction bit. Table 15-5 summarizes
the operation of the port E pins.
Table 15-5. Port E Pin Functions
DDRE
Bit
PTE
Bit
Accesses
to DDRE
I/O Pin Mode
Accesses to PTE
Read/Write
Read
Write
0
X(1)
Input, Hi-Z(2)
DDRE[7:0]
Pin
PTE[7:0](3)
1
X
Output
DDRE[7:0]
PTE[7:0]
PTE[7:0]
1. X = don’t care
2. Hi-Z = high impedance
3. Writing affects data register, but does not affect input.
15.8 Port F
Port F is a 6-bit, special function port that shares four of its pins with the
serial peripheral interface module (SPI) and two pins with the serial
communications interface (SCI).
15.8.1 Port F Data Register
The port F data register (PTF) contains a data latch for each of the six
port F pins.
Address:
$0009
Bit 7
6
Read:
0
0
Write:
R
R
Reset:
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
PTF5
PTF4
PTF3
PTF2
PTF1
PTF0
Unaffected by reset
R
= Reserved
Figure 15-16. Port F Data Register (PTF)
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
Advance Information
321
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
PTF[5:0] — Port F Data Bits
These read/write bits are software programmable. Data direction of
each port F pin is under the control of the corresponding bit in data
direction register F. Reset has no effect on PTF[5:0].
NOTE:
Data direction register F (DDRF) does not affect the data direction of port
F pins that are being used by the SPI or SCI module. However, the
DDRF bits always determine whether reading port F returns the states
of the latches or the states of the pins.
15.8.2 Data Direction Register F
Data direction register F (DDRF) determines whether each port F pin is
an input or an output. Writing a logic 1 to a DDRF bit enables the output
buffer for the corresponding port F pin; a logic 0 disables the output
buffer.
Address:
$000D
Bit 7
6
Read:
0
0
Write:
R
R
Read:
R
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
DDRF5
DDRF4
DDRF3
DDRF2
DDRF1
DDRF0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Reserved
Figure 15-17. Data Direction Register F (DDRF)
DDRF[5:0] — Data Direction Register F Bits
These read/write bits control port F data direction. Reset clears
DDRF[5:0], configuring all port F pins as inputs.
1 = Corresponding port F pin configured as output
0 = Corresponding port F pin configured as input
NOTE:
Avoid glitches on port F pins by writing to the port F data register before
changing data direction register F bits from 0 to 1.
Figure 15-18 shows the port F I/O logic.
Advance Information
322
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
MOTOROLA
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
Port F
READ DDRF ($000D)
INTERNAL DATA BUS
WRITE DDRF ($000D)
RESET
DDRFx
WRITE PTF ($0009)
PTFx
PTFx
READ PTF ($0009)
Figure 15-18. Port F I/O Circuit
When bit DDRFx is a logic 1, reading address $0009 reads the PTFx
data latch. When bit DDRFx is a logic 0, reading address $0009 reads
the voltage level on the pin. The data latch can always be written,
regardless of the state of its data direction bit. Table 15-6 summarizes
the operation of the port F pins.
Table 15-6. Port F Pin Functions
DDRF
Bit
PTF
Bit
I/O Pin Mode
Accesses
to DDRF
Accesses to PTF
Read/Write
Read
Write
0
X(1)
Input, Hi-Z(2)
DDRF[6:0]
Pin
PTF[6:0](3)
1
X
Output
DDRF[6:0]
PTF[6:0]
PTF[6:0]
1. X = don’t care
2. Hi-Z = high impedance
3. Writing affects data register, but does not affect input.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
Advance Information
323
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
Advance Information
324
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Input/Output (I/O) Ports
MOTOROLA
Advance Information — MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32
Section 16. Computer Operating Properly (COP)
16.1 Contents
16.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 325
16.3
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 326
16.4 I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 327
16.4.1 CGMXCLK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .327
16.4.2 COPCTL Write . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 327
16.4.3 Power-On Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .327
16.4.4 Internal Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328
16.4.5 Reset Vector Fetch. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328
16.4.6 COPD (COP Disable). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328
16.5
COP Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328
16.6
Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328
16.7
Monitor Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .329
16.8
Wait Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 329
16.9
Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 329
16.2 Introduction
This section describes the computer operating properly module, a
free-running counter that generates a reset if allowed to overflow. The
computer operating properly (COP) module helps software recover from
runaway code. Prevent a COP reset by periodically clearing the COP
counter.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Computer Operating Properly (COP)
Advance Information
325
Computer Operating Properly (COP)
16.3 Functional Description
Figure 16-1 shows the structure of the COP module. A summary of the
input/output (I/O) register is shown in Figure 16-2.
6,0
SIM RESET CIRCUIT
13-BIT SIM COUNTER
SIM RESET STATUS REGISTER
CLEAR BITS 12–4
CLEAR ALL BITS
CGMXCLK
INTERNAL RESET SOURCES(1)
RESET VECTOR FETCH
COPCTL WRITE
&2302'8/(
6-BIT COP COUNTER
COPD (FROM CONFIG)
RESET
COPCTL WRITE
CLEAR
COP COUNTER
Note 1. See 7.4.2 Active Resets from Internal Sources.
Figure 16-1. COP Block Diagram
Addr.
$FFFF
Register Name
Bit 7
Read:
COP Control Register
(COPCTL) Write:
See page 328.
Reset:
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Low byte of reset vector
Clear COP counter
Unaffected by reset
Figure 16-2. COP I/O Register Summary
Advance Information
326
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Computer Operating Properly (COP)
MOTOROLA
Computer Operating Properly (COP)
I/O Signals
The COP counter is a free-running, 6-bit counter preceded by the 13-bit
system integration module (SIM) counter. If not cleared by software, the
COP counter overflows and generates an asynchronous reset after
218–24 CGMXCLK cycles. With a 4.9152-MHz crystal, the COP timeout
period is 53.3 ms. Writing any value to location $FFFF before overflow
occurs clears the COP counter and prevents reset.
A COP reset pulls the RST pin low for 32 CGMXCLK cycles and sets the
COP bit in the SIM reset status register (SRSR). See 7.8.2 SIM Reset
Status Register.
NOTE:
Place COP clearing instructions in the main program and not in an
interrupt subroutine. Such an interrupt subroutine could keep the COP
from generating a reset even while the main program is not working
properly.
16.4 I/O Signals
This section describes the signals shown in Figure 16-1.
16.4.1 CGMXCLK
CGMXCLK is the crystal oscillator output signal. CGMXCLK frequency
is equal to the crystal frequency.
16.4.2 COPCTL Write
Writing any value to the COP control register (COPCTL) (see 16.5 COP
Control Register) clears the COP counter and clears bits 12–4 of the
SIM counter. Reading the COP control register returns the reset vector.
16.4.3 Power-On Reset
The power-on reset (POR) circuit in the SIM clears the SIM counter 4096
CGMXCLK cycles after power-up.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Computer Operating Properly (COP)
Advance Information
327
Computer Operating Properly (COP)
16.4.4 Internal Reset
An internal reset clears the SIM counter and the COP counter.
16.4.5 Reset Vector Fetch
A reset vector fetch occurs when the vector address appears on the data
bus. A reset vector fetch clears the SIM counter.
16.4.6 COPD (COP Disable)
The COPD signal reflects the state of the COP disable bit (COPD) in the
configuration register (CONFIG). See Section 5. Configuration
Register (CONFIG).
16.5 COP Control Register
The COP control register is located at address $FFFF and overlaps the
reset vector. Writing any value to $FFFF clears the COP counter and
starts a new timeout period. Reading location $FFFF returns the low
byte of the reset vector.
Address:
$FFFF
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
Read:
Low byte of reset vector
Write:
Clear COP counter
Reset:
Unaffected by reset
2
1
Bit 0
Figure 16-3. COP Control Register (COPCTL)
16.6 Interrupts
The COP does not generate CPU interrupt requests.
Advance Information
328
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Computer Operating Properly (COP)
MOTOROLA
Computer Operating Properly (COP)
Monitor Mode
16.7 Monitor Mode
The COP is disabled in monitor mode when VHI is present on the IRQ pin
or on the RST pin.
16.8 Wait Mode
The WAIT instruction puts the MCU in low power-consumption standby
mode.
The COP continues to operate during wait mode.
16.9 Stop Mode
Stop mode turns off the CGMXCLK input to the COP and clears the COP
prescaler. Service the COP immediately before entering or after exiting
stop mode to ensure a full COP timeout period after entering or exiting
stop mode.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Computer Operating Properly (COP)
Advance Information
329
Computer Operating Properly (COP)
Advance Information
330
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Computer Operating Properly (COP)
MOTOROLA
Advance Information — MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32
Section 17. External Interrupt (IRQ)
17.1 Contents
17.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 331
17.3
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 331
17.4
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 332
17.5
IRQ Pin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .335
17.6
IRQ Status and Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 336
17.2 Introduction
This section describes the external interrupt (IRQ) module, which
supports external interrupt functions.
17.3 Features
Features of the IRQ module include:
•
A dedicated external interrupt pin, IRQ
•
Hysteresis buffers
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
External Interrupt (IRQ)
Advance Information
331
External Interrupt (IRQ)
17.4 Functional Description
A logic 0 applied to any of the external interrupt pins can latch a CPU
interrupt request. Figure 17-1 shows the structure of the IRQ module.
Interrupt signals on the IRQ pin are latched into the IRQ1 latch. An
interrupt latch remains set until one of the following actions occurs:
•
Vector fetch — A vector fetch automatically generates an interrupt
acknowledge signal that clears the latch that caused the vector
fetch.
•
Software clear — Software can clear an interrupt latch by writing
to the appropriate acknowledge bit in the interrupt status and
control register (ISCR). Writing a logic 1 to the ACK1 bit clears the
IRQ1 latch.
•
Reset — A reset automatically clears both interrupt latches.
ACK1
V''
D
CLR
Q
CK
IRQ
SYNCHRONIZER
IRQ
INTERRUPT
REQUEST
HIGH
VOLTAGE
DETECT
TO MODE
SELECT
LOGIC
IRQ
LATCH
IMASK1
MODE1
Figure 17-1. IRQ Module Block Diagram
Addr.
$003F
Register Name
IRQ Status/Control Register
(ISCR)
See page 336.
Read:
Bit 7
6
5
4
0
0
0
0
3
2
R
R
R
R
Reset:
0
0
0
0
R
Bit 0
0
IRQF
Write:
1
IMASK1 MODE1
ACK1
0
0
0
0
= Reserved
Figure 17-2. IRQ I/O Register Summary
Advance Information
332
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
External Interrupt (IRQ)
MOTOROLA
External Interrupt (IRQ)
Functional Description
The external interrupt pins are falling-edge-triggered and are
software-configurable to be both falling-edge and low-level-triggered.
The MODE1 bit in the ISCR controls the triggering sensitivity of the
IRQ pin.
When the interrupt pin is edge-triggered only, the interrupt latch remains
set until a vector fetch, software clear, or reset occurs.
When the interrupt pin is both falling-edge and low-level-triggered, the
interrupt latch remains set until both of these occur:
•
Vector fetch, software clear, or reset
•
Return of the interrupt pin to logic 1
The vector fetch or software clear can occur before or after the interrupt
pin returns to logic 1. As long as the pin is low, the interrupt request
remains pending.
When set, the IMASK1 bit in the ISCR masks all external interrupt
requests. A latched interrupt request is not presented to the interrupt
priority logic unless the IMASK bit is clear.
NOTE:
The interrupt mask (I) in the condition code register (CCR) masks all
interrupt requests, including external interrupt requests.
(See Figure 17-3.)
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
External Interrupt (IRQ)
Advance Information
333
External Interrupt (IRQ)
FROM RESET
YES
I BIT SET?
NO
INTERRUPT?
YES
NO
STACK CPU REGISTERS
SET I BIT
LOAD PC WITH INTERRUPT VECTOR
FETCH NEXT
INSTRUCTION
SWI
INSTRUCTION?
YES
NO
RTI
INSTRUCTION?
YES
UNSTACK CPU REGISTERS
NO
EXECUTE INSTRUCTION
Figure 17-3. IRQ Interrupt Flowchart
Advance Information
334
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
External Interrupt (IRQ)
MOTOROLA
External Interrupt (IRQ)
IRQ Pin
17.5 IRQ Pin
A logic 0 on the IRQ pin can latch an interrupt request into the IRQ latch.
A vector fetch, software clear, or reset clears the IRQ latch.
If the MODE1 bit is set, the IRQ pin is both falling-edge-sensitive and
low-level-sensitive. With MODE1 set, both of these actions must occur
to clear the IRQ1 latch:
•
Vector fetch, software clear, or reset — A vector fetch generates
an interrupt acknowledge signal to clear the latch. Software can
generate the interrupt acknowledge signal by writing a logic 1 to
the ACK1 bit in the interrupt status and control register (ISCR).
The ACK1 bit is useful in applications that poll the IRQ pin and
require software to clear the IRQ1 latch. Writing to the ACK1 bit
can also prevent spurious interrupts due to noise. Setting ACK1
does not affect subsequent transitions on the IRQ pin. A falling
edge that occurs after writing to the ACK1 bit latches another
interrupt request. If the IRQ1 mask bit, IMASK1, is clear, the CPU
loads the program counter with the vector address at locations
$FFFA and $FFFB.
•
Return of the IRQ pin to logic 1 — As long as the IRQ pin is at logic
0, the IRQ1 latch remains set.
The vector fetch or software clear and the return of the IRQ pin to logic 1
can occur in any order. The interrupt request remains pending as long
as the IRQ pin is at logic 0.
If the MODE1 bit is clear, the IRQ pin is falling-edge-sensitive only. With
MODE1 clear, a vector fetch or software clear immediately clears the
IRQ1 latch.
Use the branch if IRQ pin high (BIH) or branch if IRQ pin low (BIL)
instruction to read the logic level on the IRQ pin.
NOTE:
When using the level-sensitive interrupt trigger, avoid false interrupts by
masking interrupt requests in the interrupt routine.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
External Interrupt (IRQ)
Advance Information
335
External Interrupt (IRQ)
17.6 IRQ Status and Control Register
The IRQ status and control register (ISCR) has these functions:
•
Clears the IRQ interrupt latch
•
Masks IRQ interrupt requests
•
Controls triggering sensitivity of the IRQ interrupt pin
Address:
Read:
$003F
Bit 7
6
5
4
0
0
0
0
3
2
R
R
R
R
Reset:
0
0
0
0
R
Bit 0
IMASK1
MODE1
0
0
0
IRQF
Write:
1
ACK1
0
0
= Reserved
Figure 17-4. IRQ Status and Control Register (ISCR)
ACK1 — IRQ Interrupt Request Acknowledge Bit
Writing a logic 1 to this write-only bit clears the IRQ latch. ACK1
always reads as logic 0. Reset clears ACK1.
IMASK1 — IRQ Interrupt Mask Bit
Writing a logic 1 to this read/write bit disables IRQ interrupt requests.
Reset clears IMASK1.
1 = IRQ interrupt requests disabled
0 = IRQ interrupt requests enabled
MODE1 — IRQ Edge/Level Select Bit
This read/write bit controls the triggering sensitivity of the IRQ pin.
Reset clears MODE1.
1 = IRQ interrupt requests on falling edges and low levels
0 = IRQ interrupt requests on falling edges only
IRQF — IRQ Flag
This read-only bit acts as a status flag, indicating an IRQ event
occurred.
1 = External IRQ event occurred.
0 = External IRQ event did not occur.
Advance Information
336
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
External Interrupt (IRQ)
MOTOROLA
Advance Information — MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32
Section 18. Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI)
18.1 Contents
18.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 337
18.3
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 337
18.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 338
18.4.1 Polled LVI Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 339
18.4.2 Forced Reset Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 339
18.4.3 False Reset Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .339
18.4.4 LVI Trip Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 340
18.5
LVI Status and Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .340
18.6
LVI Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .341
18.7
Wait Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 341
18.8
Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 342
18.2 Introduction
This section describes the low-voltage inhibit (LVI) module, which
monitors the voltage on the VDD pin and can force a reset when the VDD
voltage falls to the LVI trip voltage.
18.3 Features
Features of the LVI module include:
•
Programmable LVI reset
•
Programmable power consumption
•
Digital filtering of VDD pin level
•
Selectable LVI trip voltage
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI)
Advance Information
337
Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI)
18.4 Functional Description
Figure 18-1 shows the structure of the LVI module. The LVI is enabled
out of reset. The LVI module contains a bandgap reference circuit and
comparator. The LVI power bit, LVIPWR, enables the LVI to monitor VDD
voltage. The LVI reset bit, LVIRST, enables the LVI module to generate
a reset when VDD falls below a voltage, VLVRX, and remains at or below
that level for nine or more consecutive CGMXCLK. VLVRX and VLVHX are
determined by the TRPSEL bit in the LVISCR (see Figure 18-2).
LVIPWR and LVIRST are in the configuration register (CONFIG). See
Section 5. Configuration Register (CONFIG).
Once an LVI reset occurs, the MCU remains in reset until VDD rises
above a voltage, VLVRX + VLVHX. VDD must be above VLVRX + VLVHX for
only one CPU cycle to bring the MCU out of reset. See 7.4.2.6
Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI) Reset. The output of the comparator controls
the state of the LVIOUT flag in the LVI status register (LVISCR).
An LVI reset also drives the RST pin low to provide low-voltage
protection to external peripheral devices. See 22.6 DC Electrical
Characteristics (VDD = 5.0 Vdc ± 10%).
V''
LVIPWR
FROM CONFIG
FROM CONFIG
CPU CLOCK
LOW V''
DETECTOR
V'' > LVItrip = 0
LVIRST
V''
DIGITAL FILTER
LVI RESET
V'' < LVItrip = 1
TRPSEL
FROM LVISCR
ANLGTRIP
LVIOUT
Figure 18-1. LVI Module Block Diagram
Advance Information
338
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI)
MOTOROLA
Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI)
Functional Description
Addr.
$FE0F
Register Name
Bit 7
Read: LVIOUT
LVI Status and Control
Register (LVISCR) Write:
R
See page 340.
Reset:
0
R
6
5
0
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
R
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
TRPSEL
R
0
0
= Reserved
Figure 18-2. LVI I/O Register Summary
18.4.1 Polled LVI Operation
In applications that can operate at VDD levels below VLVRX, software can
monitor VDD by polling the LVIOUT bit. In the configuration register, the
LVIPWR bit must be at logic 1 to enable the LVI module, and the LVIRST
bit must be at logic 0 to disable LVI resets. See Section 5.
Configuration Register (CONFIG). TRPSEL in the LVISCR selects
VLVRX.
18.4.2 Forced Reset Operation
In applications that require VDD to remain above VLVRX, enabling LVI
resets allows the LVI module to reset the MCU when VDD falls to the
VLVRX level and remains at or below that level for nine or more
consecutive CPU cycles. In the CONFIG register, the LVIPWR and
LVIRST bits must be at logic 1 to enable the LVI module and to enable
LVI resets. TRPSEL in the LVISCR selects VLVRX.
18.4.3 False Reset Protection
The VDD pin level is digitally filtered to reduce false resets due to power
supply noise. In order for the LVI module to reset the MCU, VDD must
remain at or below VLVRX for nine or more consecutive CPU cycles. VDD
must be above VLVRX + VLVHX for only one CPU cycle to bring the MCU
out of reset. TRPSEL in the LVISCR selects VLVRX + VLVHX.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI)
Advance Information
339
Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI)
18.4.4 LVI Trip Selection
The TRPSEL bit allows the user to chose between 5 percent and
10 percent tolerance when monitoring the supply voltage. The
10 percent option is enabled out of reset. Writing a logic 1 to TRPSEL
will enable 5 percent option.
NOTE:
The microcontroller is guaranteed to operate at a minimum supply
voltage. The trip point (VLVR1 or VLVR2) may be lower than this.
See 22.6 DC Electrical Characteristics (VDD = 5.0 Vdc ± 10%).
18.5 LVI Status and Control Register
The LVI status register (LVISCR) flags VDD voltages below the VLVRX
level.
Address:
$FE0F
Bit 7
Read: LVIOUT
6
5
0
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
R
R
R
R
R
0
0
0
0
0
TRPSEL
Write:
R
R
Reset:
0
0
R
0
= Reserved
Figure 18-3. LVI Status and Control Register (LVISCR)
LVIOUT — LVI Output Bit
This read-only flag becomes set when the VDD voltage falls below the
VLVRX voltage for 32 to 40 CGMXCLK cycles. See Table 18-1. Reset
clears the LVIOUT bit.
Advance Information
340
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI)
MOTOROLA
Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI)
LVI Interrupts
Table 18-1. LVIOUT Bit Indication
VDD
For Number of
CGMXCLK Cycles:
LVIOUT
At Level:
VDD > VLVRX + VLVHX
Any
0
VDD < VLVRX
< 32 CGMXCLK cycles
0
VDD < VLVRX
Between 32 & 40 CGMXCLK cycles
0 or 1
VDD < VLVRX
> 40 CGMXCLK cycles
1
VLVRX < VDD < VLVRX + VLVHX
Any
Previous
value
TRPSEL — LVI Trip Select Bit
This bit selects the LVI trip point. Reset clears this bit.
1 = 5 percent tolerance. The trip point and recovery point are
determined by VLVR1 and VLVH1, respectively.
0 = 10 percent tolerance. The trip point and recovery point are
determined by VLVR2 and VLVH2, respectively.
NOTE:
If LVIRST and LVIPWR are at logic 0, note that when changing the
tolerence, LVI reset will be generated if the supply voltage is below the
trip point.
18.6 LVI Interrupts
The LVI module does not generate interrupt requests.
18.7 Wait Mode
The WAIT instruction puts the MCU in low power-consumption standby
mode.
With the LVIPWR bit in the configuration register programmed to logic 1,
the LVI module is active after a WAIT instruction.
With the LVIRST bit in the configuration register programmed to logic 1,
the LVI module can generate a reset and bring the MCU out of wait
mode.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI)
Advance Information
341
Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI)
18.8 Stop Mode
If enabled, the LVI module remains active in stop mode. If enabled to
generate resets, the LVI module can generate a reset and bring the MCU
out of stop mode.
Advance Information
342
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI)
MOTOROLA
Advance Information — MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32
Section 19. Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
19.1 Contents
19.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 344
19.3
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 344
19.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 344
19.4.1 ADC Port I/O Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 345
19.4.2 Voltage Conversion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 346
19.4.3 Conversion Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .346
19.4.4 Continuous Conversion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 347
19.4.5 Result Justification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 347
19.4.6 Monotonicity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 348
19.5
Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 348
19.6
Wait Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 349
19.7 I/O Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 349
19.7.1 ADC Analog Power Pin (VDDAD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 349
19.7.2 ADC Analog Ground Pin (VSSAD). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 349
19.7.3 ADC Voltage Reference Pin (VREFH) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 349
19.7.4 ADC Voltage Reference Low Pin (VREFL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 350
19.7.5 ADC Voltage In (ADVIN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 350
19.7.6 ADC External Connections. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 350
19.7.6.1
VREFH and VREFL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 350
19.7.6.2
ANx . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 350
19.7.6.3
Grounding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 351
19.8 I/O Registers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 351
19.8.1 ADC Status and Control Register. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 351
19.8.2 ADC Data Register High . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 354
19.8.3 ADC Data Register Low . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 355
19.8.4 ADC Clock Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 356
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
Advance Information
343
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
19.2 Introduction
This section describes the 10-bit analog-to-digital converter (ADC).
19.3 Features
Features of the ADC module include:
•
10 channels with multiplexed input
•
Linear successive approximation
•
10-bit resolution, 8-bit accuracy
•
Single or continuous conversion
•
Conversion complete flag or conversion complete interrupt
•
Selectable ADC clock
•
Left or right justified result
•
Left justified sign data mode
•
High impedance buffered ADC input
19.4 Functional Description
Ten ADC channels are available for sampling external sources at pins
PTC1/ATD9:PTC0/ATD8 and PTB7/ATD7:PTB0/ATD0. To achieve the
best possible accuracy, these pins are implemented as input-only pins
when the analog-to-digital (A/D) feature is enabled. An analog
multiplexer allows the single ADC to select one of the 10 ADC channels
as ADC voltage IN (ADCVIN). ADCVIN is converted by the successive
approximation algorithm. When the conversion is completed, the ADC
places the result in the ADC data register (ADRH and ADRL) and sets a
flag or generates an interrupt. See Figure 19-1.
Advance Information
344
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
MOTOROLA
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
Functional Description
INTERNAL
DATA BUS
PTB/Cx
ADC CHANNEL x
READ PTB/PTC
DISABLE
ADC DATA REGISTERS
INTERRUPT
LOGIC
AIEN
ADC VOLTAGE IN
ADVIN
CONVERSION
COMPLETE
ADC
CHANNEL
SELECT
ADCH[4:0]
COCO/IDMAS
ADC CLOCK
PTx
CGMXCLK
BUS CLOCK
CLOCK
GENERATOR
ADIV[2:0]
ADICLK
Figure 19-1. ADC Block Diagram
19.4.1 ADC Port I/O Pins
PTC1/ATD9:PTC0/ATD8 and PTB7/ATD7:PTB0/ATD0 are
general-purpose I/O pins that are shared with the ADC channels.
The channel select bits define which ADC channel/port pin will be used
as the input signal. The ADC overrides the port logic when that port is
selected by the ADC multiplexer. The remaining ADC channels/port pins
are controlled by the port logic and can be used as general-purpose
input/output (I/O) pins. Writes to the port register or DDR will not have
any effect on the port pin that is selected by the ADC. Read of a port pin
which is in use by the ADC will return a logic 0.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
Advance Information
345
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
19.4.2 Voltage Conversion
When the input voltage to the ADC equals VREFH, the ADC converts the
signal to $3FF (full scale). If the input voltage equals VREFL, the ADC
converts it to $000. Input voltages between VREFH and VREFL are
straight-line linear conversions. All other input voltages will result in
$3FF if greater than VREFH and $000 if less than VREFL.
NOTE:
Input voltage should not exceed the analog supply voltages. See
22.14 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) Characteristics.
19.4.3 Conversion Time
Conversion starts after a write to the ADSCR. A conversion is between
16 and 17 ADC clock cycles, therefore:
Conversion time =
16 to17 ADC Cycles
ADC Frequency
Number of Bus Cycles = Conversion Time x CPU Bus Frequency
The ADC conversion time is determined by the clock source chosen and
the divide ratio selected. The clock source is either the bus clock or
CGMXCLK and is selectable by ADICLK located in the ADC clock
register. For example, if CGMXCLK is 4 MHz and is selected as the ADC
input clock source, the ADC input clock divide-by-4 prescale is selected
and the CPU bus frequency is 8 MHz:
Conversion Time =
16 to 17 ADC Cycles
= 16 to 17µs
4 MHz/4
Number of bus cycles = 16 µs x 8 MHz = 128 to 136 cycles
NOTE:
The ADC frequency must be between fADIC minimum and fADIC
maximum to meet A/D specifications. See 22.14 Analog-to-Digital
Converter (ADC) Characteristics.
Since an ADC cycle may be comprised of several bus cycles (eight, 136
minus 128, in the previous example) and the start of a conversion is
initiated by a bus cycle write to the ADSCR, from zero to eight additional
bus cycles may occur before the start of the initial ADC cycle. This
results in a fractional ADC cycle and is represented as the 17th cycle.
Advance Information
346
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
MOTOROLA
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
Functional Description
19.4.4 Continuous Conversion
In continuous conversion mode, the ADC data registers ADRH and
ADRL will be filled with new data after each conversion. Data from the
previous conversion will be overwritten whether that data has been read
or not. Conversions will continue until the ADCO bit is cleared. The
COCO bit is set after the first conversion and will stay set for the next
several conversions until the next write of the ADC status and control
register or the next read of the ADC data register.
19.4.5 Result Justification
The conversion result may be formatted in four different ways:
1. Left justified
2. Right justified
3. Left Justified sign data mode
4. 8-bit truncation mode
All four of these modes are controlled using MODE0 and MODE1 bits
located in the ADC clock register (ADCR).
Left justification will place the eight most significant bits (MSB) in the
corresponding ADC data register high, ADRH. This may be useful if the
result is to be treated as an 8-bit result where the two least significant
bits (LSB), located in the ADC data register low, ADRL, can be ignored.
However, ADRL must be read after ADRH or else the interlocking will
prevent all new conversions from being stored.
Right justification will place only the two MSBs in the corresponding ADC
data register high, ADRH, and the eight LSBs in ADC data register low,
ADRL. This mode of operation typically is used when a 10-bit unsigned
result is desired.
Left justified sign data mode is similar to left justified mode with one
exception. The MSB of the 10-bit result, AD9 located in ADRH, is
complemented. This mode of operation is useful when a result,
represented as a signed magnitude from mid-scale, is needed. Finally,
8-bit truncation mode will place the eight MSBs in ADC data register low,
ADRL. The two LSBs are dropped. This mode of operation is used when
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
Advance Information
347
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
compatibility with 8-bit ADC designs are required. No interlocking
between ADRH and ADRL is present.
NOTE:
Quantization error is affected when only the most significant eight bits
are used as a result. See Figure 19-2.
8-BIT 10-BIT
RESUL7 RESULT
IDEAL 8-BIT CHARACTERISTIC
WITH QUANTIZATION = ±1/2
10-BIT TRUNCATED
TO 8-BIT RESULT
003
00B
00A
009
002
IDEAL 10-BIT CHARACTERISTIC
WITH QUANTIZATION = ±1/2
008
007
006
005
001
004
WHEN TRUNCATION IS USED,
ERROR FROM IDEAL 8-BIT = 3/8 LSB
DUE TO NON-IDEAL QUANTIZATION.
003
002
001
000
000
1/2
2 1/2
1 1/2
1/2
4 1/2
3 1/2
6 1/2
5 1/2
8 1/2
7 1/2
1 1/2
9 1/2
2 1/2
INPUT VOLTAGE
REPRESENTED AS 10-BIT
INPUT VOLTAGE
REPRESENTED AS 8-BIT
Figure 19-2. 8-Bit Truncation Mode Error
19.4.6 Monotonicity
The conversion process is monotonic and has no missing codes.
19.5 Interrupts
When the AIEN bit is set, the ADC module is capable of generating a
CPU interrupt after each ADC conversion. A CPU interrupt is generated
if the COCO bit is at logic 0. The COCO bit is not used as a conversion
complete flag when interrupts are enabled.
Advance Information
348
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
MOTOROLA
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
Wait Mode
19.6 Wait Mode
The WAIT instruction can put the MCU in low power-consumption
standby mode.
The ADC continues normal operation during wait mode. Any enabled
CPU interrupt request from the ADC can bring the MCU out of wait
mode. If the ADC is not required to bring the MCU out of wait mode,
power down the ADC by setting ADCH[4:0] in the ADC status and control
register before executing the WAIT instruction.
19.7 I/O Signals
The ADC module has 10 input signals that are shared with port B and
port C.
19.7.1 ADC Analog Power Pin (VDDAD)
The ADC analog portion uses VDDAD as its power pin. Connect the
VDDAD pin to the same voltage potential asVDD. External filtering may be
necessary to ensure clean VDDAD for good results.
NOTE:
Route VDDAD carefully for maximum noise immunity and place bypass
capacitors as close as possible to the package.
19.7.2 ADC Analog Ground Pin (VSSAD)
The ADC analog portion uses VSSAD as its ground pin. Connect the
VSSAD pin to the same voltage potential as VSS.
19.7.3 ADC Voltage Reference Pin (VREFH)
VREFH is the power supply for setting the reference voltage VREFH.
Connect the VREFH pin to the same voltage potential as VDDAD. There
will be a finite current associated with VREFH. See Section 22. Electrical
Specifications.
NOTE:
Route VREFH carefully for maximum noise immunity and place bypass
capacitors as close as possible to the package.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
Advance Information
349
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
19.7.4 ADC Voltage Reference Low Pin (VREFL)
VREFL is the lower reference supply for the ADC. Connect the VREFL pin
to the same voltage potential as VSSAD. A finite current will be
associated with VREFL. See Section 22. Electrical Specifications.
NOTE:
In the 56-pin shrink dual in-line package (SDIP), VREFL and VSSAD are
tied together.
19.7.5 ADC Voltage In (ADVIN)
ADVIN is the input voltage signal from one of the 10 ADC channels to
the ADC module.
19.7.6 ADC External Connections
This section describes the ADC external connections: VREFH and VREFL,
ANx, and grounding.
19.7.6.1 VREFH and VREFL
Both ac and dc current are drawn through the VREFH and VREFL loop.
The AC current is in the form of current spikes required to supply charge
to the capacitor array at each successive approximation step. The
current flows through the internal resistor string. The best external
component to meet both these current demands is a capacitor in the
0.01 µF to 1 µF range with good high frequency characteristics. This
capacitor is connected between VREFH and VREFL and must be placed
as close as possible to the package pins. Resistance in the path is not
recommended because the dc current will cause a voltage drop which
could result in conversion errors.
19.7.6.2 ANx
Empirical data shows that capacitors from the analog inputs to VREFL
improve ADC performance. 0.01-µF and 0.1-µF capacitors with good
high-frequency characteristics are sufficient. These capacitors must be
placed as close as possible to the package pins.
Advance Information
350
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
MOTOROLA
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
I/O Registers
19.7.6.3 Grounding
In cases where separate power supplies are used for analog and digital
power, the ground connection between these supplies should be at the
VSSA pin. This should be the only ground connection between these
supplies if possible. The VSSA pin makes a good single point ground
location. Connect the VREFL pin to the same potential as VSSAD at the
single point ground location.
19.8 I/O Registers
These I/O registers control and monitor operation of the ADC:
•
ADC status and control register, ADSCR
•
ADC data registers, ADRH and ARDL
•
ADC clock register, ADCLK
19.8.1 ADC Status and Control Register
This section describes the function of the ADC status and control
register (ADSCR). Writing ADSCR aborts the current conversion and
initiates a new conversion.
Address: $0040
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
COCO
AIEN
ADCO
ADCH4
ADCH3
ADCH2
ADCH1
ADCH0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Figure 19-3. ADC Status and Control Register (ADSCR)
COCO — Conversions Complete Bit
When AIEN bit is a logic 0, the COCO is a read-only bit which is set
each time a conversion is completed except in the continuous
conversion mode where it is set after the first conversion. This bit is
cleared whenever the ADC status and control register is written or
whenever the ADC data register is read.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
Advance Information
351
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
If AIEN bit is a logic 1, the COCO is a read/write bit. Reset clears this
bit.
1 = Conversion completed (AIEN = 0)
0 = Conversion not completed (AIEN = 0)/CPU interrupt (AIEN = 1)
AIEN — ADC Interrupt Enable Bit
When this bit is set, an interrupt is generated at the end of an ADC
conversion. The interrupt signal is cleared when the data register is
read or the status/control register is written. Reset clears the AIEN bit.
1 = ADC interrupt enabled
0 = ADC interrupt disabled
ADCO — ADC Continuous Conversion Bit
When set, the ADC will convert samples continuously and update the
ADR register at the end of each conversion. Only one conversion is
allowed when this bit is cleared. Reset clears the ADCO bit.
1 = Continuous ADC conversion
0 = One ADC conversion
ADCH[4:0] — ADC Channel Select Bits
ADCH4, ADCH3, ADCH2, ADCH1, and ADCH0 form a 5-bit field
which is used to select one of 10 ADC channels. The ADC channels
are detailed in Table 19-1.
NOTE:
Take care to prevent switching noise from corrupting the analog signal
when simultaneously using a port pin as both an analog and digital input.
The ADC subsystem is turned off when the channel select bits are all
set to 1. This feature allows for reduced power consumption for the
MCU when the ADC is not used.
NOTE:
Recovery from the disabled state requires one conversion cycle to
stabilize.
The voltage levels supplied from internal reference nodes as
specified in Table 19-1 are used to verify the operation of the ADC
both in production test and for user applications.
Advance Information
352
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
MOTOROLA
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
I/O Registers
Table 19-1. Mux Channel Select
ADCH4
ADCH3
ADCH2
ADCH1
ADCH0
Input Select
0
0
0
0
0
PTB0/ATD0
0
0
0
0
1
PTB1/ATD1
0
0
0
1
0
PTB2/ATD2
0
0
0
1
1
PTB3/ATD3
0
0
1
0
0
PTB4/ATD4
0
0
1
0
1
PTB5/ATD5
0
0
1
1
0
PTB6/ATD6
0
0
1
1
1
PTB7/ATD7
0
1
0
0
0
PTC0/ATD8
0
1
0
0
1
PTC1/ATD9 ***
0
1
0
1
0
Unused *
0
1
0
1
1
Ø
0
1
1
0
0
Ø
0
1
1
0
1
Ø
0
1
1
1
0
Ø
0
1
1
1
1
Ø
1
0
0
0
0
Ø
1
1
0
1
0
Unused *
1
1
0
1
1
Reserved **
1
1
1
0
0
Unused *
1
1
1
0
1
VREFH
1
1
1
1
0
VREFL
1
1
1
1
1
ADC power off
* If any unused channels are selected, the resulting ADC conversion will be unknown.
** Used for factory testing.
*** ATD9 is not available in the 56-pin SDIP package.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
Advance Information
353
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
19.8.2 ADC Data Register High
In left justified mode, this 8-bit result register holds the eight MSBs of the
10-bit result. This register is updated each time an ADC single channel
conversion completes. Reading ADRH latches the contents of ADRL
until ADRL is read. Until ADRL is read, all subsequent ADC results will
be lost.
Address:
$0041
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
AD9
AD8
AD7
AD6
AD5
AD4
AD3
AD2
Write:
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Reset:
Unaffected by reset
R
= Reserved
Figure 19-4. ADC Data Register High (ADRH)
Left Justified Mode
In right justified mode, this 8-bit result register holds the two MSBs of the
10-bit result. All other bits read as 0. This register is updated each time
a single channel ADC conversion completes. Reading ADRH latches the
contents of ADRL until ADRL is read. Until ADRL is read, all subsequent
ADC results will be lost.
Address:
$0041
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
0
0
0
0
0
0
AD9
AD8
Write:
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Reset:
Unaffected by reset
R
= Reserved
Figure 19-5. ADC Data Register High (ADRH)
Right Justified Mode
Advance Information
354
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
MOTOROLA
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
I/O Registers
19.8.3 ADC Data Register Low
In left justified mode, this 8-bit result register holds the two LSBs of the
10-bit result. All other bits read as 0. This register is updated each time
a single channel ADC conversion completes. Reading ADRH latches the
contents of ADRL until ADRL is read. Until ADRL is read, all subsequent
ADC results will be lost.
Address:
$0042
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
AD1
AD0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Write:
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Reset:
Unaffected by reset
R
= Reserved
Figure 19-6. ADC Data Register Low (ADRL)
Left Justified Mode
In right justified mode, this 8-bit result register holds the eight LSBs of
the 10-bit result. This register is updated each time an ADC conversion
completes. Reading ADRH latches the contents of ADRL until ADRL is
read. Until ADRL is read, all subsequent ADC results will be lost.
Address:
$0042
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
AD7
AD6
AD5
AD4
AD3
AD2
AD1
AD0
Write:
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Reset:
Unaffected by reset
R
= Reserved
Figure 19-7. ADC Data Register Low (ADRL)
Right Justified Mode
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
Advance Information
355
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
In 8-bit mode, this 8-bit result register holds the eight MSBs of the 10-bit
result. This register is updated each time an ADC conversion completes.
In 8-bit mode, this register contains no interlocking with ADRH.
Address:
$0042
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Read:
AD9
AD8
AD7
AD6
AD5
AD4
AD3
AD2
Write:
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Reset:
Unaffected by reset
R
= Reserved
Figure 19-8. ADC Data Register Low (ADRL) 8-Bit Mode
19.8.4 ADC Clock Register
This register selects the clock frequency for the ADC, selecting between
modes of operation.
Address:
$0043
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
ADIV2
ADIV1
ADIV0
ADICLK
MODE1
MODE0
0
Read:
0
Write:
Reset:
Bit 0
R
0
R
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
= Reserved
Figure 19-9. ADC Clock Register (ADCLK)
ADIV2:ADIV0 — ADC Clock Prescaler Bits
ADIV2, ADIV1, and ADIV0 form a 3-bit field which selects the divide
ratio used by the ADC to generate the internal ADC clock.
Table 19-2 shows the available clock configurations.
Advance Information
356
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
MOTOROLA
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
I/O Registers
Table 19-2. ADC Clock Divide Ratio
ADIV2
ADIV1
ADIV0
ADC Clock Rate
0
0
0
ADC input clock /1
0
0
1
ADC input clock /2
0
1
0
ADC input clock /4
0
1
1
ADC input clock /8
1
X
X
ADC input clock /16
X = don’t care
ADICLK — ADC Input Clock Select Bit
ADICLK selects either bus clock or CGMXCLK as the input clock
source to generate the internal ADC clock. Reset selects CGMXCLK
as the ADC clock source.
If the external clock (CGMXCLK) is equal to or greater than 1 MHz,
CGMXCLK can be used as the clock source for the ADC. If
CGMXCLK is less than 1 MHz, use the PLL-generated bus clock as
the clock source. As long as the internal ADC clock is at fADIC, correct
operation can be guaranteed. See 22.14 Analog-to-Digital
Converter (ADC) Characteristics.
1 = Internal bus clock
0 = External clock, CGMXCLK
fADIC =
CGMXCLK or bus frequency
ADIV[2:0]
MODE1:MODE0 — Modes of Result Justification Bits
MODE1:MODE0 selects among four modes of operation. The
manner in which the ADC conversion results will be placed in the ADC
data registers is controlled by these modes of operation. Reset
returns right-justified mode.
00 = 8-bit truncation mode
01 = Right justified mode
10 = Left justified mode
11 = Left justified sign data mode
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
Advance Information
357
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
Advance Information
358
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC)
MOTOROLA
$GYDQFH,QIRUPDWLRQ²0&+&050&+&05
Section 20. Power-On Reset (POR)
20.1 Contents
20.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 359
20.3
Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 359
20.2 Introduction
This section describes the power-on reset (POR) module.
20.3 Functional Description
The POR module provides a known, stable signal to the microcontroller
unit (MCU) at power-on. This signal tracks VDD until the MCU generates
a feedback signal to indicate that it is properly initialized. At this time, the
POR drives its output low.
The POR is not a brown-out detector, low-voltage detector, or glitch
detector. VDD at the POR must go completely to 0 to reset the MCU. To
detect power-loss conditions, use a low-voltage inhibit module (LVI) or
other suitable circuit.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Power-On Reset (POR)
Advance Information
359
Power-On Reset (POR)
Advance Information
360
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Power-On Reset (POR)
MOTOROLA
Advance Information — MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32
Section 21. Break Module (BRK)
21.1 Contents
21.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 361
21.3
Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 362
21.4 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 362
21.4.1 Flag Protection During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 364
21.4.2 CPU During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .364
21.4.3 TIM1 and TIM2 During Break Interrupts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 364
21.4.4 COP During Break Interrupts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .364
21.5 Low-Power Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 364
21.5.1 Wait Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .364
21.5.2 Stop Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .365
21.6 Break Module Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 365
21.6.1 Break Status and Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .365
21.6.2 Break Address Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 366
21.6.3 Break Status Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 367
21.6.4 Break Flag Control Register . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 368
21.2 Introduction
This section describes the break module (BRK). The break module can
generate a break interrupt that stops normal program flow at a defined
address to enter a background program.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Break Module (BRK)
Advance Information
361
Break Module (BRK)
21.3 Features
Features of the break module include:
•
Accessible input/output (I/O) registers during the break interrupt
•
Central processor unit (CPU) generated break interrupts
•
Software-generated break interrupts
•
Computer operating properly (COP) disabling during break
interrupts
21.4 Functional Description
When the internal address bus matches the value written in the break
address registers, the break module issues a breakpoint signal to the
CPU. The CPU then loads the instruction register with a software
interrupt instruction (SWI) after completion of the current CPU
instruction. The program counter vectors to $FFFC and $FFFD ($FEFC
and $FEFD in monitor mode).
These events can cause a break interrupt to occur:
•
A CPU-generated address (the address in the program counter)
matches the contents of the break address registers.
•
Software writes a logic 1 to the BRKA bit in the break status and
control register.
When a CPU-generated address matches the contents of the break
address registers, the break interrupt begins after the CPU completes its
current instruction. A return-from-interrupt instruction (RTI) in the break
routine ends the break interrupt and returns the microcontroller unit
(MCU) to normal operation. Figure 21-1 shows the structure of the break
module.
Advance Information
362
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Break Module (BRK)
MOTOROLA
Break Module (BRK)
Functional Description
IAB15–IAB8
BREAK ADDRESS REGISTER HIGH
8-BIT COMPARATOR
IAB15–IAB0
CONTROL
BREAK
8-BIT COMPARATOR
BREAK ADDRESS REGISTER LOW
IAB7–IAB0
Figure 21-1. Break Module Block Diagram
Addr.
Register Name
Read:
SIM Break Status Register
$FE00
(SBSR) Write:
See page 367.
Reset:
$FE03
$FE0C
$FE0D
Read:
SIM Break Flag Control
Register (SBFCR) Write:
See page 368.
Reset:
Read:
Break Address Register
High (BRKH) Write:
See page 366.
Reset:
Read:
Break Address Register
Low (BRKL) Write:
See page 366.
Reset:
Read:
Break Status and Control
$FE0E
Register (BRKSCR) Write:
See page 365.
Reset:
Note: Writing a logic 0 clears BW.
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
R
R
R
R
R
R
BW
R
0
BCFE
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
BRKE
BRKA
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
= Unimplemented
R
= Reserved
0
Figure 21-2. I/O Register Summary
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Break Module (BRK)
Advance Information
363
Break Module (BRK)
21.4.1 Flag Protection During Break Interrupts
The BCFE bit in the SIM break flag control register (SBFCR) enables
software to clear status bits during the break state.
21.4.2 CPU During Break Interrupts
The CPU starts a break interrupt by:
•
Loading the instruction register with the SWI instruction
•
Loading the program counter with $FFFC and $FFFD ($FEFC and
$FEFD in monitor mode)
The break interrupt begins after completion of the CPU instruction in
progress. If the break address register match occurs on the last cycle of
a CPU instruction, the break interrupt begins immediately.
21.4.3 TIM1 and TIM2 During Break Interrupts
A break interrupt stops the timer counters.
21.4.4 COP During Break Interrupts
The COP is disabled during a break interrupt when VTST is present on
the RST pin.
21.5 Low-Power Modes
The WAIT and STOP instructions put the MCU in low powerconsumption standby modes.
21.5.1 Wait Mode
If enabled, the break module is active in wait mode. In the break routine,
the user can subtract one from the return address on the stack if SBSW
is set. Clear the BW bit by writing logic 0 to it.
Advance Information
364
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Break Module (BRK)
MOTOROLA
Break Module (BRK)
Break Module Registers
21.5.2 Stop Mode
The break module is inactive in stop mode. The STOP instruction does
not affect break module register states.
21.6 Break Module Registers
These registers control and monitor operation of the break module:
•
Break status and control register (BRKSCR)
•
Break address register high (BRKH)
•
Break address register low (BRKL)
•
SIM break status register (SBSR)
•
SIM break flag control register (SBFCR)
21.6.1 Break Status and Control Register
The break status and control register (BRKSCR) contains break module
enable and status bits.
Address:
$FE0E
Bit 7
6
BRKE
BRKA
0
0
Read:
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Write:
Reset:
= Unimplemented
Figure 21-3. Break Status and Control Register (BRKSCR)
BRKE — Break Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables breaks on break address register matches.
Clear BRKE by writing a logic 0 to bit 7. Reset clears the BRKE bit.
1 = Breaks enabled on 16-bit address match
0 = Breaks disabled on 16-bit address match
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Break Module (BRK)
Advance Information
365
Break Module (BRK)
BRKA — Break Active Bit
This read/write status and control bit is set when a break address
match occurs. Writing a logic 1 to BRKA generates a break interrupt.
Clear BRKA by writing a logic 0 to it before exiting the break routine.
Reset clears the BRKA bit.
1 = When read, break address match
0 = When read, no break address match
21.6.2 Break Address Registers
The break address registers (BRKH and BRKL) contain the high and low
bytes of the desired breakpoint address. Reset clears the break address
registers.
Address:
$FE0C
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Bit 8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Figure 21-4. Break Address Register High (BRKH)
Address:
$FE0D
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Read:
Write:
Reset:
Figure 21-5. Break Address Register Low (BRKL)
Advance Information
366
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Break Module (BRK)
MOTOROLA
Break Module (BRK)
Break Module Registers
21.6.3 Break Status Register
The break status register (SBSR) contains a flag to indicate that a break
caused an exit from wait mode. The flag is useful in applications
requiring a return to wait mode after exiting from a break interrupt.
Address:
$FE00
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
R
R
R
R
R
R
BW
R
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
Figure 21-6. SIM Break Status Register (SBSR)
BW — Break Wait Bit
This read/write bit is set when a break interrupt causes an exit from
wait mode. Clear BW by writing a logic 0 to it. Reset clears BW.
1 = Break interrupt during wait mode
0 = No break interrupt during wait mode
BW can be read within the break interrupt routine. The user can
modify the return address on the stack by subtracting 1 from it. The
following code is an example.
This code works if the H register was stacked in the break interrupt
routine. Execute this code at the end of the break interrupt routine.
HIBYTE
EQU
5
LOBYTE
EQU
6
; If not BW, do RTI
BRCLR
BW,BSR, RETURN
; See if wait mode or stop mode
; was exited by break.
TST
LOBYTE,SP
; If RETURNLO is not 0,
BNE
DOLO
; then just decrement low byte.
DEC
HIBYTE,SP
; Else deal with high byte also.
DOLO
DEC
LOBYTE,SP
; Point to WAIT/STOP opcode.
RETURN
PULH
RTI
; Restore H register.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Break Module (BRK)
Advance Information
367
Break Module (BRK)
21.6.4 Break Flag Control Register
The break flag control register (SBFCR) contains a bit that enables
software to clear status bits while the MCU is in a break state.
Address:
$FE03
Bit 7
6
5
4
3
2
1
Bit 0
BCFE
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Read:
Write:
Reset:
0
R
= Reserved
Figure 21-7. SIM Break Flag Control Register (SBFCR)
BCFE — Break Clear Flag Enable Bit
This read/write bit enables software to clear status bits by accessing
status registers while the MCU is in a break state. To clear status bits
during the break state, the BCFE bit must be set.
1 = Status bits clearable during break
0 = Status bits not clearable during break
Advance Information
368
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Break Module (BRK)
MOTOROLA
Advance Information — MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32
Section 22. Electrical Specifications
22.1 Contents
22.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 369
22.3
Absolute Maximum Ratings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 370
22.4
Functional Operating Range. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 371
22.5
Thermal Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 371
22.6
DC Electrical Characteristics
(VDD = 5.0 Vdc ± 10%) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 372
22.7
FLASH Memory Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .373
22.8
Control Timing (VDD = 5.0 Vdc ± 10%) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 374
22.9
Serial Peripheral Interface Characteristics
(VDD = 5.0 Vdc ± 10%) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 375
22.10 TImer Interface Module Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 378
22.11 Clock Generation Module Component Specifications . . . . . . 378
22.12 CGM Operating Conditions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 378
22.13 CGM Acquisition/Lock Time Specifications
. . . . . . . . . . . . 379
22.14 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) Characteristics. . . . . . . . .380
22.2 Introduction
This section contains electrical and timing specifications. These values
are design targets and have not yet been fully characterized.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Electrical Specifications
Advance Information
369
Electrical Specifications
22.3 Absolute Maximum Ratings
Maximum ratings are the extreme limits to which the MCU can be
exposed without permanently damaging it.
NOTE:
This device is not guaranteed to operate properly at the maximum
ratings. For guaranteed operating conditions, refer to 22.6 DC Electrical
Characteristics (VDD = 5.0 Vdc ± 10%).
Characteristic(1)
Symbol
Value
Unit
Supply voltage
VDD
–0.3 to +6.0
V
Input voltage
VIn
VSS –0.3 to
VDD +0.3
V
Input high voltage
VHI
VDD + 4 maximum
V
I
±25
mA
Storage temperature
TSTG
–55 to +150
°C
Maximum current out of VSS
IMVSS
100
mA
Maximum current into VDD
IMVDD
100
mA
Maximum current per pin
excluding VDD and VSS
1. Voltages referenced to VSS.
NOTE:
Advance Information
370
This device contains circuitry to protect the inputs against damage due
to high static voltages or electric fields; however, it is advised that normal
precautions be taken to avoid application of any voltage higher than
maximum-rated voltages to this high-impedance circuit. For proper
operation, it is recommended that VIn be constrained to the range
VSS ≤ (VIn) ≤ VDD. Reliability of operation is enhanced if unused inputs
are connected to an appropriate logic voltage level (for example, either
VSS or VDD).
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Electrical Specifications
MOTOROLA
Electrical Specifications
Functional Operating Range
22.4 Functional Operating Range
Characteristic
Operating temperature range(1)
MC68HC908MR24CFU
MC68HC908MR24VFU
Operating voltage range
Symbol
Value
Unit
TA
–40 to 85
–40 to 105
°C
VDD
5.0 ± 10%
V
1. See Motorola representative for temperature availability.
C = Extended temperature range (–40°C to +85°C)
V = Automotive temperature range (–40°C to +105°C)
22.5 Thermal Characteristics
Characteristic
Symbol
Value
Unit
Thermal resistance,
64-pin QFP
θJA
76
°C/W
I/O pin power dissipation
PI/O
User determined
W
Power dissipation(1)
PD
PD = (IDD x VDD) + PI/O =
K/(TJ + 273°C)
W
Constant(2)
K
Average junction temperature
Maximum junction temperature
PD x (TA + 273°C)
+ PD2 x θJA
W/°C
TJ
TA + (PD x θJA)
°C
TJM
125
°C
1. Power dissipation is a function of temperature.
2. K is a constant unique to the device. K can be determined for a known TA and
measured PD. With this value of K, PD and TJ can be determined for any value of TA.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Electrical Specifications
Advance Information
371
Electrical Specifications
22.6 DC Electrical Characteristics (VDD = 5.0 Vdc ± 10%)
Symbol
Min
Typ(2)
Max
Unit
Output high voltage
(ILoad = –2.0 mA) all I/O pins
VOH
VDD –0.8
—
—
V
Output low voltage
(ILoad = 1.6 mA) all I/O pins
VOL
—
—
0.4
V
PWM pin output source current
(VOH = VDD –0.8 V)
IOH
–7
—
—
mA
PWM pin output sink current (VOL = 0.8 V)
IOL
—
—
VDD
mA
VIH
20
0.7 x VDD
—
Input high voltage, all ports, IRQs, RESET, OSC1
Input low voltage, all ports, IRQs, RESET, OSC1
VDD supply current
VIL
VSS
—
0.3 x VDD
V
—
—
—
—
—
—
30
12
700
mA
mA
µA
Characteristic
Run(3)
Wait(4)
IDD
V
Stop(5)
I/O ports high-impedance leakage current
IIL
—
—
±10
µA
Input current (input only pins)
IIn
—
—
±1
µA
COut
CIn
—
—
—
—
12
8
pF
Capacitance
Ports (as input or output)
Low-voltage inhibit reset(9)
Low-voltage reset/recover hysteresis
Low-voltage inhibit reset recovery
(VREC1 = VLVR1 + VLVH1)
VLVR1
4.0
4.35
4.65
V
VLVH1
40
90
150
mV
VREC1
4.04
4.5
4.75
V
Low-voltage inhibit reset
VLVR2
3.85
4.15
4.45
V
Low-voltage reset/recover hysteresis
Low-voltage inhibit reset recovery
(VREC2 = VLVR2 + VLVH2)
VLVH2
150
210
250
mV
VREC2
4.0
4.4
4.6
V
VPOR
0
—
100
mV
RPOR
0.035
—
—
V/ms
VPORRST
0
VDD + 2.5
700
800
VDD + Hi
V
POR re-arm voltage (6)
POR rise time ramp
POR reset voltage
rate(8)
Monitor mode entry voltage (on IRQ)
VHi
—
V
1. VDD = 5.0 Vdc ± 10%, V SS = 0 Vdc, T A = TL to TH, unless otherwise noted
2. Typical values reflect average measurements at midpoint of voltage range, 25°C only.
3. Run (operating) IDD measured using external square wave clock source (fOSC = 8.2 MHz). All inputs 0.2 V from rail; no
dc loads; less than 100 pF on all outputs. CL = 20 pF on OSC2; all ports configured as inputs; OSC2 capacitance linearly
affects run IDD; measured with all modules enabled
4. Wait IDD measured using external square wave clock source (fOSC = 8.2 MHz); all inputs 0.2 V from rail; no dc loads;
less than 100 pF on all outputs. C L = 20 pF on OSC2; all ports configured as inputs; OSC2 capacitance linearly affects
wait IDD; measured with PLL and LVI enabled
5. Stop IDD measured with PLL and LVI disengaged, OCS1 grounded, no port pins sourcing current. It is measured
through combination of VDD, VDDAD, and VDDA.
6. Maximum is highest voltage that POR is guaranteed.
7. Maximum is highest voltage that POR is possible.
8. If minimum VDD is not reached before the internal POR is released, RST must be driven low externally until
minimum VDD is reached.
9. The low-voltage inhibit reset is software selectable. Refer to Section 18. Low-Voltage Inhibit (LVI).
Advance Information
372
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Electrical Specifications
MOTOROLA
Electrical Specifications
FLASH Memory Characteristics
22.7 FLASH Memory Characteristics
Symbol/
Description
Min
Max
Units
VRDR
1.3
—
V
—
1
—
MHz
FLASH read bus clock frequency
fRead(1)
32 k
8.4 M
Hz
FLASH page erase time
tErase(2)
1
—
ms
FLASH mass erase time
tMErase(3)
4
—
ms
FLASH PGM/Erase to HVEN set up time
tNVS
10
—
µs
FLASH high-voltage hold time
tNVH
5
—
µs
FLASH high-voltage hold time (mass erase)
tNVHL
100
—
µs
FLASH program hold time
tPGS
5
—
µs
FLASH program time
tPROG
30
40
µs
FLASH return to read time
tRCV(4)
1
—
µs
FLASH cumulative program HV period
tHV(5)
—
4
ms
FLASH row erase endurance(6)
—
10 k
—
Cycles
FLASH row program endurance(7)
—
10 k
—
Cycles
FLASH data retention time(8)
—
10
—
Years
Characteristic
RAM data retention voltage
FLASH program bus clock frequency
1. fRead is defined as the frequency range for which the FLASH memory can be read.
2. If the page erase time is longer than tErase (min), there is no erase-disturb, but it reduces the endurance of the FLASH
memory.
3. If the mass erase time is longer than tMErase (min), there is no erase-disturb, but it reduces the endurance of the FLASH
memory.
4. tRCV is defined as the time it needs before the FLASH can be read after turning off the high voltage charge pump, by clearing HVEN to logic 0.
5. tHV is defined as the cumulative high voltage programming time to the same row before next erase.
tHV must satisfy this condition: tNVS + tNVH + tPGS + (tPROG × 64) ≤ tHV max.
6. The minimum row endurance value specifies each row of the FLASH memory is guaranteed to work for at
least this many erase/program cycles.
7. The minimum row endurance value specifies each row of the FLASH memory is guaranteed to work for at
least this many erase/program cycles.
8. The FLASH is guaranteed to retain data over the entire operating temperature range for at least the minimum
time specified.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Electrical Specifications
Advance Information
373
Electrical Specifications
22.8 Control Timing (VDD = 5.0 Vdc ± 10%)
Characteristic(1)
Symbol
Min
Max
Unit
Frequency of operation(2)
Crystal option
External clock option(3)
fOSC
1
dc(4)
8
32.8
MHz
Internal operating frequency
fOP
—
8.2
MHz
RESET input pulse width low(5)
tIRL
50
—
ns
1. VSS = 0 Vdc; timing shown with respect to 20% VDD and 70% V DD, unless otherwise noted
2. See 22.9 Serial Peripheral Interface Characteristics (VDD = 5.0 Vdc ± 10%) for more information.
3. No more than 10% duty cycle deviation from 50%.
4. Some modules may require a minimum frequency greater than dc for proper operation; see appropriate table for this
information.
5. Minimum pulse width reset is guaranteed to be recognized. It is possible for a smaller pulse width to cause a reset.
Advance Information
374
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Electrical Specifications
MOTOROLA
Electrical Specifications
Serial Peripheral Interface Characteristics (VDD = 5.0 Vdc ± 10%)
22.9 Serial Peripheral Interface Characteristics (VDD = 5.0 Vdc ± 10%)
Diagram
Number(1)
Characteristic(2)
Symbol
Min
Max
Unit
Operating frequency
Master
Slave
fOP(M)
fOP(S)
fOP/128
fOP/2
fOP
MHz
dc
1
Cycle time
Master
Slave
tCYC(M)
tCYC(S)
2
1
128
—
tCYC
2
Enable lead time
tLead(S)
15
—
ns
3
Enable lag time
tLag(S)
15
—
ns
4
Clock (SPCK) high time
Master
Slave
tSCKH(M)
tSCKH(S)
100
50
—
—
ns
5
Clock (SPCK) low time
Master
Slave
tSCKL(M)
tSCKL(S)
100
50
—
—
ns
6
Data setup time (inputs)
Master
Slave
tSU(M)
tSU(S)
45
5
—
—
ns
7
Data hold time (inputs)
Master
Slave
tH(M)
tH(S)
0
15
—
—
ns
8
Access time, slave(3)
CPHA = 0
CHPA = 1
tA(CP0)
tA(CP1)
0
0
40
20
ns
9
Disable time, slave(4)
tDIS(S)
—
25
ns
10
Data valid time after enable edge
Master
Slave(5)
tV(M)
tV(S)
—
—
10
40
ns
1. All timing is shown with respect to 20% VDD and 70% VDD, unless otherwise noted; assumes 100 pF load on all SPI pins
2. Numbers refer to dimensions in Figure 22-1 and Figure 22-2.
3. Time to data active from high-impedance state
4. Hold time to high-impedance state
5. With 100 pF on all SPI pins
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Electrical Specifications
Advance Information
375
Electrical Specifications
SS
INPUT
SS PIN OF MASTER HELD HIGH
1
SPCK, CPOL = 0
OUTPUT
NOTE
SPCK, CPOL = 1
OUTPUT
NOTE
5
4
5
4
6
MISO
INPUT
MSB IN
BITS 6–1
10
11
MOSI
OUTPUT
MASTER MSB OUT
7
LSB IN
10
11
BITS 6–1
MASTER LSB OUT
Note: This first clock edge is generated internally, but is not seen at the SCK pin.
a) SPI Master Timing (CPHA = 0)
SS
INPUT
SS PIN OF MASTER HELD HIGH
1
SPCK, CPOL = 0
OUTPUT
SPCK, CPOL = 1
OUTPUT
5
NOTE
4
5
NOTE
4
6
MISO
INPUT
10
MOSI
OUTPUT
MSB IN
BITS 6–1
11
MASTER MSB OUT
7
LSB IN
10
BITS 6–1
11
MASTER LSB OUT
Note: This last clock edge is generated internally, but is not seen at the SCK pin.
b) SPI Master Timing (CPHA = 1)
Figure 22-1. SPI Master Timing
Advance Information
376
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Electrical Specifications
MOTOROLA
Electrical Specifications
Serial Peripheral Interface Characteristics (VDD = 5.0 Vdc ± 10%)
SS
INPUT
3
1
SPCK, CPOL = 0
INPUT
11
5
4
2
SPCK, CPOL = 1
INPUT
5
4
9
8
MISO
INPUT
SLAVE
MSB OUT
6
MOSI
OUTPUT
BITS 6–1
7
NOTE
11
11
10
MSB IN
SLAVE LSB OUT
BITS 6–1
LSB IN
Note: Not defined, but normally MSB of character just received
a) SPI Slave Timing (CPHA = 0)
SS
INPUT
1
SPCK, CPOL = 0
INPUT
5
4
2
3
SPCK, CPOL = 1
INPUT
8
MISO
INPUT
MOSI
OUTPUT
5
4
10
NOTE
9
SLAVE
MSB OUT
6
7
BITS 6–1
11
10
MSB IN
SLAVE LSB OUT
BITS 6–1
LSB IN
Note: Not defined, but normally LSB of character previously transmitted
b) SPI Slave Timing (CPHA = 1)
Figure 22-2. SPI Slave Timing
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Electrical Specifications
Advance Information
377
Electrical Specifications
22.10 TImer Interface Module Characteristics
Characteristic
Input capture pulse width
Input clock pulse width
Symbol
Min
Max
Unit
tTIH, tTIL
125
—
ns
tTCH, tTCL
(1/fOP) + 5
—
ns
22.11 Clock Generation Module Component Specifications
Characteristic
Symbol
Min
Typ
Max
Notes
Crystal load capacitance
CL
—
—
—
Consult crystal
manufacturing data
Crystal fixed capacitance
C1
—
2 * CL
—
Consult crystal
manufacturing data
Crystal tuning capacitance
C2
—
2 * CL
—
Consult crystal
manufacturing data
Feedback bias resistor
RB
—
22 MΩ
—
Series resistor
RS
0
330 kΩ
1 MΩ
Filter capacitor
CF
—
CFACT*
(VDDA/fXCLK)
—
Bypass capacitor
CBYP
0.1 µF
—
—
Not required
C BYP must provide low ac
impedance from
f = fXCLK/100 to 100*fVCLK,
so series resistance must
be considered
22.12 CGM Operating Conditions
Characteristic
Symbol
Min
Typ
Max
Unit
Crystal reference frequency
fXCLK
1
—
8
MHz
Range nominal multiplier
fNOM
—
4.9152
—
MHz
VCO center-of-range frequency
fVRS
4.9152
—
32.8
MHz
VCO frequency multiplier
N
1
—
15
—
VCO center of range multiplier
L
1
—
15
—
fVCLK
fVRSMIN
—
fVRSMAX
—
VCO operating frequency
Advance Information
378
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Electrical Specifications
MOTOROLA
Electrical Specifications
CGM Acquisition/Lock Time Specifications
22.13 CGM Acquisition/Lock Time Specifications
Description
Symbol
Min
Typ
Max
Notes
Filter capacitor multiply factor
CFACT
—
0.0154
—
F/sV
Acquisition mode time factor
KACQ
—
0.1135
—
V
Tracking mode time factor
KTRK
—
0.0174
—
V
Manual mode time to stable
tACQ
—
(8*VDDA)/
(fXCLK*KACQ)
—
If C F chosen
correctly
tAL
—
(4*VDDA)/
(fXCLK*KTRK)
—
If C F chosen
correctly
Manual acquisition time
tLock
—
tACQ+tAL
—
Tracking mode entry frequency
tolerance
∆TRK
0
—
±3.6%
Acquisition mode entry frequency
tolerance
∆ACQ
±6.3%
—
±7.2%
Lock entry frequency tolerance
∆Lock
0
—
±0.9%
Lock exit frequency tolerance
∆UNL
±0.9%
—
±1.8%
Reference cycles per acquisition
mode measurement
nACQ
—
32
—
Reference cycles per tracking
mode measurement
nTRK
—
128
—
Automatic mode time to stable
tACQ
nACQ/fXCLK
(8*VDDA)/
(fXCLK*KACQ)
—
If C F chosen
correctly
tAL
nTRK/fXCLK
(4*VDDA)/
(fXCLK*KTRK)
—
If C F chosen
correctly
tLock
—
tACQ+tAL
—
fJ
0
—
± (fXCLK)
*(0.025%)
*(N/4)
Manual stable to lock time
Automatic stable to lock time
Automatic lock time
PLL jitter (deviation of average bus
frequency over 2 ms)
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Electrical Specifications
N = VCO
freq. mult.
Advance Information
379
Electrical Specifications
22.14 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC) Characteristics
Characteristic
Symbol
Min
Typ
Max
Unit
Notes
Supply voltage
VDDAD
4.5
—
5.5
V
VDDAD should be tied
to the same potential
as VDD via separate
traces
Input voltages
VADIN
0
—
VDDAD
V
VADIN <= VDDAD
Resolution
BAD
10
—
10
Bits
Absolute accuracy
AAD
—
—
±4
Counts
Includes quantization
ADC internal clock
fADIC
500 k
—
1.048 M
Hz
tAIC = 1/fADIC
Conversion range
RAD
VSSAD
—
VDDAD
V
Power-up time
tADPU
16
—
—
tAIC cycles
Conversion time
tADC
16
—
17
tAIC cycles
Sample time
tADS
5
—
—
tAIC cycles
Monotonicity
MAD
Zero input reading
ZADI
000
—
003
Hex
VADIN = VSSAD
Full-scale reading
FADI
3FC
—
3FF
Hex
VADIN = VDDAD
Input capacitance
CADI
—
—
30
pF
Not tested
VREFH/VREFL current
IVREF
—
1.6
—
mA
Absolute accuracy
(8-bit truncation mode)
AAD
—
—
±1
LSB
Quantization error
(8-bit truncation mode)
—
—
—
+7/8
–1/8
LSB
Advance Information
380
Guaranteed
Includes quantization
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Electrical Specifications
MOTOROLA
Advance Information — MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32
Section 23. Mechanical Specifications
23.1 Contents
23.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 381
23.3
64-Pin Plastic Quad Flat Pack (QFP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .382
23.4
56-Pin Shrink Dual In-Line Package (SDIP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .383
23.2 Introduction
This section gives the dimensions for the 64-lead plastic quad flat pack
(QFP) and 56-pin shrink dual in-line package (SDIP).
Figure 23-1 and Figure 23-2 show the latest package at the time of this
publication. To make sure that you have the latest package
specifications, contact one of the following:
•
Local Motorola Sales Office
•
World Wide Web at http://www.motorola.com/semiconductors/
Follow the World Wide Web on-line instructions to retrieve the current
mechanical specifications.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Mechanical Specifications
Advance Information
381
Mechanical Specifications
23.3 64-Pin Plastic Quad Flat Pack (QFP)
L
48
33
49
DETAIL A
S
D
S
H A-B
D
V
P
B
M
B
B
0.20 (0.008)
L
0.20 (0.008) M C A-B
0.05 (0.002) A-B
-B-
-A-
S
S
32
-A-, -B-, DDETAIL A
17
64
1
F
16
-DA
0.20 (0.008) M C A-B
0.05 (0.002) A-B
0.20 (0.008)
M
S
H A-B
S
S
D
S
D
S
J
N
BASE METAL
M
E
DETAIL C
D
0.20 (0.008)
C
-H-
-CH
SEATING
PLANE
M
G
U
T
R
DATUM
PLANE
-HQ
K
W
X
DETAIL C
DATUM
PLANE
M
C A-B
S
D
S
SECTION B-B
0.01 (0.004)
NOTES:
1. DIMENSIONING AND TOLERANCING PER ANSI
Y14.5M, 1982.
2. CONTROLLING DIMENSION: MILLIMETER.
3. DATUM PLANE ĆHĆ IS LOCATED AT BOTTOM OF
LEAD AND IS COINCIDENT WITH THE LEAD WHERE
THE LEAD EXITS THE PLASTIC BODY AT THE
BOTTOM OF THE PARTING LINE.
4. DATUMS A-B AND ĆDĆ TO BE DETERMINED AT
DATUM PLANE ĆHĆ.
5. DIMENSIONS S AND V TO BE DETERMINED AT
SEATING PLANE ĆCĆ.
6. DIMENSIONS A AND B DO NOT INCLUDE MOLD
PROTRUSION. ALLOWABLE PROTRUSION IS 0.25
(0.010) PER SIDE. DIMENSIONS A AND B DO
INCLUDE MOLD MISMATCH AND ARE DETERMINED
AT DATUM PLANE ĆHĆ.
7. DIMENSION D DOES NOT INCLUDE DAMBAR
PROTRUSION. ALLOWABLE DAMBAR PROTRUSION
SHALL BE 0.08 (0.003) TOTAL IN EXCESS OF THE D
DIMENSION AT MAXIMUM MATERIAL CONDITION.
DAMBAR CANNOT BE LOCATED ON THE LOWER
RADIUS OR THE FOOT.
DIM
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
J
K
L
M
N
P
Q
R
S
T
U
V
W
X
MILLIMETERS
MIN
MAX
13.90 14.10
13.90 14.10
2.45
2.15
0.45
0.30
2.40
2.00
0.40
0.30
0.80 BSC
0.25
Ċ
0.23
0.13
0.95
0.65
12.00 REF
10°
5°
0.17
0.13
0.40 BSC
7°
0°
0.30
0.13
16.95 17.45
Ċ
0.13
Ċ
0°
16.95 17.45
0.45
0.35
1.6 REF
INCHES
MIN
MAX
0.547 0.555
0.547 0.555
0.085 0.096
0.012 0.018
0.079 0.094
0.012 0.016
0.031 BSC
Ċ
0.010
0.005 0.009
0.026 0.037
0.472 REF
5°
10°
0.005 0.007
0.016 BSC
0°
7°
0.005 0.012
0.667 0.687
0.005
Ċ
0°
Ċ
0.667 0.687
0.014 0.018
0.063 REF
Figure 23-1. MC68HC908MR32FU
Advance Information
382
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Mechanical Specifications
MOTOROLA
Mechanical Specifications
56-Pin Shrink Dual In-Line Package (SDIP)
23.4 56-Pin Shrink Dual In-Line Package (SDIP)
–A–
56
NOTES:
1. DIMENSIONING AND TOLERANCING PER ANSI
Y14.5M, 1982.
2. CONTROLLING DIMENSION: INCH.
3. DIMENSION L TO CENTER OF LEAD WHEN
FORMED PARALLEL.
4. DIMENSIONS A AND B DO NOT INCLUDE MOLD
FLASH. MAXIMUM MOLD FLASH 0.25 (0.010)
29
–B–
1
28
L
H
C
–T–
K
SEATING
PLANE
D 56 PL
0.25 (0.010)
N
G
F
E
M
T A
J
S
M
56 PL
0.25 (0.010)
M
T B
DIM
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
J
K
L
M
N
INCHES
MIN
MAX
2.035
2.065
0.540
0.560
0.155
0.200
0.014
0.022
0.035 BSC
0.032
0.046
0.070 BSC
0.300 BSC
0.008
0.015
0.115
0.135
0.600 BSC
0_
15 _
0.020
0.040
MILLIMETERS
MIN
MAX
51.69
52.45
13.72
14.22
3.94
5.08
0.36
0.56
0.89 BSC
0.81
1.17
1.778 BSC
7.62 BSC
0.20
0.38
2.92
3.43
15.24 BSC
0_
15 _
0.51
1.02
S
Figure 23-2. MC68HC908MR32B
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Mechanical Specifications
Advance Information
383
Mechanical Specifications
Advance Information
384
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Mechanical Specifications
MOTOROLA
Advance Information — MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32
Section 24. Ordering Information
24.1 Contents
24.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 385
24.3
Order Numbers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 385
24.2 Introduction
This section contains instructions for ordering the MC68HC908MR16
and MC68HC908MR32.
24.3 Order Numbers
Table 24-1. Order Numbers
MC Order Number(1)
Operating
Temperature Range
68HC908MR16CFU
68HC908MR16VFU
–40°C to +85°C
–40°C to +105°C
68HC908MR16CB
68HC908MR16VB
–40°C to +85°C
–40°C to +105°C
68HC908MR32CFU
68HC908MR32VFU
–40°C to +85°C
–40°C to +105°C
68HC908MR32CB
68HC908MR32VB
–40°C to +85°C
–40°C to +105°C
1. FU = quad flat pack
B = shrink dual in-line package
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
Ordering Information
Advance Information
385
Ordering Information
Advance Information
386
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
Ordering Information
MOTOROLA
Advance Information — MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32
Appendix A. MC68HC908MR16
A.1 Contents
A.2
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 387
A.3
Memory Map. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 388
A.2 Introduction
The information contained in this document pertains to the
MC68HC908MR16 with the except of that shown in Figure A-1.
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MOTOROLA
MC68HC908MR16
Advance Information
387
MC68HC908MR16
A.3 Memory Map
$0000
↓
$005F
$0060
↓
$035F
$0360
↓
$7FFF
$8000
↓
$BEFF
$BF00
↓
$FDFF
$FE00
$FE01
$FE02
$FE03
$FE04
$FE05
$FE06
$FE07
$FE08
$FE09
$FE0A
$FE0B
$FE0C
$FE0D
$FE0E
$FE0F
$FE10
↓
$FEFF
$FF00
↓
$FF7D
$FF7E
$FF7F
↓
$FFD1
$FFD2
↓
$FFFF
I/O REGISTERS — 96 BYTES
RAM — 768 BYTES
UNIMPLEMENTED — 31,904 BYTES
FLASH — 16,128 BYTES
UNIMPLEMENTED — 16,128 BYTES
SIM BREAK STATUS REGISTER (SBSR)
SIM RESET STATUS REGISTER (SRSR)
RESERVED
SIM BREAK FLAG CONTROL REGISTER (SBFCR)
RESERVED
RESERVED
RESERVED
RESERVED
FLASH CONTROL REGISTER (FLCR)
UNIMPLEMENTED
UNIMPLEMENTED
UNIMPLEMENTED
SIM BREAK ADDRESS REGISTER HIGH (BRKH)
SIM BREAK ADDRESS REGISTER LOW (BRKL)
SIM BREAK FLAG CONTROL REGISTER (SBFCR)
LVI STATUS AND CONTROL REGISTER (LVISCR)
MONITOR ROM — 240 BYTES
UNIMPLEMENTED — 126 BYTES
FLASH BLOCK PROTECT REGISTER (FLBPR)
UNIMPLEMENTED — 83 BYTES
VECTORS — 46 BYTES
Figure A-1. MC68HC908MR16 Memory Map
Advance Information
388
MC68HC908MR16/MC68HC908MR32 — Rev. 5.0
MC68HC908MR16
MOTOROLA
blank
USA/EUROPE/LOCATIONS NOT LISTED:
Motorola Literature Distribution
P.O. Box 5405
Denver, Colorado 80217
1-303-675-2140
1-800-441-2447
TECHNICAL INFORMATION CENTER:
1-800-521-6274
JAPAN:
Motorola Japan Ltd.
SPS, Technical Information Center
3-20-1, Minami-Azabu, Minato-ku
Tokyo 106-8573 Japan
81-3-3440-3569
MC68HC08AS60 Technical Data
How to Reach Us:
ASIA/PACIFIC:
Motorola Semiconductors H.K. Ltd.
Silicon Harbour Centre
2 Dai King Street
Tai Po Industrial Estate
Tai Po, N.T., Hong Kong
852-26668334
HOME PAGE:
http://www.motorola.com/semiconductors/
MC68HC908MR32/D
REV 5
Q4/00
REV 1
This datasheet has been download from:
www.datasheetcatalog.com
Datasheets for electronics components.